Автор: Truesdell C.  

Теги: physics   encyclopedia  

ISBN: 3-540-05535-5

Год: 1972

Текст
                    ENCYCLOPEDIA OF PHYSICS
CHIEF EDITOR
S. FLUGGE
VOLUME VIa/2
MECHANICS OF SOLIDS II
EDITOR
C. TRUESDELL
WITH 15 FIGURES
SPRINGER-VERLAG
BERLIN • HEIDELBERG • NEWYORK
1972


HANDBUCH DER PHYSIK HERAUSGEGEBEN VON S. FLUGGE BAND VIa/2 FESTKORPERMECHANIK II BANDHERAUSGEBER C.TRUESDELL MIT 25 FIG U REN SPRINGER-VERLAG BERLIN • HEIDELBERG • NEW YORK 1972
ISBN 3-540-05535-5 Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg New York ISBN 0-387-05535-5 Springer-Verlag New York Heidelberg Berlin Das Werk ist urheberrechtlich geschiitzt. Die dadurch begrtindeten Rechte, insbesondere die der Ober- setzung, des Nachdruckes, der Entnahme von Abbildungen, der Funksendung, der Wiedergabe auf photomechanischem oder ahnlichem Wege und der Speicherung in Datenverarbeitungsanlagen bleiben auch bei nur auszugsweiser Verwertung, vorbehalten. Bei Vervielfaltigungen fur gewerbliche Zwecke ist gemaB § 54 UrhG eine Vergiitung an den Verlag zu zahlen, deren Hohe mit dem Verlag zu verein- baren ist. © by Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg 1972. Library of Congress Catalog Card Number A 56-2942. Printed in Germany. Satz, Druck und Bindearbeiten: Universitatsdruckerei H. Stiirtz AG, Wurzburg. Die Wiedergabe von Gebrauchsnamen, Handelsnamen, Warenbezeichnungfen usw. in diesem Werk berechtigt auch ohne besondere Kennzeichnung nicht zu der Annahme, daB solche Namen im Sinne der Warenzeichen- und Markenschutz-Gesetzgebung als frei zu betrachten waren und daher von jeder- mann benutzt werden diirften.
Contents. The Linear Theory of Elasticity. By Morton E. Gurtin, Professor of Mathematics, Carnegie-Mellon University, Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania (USA). (With 18 Figures) . l A. Introduction 1 1. Background. Nature of this treatise 1 2. Terminology and general scheme of notation 2 B. Mathematical preliminaries 5 I. Tensor analysis 5 3. Points. Vectors. Second-order tensors 5 4. Scalar fields. Vector fields. Tensor fields 10 II. Elements of potential theory 12 5. The body B. The subsurfaces Sfx and ^ of 8B 12 6. The divergence theorem. Stokes' theorem 16 7. The fundamental lemma. Rellich's lemma 19 8. Harmonic and biharmonic fields 20 III. Functions of position and time 24 9. Class C^.^ 24 10. Convolutions 25 11. Space-time 27 C. Formulation of the linear theory of elasticity 28 I. Kinematics 28 \12. Finite deformations. Infinitesimal deformations 28 v 13. Properties of displacement fields. Strain 31 vl4. Compatibility 39 II. Balance of momentum. The equations of motion and equilibrium .... 42 15. Balance of momentum. Stress 42 16. Balance of momentum for finite motions 51 \l7. General solutions of the equations of equilibrium 53 V 18. Consequences of the equation of equilibrium 59 \ 19. Consequences of the equation of motion 64 III. The constitutive relation for linearly elastic materials 67 ^0 . The elasticity tensor 67 \21 . Material symmetry 69 v 22. Isotropic materials 74 v 23. The constitutive assumption for finite elasticity 80 * 24. Work theorems. Stored energy 81 \25. Strong ellipticity 86 \j26. Anisotropic materials 87 D. Elastostatics 89 I. The fundamental field equations. Elastic states. Work and energy .... 89 27. The fundamental system of field equations 89 28. Elastic states. Work and energy 94 II. The reciprocal theorem. Mean strain theorems 96 29. Mean strain and mean stress theorems. Volume change 96 30. The reciprocal theorem 98
[ Contents. III. Boundary-value problems. Uniqueness 102 31. The boundary-value problems of elastostatics 102 32. Uniqueness 104 33. Nonexistence 109 \ IV. The variational principles of elastostatics 110 34. Minimum principles 110 35- Some extensions of the fundamental lemma 115 36. Converses to the minimum principles 116 37- Maximum principles 120 38. Variational principles 122 39. Convergence of approximate solutions 125 V. The general boundary-value problem. The contact problem 129 40. Statement of the problem. Uniqueness 129 41. Extension of the minimum principles 130 VI. Homogeneous and isotropic bodies 131 42. Properties of elastic displacement fields 131 43. The mean value theorem 133 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium .... 138 VII. The plane problem 150 45- The associated plane strain and generalized plane stress solutions . . .150 46. Plane elastic states 154 47- Airy's solution 1 56 VIII. Exterior domains 165 48. Representation of elastic displacement fields in a neighborhood of infinity 165 49. Behavior of elastic states at infinity 167 50. Extension of the basic theorems in elastostatics to exterior domains . . 169 IX. Basic singular solutions. Concentrated loads. Green's functions 173 51. Basic singular solutions 173 52. Concentrated loads. The reciprocal theorem 179 53. Integral representation of solutions to concentrated-load problems . . 185 X. Saint-Venant's principle 190 54. The v. Mises-Sternberg version of Saint-Venant's principle 190 55. Toupin's version of Saint-Venant's principle 196 56. Knowles' version of Saint-Venant's principle 200 56a. The Zanaboni-Robinson version of Saint-Venant's principle 206 XI. Miscellaneous results 207 57- Some further results for homogeneous and isotropic bodies 207 58. Incompressible materials 210 E. Elastodynamics 212 I. The fundamental field equations. Elastic processes. Power and energy. Reciprocity 212 59. The fundamental system of field equations 212 60. Elastic processes. Power and energy 21 5 61. Graffi's reciprocal theorem 218 II. Boundary-initial-value problems. Uniqueness 219 62. The boundary-initial-value problem of elastodynamics 219 63. Uniqueness 222 III. Variational principles 223 64. Some further extensions of the fundamental lemma 223 65. Variational principles 225 66. Minimum principles 230 IV. Homogeneous and isotropic bodies 232 67. Complete solutions of the field equations 232 68. Basic singular solutions 239 69. Love's integral identity 242
Contents. VII V. Wave propagation 243 70. The acoustic tensor 243 71. Progressive waves 245 72. Propagating surfaces. Surfaces of discontinuity 248 73. Shock waves. Acceleration waves. Mild discontinuities 253 74. Domain of influence. Uniqueness for infinite regions 257 VI. The free vibration problem 261 75. Basic equations 261 76. Characteristic solutions. Minimum principles 262 77. The minimax principle and its consequences 268 78. Completeness of the characteristic solutions 270 References 273 Linear Thermoelasticity. By Professor Donald E. Carlson, Department of Theoretical and Applied Mechanics, University of Illinois, Urbana, Illinois (USA) 297 A. Introduction 297 1. The nature of this article 297 2. Notation 297 B. The foundations of the linear theory of thermoelasticity 299 3. The basic laws of mechanics and thermodynamics 299 4. Elastic materials. Consequences of the second law 301 5. The principle of material frame-indifference 305 6. Consequences of the heat conduction inequality 307 7. Derivation of the linear theory 307 8. Isotropy 311 C. Equilibrium theory 312 9. Basic equations. Thermoelastic states 312 10. Mean strain and mean stress. Volume change 314 11. The body force analogy 316 12. Sptecial results for homogeneous and isotropic bodies 317 13. The theorem of work and energy. The reciprocal theorem 319 14. The boundary-value problems of the equilibrium theory. Uniqueness .... 320 15. Temperature fields that induce displacement free and stress free states . . . 322 16. Minimum principles 323 17. The uncoupled-quasi-static theory 325 D. Dynamic theory 326 18. Basic equations. Thermoelastic processes 326 19. Special results for homogeneous and isotropic bodies 327 20. Complete solutions of the field equations 329 21. The theorem of power and energy. The reciprocal theorem .: 331 22. The boundary-initial-value problems of the dynamic theory 335 23. Uniqueness 337 24. Variational principles 338 25. Progressive waves 342 List of works cited 343 Existence Theorems in Elasticity. By Professor Gaetano Fichbra, University of Rome, Rome (Italy) 347 1. Prerequisites and notations • 348 0 2. The function spaces Hm and Hm 349 3. Elliptic linear systems. Interior regularity 355 4. Results preparatory to the regularization at the boundary 357 5. Strongly elliptic systems 365 6. General existence theorems 368 7. Propagation problems 371 8. Diffusion problems 373 9. Integro-differential equations 373 10. Classical boundary value problems for a scalar 2nd order elliptic operator .... 374 11. Equilibrium of a thin plate 377
VIII Contents. 12. Boundary value problems of equilibrium in linear elasticity 380 13. Equilibrium problems for heterogeneous media 386 Bibliography 388 Boundary Value Problems of Elasticity with Unilateral Constraints. By Professor Gaetano Fichera, University of Rome, Rome (Italy) 391 1. Abstract unilateral problems: the symmetric case 391 2. Abstract unilateral problems: the nonsymmetric case 395 3. Unilateral problems for elliptic operators 399 4. General definition for the convex set V 401 5. Unilateral problems for an elastic body 402 6. Other examples of unilateral problems 404 7. Existence theorem for the generalized Signorini problem 407 8. Regularization theorem: interior regularity 408 9. Regularization theorem: regularity near the boundary 411 10. Analysis of the Signorini problem 413 11. Historical and bibliographical remarks concerning Existence Theorems in Elasticity 418 Bibliography 423 The Theory of Shells and Plates. By P. M. Naghdi, Professor of Engineering Science, University of California, Berkeley, California (USA). (With 2 Figures) 425 A. Introduction 425 1. Preliminary remarks 425 2. Scope and contents 429 3. Notation and a list of symbols used 431 B. Kinematics of shells and plates 438 4. Coordinate systems. Definitions. Preliminary remarks 438 5. Kinematics of shells: I. Direct approach 449 a) General kinematical results 449 /S) Superposed rigid body motions 452 y) Additional kinematics 455 6. Kinematics of shells continued (linear theory): I. Direct approach 456 8) Linearized kinematics 456 e) A catalogue of linear kinematic measures 458 £) Additional linear kinematic formulae 461 rj) Compatibility equations 463 7. Kinematics of shells: II. Developments from the three-dimensional theory . . 466 a) General kinematical results 466 (}) Some results valid in a reference configuration 471 y) Linearized kinematics 473 <5) Approximate linearized kinematic measures 476 e) Other kinematic approximations in the linear theory 477 C. Basic principles for shells and plates 479 8. Basic principles for shells: I. Direct approach 479 a) Conservation laws 479 (}) Entropy production 483 y) Invariance conditions 484 8) An alternative statement of the conservation laws 487 e) Conservation laws in terms of field quantities in a reference state .... 490 9. Derivation of the basic field equations for shells: I. Direct approach .... 492 a) General field equations in vector forms 492 /S) Alternative forms of the field equations 498 y) Linearized field equations 500 8) The basic field equations in terms of a reference state 502 10. Derivation of the basic field equations of a restricted theory: I. Direct approach 503 11. Basic field equations for shells: II. Derivation from the three-dimensional theory 508 a) Some preliminary results 508 /S) Stress-resultants, stress-couples and other resultants for shells 512 y) Developments from the energy equation. Entropy inequalities 515
Contents. IX 12. Basic field equations for shells continued: II. Derivation from the three- dimensional theory 519 <5) General field equations 519 e) An approximate system of equations of motion 522 £) Linearized field equations 523 rj) Relationship with results in the classical linear theory of thin shells and plates 524 12 A. Appendix on the history of derivations of the equations of equilibrium for shells 527 D. Elastic shells 528 13. Constitutive equations for elastic shells (nonlinear theory): I. Direct approach 528 a) General considerations. Thermodynamical results 529 /3) Reduction of the constitutive equations under superposed rigid body motions 534 y) Material symmetry restrictions 537 <5) Alternative forms of the constitutive equations 540 14. The complete theory. Special results: I. Direct approach 544 a) The boundary-value problem in the general theory 544 fl) Constitutive equations in a mechanical theory 544 y) Some special results 546 8) Special theories 546 15. The complete restricted theory: I. Direct approach 549 16. Linear constitutive equations: I. Direct approach 553 a) General considerations 553 /3) Explicit results for linear constitutive equations 555 y) A restricted form of the constitutive equations for an isotropic material . 557 8) Constitutive equations of the restricted linear theory 560 17. The complete theory for thermoelastic shells: II. Derivation from the three- dimensional theory 561 a) Constitutive equations in terms of two-dimensional variables. Thermodynamical results 561 f}) Summary of the basic equations in a complete theory 565 18. Approximation for thin shells: II. Developments from the three-dimensional theory 566 a) An approximation procedure 566 /3) Approximation in the linear theory 568 19. An alternative approximation procedure in the linear theory: II. Developments from the three-dimensional theory 569 20. Explicit constitutive equations for approximate linear theories of plates and shells: II. Developments from the three-dimensional theory 572 a) Approximate constitutive equations for plates 572 f}) The classical plate theory. Additional remarks 575 y) Approximate constitutive relations for thin shells 578 8) Classical shell theory. Additional remarks 580 21. Further remarks on the approximate linear and nonlinear theories developed from the three-dimensional equations 585 21 A. Appendix on the history of the derivation of linear constitutive equations for thin elastic shells 589 22. Relationship of results from the three-dimensional theory and the theory of Cosserat surface 594 E. Linear theory of elastic plates and shells 595 23. The boundary-value problem in the linear theory 596 a) Elastic plates 596 /3) Elastic shells 597 24. Determination of the constitutive coefficients 598 a) The constitutive coefficients for plates 598 /3) The constitutive coefficients for shells 606 25. The boundary-value problem of the restricted linear theory 607 26. A uniqueness theorem. Remarks on the general theorems 610 I b Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2.
X Contents. F. Appendix: Geometry of a surface and related results 615 A. 1. Geometry of Euclidean space 615 A.2. Some results from the differential geometry of a surface 621 a) Definition of a surface. Preliminaries 621 /3) First and second fundamental forms 623 y) Covariant derivatives. The curvature tensor 624 6) Formulae of Weingarten and Gauss. Integrability conditions 625 e) Principal curvatures. Lines of curvature 627 A. 3. Geometry of a surface in a Euclidean space covered by normal coordinates . 628 A.4. Physical components of surface tensors in lines of curvature coordinates . . 631 References 633 The Theory of Rods. By Professor Stuart S. Antman, New York University, New York (USA). (With 5 Figures) 641 A. Introduction 641 1. Definition and purpose of rod theories. Nature of this article 641 2. Notation 642 3. Background 643 B. Formation of rod theories 646 I. Approximation of three-dimensional equations 646 4. Nature of the approximation process 646 5. Representation of position and logarithmic temperature 647 6. Moments of the fundamental equations 649 7. Approximation of the fundamental equations 652 8. Constitutive relations 654 9. Thermo-elastic rods 656 10. Statement of the boundary value problems 658 11. Validity of the projection methods 660 12. History of the use of projection methods for the construction of rod theories 663 13. Asymptotic methods 664 II. Director theories of rods 665 14. Definition of a Cosserat rod 665 15. Field equations 666 16. Constitutive equations 669 III. Planar problems 670 17. The governing equations 670 18. Boundary conditions 674 C. Problems for nonlinearly elastic rods 676 19. Existence 676 20. Variational formulation of the equilibrium problems 676 21. Statement of theorems 680 22. Proofs of the theorems 682 23. Straight and circular rods 690 24. Uniqueness theorems 692 25. Buckled states 694 26. Integrals of the equilibrium equations. Qualitative behavior of solutions . 696 27. Problems of design 698 28. Dynamical problems 699 References 700 Namenverzeichnis. — Author Index 705 Sachverzeichnis (Deutsch-Englisch) 711 Subject Index (English-German) 729
The Linear Theory of Elasticity. By Morton E. Gurtin. With 18 Figures. Dedicated, to Eli Sternberg. A. Introduction. 1. Background. Nature of this treatise. Linear elasticity is one of the more successful theories of mathematical physics. Its pragmatic success in describing the small deformations of many materials is uncontested. The origins of the three-dimensional theory go back to the beginning of the 19th century and the derivation of the basic equations by Cauchy, Navier, and Poisson. The theoretical development of the subject continued at a brisk pace until the early 20th century with the work of Beltrami, Betti, Boussinesq, Kelvin, Kirchhoff, Lame, Saint-Venant, Somigliana, Stokes, and others. These authors established the basic theorems of the theory, namely compatibility, reciprocity, and uniqueness, and deduced important general solutions of the underlying field equations. In the 20th century the emphasis shifted to the solution of boundary-value problems, and the theory itself remained relatively dormant until the middle of the century when new results appeared concerning, among other things, Saint-Ve- nant's principle, stress functions, variational principles, and uniqueness. It is the purpose of this treatise to give an exhaustive presentation of the linear theory of elasticity.1 Since this volume contains two articles by Fichera concerning existence theorems, that subject will not be discussed here. I have tried to maintain the level of rigor now customary in pure mathematics. However, in order to ease the burden on the reader, many theorems are stated with hypotheses more stringent than necessary. Acknowledgement. I would like to acknowledge my debt to my friend and teacher, Eli Sternberg, who showed me in his lectures2 that it is possible to present the linear theory in a concise and rational form—a form palatable to both engineers and mathematicians. Portions of this treatise are based on Sternberg's unpublished lecture notes; I have tried to indicate when such is the case. I would like to express my deep gratitude to D. Carlson, G. Fichera, R. Huilgol, E. Sternberg, and C. Truesdell for their valuable detailed criticisms of the manuscript. I would also like to thank G. Benthien, W. A. Day, J. Ericksen, R. Knops, M. Oliver, G. de La Penha, T. Ralston, L. Solomon, E. Walsh, L. Wheeler, and W. Williams for valuable comments, and H. Ziegler for generously sending me a copy of 1 Specific applications are not taken up in this article. They will be treated in a sequel by L. Solomon, Some Classic Problems of Elasticity, to appear in the Springer Tracts in Natural Philosophy. 2 At Brown University in 1959-1961. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 1
2 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 2. Prangb's 1916 Habilitation Dissertation. Most of the historical research for this treatise was carried out at the Physical Sciences Library of Brown University; without the continued support and hospitality of the staff of that great library this research would not have been possible. Finally, let me express my gratitude to the U.S. National Science Foundation for their support through a research grant to Carnegie-Mellon University. 2. Terminology and general scheme of notation. I have departed radically from the customary notation in order to present the theory in what I believe to be a form most easily understood by someone not prejudiced by a past acquaintance with the subject. Direct notation, rather than cartesian or general coordinates, is utilized throughout. I do not use what is commonly called "dyadic notation"; most of the notions used, e.g. vector, linear transformation, tensor product, can be found in a modern text in linear algebra. General scheme of notation. Italic boldface minuscules a,b,u,v ...: vectors and vector fields; x, y, z, £, ...: points of space. Italic boldface majuscules A,B, ...: (second-order) tensors or tensor fields. Italic lightface letters A, a, on, 0, ...: scalars or scalar fields. C, K: fourth-order tensors. Sans-serif boldface majuscules M, N ... (except C, K): four-tensors or fields with such values. Sans-serif boldface minuscules u,%,...: four-vectors or four-vector fields. Italic lightface majuscules B, D, E, ...: regions in euclidean space. ^: a group of second order tensors. Script majuscules <€,£?,... (except ^): surfaces in euclidean space. Italic indices i, j, ...: tensorial indices with the range (1, 2, 3)- Greek indices a, /3, ...: tensorial indices with the range (1,2). Index of frequently used symbols. Only symbols used frequently are listed. It has not been possible to adhere rigidly to these notations, so that sometimes within a single section these same letters are used for quantities other than those listed below. Symbol Name Place of definition or first occurrence A(m) A B C Dt E E E(B) <? <f«> Acoustic tensor Beltrami stress function Body Elasticity tensor Set of points of application of system I of concentrated loads Strain tensor Traceless part of strain tensor Mean strain Three-dimensional euclidean space = <f x(—00, 00) = space-time
Sect. 2. Terminology and general scheme of notation. 3 Symbol Name Place of definition or first occurrence K K M 0 P Q R S o S(B) &\t &2 U{E} W -r irtA) w or a b c c Cl c2 ei f / i k I tn n P P Pc p r s s 4 «tfffl 4 <»' 0 ij, Sjmimetry group for the material at x Kinetic energy Compliance tensor Stress-momentum tensor Origin, zero vector, zero tensor Part of B Orthogonal tensor Plane region Stress tensor Traceless part of stress tensor Mean stress Complementary subsets of 8B Strain energy Total energy Vector space associated with $ = "Tx{—00,00) Rotation tensor Singular surface Amplitude of wave Body force Centroid of B Speed of propagation, also the constant • i67in{\ — v) Irrotational velocity Isochoric velocity Orthonormal basis Pseudo body force field System of forces ]f— i, also function with values i(t) —t Modulus of compression System of concentrated loads Direction of propagation Outward unit normal vector on dB Pressure Position vector from the origin 0 Position vector from the centroid c Admissible process, elastic process =|«—o| Surface traction Prescribed surface traction Admissible state, elastic state Kelvin state corresponding to a concentrated load I at y Unit Kelvin state corresponding to the unit load ei&ty Unit doublet states at y Center of compression at y Center of rotation at y parallel to the #,-axis 1*
4 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 2. Symbol Name Place of definition or first occurrence t Time u Displacement vector u Prescribed displacement on boundary u0 Initial displacement v0 Initial velocity v(B) Volume of B w Rigid displacement x, y, z Points in space xt Cartesian components of x z Complex variable 0{i} Functional in Hellinger-Prange-Reissner principle A{t} Functional in Hu-Washizu principle -¾ (y) Open ball with radius d and center at y 0{s>} Functional in principle of minimum potential energy !P{<i} Functional in principle of minimum complementary energy /3 Young's modulus dtj Kronecker's delta dv(B) Volume change e Internal energy density ei}k Three-dimensional alternator eap Two-dimensional alternator A Lame modulus fi Shear modulus fiu Maximum elastic modulus fim Minimum elastic modulus v Poisson's ratio % Point in space-time q Density q> Scalar field in Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution, Airy stress function, scalar field in Lame solution \j/ Vector field in Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution, vector field in Lam6 solution (o Rotation vector 1 Unit tensor sym Symmetric part of a tensor skw Skew part of a tensor tr Trace of a tensor ® Tensor product of two vectors V Gradient F(4) Gradient in space-time V Symmetric gradient curl Curl div Divergence div(4) Divergence in space-time A Laplacian
Sect. 3. Points. Vectors. Second-order tensors. 5 Symb< d1 Name □ i, D2 Wave operators [ ] Jump in a function da Element of area dv Element of volume * Convolution # Tensor product convolution Place of definition or first occurrence B. Mathematical preliminaries. I. Tensor analysis. 3. Points. Vectors. Second-order tensors. The space under consideration is always a three-dimensional euclidean point space <f. The term "point" will be reserved for elements of <f, the term "vector" for elements of the associated vector space 'f. The inner product of two vectors u and v will be designated by u • v. A cartesian coordinate frame consists of an orthonormal basis {ej —{e1,ei,e^ together with a point 0 called the origin. The symbol p will always denote the position-vector field on <f defined by p(x)=x — 0. We assume once and for all that a single, fixed cartesian coordinate frame is given. If u is a vector and a; is a point, then u{ and xt denote their (cartesian) components: «,- = M-e,., xi = (x — 0)-ei. We will occasionally use indicial notation; thus subscripts are assumed to range over the integers 1, 2, 3» and summation over repeated subscripts is implied: 3 u-v=uivi='Zuivi. i=l We denote the vector product of two vectors u and »byMX». In components (UXV){ = 8iihUtVh, where ei;ft is the alternator: + 1 if (i, j, k) is an even permutation of (1, 2, 3) ei;-ft = • — 1 if (i, j, k) is an odd permutation of (1, 2, 3) 0 if (i, j, k) is not a permutation of (1, 2, 3) • We will frequently use the identity eijk eipq — °jp °kq—°iq °kp> where (5,,- is the Kronecker delta: \\ if i=j
6 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 3. For convenience, we use the term "(second-order) tensor" as a synonym for "linear transformation from T^*into "T". Thus a tensor S is a linear mapping that assigns to each vector v a vector u=Sv. The (cartesian) components S,-, of S are defined by so that u = Sv is equivalent to «< = 5,-/w,- We denote the identity tensor by 1 and the zero tensor by 0: lv =v and 0» = 0 for every vector v. Clearly, the components of 1 are (5,-,. The product ST of two tensors is defined by composition: (ST) (v) =S(T(v)) for every vector v; hence (ST)i}—Sik Tkj. We write ST for the transpose of S; it is the unique tensor with the following property: Su ■ v =u ■ ST v for all vectors u and v. We call S> symmet ric if S—ST,skew if S = —ST. Since Sit- = Sjj, it follows that S is symmetric or skew according as 5i;- = S,,- or S,; = —S,,-. Every tensor S admits the unique decomposition S — sym S + skw S, where sym S> is symmetric and skw S> is skew; in fact, symS = i(S + ST), skwS = ^(S-S1). We call sym S the symmetric part and skw S the skew part of S. There is a one-to-one correspondence between vectors and skew tensors: given any skew tensor W, there exists a unique vector at such that Wu = o) X u for every vector u; indeed, <Oi = -^eijkWjk. We call o) the axial vector corresponding to W. Conversely, given a vector at, there exists a unique skew tensor FT such that the above relation holds; in fact, WH = — eiikcok. We write tr S for the trace and det S for the determinant of S. In terms of the components S,-;- of S: trS=Sii( and det S is the determinant of the matrix •Jll -^12 --^13 ^21-^2 2 -^2 3 ■ .-^31 -^32 -^3 3.
Sect. 3. Points. Vectors. Second-order tensors. 7 Given any two tensors S> and T, tr(ST)=tr(TS), det (ST) = (det S) (det T). A tensor Q is orthogonal provided The set of all orthogonal tensors forms a group called the orthogonal group; the set of all orthogonal tensors with positive determinant forms a subgroup called the proper orthogonal group. If {e,} is an orthonormal basis and with Q orthogonal, then {ej} is orthonormal. Conversely, if {ej and {e^} are ortho- normal, then there exists a unique orthogonal tensor Q such that ef = Qe{. If such is the case, the components w'{ of a vector to with respect to {e^} obey the following law of transformation of coordinates: Here Qit- and wi are the components of Q and w with respect to {e^}. Likewise, for a tensor S, Sij—QkiQljSkl- The tensor product a ® 6 of two vectors a and b is the tensor that assigns to each vector u the vector a (b ■ u): (a ® b) (w) =a(b ■ u) for every vector u. In components («$&)!, = «<&,■. and it follows that tr(a(g)b) =a ■ b. Further, we conclude from the above definition that the negative of the vector product a X b is equal to twice the axial vector corresponding to the skew part of a®b. The inner product S ■ T of two second-order tensors is defined by S.T=tr(STT)=SiiTii, while |s|=ys-s is called the magnitude of S>. Given any tensor S and any pair of vectors a and b, a-Sb=S (a®6). This identity implies that («i®«/) • (e*®e,) =¾ ■ [(e<®e,.)e,] =¾ • [e,(ey • e,)]; therefore, since {e,} is orthonormal, (e<®e/)-(e*®ei)=*i**/i.
8 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity, and the nine tensors et®e;- are orthonormal. Moreover, (Si}- e,-®e,-) v = e,Sif{v ■ e,-) = e< Sif v^Sv, S=Sijei<g)ei. Sect. 3. and thus Consequently, the nine tensors e^®^- span the set of all tensors, and we have the following theorem: (1) The set of all tensors symmetric tensors skew tensors is a vector space of dimension form an orthonormal basis. , and the 9| [ et®e,- 6 ■ tensors < j/2 sym e^ ® e;- 3 J [j/2 skw et ® e;-, i < j We say that a scalar X is a principal or characteristic value of a tensor S if there exists a unit vector n such that Sn=An, in which case we call n a.principal direction corresponding to A. The characteristic space for S> corresponding to A is the subspace of ^consisting of all vectors u that satisfy the equation Su=hu. We now record, without proof, the (2) Spectral theorem.1 Let S be a symmetric tensor. Then there exists an orthonormal basis w^n^ng and three (not necessarily distinct) principal values 2^, X2, A3 of S> such that Sni—hini (no sum) (a) s = 2^M<®»i- •=i (b) Conversely, if S admits the representation (b) with {nj orthonormal, then (a) holds. The relation (b) is called a spectral decomposition of S. (i) If Xy, A2, and X% are distinct, then the characteristic spaces for S are the line spanned by %, the line spanned by n2, and the line spanned by ns. (ii) If A2 =^3, then (b) reduces to S =A!Mi®«l+^2 (1—^¾¾^¾) . (c) Conversely, if (c) AoWs m% ^4=^; iAe« ^ a«(f A2 are the only distinct principal values of S, and S has two distinct characteristic spaces: the line spanned by 1¾ and the plane perpendicular to n^. (iii) %i = A2 = A3 = A if and only if s=n, (d) in which case the entire vector space "fis the only characteristic space for S. 1 See, e.g., Halmos [1958, 9], § 79-
Sect. 3. Points. Vectors. Second-order tensors. 9 We say that two tensor S and Q commute if SQ = QS. (3) Commutation theorem.1 A symmetric tensor S commutes with an orthogonal tensor Q if and only if Q leaves each characteristic space of S invariant, i.e. if and only if Q maps each characteristic space into itself. A tensor P is a perpendicular projection if P is symmetric and P*=P. If P is a perpendicular projection, then (1-P)(1-P)=1-2P+P2 = 1-P, and therefore 1 — P is also a perpendicular projection. Since (1 -P) P=P(1-P) =P-P2 = 0, it follows that Pu ■ (1 -P) v =u ■ P(l -P) v = 0; therefore the range of P is orthogonal to the range of 1 —P. Two simple examples of perpendicular projections are 1 and 0. Two other examples are n ®n and 1 — n ®n, where n is a unit vector. The first associates with any vector its component in the direction of n, the second associates with any vector its component in the plane perpendicular to n. The next theorem shows that every perpendicular projection is of one of the above four types. (4) Structure of perpendicular projections. IfP is a perpendicular projection, then P admits one of the following four representations: 1, 0, n®n, 1— n®n, where n is a unit vector. Proof. Let A be a principal value and n a principal direction of P. Then Pn—hn, and hence P*n —APn, which implies Pn=XPn. Thus each principal value of P is either zero or one. If all principal values are zero, thenP = 0; if all are unity, then P= 1. If exactly one principal value is unity, then we conclude from the spectral theorem that P=n®n with n a unit vector. If exactly two are unity, then P=m1®m1-\-mi®mi, where m^ and m2 are the corresponding principal directions, and it is a simple matter to verify that this representation is equivalent to P=l—n®n, where n =m1xm!. □ Notice that, in view of (4), the spectral decompositions (a)-(d) in (2) are all expansions in terms of perpendicular projections. We shall identify fourth-order tensors with linear transformations on the space of all (second-order) tensors. Thus a. fourth-order tensor C[-] is a linear mapping that assigns to each second-order tensor E a second-order tensor S = C[E]. 1 This theorem is a corollary to Theorem 2, § 43 and Theorem 3, § 79 of Halmos [1958, 9].
10 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 4. The components of C [ ■ ] are defined by Cijki=ei'c[e*®e,] ej = (e,-®ef) ■ C[ek<g>e,], so that the relation S = C [JS] becomes ■5j,- — Cijk i^ki- If C^; are the components of C[-] with respect to a second orthonormal basis {ei, 4. 63} with e\ = Qei, then Ciikl—QmiQnjQpkQql Cmnpq- The transpose CT of a fourth-order tensor C is the unique fourth-order tensor with the following property: E ■ C[F] = CT[E] ■ F for all (second-order) tensorsE and F. In components C^-jj = CkHi. The magnitude \C\ of C is defined by |C|=sup{|C[JS]|:|£;|=l}. Clearly, |c[fl]|<;|c||fl|. We will occasionally have to deal separately with the components %, w2 in the %, #2-plane of a vector w. For this reason, Greek subscripts will always range over the integers 1, 2 and summation from 1 to 2 over repeated Greek subscripts is implied, i.e., 2 a=l The two-dimensional alternator will be designated by ea/3; thus 4. Scalar fields. Vector fields. Tensor fields. Let D be an open set in <f. By a scalar, vector, or tensor field on D we mean a function <p that assigns to each point xiD, respectively, a scalar, vector, or tensor <p (x). We say that a sco/ar field <p is differentiahle at as if there exists a vector to with the following property: q>(y) — ^(x)=w-(y—x)+o(\y—x\) as t/->#. If such a vector exists, it is unique; we write w = V<p{x) and call V<p{x) the gradient of 99 at a*. The partial derivatives of q> at x, written <pti{x), are defined by More generally, let T^be a finite-dimensional inner product space, and let W be a mapping from D into #7 For example, 70^ may be the translation space "T corresponding to <f or the space of all tensors. Then W is differentiable at xtD if there exists a linear function £?[ • ] from "Tm\.o T^such that V(s)-V(x)=S?\3i-x]+o(\y-x\) as y-+x. If .S?exists, it is unique; we write £?= VxP(x) and call VW{x) the gradient of W at x. It is not difficult to show that the linear transformation VWfa) can be computed using the formula VV(x)\v] = -faW(x + 0iv)\am0, which holds for every vector vd'f.
Sect. 4. Scalar fields. Vector fields. Tensor fields. 11 We say that W is of class C1 on D, or smooth on D, if W is differentiable at every point of D and VW is continuous on D. The gradient of VW is denoted by [7(2) W. Continuing in this manner, we say that W is of class CN on D if it is class Cw_1 and its (2V— l)th gradient V^N~X)W is smooth. Clearly, the gradient of a smooth scalar field is a vector field, while the gradient of a smooth vector field is a tensor field. We say that W is of class CN onZJ if W is of class CN on Z) and for each «e {0,1,..., N} F(n> !F has a continuous extension to D. (In this case we also write V^W for the extended function.) A field W is analytic on D if given any x m D,W can be represented by a power series in some neighborhood of x. Of course, if W is analytic, then W is of class C°°. Let u be a vector field on D, and suppose that u is differentiable at a point a?eZ). Then the divergence of w at as is the scalar div m (x) = tr Fm (as), and the partial derivatives of u are defined by «<.,■(*) = -¾^^ • F«(*)e, = [7«(*)]„; hence div w (as) = wi)t(as). The curl of u at as, denoted curl u (x), is defined to be twice the axial vector corresponding to the skew part of Vu(x); i.e. curl u(x) is the unique vector with the property: [Vu(x) — Vu(x)T]a = (curl u(x)) x« for every vector a. In components [c"rl«(*)]< = eijkuk>j(x) -5 vtn 0^,.-^. JU w. We write Vu(x) for the symmetric gradient of w: "Ac |vu<. _^ Fm(jj) =sym Ftt(a?) = i{Vu{x) + Ftt(a?)r}. Let S be a tensor field on D, and suppose that S is differentiable at x. Then the tensor field ST is also differentiable at x; the divergence of S at as, written div S(x), is the unique vector with the property: [div S (x)1 • a=div [ST (x) a] for every fixed vector a. In the same manner, we define the curl of S at *, written curl S(as), to be the unique tensor with the property: [curl S(x)] a = curl [ST (x) a] for every a. The partial derivatives of S> are given by thus [divS(x)]i=Siu(x), [curl S (x)]if = eipkSfk>p (x). Let <p be a differentiable scalar field, and suppose that Vq> is differentiable at x. Then we define the Laplacian of <p at x by A <p (x) — div V<p (x).
12 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 5. We define the Lapladan of a vector field u with analogous properties in the same manner: Au(x) =div Vu(x). Clearly, A(p{x)=(pM(x), {Au(x)\t=uiii1(x). Finally, the Lapladan AS(x) of a sufficiently smooth tensor field S is the unique tensor with the property: [AS(x)]a=A[S{x)a]; in components [A8(xy]ti = Siiihh{x). Of future use are the following (1) Identities. Let <pbe a scalar field, u a vector field, and S a tensor field, all of class C2 on D. Then curl Vq> = 0, (1) div curl m = 0, (2) curl curl m = F div m — Au, (3) ' curlFtt = 0, (4) curl(VuT) = Vcmlu, (5) Vu = -VuT =» Wu = 0, (6) div curl S = curl div ST, (7) div(curlS)r = 0, (8) (curl curl S)T = curl curl ST, (9) cur%l) = — [curl(9?l)]r, (10) div(SrM) =u ■ div S +S ■ Vu. (11) If S is symmetric, tr(curlS)=0, (12) curl curl S = - A S+2 V div S - V V (tr S) +1 [A (tr) S - div div S]. (13) If S is symmetric and S = 6? — 1 tr 6f, then curl cwlS = -AG + 2V div Gf-1 div div Gf. (14) If S is skew and u is its axial vector, then curl S = l div u — Vu. (15) II. Elements of potential theory. 5. The body B. The subsurfaces Sf\ and 5^g of dB. Given a region D in S, we write D for its closure, D for its interior, and 8D for its boundary. We will consistently write Ze (y) for the open ball in S of radius q and center at y.
Sect. 5. The body B. The subsurfaces S\ and SP% of 8B. n Let D be an open region in <f or in the xx, #2-plane. We say that D is simply- connected if every closed curve in D can be continuously deformed to a point without leaving D (i.e., if given any continuous function g: [0, i]-+D satisfying g(0) =g{\) there exists a continuous function /: [0,1] X [0,1]->D and a point yeDsuch that/(s, 0) =g{s) and/(s, i) =y for every se[0,1]). The following definitions will enable us to define concisely the notion of a regular region of space.1 A regular arc is a set -a in <f which, for some orientation of the cartesian coordinate system, admits a representation «={»: #2=/(¾). #3=g(*i), «^#i^6}, where a<6 and / and g are smooth on [a, b]. A regular curve is a set c in <f consisting of a finite number of regular arcs arranged in order, and such that the terminal point of each arc (other than the last) is the initial point of the following arc. The arcs have no other points in common, except that the terminal point of the last arc may be the initial point of the first arc, in which case c is a closed, regular curve. A regular surface element is a (non-empty) set 0t<=.S which, for some orientation of the cartesian coordinate system, admits a representation 0t={x: xs=f{x1, x2), (xlt x2)<eR}, where ^Js_acomgact connected region in the %, %-plane, 8R is a closed regular curve, and / is smooth on R. The union of a finite number of regular surface elements is called a regular surface provided: (i) the intersection of any two of the elements is either empty, a single point which is a vertex for both, or a single regular arc which is an edge for both; (ii) the intersection of any collection of three or more elements consists at most of vertices; (iii) any two of the elements are the first and last of a chain such that each has an edge in common with the next; (iv) all elements having a vertex in common form a chain such that each has an edge, terminating in that vertex, in common with the next; the last may, or may not, have an edge in common with the first. The term edge here refers to one of the (finite number of) regular arcs comprising the boundary of a regular surface element, while a vertex is a point at which two edges meet. If all the edges of a regular surface belong each to two of its surface elements, the surface is a closed regular surface. Note that a regular surface (and hence a closed regular surface) is necessarily both connected and bounded. Thus, e.g., the boundary of the spherical shell {aj:oc^|a5-a50|^/S} («</?) is not a regular surface, but rather the union of two closed regular surfaces. Let B be an open set in &. We say that B is a bounded regular region if B is the interior of a closed and bounded region E in S whose boundary dB is the union of a finite number of non-intersecting closed regular surfaces. Note that the boundary of a bounded regular region may have corners and edges. We will occasionally deal with infinite domains. We say that B is an unbounded regular region if B is unbounded, but J3n27e(0) is a bounded regular region 1 All of the definitions contained in this paragraph are from Kellogg [1929, 2], Chap. IV, §8.
14 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 5. for all sufficiently large q. Note that the boundary of such a region may extend to infinity. An unbounded regular region whose boundary is finite is called an exterior domain. Throughout this article, unless specified to the contrary, B will denote a bounded regular region. We will refer to B as the body. A (not necessarily proper) bounded regular subregion P of B will be referred to as a part of B. We shall designate the outward unit normal to 8B at x^8B by n(x). If the function n is continuous at *, then x will be referred to as a regular point of 8B. We say that Sf c dB is a regular subsurface of 8B if the intersection of £f with each of the closed regular surfaces comprising 8B is itself a regular surface. The symbols _^ and Sf% will alwaysjdenote complementwyLregMlar subsurfaces oidB 1 i.e. regular subsurfaces of 8B with the following property: where 5^ is the (relative) interior of ^. Note that since Sf^ is regular, 5^=^, where £fa is the (relative) closure of 5^. Let B be bounded or unbounded. A partition for B is a finite collection B1, B2, ..., BN of mutually disjoint regular subregions of B such that N B=\JEn. A function W is piecewise continuous on B if there exists a partition S1( J32, ..., BN of S such that for each B„ the restriction of W to J5„ is bounded onF„ and continuous onI?n—D, where I) is a (possibly empty) finite subset of Bn. W is piecewise smooth onB if VW exists almost everywhere on B and is piecewise continuous on E. Piecewise continuity on regular surfaces is defined in a strictly analogous manner. We say that a function W on S?a is jpieceioise regular if ¥* is piece- wise continuous on £f„. and each regular point of ya is a point of continuity of W. Suppose that W and W are piecewise regular on SPa. Then we write W = W on ,5^ if ^(as) = ¥*(») at each regular point xeS^a. We say that B is properly regular1 provided the following hypotheses are satisfied: (i) B is a bounded regular region; (ii) for each x0z8B there exists a neighborhood N of x0 and a piecewise smooth homeomorphism h of NnE onto the solid hemisphere {as: #3^0, *? + #! +*|^;i} such that ft maps2Vn0J3 onto the set {x: xz—0, x\-\-x\<,\}; (iii) det Vh is positive and bounded away from zero. We say that B is star-shaped if there exists a point x0e B such that the line segment connecting x0 and any point xe8B intersects 8B only at x. We state without proof the following property of star-shaped regions: (1) Let B be star-shaped. Then there exists a point x0&B such that (x—x0) -n(x)>0 at every regular point xe8B. 1 This definition is due to Fichera [1971, 1], § 2.
Sect. 5- The body B. The subsurfaces 5^ and S?2 of SB. 15 Let (xv x2, x3) denote cartesian coordinates. We say that B is X(-convex (i fixed) if every line segment parallel to the #raxis lies entirely in B whenever its end points belong to B. Consider the following projections of B: and for each xs£Bs, let Note that B12 = {(x1,x2):xeB}, B3={x3:xeB}, B12(xs) = {{x1, x2): (xlt x2, x3)eB}. B12= (J J312(*3). x,€Bt (2) Lemma. Let M 2gl and N 2gl be fixed integers, and consider the following hypotheses on B: (i) B is xs-convex. (ii) B12(x3) is simply-connected for each xseBs. (iii) There exist scalar fields x^ and x2 of class CM on Es and CN on Bs such that the curve ® ==l(%> X2> XSI • % = -*i(^3)> X2 = X2\X3)> X3^^S) is contained in B. (iv) There exists a scalar field xs of class CM on B12 and CN on B12 such that the surface ^*~\\%1> X2> X3) • XZ~XZ\X1i X2)i \x1> ^-2)^-^12/ is contained in B. j | ¢3 + 1 ^ / A Bn —^- *\>*1 Fig. 1. Let &{M, N) denote the set of all scalar fields of class CM on B and class CN on B. Then the following two assertions are true:
16 M.E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 6. (a) If (i) and (iv) hold, and if X^{M, N), then there exists a field coi^(M, N) such that co)3=A. (b) If (ii) and (iii) hold, and if vae^(M, N) and satisfies ^a—»8,1=0, then there exists a field (p^[M, N) such that v* = q>,a. Proof. In view of (i)-(iv), the functions q>(x1, x2,xs) = / va{xi, Xz, x3) dx*. ** °* \x\, #2 > #3) = J « (%, #2' %) ** % » where /"(%, *a, #s) *s any smooth path in 5ia(*s) connecting the points (^Wi^W) ajl^ (%' *a)> have the desired properties. D Let S^C dB. We say that B is convex with respect to Sf if the line segment connecting any pair of points x and x of £f intersects dB only at x and 2. Note that this implies, in particular, that £f is convex, though B need not be. 6. The divergence theorem. Stokes' theorem. (1) Divergence theorem. Let B be a bounded or unbounded regular region. Let cp be a scalar field, u a vector field, and T a tensor field, and let q>, u and T be continuous onE, differentiable almost everywhere on B, and of bounded support. Then / q>nda=JVq>dv, dB /u®nda=jVudv, SB B f u-nda =/div u dv, 0B B / n X u da =/curl u d v, dB B / Tn da = f div Tdv, dB B whenever the integrand on the right is piecewise continuous on E. Proof. The results concerning q> and u are classical and will not be verified here.1 To establish the last relation, let 6 be a vector. Then b- fTnda= fb-Tnda= f{TTb)-nda 8B dB dB =/div {TTb) dv =/ (div T) • b dv =b -/div T dv, B B B which implies the desired result since 6 is arbitrary. □ 1 See, e.g., Kellogg [1929,1].
Sect. 6. The divergence theorem. Stokes' theorem. i 7 (2) Stokes' theorem. Let ubea smooth vector field and T a smooth tensor field on B. Then given any closed regular surface £f in E, /(curltt) ■nda = 0, f {curl T)Tn da =0. se Proof. The relation concerning u is well known.1 To estabhsh the second result, let 6 be a vector, and let u = TTb. Then 6 -/(curl T)Tn da =/b • (curl T)Tn da =fn ■ (curl T)bda Sf 9> Sf = fn • curl (TTb) da =/ (curl u) • n da =0, which implies the desired result, since 6 is arbitrary. □ (3) Theorem on irrotational fields. Assume that B is simply-connected. (i) Let ube a class CN (iVSH) vector field on B that satisfies curl u = 0. Then there exists a scalar field <p of class CN+1 on B such that u — V<p. (ii) Let T be a class CN tensor field on B that satisfies curlT = 0. Then there exists a vector field u of class CN+1 on B such that T = Vu. (iii) Let T obey the hypotheses of (ii), and, in addition, assume that trT = 0. Then there exists a skew tensor field W of class CN+1 on B such that T = cwlW. Proof. Part (i) is well known.2 Indeed, the function <p defined by X q>{x) = fu(y)-dy has the desired properties. Here x0 is a fixed point of B, and the integral is taken along any curve in B connecting x0 and x. To establish (ii) let ti = TTei. (a) Then curl tf = curl [TTe>) = (curl T) e, = 0, and by (i) there exist scalar fields ut such that ti = Vu{. (b) 1 See, e.g., Courant [1957, 4], Chap. 5. 2 See, e.g., Phillips [1933, 3], § 45- Handbuchdcr Physik, Bd. VIa/2. 2
18 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 6. Let u^UfCf. Then, since ui=wei, it follows that Vu. = (Vu)Tei> (c) and (a)-(c) imply T = Vu. To prove (iii) let u be the vector field established in (ii), and let W be the negative of the skew tensor field corresponding to u. Then div u = 0, since tr T = 0, and we conclude from (15) of (4.1) that cvilW—Vu. a (4) Theorem on solenoidal fields. Assume that 8B is of class C3. Let !F denote the set of all fields of class C2 on B and class C3 on B. (i)1 Let u& be a vector field, and suppose that fu- nda=0 se for every closed regular surface S?cB. Then there exists a vector field we& such that u = curl tt>. (ii) Let T& be a tensor field, and suppose that fTTnda=0 se for every closed regular surface S^cB. Then there exists a tensor field W& such that T=cwlW. Proof. We omit the proof of (i).2 To establish (ii) let ti = Te{. Then / t{- nda=ei • f TTnda=0, and we conclude from (i) that there exist vector fields w{ such that f< = curli«t-. Let W—e^Wi and note that for any vector a, WTa = aiwi. Thus Ta = «,• Te,- = curl («,• w{) = curl (WTa) = (curl W) a, 1 The usual statement of this theorem (see, e.g., Phillips [1933, 3], §49, Courant [1957, 4], pp. 404-406), which asserts that div u = 0 implies u = curl w, is correct only when dB consists of a single closed surface. In this instance div u = 0 is equivalent to the assertion that / u-nda = o (*) for every closed regular surface S?CB. However, if SB consists of two or more closed surfaces (e.g. when B is a spherical shell) there exist divergence-free vector fields in &• that do not satisfy (*). Note that by Stokes' theorem, (*) holds whenever u is the curl of a vector field. 2 See Lichtenstein [1929, 2], pp. 101-106.
Sect. 7. The fundamental lemma. Rellich's lemma. 19 and hence T = curlW. □ (5) Properties of the Newtonian potential.1 Let q> be a scalar field that is continuous on B and of class CN (N ^ 1) on B, and let rv ' 4n J \x-y\ y B for every xeB. Then f is of class CN+1 on B and Ay>=q>. Further, an analogous result holds for vector and tensor fields. (6) Properties of the logarithmic potential.2 Let R be a measurable region in the %, x2-plane. Let q> be a scalar field that is continuous onR and of class CN{N^i) on R, and let for every (xlt x2)eR. Then y> is of class CN+1 on R and Ay> = q>. (7) Helmholtz's theorem. Let u be a vector field that is continuous on B and of class CN (N^tfon B. Then there exists a scalar field q> and a vector field w, both of class CN on B, such that u = Vq> + c\xrlw, div«j=0. Proof. By (5) there exists a class CN+1 vector field v on B such that u=Av. By (3) of (4.1), u — Fdiv v — curl curl v; thus if we let 9? = divt>, w = — curlv, the desired conclusion follows. □ 7. The fundamental lemma. Rellich's lemma. For x0 a point of <f and h a positive scalar, let 0h (x0) denote the set of all class C°° scalar fields <p on S with the following properties: (a) (p > 0 on the open ball Eh(a50) of radius h and center at x0; (b) q> — 0 on & — Zh(x0). For h > 0 the set <H>h (x0) is not empty. Indeed, the function q> defined by xsZh{x0) belongs to 0h{xo). lo, 1 See e.g., Kellogg [1929, 1], p. 156; Courant [1962, 5], p. 249. a See, e.g., Kellogg [1929, 1], p. 174; Courant [1962, 5], p. 250. 2*
20 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 8. Let «9" be a subset of 8B. We say that a function / on B vanishes near ^provided there exists a neighborhood N of S? such that /=0 on NnE. We are now in a position to establish a version of the fundamental lemma of the calculus of variations that is sufficiently general for our use. (1) Fundamental lemma. Let W be a finite-dimensional inner product space. Let w: B-+W be continuous and satisfy fw ■ vdv=0 B for every class C°° function v: B-+W that vanishes near 8B. Then w = 0 on E. Proof. Let e1, e2,..., en be an orthonormal basis in 'W, and let » w = ^wiei. »=i Assume that for some x0eB and some integer k, wh(x0)=£0. Then there exists an h>0 such that Zh(x0)cB and wh>0 on £h(x0) or wh<0 on Zh(x0). Assume, without loss in generality, that the former holds. If we let v = <peh, where q>e 0h (x0), then v is of class C°° on B and vanishes near 8B, and by properties (a) and (b) of <p, fw-vdv — f<pw-ehdv = f <pwhdv>0. But by hypothesis, fw • v dv=0. B Thus w = 0 on B. But w is continuous on B. Thus w = 0 on B. □ We now state, without proof, (2) Rellich's lemma.1 Let B be properly regular. Further, let {un} be a sequence of continuous and piecewise smooth vector fields on B, and suppose that there exist constants Mx and M2 such that flu^dv^M^ f\Vu„\*^M2, «=1,2,.... B B Then there exists a subsequence {mm/J such that lim f\u^—uni\2dv=0. j, *->oo £ 8. Harmonic and biharmonic fields. Let D be an open region in S, and let W be a scalar, vector, or tensor field on D. We say that W is harmonic on D if W is of class C2 on D and AW = 0. We say that W is biharmonic on D if W is of class C4 on D and AAW=0. We now state, without proof, some well known theorems concerning harmonic and biharmonic fields. 1 Reixich [1930, 4]. See also, Fichera [1971, 1], Theorem 2.IV.
Sect. 8. Harmonic and biharmonic fields. 24 (1) Every harmonic or biharmonic field is analytic. (2) Harnack's convergence theorem.1 Let Ws be harmonic on D for each <5(0<<5<<50), and let W^W as S-+0 uniformly on each closed subregion of D. Then W is harmonic on D, and for each fixed integer n, (7(»)y/«^F(»)<F as S-+0 uniformly on every closed subregion of D. (3) Mean value theorem. Let q> and ip be scalar, vector, or tensor fields on D with q> harmonic andip biharmonic. Then given any ball Ee =2e(y) in D: Vto)=4-*pf<P*i>' (2) sP v>(y)+e*-My) = j~*fv><i<*, (3)2 dSp dSp (4)2 Sp ' dSp We now summarize some results concerning spherical harmonics.3 Let (r, 6, y) be spherical coordinates, related to the cartesian coordinates (xlt x2, xs) through the mapping x1=r sin 6 cosy, x2—r sin dsiny, xs=r cos 6, 0<Lr<oo, 0<^0^7t, 0^y<2n. Then the general scalar solid spherical harmonic of degree h admits the representation HW(r, 6, y) =SW(0. y) r* (k = 0, ± 1, ± 2,...), where S(*> (6, y) is the general surface spherical harmonic of the same degree: 1*1 S« (0, y) = 2 [4"> cos n y + btf sin n y] P*<"> (Cos 0), b^ = 0. »=o Here PS(M) designates the associated Legendre function of the first kind, of degree k and order n, while a$\ a^\ b^ (n — 1, 2,..., \k\), for fixed k, are 2k + i arbitrary constants. If k and n are non-negative integers, where Pft is the Legendre polynomial of degree k. Consequently, ^(o) ® = Pk (i). nn) (i) = o («> * ^ o). In addition, we have the recursion relations PinU (I) = ^(M) (I), 1 See, for example, Kellogg [1929, J], p. 249- 2 Nicolesco [1936, 3]. See also Diaz and Payne [1958, 6]. 3 See, for example, Poincare [1899, 1], Kellogg [1929, 1], and Hobson [1931, 4].
22 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 8. which are valid for unrestricted ft and n. As is evident from the above relations, every surface harmonic of degree — 1 — ft is a surface harmonic of degree ft. Next, we recall that any two surface harmonics of distinct degree are orthogonal over the unit sphere r = 1: [S« S«~>] =// S<*>(0, y) S<m> (0, y) sin 0 <*0 dy = 0 (ft + », ft + - m -1). o o A vector solid spherical harmonic ft(ft) of degree ft is a vector-valued function with the property that given any vector e, the function e • ft(ft) is a scalar solid spherical harmonic of degree ft. The solid harmonics of degree ft are harmonic functions, which are homogeneous of degree ft with respect to the cartesian coordinates (%, x2, 3¾); they are homogeneous polynomials of degree ft in the xf if ft is a non-negative integer. Further, if H(ft) is a scalar solid harmonic of degree ft, then VH(k) is a vector solid harmonic of degree ft — 1 and p.FH<*>=ftH<*>, where p (x) =x — 0. Similarly, (Fft<*>)p=ftft<*> for a vector solid harmonic ft1*' of degree ft. Turning from solid spherical harmonics to general harmonic functions, we cite the following theorem, in which 27 (oo) is the following neighborhood of infinity: 27(oo) ={»: r0< \x — 0| < oo}. Here r0> 0 is fixed. (4) Representation theorem for harmonic fields in a neighborhood of infinity. Let <p be a harmonic scalar field on 27(oo). Then: (i) <p admits the representation A——oo where the H(ft) are uniquely determined solid spherical harmonics of degree ft, and the infinite series is uniformly convergent in every closed subregion of 27( oo); (ii) q> has derivatives of all orders, series representations of which may be obtained by performing the corresponding termwise differentiations, the resulting expansions being also uniformly convergent in every closed subregion of 27( oo) ; (iii) if n is a fixed integer, the three statements (a) cp{x)=0{r»-i), (/8) <p(x)=o(r»), (y) H<*>=0 for ft=«, are equivalent and imply (d) V<p(x)=0{rn-2). An analogous result holds for harmonic vector fields on 27(oo). We now state and prove a theorem which is the counterpart for biharmonic functions of (4). (5) Representation theorem for biharmonic fields in a neighborhood of infinity.1 Let ip be a biharmonic scalar field on 27(oo). Then: 1 Picone [1936, 4]. See also Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11].
Sect. 8. Harmonic and biharmonic fields. 23 (i) y admits the representation roAwe G(ft) a«^ H(*> are solid spherical harmonics of degree k, and both infinite series are uniformly convergent in every closed subregion of 27(00); (ii) y> has derivatives of all orders, series representations of which may be obtained by performing the corresponding termwise differentiations, the resulting expansions being also uniformly convergent in every closed subregion of E{ 00); (iii) if n is a fixed integer, the three statements (a) v(x) =0(^-1). (fl)W{x)=o{r»), (y) G<*>=H<*-2>=0 for k^n, are equivalent and imply (<5) Vy>(x)=0(rn-2). An analogous result holds for biharmonic vector fields on E{00). Proof. We show first that ip admits Almansi's representation xp = <p-\-ri 0, where 99 and 0 are harmonic on £(00). A completeness proof for this representation, applicable to a region that is star-shaped with respect to 0 in its interior, is indicated by Frank and v. Mises.1 To establish the completeness of this representation in the present circumstances, it is sufficient to exhibit a harmonic function 0 that satisfies A(ip — r2 0)=0, or equivalently, 4r8^- + 60=Arp. (a) Since, by hypothesis, Aip is harmonic, we know from (4) that it admits the expansion 00 Ay>(r,d,y)= ZSV»(d,y)r*, (b) a=—00 where the 5(ft)(0, y) are surface harmonics of degree k and the infinite series has the convergence properties asserted in parts (i) and (ii) of (4). Now consider 0 defined by 0(r, 6, y) = §J5« (0, y) r\ S<*> = ^3), Clearly, 0 is harmonic. Further, this function also satisfies (a), as is confirmed with the aid of (b). On applying (i) and (ii) of (4) to <p and 0, (i) and (ii) of the present theorem follow at once. With a view toward establishing (iii), we observe that (/?) is immediate from (a). We show next that (/?) implies (y). Let s(ft)(0, y) and S(ft) (0, y) be the respective surface harmonics corresponding to the solid harmonics G(*' and H(ft). We now multiply the right-hand member of the equation in (i) by r_ns(B,)(6, y) (m = 0, ±1, ±2,...) and integrate termwise over 0^0^^, 1 [1943,1], p. 848.
24 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 9. 0^,y^2n. Bearing in mind the convergence properties asserted in (i) as well as the orthogonality relations, we find that the integral Imn (*) = r- f f v (r, 0, y) s<"> (0, y) sin Od 0 dy, (c) o o for all sufficiently large values of r, is given by Imn (r) = rm~n [jW, s<m>] + r-»-«+i [st-"-1), si"1*] I rm-n+2 rg(m) s(»)-| i y-«-m+l rjl-w-l^ s(m)"| _ I ' It follows from (/?) and (c) that /m„(r) tends to zero as r->-oo for fixed w and «; consequently, the same is true of the right-hand member of (d). Noting that the coefficients of the inner products appearing in (d) are four distinct powers of r, we conclude that [s{m\ s(B,)] =0 if m — wS^O. Thus s(B,) = 0, which implies that G(m)=0 for m^n. In a similar manner we verify that Z/(m)=0 for m^n—2. Hence (/?) is a sufficient condition for (y). We have to show further that (y) implies (a). This is readily seen to be true by observing that each of the series in (i) represents a field that is harmonic on 27(oo), and by invoking part (iii) of (4). Finally, (y) implies (d) because of (ii) of the present theorem and (iii) of (4). Theorem (5) has thus been proved in its entirety. □ The following well-known proposition on divergence-free and curl-free vector fields will be extremely useful. (6) Let v be a smooth vector field on B that satisfies div«=0, curl«=0. Then v is harmonic. Proof. Let D be an arbitrary open ball in B. By hypothesis and (i) of (6.3), there exists a class C2 scalar field <p on D such that v — Vtp. Since v is divergence-free, <p is harmonic, and this, in turn, implies that v is harmonic. □ III. Functions of position and time. 9. Class CM,N. By a time-interval T we mean an interval of the form ( —oo,/0), (0, /0), or [0, /0), where /0>0 may be infinity. We frequently deal with functions of position and time having as their domain of definition the cartesian product D x T of a set D in $ and a time-interval T. In this physical context x will always stand for a point of D and t will denote the time. If W is a function on D X T, we write W{ •, t) for the subsidiary mapping of D obtained by holding t fixed and W{x, •) for the mapping of T obtained by holding x fixed. We say that such a function W is continuous (smooth) in time if W{x, •) is continuous (smooth) on T for each xeD. If D X T is open, we write V^Wfo, t) for the n-thgradient of ¥ with respect. toje holding t fixed and IF'"' (x, t) for the «j^jienvahye_ of W with respect to t holding x fixed. Ordinarily, we write W, ¥ instead of !F(1), if(2). Let M and N be non-negative integers. We say that W is of class CM'N on B X (0, /0) if W is continuous on B X (0, /0) and the functions pW >p(n)> ma{Q,\,...,M}, na{0,i,...,N}, m+n^max{M, N},
Sect. 10. Convolutions. 25 exist and are continuous on Bx(0,t0). We say that W is of class CM,N on Bx[0,t0) if W is of class CM<N on Bx(0,t0) and for each me{0, i,..., M}, »€{0, 1, .... N}, V(m) W(fi) has a continuous extension to Bx[0, t0) (in this case we also write F(m) if1"' for the extended function). Finally, we write C^for CN,N. We say that a function W on ^, X [0, /0) is piecewise regular if if is piecewise continuous on £?, x [0, /0) and W(-,t) is piecewise regular on Sfa for 0 =/<t0. 10. Convolutions. Let T=[0,t0) or (— oo, oo), and let (p and f be scalar fields on D X T that are continuous in time. Then the convolution <p*rp of <p and yi is the function on D x T defined by t <p*xp{x, t) = f <p{x, t — r) ip(x, t) dr. o _ Let if be a function on D X [0, oo). We say that W has a Laplace transform W if there exists a real number rj0= 0 such that for every rje[rj0, oo) the integral oo W(x,r))=fe-i'W(x,t)dt o converges uniformly on D. (1) Properties of the convolution. Let <p, ip, and a> be scalar fields on D X [0, /0) that are continuous in time. Then (i) <p*ip = y)*<p; (ii) (<p*rp)*a> = <p*(rp*a>) = q>*ip*co; (iii) (p*(yi + co) = (p*xp-\-<p*co; (iv) for xeD, if <p(x, •) >0 on (0, t0), then (p*ip(x,-) —0 => rp(x, «)=0; (v) for xeD, if t0 — oo, then <p*rp(x,-)=0 =» (p(x, .)=0 or rp(x, «)=0; (vi) «'/ <p is smooth in time, then (p*ip = (p*ip-{- <p(-, 0)ip; (vii) if t0 — oo and <p,xp possess Laplace transforms, then so also does <p*ip, and (p*ip = (pip on Dx[%, oo) for some r)07>0. Proof. The results (i)-(iii), (v), and (vii) are well known,1 while (vi) follows directly upon differentiating (p*y. To establish (iv) let <p = <p{x, •), rp=y)(x, • ), assume that y> does not vanish identically on [0, /0), and let ^=inf{^[0,g:vW4=0}. Since ip is continuous, there exists a number t2 with tx< t2< t0 such that xp > 0 on (^, t2) or f < 0 on (<j, t2). In either case, since <p > 0, it follows that '. / 9>(*2— t)v(t) ^t4=0, o and we have a contradiction. □ 1 Properties (i)-(iii) are established in Chap. I of Mikusinski [1959, 10]. Titchmarsh's theorem (v) is proved in Chap. II of the same book.
26 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 10. Let #"bea finite-dimensional inner product space, e.g. if = "T or 1^= the set of all tensors, and let 0 and !P be T^-valued fields on DxT that are continuous in time. Then we write (p**P for the 7F-valued field on DxT defined by <p* Y(x, t) = $<p(x, t-r)V (a?, t) It, o and 0* !P for the scalar field on DxT defined by 0* W(x, *) = / 0(x, t-r)- T{x, T) dr. o Thus if 9? is a scalar field, u and v vector fields, and S and T tensor fields, all defined on DxT, then (p*u is a vector field, <p*S is a tensor field, and u*v and S*T are scalar fields; in components [(p*u\i = (p*ui, [(p*S]ij = (p*Sij, u*v = ui*vi, S*T = Sij*Tij. Finally, we write S*u for the vector field S*u(x, t) = f S(x, t — r) u(x, t) dx; o then [S*u]i = Si]-*uj. Properties analogous to (i)-(iv) of (1) obviously hold for the convolutions defined above. Let I and k be continuous vector functions on (— oo, oo). Then l#k is for the tensor function on this interval defined by l#k(f)=fl{t-T)®k(T)dr. o In components For convenience, we write la for the function on (— oo, oo) defined by la(t) =!(*-«). Further, we let ££ denote the set of all smooth vector functions on (— oo, oo) that vanish on (—oo, 0). (2) Let I, keSC and let a>0. Then la#k=l#kx, la#k=l#ka. Proof. Since J=fc = 0 on (—oo.O], (a) Ia = fca = Ia=fca=0 on (—°°. «3. the above relations hold trivially on (—oo, 0]. Thus choose te(0, oo). Then la#k(t)=f l(t — r—a.)®k(r)dr.
Sect. 11. Space-time. 27 Thus, letting t=A—a, we arrive at la#k(t)= fai(t-l)®ka(X)dX, a and, in view of (a), Ia#fc(0=/I(*-A)®fca(A)iA = I#fca(<). o Next, ia#fcW=i#*«W=/i('-T)®fca(T)iT. (b) 0 Since i(/-T) = -^I(*-T), if we integrate (b) by parts, we arrive at i«#fcW = -[I(*-T)®fca(T)]JIo + /l(*-T)®fca(T)iT. (C) o Because of (a), (c) yields the second relation in (2). □ 11. Space-time. We call the four-dimensional point space space-time; in our physical context a point % = (x, fye&W consists of a point x of space and a time /. The translation space associated with $<4> is rw=-rx (-00,00); elements of 1^"<4> will be referred to as four-vectors. As is natural, we write a ■ b=a ■ b+a/J for the inner product of two four-vectors a = (a, a) and b = (6, /?). A four-tensor M is a linear transformation from T^"l4> into -)Tl4'. Thus M assigns to each four-vector (a, a) a four-vector (&,|8)=M(a,a). Given a four-tensor M, there exists a unique tensor M (on 1^"), unique vectors m, mei^\ and a unique scalar X such that for every four-vector (a, a), M(a, 0) = (Ma, m • a), M(0, a) =(ma, Aa). Thus M(a, a) =(Ma+ma, m • a + Aa). We call the array M m\ m X (a) the space-time partition of M. As before, we define the transpose Mr of M to be the unique four-tensor with the property: Ma • b=a • MT b for all four-vectors a and b.
28 M.E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 12. It is not difficult to show that the space-time partition of MT is MT m m X\' Let (p be a smooth scalar field on an open set D in <f4>. Then the gradient in <f(4> of q> is the four-vector field VW(p = {Vq>,q>). Let u = (u, /a) be a smooth four-vector field and M a smooth four-tensor field on D (i.e. the values of M are four-tensors). We define the divergences of u and M by the relations: div(4) u = div u-\-fi, (div(4) M) • a =div(4) (Mro) for every o6^4). For future use, we now record the following (1) Identity. Let M be a smooth four-tensor field on an open set D in <f(4>, and let (a) be the space-time partition of M. Then div(4) M = (div M + in, div m + A). Proof. Since M3 o = (MT a +ma, m ■ a + Aa), it follows that div(4)(/Mro) =div(Mra) +a div m+a • m+aA = (div M + m, div m + A) • (a, a), which implies the desired identity. □ (2) Divergence theorem in space-time. Let D be a bounded regular region in $(4). Let u and M be a four-vector field and a four-tensor field, respectively, both continuous onD and smooth on D. Then f u ■ n da = f div(4) u dv, dD D f Mn da — f div(4)M dv, dD D whenever the integrand on the right is continuous on D. Here n is the outward unit normal to dD. Proof. The first result is simply the classical divergence theorem in <f(4); the second can be established using the procedure given in the proof of (6.1). □ C. Formulation of the linear theory of elasticity. I. Kinematics. 12. Finite deformations. Infinitesimal deformations. In this section we motivate some of the notions of the infinitesimal theory. When we present the linear theory we will give the axioms and definitions that form its foundation; while j these are motivated by viewing the linear theory as a first-order approximation to . the finite theory, the linear theory itself is independent of these considerations and stands on its own as a completely consistent mathematical theory.
Sect. 12. Finite deformations. Infinitesimal deformations. 29 Consider a body1 identified with the region B it occupies in a fixed reference configuration.2 A deformation* of B is a smooth homeomorphism x of £ onto a region x (B) in <f with det Vx > 0. The point x (a?) is the place occupied by the material point x in the deformation x, while u(x)=x(x)—x (a) is the displacement of a? (see Fig. 2). The tensor fields F = Vx (b) and Fit are called, respectively, the deformation gradient and the displacement gradient. By (a) and (b), Vu=F — 1. (c) Fig. 2. The importance of the concept of strain cannot be established by a study of kinematics alone; its relevance becomes clear when one studies the restrictions placed on constitutive assumptions by material-frame indifference.4 Many different measures of strain appear in the literature; however all of the properly invariant choices are, in a certain sense, equivalent.5 The most useful for our purposes is the finite strain tensor D defined by D=%(FTF-1). (d)6 Of importance in the linear theory is the infinitesimal strain tensor E = %(Vu+VuT); (e) by (c), D=E + %VuTVu. (f) The infinitesimal theory models physical situations in which the displacement u and the displacement gradient Vu are, in some sense, small. In view of (e) and (f), D and E can be considered functions of Vu. Writing s = \Vu\, (g) 1 See, e.g., Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § IS. 2 See, e.g., Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § 21. 3 Truesdell and Toupin [i960, 17], §§ 13-58 give a thorough discussion of finite deformations. 4 See, e.g., Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], §§ 19, 29. 5 See, e.g., Truesdell and Toupin [i960,17], § 32. 6 The tensor C = FTF — 2D + 1 is the right Cauchy-Green strain tensor (Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § 23).
30 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 12. we conclude from (f) that to within an error of 0(s2) as e->-0, the finite strain tensor D and the infinitesimal strain tensor E coincide. A finite rigid deformation is a deformation of the form: x{x)=y0 + Q[x-x0], where x0 and y0 are fixed points of & and Q is an orthogonal tensor. In this instance F=-Q and Vu = Q-l (h) are constants and u (x) =u0 + Vu [x — aj0], (i) where u0=y0—x0. Moreover, since QTQ = 1, (d), (e), and (h), imply D=0, E=m+QT)-i- (]) Thus in a rigid deformation the finite strain tensor D vanishes, but E does not. For this reason E is not used as a measure of strain in finite elasticity. By (f) and (j), E = -%VuTVu, and we conclude from (g) that in a rigid deformation to within an error of 0(sz) the infinitesimal strain tensor vanishes. Thus Vu = -VuT+0{e*); i.e., to within an error of 0(e2) the displacement gradient is skew. This motivates our defining an infinitesimal rigid displacement to be a field of the form u(x) =11^ + W[x —x0] with W skew. The volume change dV in the deformation x is given by dV= f dv-fdv. k(B) B Since the Jacobian of the mapping h is det Fx=detf, Jdv=fdetF dv; k(B) b thus dV = f (det F-\)dv, B so that detf — 1 represents the volume change per unit volume in the deformation. In view of (c), we can consider F a function of Vu. A simple analysis based on (c) and (g) implies that as e ->-0 det F =det(l + Vu) =1 +tr Vu+0{e*), or equivalently, det J— l=divw+0(e2); thus to within an error of 0(s2) the volume change per unit volume is equal to div u. For this reason we call the number dv = / div udv— Ju-nda B dB the infinitesimal volume change.
Sect. 13. Properties of displacement fields. Strain. 31 13. Properties of displacement fields. Strain. In this section we study properties of (infinitesimal) displacement fields. Most of the definitions are motivated by the results of the preceding section. A displacement field u is a class C2 vector field over B; its value u(x) at a point xeB is the displacement of x. The symmetric part E = i(Vu+VuT) of the displacement gradient, Vu, is the (infinitesimal) strain field, and the above equation relating E to u is called the strain-displacement relation. The (infinitesimal) rotation field W is the skew part of Vu, i.e. W = \{Vu-VuT), while to — \ curl u is the (infinitesimal) rotation vector. Thus Vu^E + W, and 0 is the axial vector of W; i.e. for any vector a, Wa=mxa. We call divit=tr E the dilatation. The (infinitesimal) volume change dv(P) of a part P oi B due to a continuous displacement field u on 5 is defined by dv(P) = /«• nda, dp and we say that u is isochoric if du(P) =0 for every P. By the divergence theorem, dv (P) = f div u dv = f tr E dv; p p thus u is isochoric if and only if trE = 0 on B. An (infinitesimal) rigid displacement field is a displacement field u of the form u(x)=u0 + W0[x-x0], where x0 is a point, w0 is a vector, and Wj, is a skew tensor. In this_ instance Vu{x) = W0 = -Wf and JB(*)=0 for every x in B. Of course, u may also be written in the form u(x) =u0 + o0 X [a? — ae0J, where o0 is the axial vector of W0. (1) Characterization of rigid displacements. Let u be a displacement field. Then the following three statements are equivalent. (i) u is a rigid displacement field. (ii) The strain field corresponding to u vanishes on B. (iii) u has the projection property on B: for every pair of points x.yeB [**(»)-u(y)]. [a-y]=0.
32 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 13. Proof. We will show that (i) => (iii) => (ii) => (i). If u is rigid, then u(x)-u(y)=W0[x-y] with W0 skew; hence (x-y) ■ [u(x) -u(y)] = (x -y) ■ W0[x -y] = 0 and (iii) holds. Next, assume that u has the projection property. Then differentiating the relation (iii) with respect to x, we obtain Vu{x)T [x—y]+u(x) —u(y) = 0. Differentiating this equation with respect to y and evaluating the result at y = x, we arrive at -Vu(x)T-Vu(x)=0, which implies (ii). Now assume that (ii) holds. By (6) of (4.1), Wu=0. Thus and (ii) implies that W0 is skew. □ An immediate consequence of (1) is the following important result. (2) Kirchhoff's theorem1. If two displacement fields u and u' correspond to I.'- the same strain field, then u=u' -\-w, where w is a rigid displacement field. The next theorem shows that (iii) in (1) implies (i), even if we drop the assumption that u be of class C2, but, as we shall see, the proof is much more difficult. /*y (3)2 LetFbe a non-coplanar set of points in S, and let u be a vector field on F. K--Then u is a rigid displacement field if and only if u has the projection property. Proof. Clearly, if u is rigid, it has the projection property. To establish the converse assertion we assume that [u(x)-u(y)] -(x-1/)=0 for every pair of points x, yiF. Let ziF, and let Fs be the set of all vectors from s to points of F: Fe={v:v=x—s,xeF}. Let g be the vector field on Fs defined by g(v) —u(x) — u(z), v=x—z, xeF. (a) Then g(0) =0, and g has the projection property: [g{v) -g(w)} ■ {v-w) =0 (b) for every pair of vectors v,w£Fs. Taking w =0 we conclude that g(v) -v=0 1 [1859,11 2 Cf. Nielsen [1935, 5], Chap. 3-
Sect. 13. Properties of displacement fields. Strain. 33 for every veFm, and this fact when combined with (b) implies g(v)-w = -g(w)-v (c) for all v, weF^. Next, since the points of F do not line in a plane, Fx spans the entire vector space 'V. Let w^, w)2, ws be linearly independent vectors in Fs, and let g be the function on ^defined by g(v)=vig(wi), (d) where v1 are the components of v relative to wit i.e. v=viwi. Then g is linear. We now show that g is the restriction of g to Fs. Indeed, (c) and (d) imply that for v, keFe g(v) . k = vig{wt) ■ k = —u«g(k) ■wi = —v-g{k)=g{v) k, and since this relation must hold for every ktFx, §{v)=g(v) for all 156¾. (e) Since g is linear, we may write g(t>)=wt>, (f) where Wis a tensor. Further, using (c) and (d), it is a simple matter to verify that g(v) -w = —g(w) -v for all v, wt'f. Thus W is skew. Finally, (a), (e), and (f) imply u(x) =u(s) + W[x— s] for every xeF. □ A homogeneous displacement field is a displacement field of the form u(x)—u0 +A[x—x0], where the point x0, the vector u^, and the tensor A are independent of x. Such a field is determined, to within a rigid displacement, by the strain field E, which is constant and equal to the symmetric part of A. If u0 = 0 and A is symmetric, i.e. if u(x) =E[x—x0], then u is called a pure strain from x0. (4) Let ube a homogeneous displacement field. Then u admits the decomposition u=w-\-u, where w is a rigid displacement field and u is a pure strain from an arbitrary point x0. Proof. Let u(x)=u0+A[x—y0], E = %(A+AT), W=${A-AT). Then u=w+2, where w(x) =w0 +W[x —x0], w0=u0 +A[x0 -y0], u{x)=E[x—x0\, □ Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 3
34 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 13. Let x0 be a given point, and let p0(x)=x-x0. Some examples of pure strains from the point (a) simple extension of amount e in the direction n, where \n\ —i: u=e(n -p0) n, E = en0n; (b) uniform dilatation of amount e: u=ep0 E=e\; (c) simple shear of amount x with respect to the direction pair (m, n), where m and n are perpendicular unit vectors: u =»[(m • p0) n + (n • p0) m], jE = 2xsym(m(g)n) = K[m®n+n<g)m]. •To $/j»j» / e extension \ l s -*—0 -<-o • O-*- O™* / \ Uniterm dilatation Simple shear Fig. 3. Examples of pure strains from x0.
Sect. 13. Properties of displacement fields. Strain. 35 The displacement fields corresponding to (a), (b), and (c) are shown in Fig. 3. The matrix relative to an orthonormal basis {n, e2,e^ of E in the simple extension given in (a) is [E]: and the matrix of E relative to an orthonormal basis {m, n, e3} in the simple shear given in (c) is e 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0. "0 K K 0 0 0 0" 0 0. [E] Notice that the homogeneous displacement field u = 2x(m -p0)n has the same strain as the simple shear defined in (c) and hence differs from it by a rigid displacement field. For a pure strain the ratio of the volume change dv(B) of the body to its total volume v (B) is tvE. Thus for a simple extension of amount e, dv(B) v{B)~ = e, for a uniform dilatation of amount e, 8v{B) and for any simple shear, v(B) 8v(B) = 3«. v(B We call the principal values e1, e2, ez of a strain tensor E principal strains. By (3.2), E admits the spectral decomposition 3 E=^eini®ni> «=1 where n, is a principal direction corresponding to et. We now use this decomposition to show that every pure strain can be accomplished in two ways: by three simple extensions in mutually perpendicular directions; by a uniform dilatation followed by an isochoric pure strain. (5) Decomposition theorem for pure strains. Let u be a pure strain from x0. Then u admits the following two decompositions: (i) M=tl1+M2+M3, where 1¾.¾½. and 1¾ are simple extensions in mutually perpendicular directions from x0; (ii) u=ud+uc, where ud is a uniform dilatation from x0, while uc is an isochoric pure strain from x0. Proof. Let E be the strain tensor corresponding to u. It follows from the spectral decomposition for E that
36 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 13. where Ei = eini®ni (no sum). Thus if we let M4=E,-p0, ¢=4, 2, 3, where p0{x)=x-x0, the decomposition (i) follows. On the other hand, if we let ud = %(trE)p0, uc = [E-%(trE)l]p0, then ud is a uniform dilatation, uc is an isochoric pure strain, and ud + ue=Ep0=u. □ (6) Decomposition theorem for simple shears. Let u be a simple shear of amount x with respect to the direction pair (m, n). Then u admits the decomposition u=u+ -\-u~, where m* is a simple extension of amount ±x in the direction ^-(»»±»)- Proof. Let E be the strain tensor corresponding to u. Then E =x (m (g) n -\-n®m), and it follows that A is a principal value and a a principal vector of E if and only if x(n ■ a) m-\-x(m • a) n = Xa. It is clear from this relation that the principal values of E are 0, +k, —x, the corresponding principal directions mxn, -^(m+n), ^(m-n). Thus we conclude from (i) of (5) and its proof that the decomposition given in (6) holds. □ Trivially, every simple shear is isochoric. The next theorem asserts that every isochoric pure strain is the sum of simple shears. (7) Decomposition theorem for isochoric pure strains. Let u be an isochoric pure strain from x0. Then there exists an orthonormal basis {nj.n2.n3} such that u admits the decomposition u=tt1+u2+u3, where 1¾. u2, and M3 are simple shears from x0 with respect to the direction pairs (n2,n^), (nj, tij), and (1^, n2), respectively. Proof.1 Let E be the strain tensor corresponding ton. If E=0 the theorem is trivial; thus assume E^O. Clearly, it suffices to show that there exists an 1 This proof was furnished by J. Lew (private communication) in 1968.
Sect. 13- Properties of displacement fields. Strain. 37 orthonormal basis {n^.n^.tig} such that the matrix of E relative to this basis has zero entries on its diagonal: n^ • En^—n^ • £n2=ng • JEng = 0. To prove this it is enough to establish the existence of non-zero vectors a, B such that a-0=0, (a) x Ex = B EB=0; (b) for if (¾. n2, Jig} is an orthonormal basis with then (b) yields n.- -"- n - f- % • En^^n^ • En2=0, and the fact that tr E = 0 implies ng • JEng = 0. Let m^, m2, inz be principal directions for E, and let e1, —e2, —es be the corresponding principal strains. Since trJE=0, we may assume, without loss in generality, that (if two of the principal strains are positive and one negative consider — E rather than JE). We shall now seek vectors «, B which satisfy not only (a) and (b), but also the condition &=ai> &=a2> &=—«3> (c) where a,- and /^ are the components of a and B relative to the orthonormal basis m^, m2, m,. In view of (c), conditions (a) and (b) reduce to the system: a?+a!-a| = 0 e1a.l—e2<4 — esa.l=0. It is easily verified that this system has the solution a| = "2 + «8> 02 = ¾ — es, «l=el+e2. and since E =)= 0, the vectors a and B so defined will be real and non-zero. □ We now consider displacement fields that are not necessarily homogeneous. Given a continuous strain field JE onB, we call the symmetric tensor B the mean strain. Clearly, -w-tr E(B), thus the volume change can be computed once the mean strain is known.
38 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 13. (8) Mean strain theorem. Let u be a displacement field, let E be the corresponding strain field, and suppose that E and u are continuous on E. Then the mean strain E(B) depends only on the boundary values of u and is given by E(B) = -^= f sym u ® n da. dB Proof. By the divergence theorem (6.1), f (u®n+n®u) da= f (Vu + VuT) dv = 2 f Edv. □ dB B B The next theorem, which is due to Korn, gives restrictions under which the Z.2 norm of the gradient of u (i.e. the Dirichlet norm of u) is bounded by a constant times the £2 norm of the strain field. (9) Horn's inequality.1 Let ubea class C2 displacement field on E, and assume that one of the following two hypotheses hold: (a) u = 0 on dB; (/3) B is properly regular, and either u = 0 on a non-empty regular subsurface of SB, or JWdv=0, B where W is the rotation field corresponding to u. f\Vu\*dv^Kf\E\*dv, B B where E is the strain field corresponding to u, and K is a constant depending only on B. Proof. We will establish Korn's inequality only for the case in which (a) holds. The proof under (/3), which is quite difficult, can be found in the article by Fi- chera. 2 Thus assume (a) holds. It follows from the definitions of E and W that |.E|2 = f(|J7M|2 + J7M. J7Mr), |W|2 = i(|J7tt|*-|7tt. VuT); hence \E\*-\W\* = Vu-VuT. (a) Further, we have the identity Vu- VuT = div [(Vu) u - (div u) u] + (div u)\ (b) By (a), (b), the divergence theorem, and (a), f\E\*dv-f\W\*dv=f{divu)*dv, B B B which implies f\W\*dv^f\E\*dv. (c) B B 1 Korn [1906, 4], [1908, i], [1909, 3]. Alternative proofs of Korn's inequality were given by Friedrichs [1947, l), Emus [1951, 5] (see also Mikhlin [1952, 2], §§ 40-42), Gobert [1962, 6], and Fichera [1971,1]. Numerical values of K for various types of regions can be found in the papers by Bernstein and Toupin [i960, i], Payne and Weinberger [1961, 17~\, and Dafermos [1968, 3]. 2 [1971, I\, § 12.
Sect. 14. Compatibility. 39 Thus we conclude from (c) and the identity ||7u|2=|E|2 + |W|2 that J\Vu\2dv^2j\E\2dv, B B therefore Korn's inequality holds with K = 2. □ Let u be a displacement field on B. Then u is plane if for some choice of the coordinate frame1 «a =««(%» x2>> «8 = 0. In this instance the domain of m can be identified with the following region R in the xlt #2-plane: R={(x1,x2):xeB}. Clearly, the corresponding strain field E is a function of (¾, x2) only and satisfies ■Ea/J=&Kt,/J+%d> •&18 ==^'28 = ^83 ==0. It is a simple matter to verify that a plane displacement field is rigid if and only if where x = (%, #2) and «a and co are constants. We call a two-dimensional field ua of this form a plane rigid displacement and a complex function of the form u(z)=a1-\-ia2—icoz, z = x1-\-ix2, a complex rigid displacement. Clearly, a complex function u is a complex rigid displacement if and only if its real and imaginary parts u^ and u2 are the components of a plane rigid displacement. 14. Compatibility. Given an arbitrary strain field E, the strain displacement relation E=h(Vu + Vur) constitutes a linear first-order partial differential equation for the displacement field u. The uniqueness question appropriate to this equation was settled in the last section; we proved that any two solutions differ at most by a rigid displacement. The question of existence is far less trivial. We will show that a necessary condition for the existence of a displacement field is that the strain field satisfy a certain compatibility relation, and that this relation is also sufficient when the body is simply-connected. The following proposition, which is of interest in itself, supplies the first step in the derivation of the equation of compatibility. (1) The strain field E and the rotation vector co corresponding to a class C2 displacement field satisfy curl E = Vm. Proof. If we apply the curl operator to the strain-displacement relation and use (4) and (5) of (4.1), we find that curl E = icurl (Vu + VuT) = iFcurl u = Vca. □ 1 Recall our agreement that Greek subscripts range over the integers 1, 2.
40 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 14. If we take the curl of the relation in (1) and use (4) of (4.1), we are immediately led to the conclusion that a necessary condition for the existence of a displacement field is that E satisfy the following equation of compatibility: curl curl £ = 0. This result is summarized in the first portion of the next theorem; the second portion asserts the sufficiency of the compatibility relation when the body is simply-connected. ■ (2) Compatibility theorem^ The strain field E corresponding to a class C3 displacement field satisfies the equation of compatibility. Conversely, let B be simply-connected, and let E be a class CN(N^2) symmetric tensor field on B that satisfies the equation of compatibility. Then there exists a displacement field u of class CN+1 on B such that E and u satisfy the strain-displacement relation. Proof. We have only to establish the converse assertion.2 Thus let B be simply-connected, and assume that curl curl £=0. Let A=curlE. (a) Then curl4 = 0, (b) and since E is symmetric, (a) and (12) of (4.1) imply that trA=0. (c) By (b), (c), and (iii) of (6.3), there exists a class CN skew tensor field Wsuch that .4 = -curl HP, (d) and (a), (d) imply that cml{E + W)=0; thus, by (ii) of (6.3), there exists a class CN+1 vector field u on B such that E + W=Vu, and taking the symmetric part of both sides of this equation, we arrive at the strain-displacement relation. □ In components the equation of compatibility takes the form or equivalently, 2^12,12 ==^11,22 T^22,ll< ^11,23 = ( ^23,1 +^31,2+^12,3),1) e*C- Under the hypotheses of (2) it is possible to give an explicit formula which may be useful in computing a displacement field u corresponding to the strain 1 Some of the basic ideas underlying this theorem are due to Kirchhoff [1859,1], who deduced three of the six equations of compatibility and indicated a procedure for determining the displacement when the strain is known. The complete equation of compatibility was first derived by Saint-Ven ant [1864, 1], who asserted its sufficiency. The first rigorous proof of sufficiency was given by Beltrami [1886,1], [1889, 1]. Cf. Boussinesq [1871, 1], Kirchhoff [1876, 1], Padova [1889, 2], E. and F. Cosserat [1896, 1], Abraham [1901, 1}. Explicit forms of the equation of compatibility in curvilinear coordinates were given by Od- qvist [1937, 4], Blinchikov [1938, 1], and Vlasov [1944, 3]. 2 This portion of the proof is simply a coordinate-free version of Beltrami's [1886, 1] argument.
Sect. 14. Compatibility. 41 field E. Let x0 be a fixed point in B. Then for each xeB the line integral ac u(x) = fU(y,x)dy, where Ui,-(y. x) =Eij{y) + {xk-yk) [Eif>k(y) -Ekjii{y)}, is independent of the path in B from x0 to x, and the function m so defined is a displacement field corresponding to the strain field E.1 An alternative form of the equation of compatibility is given in the following proposition. (3) Let E be a class C2 symmetric tensor field on B. Then E satisfies the equation of compatibility if and only if , ZlJB+F|7(trE)-2FdivE=0. Proof. The proof follows from the identities: curl curl E = - AE - VV(tv E) + 2 Fdiv E + 1[A (tr E) - div div JB], (a) tr[AE + VV{tvE) -2FdivE] =2[A (tr JB) -div div JB]. (b) Indeed, let curl curl E = 0. Then, if we take the trace of (a), we conclude, with the aid of (b), that Zl(trE)-divdivJE = 0, (c) and this result, in view of (a), implies the relation in (3). Conversely, if that relation hoids, then (b) implies (c), and (c) implies curl curl JE = 0. □ The following proposition will be quite useful. (4) Assume that B is simply-connected. Let u be a displacement field, and assume that the corresponding strainjield E is of class C2 on B and of class CN (Af 2:1) on B. Then u is of class CN+1 on B. Proof. Let u' be the displacement field generated by E using the procedure given in the proof of (2). By (13.2), u and u' differ by a rigid displacement field; hence ;it suffices to prove that u' is of class CN+1 on B. Since curl JE is of class CN~X on B, the function W in (d) in the proof of (2) is of class CN on B, and since E + W= Vu', u' is of class CN+1 on B. □ (5) Compatibility theorem for plane displacements. Assume that R is a simply-connected open region in the xlt x2-plane. Let ua be a class Cs field on R, and let Exp^viu^p+upj. (i) Then 2-^12,12=-^11,22+-^22,11- (11) Conversely, let Eap(=Ep0[) be a class CN(N^2) field on R that satisfies (ii). Then there exists a class CN+1 field ua on R such that (i) holds. 1 This explicit solution is due to CesAro [1906, 2]. In this connection, see also Volterra [1907, 4], Sokolnikoff [1956, 12], Boley and Weiner [I960, 3].
4U M.fc.. uurtin: The Linear iheory ot iblasticity. beet. 14. If we take the curl of the relation in (1) and use (4) of (4.1), we are immediately led to the conclusion that a necessary condition for the existence of a displacement field is that E satisfy the following equation of compatibility: curl curl 12 = 0. This result is summarized in the first portion of the next theorem; the second portion asserts the sufficiency of the compatibility relation when the body is simply-connected. ' (2) Compatibility theorem.1 The strain field E corresponding to a class Cs displacement field satisfies the equation of compatibility. Conversely, let B be simply-connected, and let E be a class CN(N 2; 2) symmetric tensor field on B that satisfies the equation of compatibility. Then there exists a displacement field u of class CN+t on B such that E and u satisfy the strain-displacement relation. Proof. We have only to establish the converse assertion.2 Thus let B be simply-connected, and assume that curl curl JE=0. Let A = cax\E. (a) Then curL4=0, (b) and since E is symmetric, (a) and (12) of (4.1) imply that trJl=0. (c) By (b), (c), and (iii) of (6.3), there exists a class CN skew tensor field W such that A =- -curl W, (d) and (a), (d) imply that curl(E + W0=°; thus, by (ii) of (6.3), there exists a class CN+1 vector field u on B such that E + W = Vu, and taking the symmetric part of both sides of this equation, we arrive at the strain-displacement relation. Q In components the equation of compatibility takes the form or equivalently, 2^-12,12 = ^11,22 + £-22,11» £-11,23 = ( £23,1+-^31,2+-^12,3),11 e^c- Under the hypotheses of (2) it is possible to give an explicit formula which may be useful in computing a displacement field u corresponding to the strain 1 Some of the basic ideas underlying this theorem are due to Kirchhofe [1859,1], who deduced three of the six equations of compatibility and indicated a procedure for determining the displacement when the strain is known. The complete equation of compatibility was first derived by Saint-Venant [1864, 1], who asserted its sufficiency. The first rigorous proof of sufficiency was.given by Beltrami [1886, T\, [1889, 1]. Cf. Boussinescj [1871, 1], Kirchhoff [1876, 1], Padova [I889, 2], E. and F. Cosserat [1896, X], Abraham [1901, 1]. Explicit forms of the equation of compatibility in curvilinear coordinates were given by Od- qvist [1937, 4], Blinchikov [1938, 1], and Vlasov [1944, 3]. 2 This portion of the proof is simply a coordinate-free version of Beltrami's [1886, 1] argument.
Sect. 15. Balance of momentum. Stress. 43 We assume given on B a continuous strictly positive function q called the density; the mass of any part P of B is then p ,-.,..( ,.f Let (0, t0) denote a fixed interval of time. A motion of the body is a class Ca vector field aonBx (0, t0). The vector u(x, t) is the displacement of* at time t, while the fields u, u, E=$(Vu+VuT), and E are the velocity, acceleration, strain, and strain-rate. We say that a motion is admissible if m, m, it, JS, and E are continuous on S X [0, t0). Given an admissible motion u and a part P of B, I(P)=/ueii» p is the linear momentum of P, and h(P)=fpxuodv V«-2 p is the angular momentum (about the origin 0) of P. Note that, for P fixed, I (P) and fc (P) are smooth functions of time on [0, t0); in fact, i(P)= f ugdv, h{P)= fpxiiodv. p p A system of forces / for the body is defined by assigning to each (x, t) 6 B x [0, t0) a vector b(x, t) and, for each unit vector n, a vector s„(x, t) such that: (i) sm is continuous on B x [0, t0) and of class C1,0 on B x (0, <0); (ii) 6 is continuous on B X [0, t0). We call s„(x, t) the stress vector at (ae, i). Let Sf be an oriented regular surface in B with unit normal n (Fig. 4). Then sn^(x, t) is the force per unit Fig. 4. area at x exerted by the portion of B on the side of Sf toward which n(x) points on the portion of B on the other side; thus fsnda = Jsnix){x,t)dax
44 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 15. and fp xs„da = fp{x)xs„(a,)(x, t) dax sr se represent the total force and moment across £?. The same consideration also applies when x is located on the boundary of B and n is the outward unit normal to 8B at x; in this case sn(x, t) is called the surface traction at (x, t). The vector 6 (x, t) is the body force at (x, t); it represents the force per unit volume exerted on the point x by bodies exterior to B. The total force f(P) on a part P is the total surface force exerted across dP plus the total body force exerted on P by the external world: f(P)=Jsnda+fbdv. dp p Analogously, the total moment m(P) on P (about 0) is given by m(P) = fpxsnda+fpxbdv. dp p An ordered array [u, /], where u is an admissible motion and / a system of forces, is called a dynamical process1 if it obeys the following postulate: for every part P of B f(P)=i(P) K) and m(P)=h(P). (m2) These two relations constitute the laws of balance of linear and angular momentum;2 (1¾) is the requirement that the total force on P be equal to the rate of change of linear momentum, (ma) that the total moment be equal to the rate of change of angular momentum. Note that by (1%), the relation (m2) holds for every choice of the origin 0 provided it holds for one such choice. Clearly, (1%) and (m2) can be written in the alternative forms: fs„da + fbdv=fuQdv, (mi) dP p p fpX.snda+fpX.bdv=fpxiiodv. (m2) dp p p For future use, we note that (m2) is equivalent to the relation: skw { /p®snda + f p<S)b dv\ =skw/p®«g dv. (mj) lap p I p The next theorem is one of the major results of continuum mechanics. (1) Cauchy-Poisson theorem.9 Let u be an admissible motion and / a system of forces. Then [«, /] is a dynamical process if and only if the following two conditions are satisfied: 1 For the results of this section weaker definitions would suffice for an admissible motion, a system of forces, and a dynamical process. The strong definitions given here allow us to use these definitions without change in later sections. 2 Cf. the discussion given by Truesdeix and Toupin [i960, 17], § 196. 3 Cauchy [1823, 1], [1827, 1] proved that balance of linear and angular momentum implies (i) and (ii) in (1), while Poisson [1829,2] established the converse assertion. In a sense, the essential ideas are implied or presumed in memoirs written by Fresnel in 1822 [1868,1), but his work rests heavily on the constitutive assumptions of linear elasticity. In a still more limited sense the scalar counterpart of (i) is foreshadowed in a work on heat conduction written by Fourier in 1814 [1822, 1], which is even more involved with special constitutive relations. For a discussion of the history of this theorem, the reader is referred to Truesdeix and Toupin [i960,17]. Gurtin, Mizel, and Williams [1968,6] established the existence of the stress tensor under somewhat weaker hypotheses.
Sect. 15. Balance of momentum. Stress. 45 (i) there exists a class C1'0 symmetric tensor field S on Bx(0, t0), called the stress field, such that for each unit vector n, sn=Sn; (ii) w, S, and b satisfy the equation of motion: divS + 6=gii. The proof of this theorem is based on two lemmas. The first is usually referred to as the law of action and reaction. (2) Cauchy's reciprocal theorem. Let [u, /] be a dynamical process. Then given any unit vector n, sn= s_m. Proof. Since B is bounded, the properties of q, u, and 6 imply that k(t) =sup \b(x, t) —q{x) U(x, t)\ xeB is finite for 0^.t<t0. Thus we conclude from (m^) that I fsnda\ ^kv(P) (a) \dP I on [0, t0), where v(P) is the volume of P. Now choose a point x0eB, a time te(0, t0), and a unit vector m. For convenience we shall suppress the argument t in what follows. Let Pe be a rectangular parallelepiped contained in B with center at x0 and sides parallel to m (see Fig. 5). Fig. 5. Suppose further that the top and bottom faces !F* and ^s~ with exterior normals m and — m are squares of length e, and that the height of Ps is a2. Let ^e denote the union of the four side faces. Then dP,=*+KJ*t-KjVt (b) and v(Pt)=e*. «(*?)=«», «(*?e)=4e3, (c) where, for any surface £?, a{SP) denotes the area of SP. By (a) and (c), — J snda->0 as e->0. (d)
46 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 15. Further, since st is continuous on B for each fixed unit vector I, we conclude from (c) that 72- / s±™<*«-*s±m(a>o) and *, -J s„da-+0 as e-*0. (e) By (b), (d), and (e), sm (3¾) + s -m (¾) = 0 > which completes the proof, since m and x0 are arbitrary. □ (3) Lemma. Let S be a class C1,0 tensor field on Bx (0, t0) with S and div S continuous on Bx [0, t0). Then given any part P of B, Jpx(Sn) da= f pxdiv S dv+2[a dv dp p p on [0, t0), where a is the axial vector corresponding to the skew part of S. Proof. Let j= fpx(Sn) da. d'P Then given any vector e, j-e= / (exp) ■ Snda= / n-ST(exp) da =f div{ST(exp)} dv, dP dP P and hence (11) of (4.1) implies Next, j■ e = /(exp) • divSdv + fS- V(exp) dv. p p (a) (b) (exp) • div S =e • (pxdiv S), S- F(exp)=2e-a; since e is arbitrary, (a) and (b) imply j= fpx div S dv+2fadv. □ p p Proof of (1). Assume first that (i) and (ii) of (1) hold. Then it follows from the properties of u and sm that S and div S are continuous on B x [0, t0). Thus given any part P of B, (ii) and the divergence theorem imply (m^). Next, since S is Fig. 6. Tetrahedron for the case in which /¾ = ex, fc2 = — e2> ^3 — — es
Sect. 1 5. Balance of momentum. Stress. 47 symmetric, its axial vector a vanishes, and (3) together with (i) and (ii) of (1) imply fpXs„da = fpxdivSdv = fpx (qu — b) dv, dP p p which is (m^). Conversely, assume that [u, f~\ is a dynamical process. Let m be a unit vector and assume that m 4= ±«j for any base vector e{ of the orthonormal basis {e1, e2, e3}. Choose a point xeB, and consider the tetrahedron P(h) in B whose sides 71(h) and 7ti(h) have outward unit normals m and k{) where fc< = — [sgn (et • in)] et (no sum), and whose faces 7ii(h) intersect at x (see Fig. 6). Let the area of 71(h) be a(h), so that the area of 7i{ (h) is —a(h)m- kt■. Since sm is continuous on B x (0, t0) for each fixed n, we conclude that and, by (2), that ^y/sm <*«-►«».(*) '«"(*) j s»ida->~(m'ki) S|«(*) = — (»»• e,.) Se,(») (no sum) (a) "((A) as A->0, where we have suppressed the argument t. On the other hand, it follows from the inequality (a) in the proof of (2) that *k/s-' ,da->0 as &->0. (b) 'a-P(A) Thus, since dP(h) is the union of 71(h) and all three 7t,(A), (a) and (b) imply sm (x) = (m • e<) sei (x) = [sei (x) ® et] m,. (c) Our derivation of (c) required that m 4= ± e, hold for every t. However, it follows from (2) that the first equation of (c) is also valid when m =±e,-; thus (c) holds for every unit vector m. Now let S be the tensor field on B X (0, t0) defined by S = sC(®e,. Then s„=Sn (d) for every unit vector n. Further, S is of class C1,0 on B X (0, t0) and continuous on B x [0, i0), because s„ has these properties for every n. Next, if we apply (mi) to an arbitrary part P (with PC-B) and use (d) and the divergence theorem we conclude that divS + 6=gM. (e) Thus to complete the proof we have only to show that S is symmetric. By (m^), (d), and (3), fodv=0 p for every part P with FcB. Thus a — 0 on B x(0, t0), which yields the symmetry ofS. □
48 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 15. We now give an alternative proof of the existence of the stress tensor.1 Let [u, f\ be a dynamical process, and let (x0,t)eBx [0, t0). It suffices to show that the mapping n -> sm(ae0, t) is the restriction (to the set of unit vectors) of a linear function on "P". For convenience, we write s(x,n) = s„ (x,t); then for any xeB we can extend the function s(x, •) to all of "K as follows: a{x,v) = \v\ 8^,-^, »4=0, s(x, 0)=0. Let a be a scalar. If a > 0, then s(a») = |«»|s(-|^)=«|»|s(]||)=as(»), (b) where we have omitted the argument x. If a<0, then (b) and Cauchy's reciprocal theorem (2) yield s(a»)=s(|a| (—»)) =|a|s(— v) =«s(»). Thus s(x,•) is homogeneous. To show that s(x, • ) is additive we first note that s (a;, w1 + w2) = s (ae, wj + s (ae, mj2) whenever w1 and mj2 are linearly dependent. Suppose then that wt and w2 are linearly independent. Fix e > 0 and consider jty, the plane through x0 with normal m^; 7t2, the plane through x0 with normal w2; and 7t3, the plane through x0 + ew3 with normal ws, where w3 = — (w1+w2). (c) Fig. 7- Consider the solid jtf=s/(e) bounded by these three planes and two planes parallel to both w± and w2 and a distance <5 from x0 (see Fig. 7). Let e and d be sufficiently small that s/ is a part of B. Then t=i 1This proof was furnished by W. Noll (private communication) in 1967.
Sect. 15. Balance of momentum. Stress. 49 where Wt is contained in n{ (¢ = 1,2,3), and ^4 and "^5 are parallel faces. Moreover, HSl"3 ¢=1,2), «3 = 0(e) as £-*0, v(sf) = — |MJ3|a3 = 25a4 = 25 a5, where at is the area of ^. Thus, by the continuity of s„, and (a) implies 3 c= 2 s(x0, Wi)+o(i) as e-^0. »=i On the other hand, we conclude from estimate (a) in the proof of (2) that c=0(e) as e->0. The last two results yield 3 2 s(ae0, *»;)=(); {=1 since s(ae,;) is homogeneous, this relation and (c) imply that s(x0, •) is additive. Thus s(x0,') is linear, and, since ae0eB was arbitrarily chosen, Noll's proof is complete. The field S of the Cauchy-Poisson theorem (1) has the following properties: (I) S is a symmetric tensor field of class C1,0 on B x (0, t0); (II) S and div S are continuous on Bx[0, i0). The continuity of div S onEx [0, i0) follows from the equation of motion and the continuity of q, U, and 6 on this set. A field S with properties (I) and (II) will be called a time-dependent admissible stress field. In view of the Cauchy- Poisson theorem, the specification of a dynamical process is equivalent to specifying an ordered array [u, S, 6], where (a) « is an admissible motion; (/?) S is a time-dependent admissible stress field; (y) 6 is a continuous vector field on B X [0, t0); (<5) «, S, and 6 satisfy the equation of motion div S + b=oii. Henceforth, a dynamical process is an ordered array [u, S, b] with properties («M<5)-_ _ If m is independent of time, the equation of motion reduces to the equation of equilibrium div S +6=0. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 4
50 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 15. Let S be a stress tensor at a point x of the body. If Sn = sn, then the scalar s is called a principal stress at x and the unit vector n is called a principal direction (of stress). Since S is symmetric, there exist three mutually perpendicular principal directions 1^,1½.¾ and three corresponding principal stresses s1( s2, s3. If a symmetric stress field S is constant, it automatically satisfies the equation of equilibrium (with vanishing body forces). Examples of such stress fields are: (a) pure tension (or compression) with tensile stress a in the direction n, where \n\ = 1: S=on<g>n; (b) uniform pressure p: 8 =-pi; (c) pure shear with shear stress r relative to the direction pair m, n, where m and n are orthogonal unit vectors: S = 2t sym (m® n). Pure tension Uniform pressure Pure shear Fig. 8.
Sect. 16. Balance of momentum for finite motions. 51 The matrix of the pure tension (a) relative to an orthonormal basis {n, e2, e3} is a 0 0" [S]= 0 0 0 , .0 0 0. and the matrix of the pure shear (c) relative to an orthonormal basis {m, n, e3} is "0 T 0 T 0 0 0" 0 0, [S] Given a unit vector k, the stress vector sfc for each of the above is: (a) sh=a(k-n) n, (b) sk=-pk, (c) sk = r[(m-k) n + (n-fe) m]. These three surface force fields are shown in Fig. 8. y 16. Balance of momentum for finite motions.1 In this section we show that the definitions and results of the previous section are, in a certain sense, consistent wkhjhajinite theory jxovided the deformations are small. We again remind the reader that this section is only to help motivate the infinitesimal theory; the remainder of the article is independent of the considerations given here. Consider a one-parameter family Kt, 0<t<t0, of deformations of B, the time t being the parameter. The point ic(a;, t)=Kt(x) is the place occupied by x at time t, while u(x, t) =k{x, t)— x (a) is the displacement of x at time t. The linear momentum I (P) of a part P is the same in the finite theory as in the linear theory; i.e. l(P)=fuQdv, (b) p where q is the density in the reference configuration. The angular momentum, however, is now equal to h*(P)=f{K-0)xuedv. (c) By (a), k—u; thus, since «xm=0, h*(P)=f{K-0)xuQdv. p (d) In the finite theory we can specify the surface forces and body forces per unit | area and volume in the deformed configuration or per unit area and volume in ; the reference configuration. The former specification leads to the Cauchy stress tensor; the latter, which is most convenient for our purposes, leads to the Piola- Kirchhoff stress tensor. A system of forces / is defined exactly as in the infinitesimal theory with the quantities sm and 6 now interpreted as follows: given any closed regular surface £f in B [rather than k (B, t)] with unit outward normal n at 056^, sn(x, t) is the force per unit area in the reference configuration 1 See, for example, Truesdeix and Toupin [1960,17], §§ 196, 200-210, and Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § 43 A. 4*
52 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 16. exerted at the material point as by the material outside of £f on the material inside; 6 (as, t) is the force per unit volume in the reference configuration exerted on the material point as by the external world. The force f(P) on a part P is the same as in the linear theory: f(P) = fsnda + fbdv; (e) dp p however, the moment m*(P) on P is now given by: m*(P) = f(K-0)xsnda+f{tc-0)xbdv. (f) dp p In terms of these quantities, the laws of balance of linear and angular momentum take the forms f{p)=i(P), m*(P)=h*(P), or equivalently, / snda+fbdv=foudv, (g) dp p p /(k — 0) xs„ da+J(k —0) x6 dv = /(k — 0) xgii dv. (h) dp p p Now let p;— — ~~{ \e = sup lit (as, t)\. | (i) By (a), L_J » ic(as, 2) — 0=ti\as, t) +as—0=tt(as, <) +p(a>), (j) and if we consider the field k as a function of the /ieW m, then (i) and (j) yield K-0=2>+O(e) as e->0. (k) Using (k) and (d), we can write (c), (f), and (h) as follows: h*(P)=J[j?+0(e)]xuQdv, p + (1) m*(P) = f[p+0(e)] xs„ da+ftpfiO{e)] xb dv, dp p f[p+0(e)]xs„da+f[p+0(e)]xbdv =/[p +0 (e)] X Qii dv. (m) dP P P These relations reduce to the corresponding relations in the linear theory provided we neglect the terms written 0(e). We can summarize the results established thus far as follows: In terms of surface forces and body forces measured per unit area and volume in the reference configuration, the linear momentum of any part P and the force on P are the same as in the linear theory, and (hence) so also is the law of balance of linear momentum. The angular momentum and the moment reduce to the corresponding quantities in the linear theory provided we neglect the terms written 0(e) in (1); therefore when these \ terms are neglected the law of balance of angular momentum reduces to the corresponding law in the infinitesimal theory. It is a simple matter to establish the consequences of balance of momentum for the finite theory. In fact, the analog of (15.1) may be stated roughly as
Sect. 17. General solutions of the equations of equilibrium. 53 follows: There exists a tensor field S, called the Piola-Kirchhoff stress tensor, such that s„=Sn, divS + b = qu, v ' SFT = FST, (0) where F = Vk is the deformation gradient. The Eqs. (n) ajce identical to their counterparts in , the infinitesimal theory. However, in the linearytheory the stress field Sis sym- %^-;, metric; in contrast, it is clear from (0) that fn the finite theory S will in general be non-symmetric. If we let -j -1 8=\Vu\, \ (p) then, since X— i. F = l + Vu, (q) (0) implies S(l+0(d))=ST (1+0(6)). Thus S is symmetric to within terms of 0(8) as <5-v0. This fact further demonstrates the consistency of the linear theory within the finite theory. The Cauchy stress tensor may be defined by the relation T = (detF)-1SFT. (r) It follows1 from this definition that for any part P fSnda = f Tvda, dP »ki (P) where v is the outward unit normal to 8 Kt(P); here K((P) is the region of space occupied by P in the deformation Kt, i.e. Kt(P)={y\y = Kt(x),xtP}. Thus Tv is the force per unit area in the deformed configuration. Clearly, (r) and (0) imply that T is symmetric. Further, as detF = 1+0(.5), <U~ <~ it follows from (p) and (q) that ,( j^ T=S(i+0(8)). :^ I Thus to within terms of 0(8) the Piola-Kirchhoff stress tensor and the Cauchy stress S T "*?" tensor coincide. > ,v" 17. General solutions of the equations of equilibrium. In the absence of body forces the equations of equilibrium take the form: divS=0, S=ST. If A is a field over B, and if J27 is a differential operator with values that are symmetric tensor fields, then S=&(A) will be a solution of the equations of equilibrium provided divJS?(4)=0. 1 See, for example, Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § 43 A.
54 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 17. A field A with this property isc^ed^stressJuncUon. The first solution of the equations of equiUbriumnrEerms of ajtressTunction was Airy's1 two-dimensional solution in terms of a single scalar field. Three-dimensional generalizations of Airy's stress function were obtained by Maxwell2 and Morera3, who established two alternative solutions, each involving a triplet of scalar stress functions. Beltrami observed that the solutions due to Maxwell and Morera may be regarded as special cases of (1) Beltrami's solution.* Let A be a class C3 symmetric tensor field on B, and let S=curl curl A. Then divS=0, S=ST. Proof. The symmetry of S follows from (9) of (4.1) and the symmetry of A. On the other hand, by (7) of (4.1), div S = div curl curl A = curl div (curl A)T, and thus we conclude from (8) of (4.1) that divS=0. □ Consider now a fixed cartesian coordinate frame. Then Beltrami's solution takes the form: Further, letting [A] denote the matrix of A relative to this frame, we have for the following special choices of A: (a) Airy's solution. ro 0 0' [4]= 0 0 0 , 0 0 <p_ ^11^ V,22» ^22 = ^,111 ^12 == V,12' ^13 = 1->23 = ^33 =0J (b) Maxwell's solution. [41 = Jlx —«2,33+a! «! 0 0 0 «2 0 0 0 «0 •->12 _fl!3,i2> etc.; 1 Airy [1863, !]■ 2 Maxwell [1868, 2], [1870,1]. 3 Morera [1892, 4]. * Beltrami [1892, 1]. This solution ha_s_.be.eri-.erx^ berg [i960, 12], to Gwyther anifFiNzi by Truesdell [1959, 16] and Truesdell and ToupiN [i960,17], and to Blokh by Lur'e [1955, 10]. Related contributions and additional references can be found in the work of Morera [1892, 5], Klein andWiEGHARDT [1905,1], Love [1906, 5], Gwyther [1912,2], [1913, 1], Finzi [1934,2], Sobrero [1935, 7]. Kuzmin [1945,2], Weber [1948,7], Finzi and Pastori [1949,1], Krutkov [1949,5], Peretti [1949, 8], Blokh [1950, 3], [1961, 2], Morinaga and N6no [1950, 9], Filonenko-Borodich [1951, 7,«], [1957,6], Arzhanyh [1953,2], Schaefer [1953, IS], [1955,-72], [1959, 12], Kroner [1954, 11], [1955, 7,8], Langhaar and Stippes [1954,12], Ornstein [1954, 17], Gunther [1954, 7], Marguerre [1955, 11], Dorn and Schild [1956, 1], BrdiCka [1957, 3], Rieder [i960, 9], [1964, 17, 18, 19], Minagawa [1962, 11], [1965, 14], Gurtin [1963, 9], Kawatate [1963, 16], Pastori [1963, 21], Inov and Vvedenskii [1964,10], N6no [1964,15], Carlson [1966, 6], [1967, 4], Stippes [1966, 25], [1967, 14], Schuler and Fosdick [1967, 13].
Sect. 17. General solutions of the equations of equilibrium. 5 5 (c) Morera's solution. [A] = 0 ms co2 co3 0 a>! a>2 a>! 0 ^11 = -2^,23. ^12 = (^1,1+^2,2-^3,3),3. etc. If we define a tensor field G on B through G=A-\\txA, then A = G — \txG, and it follows from (14) of (4.1) that Beltrami's solution (1) can be written in the alternative form1 S = -A G +2V div G -1 div div 6?. By a self-equilibrated stress field we mean a smooth symmetric tensor field S on B whose resultant force and moment vanish on each closed regular surface if in B: /Snda — f px(Sn) da=0. y y Clearly, every self-equilibrated stress field S satisfies divS = 0. On the other hand, if the boundary of B consists of a single closed surface, then any closed regular surface if in B encloses only points of B, and it follows from the divergence theorem that every divergence-free symmetric tensor field will be self-equilibrated. The assumption that dB consist of a single closed surface is necessary for the validity of this converse assertion. Indeed, let B be the spherical shell B={as:a<|as—x0\<fi}. Then the stress field S defined on B by S W = a\~lp- (x~xo) ® (as -as„) (a + 0) satisfies divS = 0, S^ST, but its resultant force on any spherical surface ^={as:|as -as0| =y} (a<y<)3) is not zero. In fact, / fin da = — / bnda = — a. This result when combined with the next theorem shows that the Beltrami solution and hence the solutions of Maxwell and Morera are, in general, not complete; i.e. there exist stress fields that do not admit a representation as a Beltrami solution. (2)2 Beltrami's solution (1) always yields a self-equilibrated stress field. 1 This version of Beltrami's solution is due to Schaefer [1953, 18], 2 Rieder [i960, 9]. See also Gurtin [1963, 9].
56 M.E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 17. Proof. Let /S = curl curl A with 4 symmetric and of class C3 on B, and let W=curl.4. (a) Then by the symmetry of S— curl curl A together with Stokes' theorem (6.2), fSnda = fSTnda=f (curl W)Tnda=0 se se se for every closed regular surface S? in B. To see that the resultant moment also vanishes on SP, consider the identity px(curl W)T n = [cwl(PW)]T n + W*n — (tr W) n, (b) which holds for any tensor field W and any vector n, where P is the skew tensor corresponding to the position vector p. In view of the symmetry of A, (a) and (12) of (4.1) imply that tr W=0. Hence (a), (b), and Stokes' theorem (6.2) yield /px(Sn) da = fpx(STn) da= fpx(curl W)Tnda sr sr se = / [curl(PH0]rnda+f (curl A)Tnda=0. □ Thus sfo-ess /ieWs #&atf are not self-equilibrated cannot be represented as Beltrami [ solutions. The next theorem shows that Beltrami's solutiojris^omBleie, provided "7 ! we restrict our...attfiDtifin_t.o self-equilibrated-Stress fields.. In order_to state this fSeorem concisely, let & denote the set of ail fields of class C2 on B and class C3 onB. (3) Completeness of the Beltrami solution.1 Assume that the boundary of B is of class C3. Let S&^ be a self-equilibrated stress field. Then there exists a symmetric tensor field A& such that S= curl curl A. Proof. Since S is self-equilibrated (and hence symmetric), fSTnda=0, (a) fpx(STn)da=0, (b) for every closed regular surface S? in B. By (a) and (ii) of (6.4), there exists a tensor field We & such that S= curl W. (c) 1 Gurtin [1963, 9]. Completeness proofs were given previously by Morinaga and N6no [1950, 9], Ornstein [1954,17], Gunther [1954, 7], and Dorn and Schild [1956, 1]. However, since the necessary restriction that S be self-equilibrated is absent in all of these investigations, they can at most be valid for a region whose boundary consists of a single closed surface. Gurtin's [1963, 9] proof is based on a minor variant of Gunther's [1954, 7] argument and is quite cumbersome. The elegant proof given here is due to Carlson [1967, 4] (see also Carlson [1966, 6]).
Sect. 17. General solutions of the equations of equilibrium. 5 7 It follows from (b), (c), the identity (b) given in the proof of (2), and Stokes' theorem (6.2) that f[W-{trW)l]Tnda = 0 se for every closed regular surface S? in B. Thus, by (ii) of (6.4), there exists a tensor field Fe J5" such that W - (tr 17)1= curl F; hence (c) implies S = curl curl V + curl [(tr W) 1]. (d) If we let A=sym V, then (9) and (10) of (4.1) yield the relations sym{curl curl V} = curl curl A, sym{curl[(trH01]} = 0. Thus, since Sis symmetric, if we take the symmetric part of both sides of (d), we arrive at S = curl curl A. □ If the boundary of B consists of a single closed surface, then every symmetric divergence-free stress field is self-equilibrated, and we have the following direct corollary of (3). (4) Assume that 8B consists of a single jtass C3 closed regular surface. Let Sz& be a symmetric tensor field that satisfies divS=0. Then there exists a symmetric tensor field A^ such that S — curl curl A. The next proposition, which is a direct consequence of the compatibility theorem (14.2), shows that two tensor fields are Beltrami representations of the same stress field if and only if they differ by a strain field. (5)1 Let S— curl curl A, (a) where A is a class C2 tensor field on B. Further, let h=a+e, E = i(Vu + VuT), (b) where u is a class C3 vector field on B. Then S = curl curl II. (c) Conversely, let B be sim^J^connecjeji, and let A and H be class C2 symmetric tensor fields on B that satisfy (a) and (c). Then there exists a class C3 vector field u on B such that (b) holds. It is clear from (5) that to prove the completeness of Maxwell's solution for situations in which Beltrami's solution is complete it suffices to establish the 1 Finzi [1934, 2].
58 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 17. existence of a class C3 displacement field u that satisfies the three equations *(«<,,- + uiii) = -Aij (»■+,-). (I) On the other hand, the completeness of Morera's solution will follow if we can find a class C3 solution u of the equations uiii=Aii (no sum). (II) Here A is a given class C2 symmetric tensor field on B. Under hypotheses (i) and (iv) of (5.2) with M = \ and IV=3, as well as analogous hypotheses obtained from (i) and (iv) by cyclic permutations of the integers (1, 2, 3), the system < (II) has a solution. Therefore^ under these hypotheses a stress field S_ admits r 11 a Morera representation whenever ii admits a Beltt■ami representation. To the author's knowledge, there is, at present, no general existence theorem | -½ ' appropriate to the system (I). I; Theorems (2) and (3) assert that the Beltrami solution is complete if and only if we restrict our attention to self-equilibrated stress fields. The next two results show that it_is_jDossible_ to■__mpdify_^ellxarQi's representation so. as_ to_fQnn.a j completely general, solution of the equation of equilibrium. \ (6) Beltrami-Schaefer solution.1 Let A be a class C3 symmetric tensor field and h a harmonic field on B, and let S = curlcurl4+2Ffc — ldivfc. Then divS = 0, S=ST. Proof. The proof follows at once from (1) and the identity div[Vh + {Vh)T-ldivh]^Ah. □ (7) Completeness of the Beltrami-Schaefer solution.2 Let S be a symmetric tensor field that is continuous on B and class C2 on B, and suppose that divS = 0. Then there exists a class C3 symmetric tensor field A and a harmonic vector field h on B such that ^ S = cUTlcurlA+2Vh — 1 divfc. Proof. By (6.5) there exists a class C3 symmetric tensor field G on B such that S = -AG. Thus S = -A G + 2P"div G -1 div div G -2Fdiv G +1 div div G, and letting A^G-ltvG, h=~6ivG, 1 Schaefer [1953, 18]. 2 Gurtin [1963, 9] introduced the following solution: S = curl curl^1 + 2/4 Vb-FPdivb, (*) where A is symmetric and 6 biharmonic, and established its completeness. Shortly thereafter Schaefer noticed that the completeness of (*) implies the completeness of the Beltrami- Schaefer solution (private communication). The direct completeness proof given above appears here in print for the first time.
Sect. 18. Consequences of the equation of equilibrium. 59 we see from (14) of (4.1) that S=curlcurl.A + 2Ffc — 1 divfc. Further, the fact that S is divergence-free implies that h is harmonic. □ Let S satisfy the hypotheses of (7), and let Se = curl curl A, Sh = 2Vh — ldivh, where A and h are the fields established in (7). By (2) Se is self-equilibrated, while (6) implies that Sh is divergence-free and symmetric. Further, since h is harmonic, so is Sh. Thus we have the (8) Decomposition theorem for stress fields.1 Let S satisfy the hypotheses of (7). Then S = Se -\- Sh, where Se is a self-equilibrated stress field, and Sh is a harmonic tensor field that satisfies divS,=0, Sh=Sf. Finally, it is clear from the proof of (6) that2 S = 2Vh-l divfc, Ah^-b furnishes a particular solution of the inhomogeneous equations of equilibrium divS + 6=0, S = ST. v 18. Consequences of the equation of equilibrium. In this section we study properties of solutions to the equation of equilibrium divS+ 6=0, assuming throughout that a continuous body force field 6 is prescribed on B. For convenience, we introduce the following two definitions. A vector field u is an admissible displacement field provided (i)3 u is of class C2 on B; (ii) u and Vu are continuous on B. On the other hand, an admissible stress field is a symmetric tensor field S with the following properties: (i) S is smooth on B; (ii) S and div S are continuous on B. The associated surface force field is then the vector field s defined at every regular point x£dB by s(x) =S(x) n(x), where n (as) is the outward unit normal vector to dB at x. 1 Cf. Gurtin [1963, 9], Theorem 4.4. 2 Schaefer [1953, 18]. 3 Actually, for the results established in this section, this requirement may be replaced by the assumption that m be smooth on B.
60 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 18. The following lemma will be extremely useful throughout this article. (1) Lemma. Let S be an admissible stress field and u an admissible displacement field. Then f s -uda= fu- div S dv + f S ■ Vudv. SB B B Proof. By the divergence theorem, (11) of (4.1), and the symmetry of S, f u ■ Snda= f (Su) ■ nda= f div(Su) dv — f u ■ div Sdv-\- f S ■ Vudv. dB dB B B B The symmetry of S also requires that S-Vu=S-VuT=S-Vu, and the proof is complete. □ If S is a solution of the equation of equilibrium, then div S = — 6, and (1) has the following important corollary. y (2) Theorem of work expended.1 Let S be an admissible stress field and u an admissible displacement field, and suppose that S satisfies the equation of equilibrium. Then fs-uda+fb-udv = fS-Edv, dB B B where E is the strain field corresponding to u. This theorem asserts that the work done2 by the surface and body forces over the displacement field u is equal to the work done by the stress field over the strain field corresponding to u. If u is a rigid displacement field, then Vu =0, and the above relation reduces to " fs-uda+fb-udv =0. dB B Thus the work expended over a rigid displacement field vanishes. Our next theorem shows that, conversely, the balance laws for forces and moments are implied by the requirement that the work done by the surface and body forces be zero over every rigid displacement. (3) Piola's theorem.3 Let s be an integrable vector field on dB. Then f s ■ w da-\- / 6 -wdv=0 dB B 1Ci. Theorem (28.3). 2 We follow Love [1927, 3], § 120, in referring to, e.g., fs-uda (a) dB as the work done by the surface force s over the displacement u. In the dynamical theory the work is given by f f st-u(da dt, (b) (, dB where [t0, <x] is the interval of time during which the time-dependent surface force st acts, and where iif is the velocity of the time-dependent displacement field ut. Formally, (b) reduces to (a) if we assume that the spatial fields s and m are applied suddenly, i.e., if st{x)— s(x) h(t—X) and ut(x)=u(x) h(t—X), where h is the Heaviside unit step function and 3 Piola [1833, 2], [1848, 1]. See also Truesdeix and Toupin [i960,17], § 232.
Sect. 18. Consequences of the equation of equilibrium. 61 for every rigid displacement w if and only if f s da+ f bdv = 0, dB B fpxsda+fpxbdv = 0. dB B Proof. Let w=u0 + W0p with W0 skew. In view of the identity a • W0 e = W0 • (a ® e), which holds for all vectors a and e, A(w) ^fs-wda+fb-wdv dB B = u0- j fsda + f bdv\ +W0-i f s®pda + / b%pdv\. Ub b > Ub b > Thus A (w) =0 for every rigid displacement w (or equivalently, for every vector u0 and every skew tensor W0) if and only if s and 6 satisfy balance of forces and, in addition, skwj fp<g>sda + f p<g)bdv\ =0. las b J This completes the proof, since the above relation is equivalent to balance of moments. □ The theorem of work expended was generalized by Signorini1 in the following manner. • (4) Signorini's theorem. Let S be an admissible stress field that satisfies the equation of equilibrium, and let w be a smooth vector field on B. Then fw<S)sda-\-fw<S)bdv— f (Vw) S dv. dB B B Proof. By the divergence theorem, fw®sda = fw<g)(Sn) da= /w>®(div/S) dv+ / (Vw) ST dv. dB dB B B This completes the proof, since ST =S and div S — — b. □ Since Pw = %{Vw + VwT), the symmetry of S yields tr[(Fw) S]=8 -Vw = S- Vw. Thus if we take the trace of Signorini's relation, we arrive at the theorem of work expended. Given an admissible stress field S, we call the symmetric tensor sw = vkfsdv B the mean stress. Here v (B) is the volume of B. 1 Signorini [1933, 4]. Actually, Signorini's theorem is slightly more general.
62 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 18. (5) Mean stress theorem.1 The mean stress corresponding to an admissible stress field that satisfies the equation of equilibrium depends only on the associated surface traction and body force fields and is given by S(B)= u(1B) [ Jp®sda + jp®bdv . Ufl B Proof. We simply take w in Signorini's theorem equal to p and use the identity Vp=l. □ The next three theorems give alternative characterizations of the equations of equilibrium and compatibility. X (6) Let S be an admissible stress field, and suppose that f S • Vudv — f b ■ udv B B i" ■ for every class '.C*'vector field uon B that vanishes near dB. Then divS+b=0. Proof. Let u be a class C°° vector field on B that vanishes near dB. By the symmetry of S, S • Vu=S • Vu; thus we conclude from (1) that the integral identity in (6) must reduce to /(divS + b) -udv=0. B Since u was arbitrarily chosen, we conclude from the fundamental lemma (7.1) that divS +6 = 0. □ (7) Let S be an admissible stress field, and suppose that f S-Edv=0 B for every class C°° symmetric tensor field E on B that vanishes near 8B and satisfies the equation of compatibility. Then "~ " ~ divS = 0. Proof. Let u be a class C00 vector field on B that vanishes near dB, and let E be the corresponding strain field. Then E satisfies the equation of compatibility and vanishes near dB; hence, by hypothesis, /S- Vudv=0, B and the proof follows from (6). □ ^(8) Donati's theorem.2 Let E be a class C2 symmetric tensor field on B. Further, suppose that3 f S-Edv=0 B 1 Chree [1892, 2], p. 336. See also Signorini [1932, 5]. 2Donati [1890, i], [1894,2]. See also Cotterill [1865, i], Southwell [1936,5], [1938,5], Locatelli [1940,3,4], Moriguti [1948,5], Klyushnikov [1954, 10], Washizu [1958, 20], Blokh [1962, 2], StickforthJi964, 21], [1965, 17], and Tonti [1967, 16, 17]. 3 Notice that S-E is continuous on B, since S vanishes near dB.
Sect. 18. Consequences of the equation of equilibrium. 63 for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on B that vanishes near dB and satisfies divS = 0. Then E satisfies the equation of compatibility. Proof. Let A be a symmetric tensor field of class C°° on_B that vanishes near dB, and let S = curl curl A. Then S vanishes near dB, and by (17.1), S is symmetric and divergence-free. Thus / E ■ (curl curl A) dv = 0. B If we apply the divergence theorem twice and use the fact that A and all of its derivatives vanish on dB, we find that / E • (curl curl A) dv = / (curl E)T ■ (curl A) dv = f (curl curl E)-Adv. B B B Thus / (curl curl E) ■ A dv = 0. B Since curl curl E is symmetric, and since the above relation must hold for every such function A, it follows from the fundamental lemma (7.1) that E satisfies the equation of compatibility. □ Let s be an integrable vector field whose domain is a regular subsurface S? of dB, let b be an integrable vector field on B, and let I be a vector field whose domain is a finite point set {&, £2, ■••. &v} of B. Further, let ln=l(^n). The function s can be thought of as a surface traction field on Sf, b as a body force field, and 1^ as a concentrated load applied at £M. We say that s, b, and I are in equilibrium if N fsda+fbdv+Zln=0, (E) fpxsda+ fpxbdv + Z(l;n-0)xln = 0. Sf B n=l A somewhat more stringent condition is that of astatic_jguilibriumi in which the system of forces is required to_remain in equilibrium..when..xQtated.through an arbitrary angle. More precisely, s, b and I are in astatic equilibrium if Qs, Qb, and Ql are in equilibrium for every orthogonal tensor Q, i.e. if JQsda + fQbdv+ZQln = 0, (A) JpxQsda + fpxQbdv + Z(l;n-0)xQln = 0, Sf B n=l for every orthogonal Q. (9) Conditions for astatic equilibrium.1 Let s, b, and I be as defined above. Then s, b, and I are in astatic equilibrium if and only if the following two conditions hold: (i) s, b, and I are in equilibrium; (ii) fp®sda+ fj>®brff+2(?»-0)®«„ = 0. sr B n=X 1 In classical statics, in which the loads are all concentrated, this result has long been known (see, e.g., Routh [1908, 3], p. 313). The extension to distributed loads is due to Berg [1969, i].
64 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 19. Proof.1 Assume that s, b, and I are in astatic equiMbrium. Then (i) follows from (A) with Q = l. Let T denote the left-hand side of (ii). By (E2), skw T = 0; thus T is symmetric. Next, by (A2), 0 = skw\ f p®Qs da + f p®Qb dv + % ($n-0)®Ql}; VST B n-l J thus, since a®Qc = (a®c)QT for all vectors a and c, skw(TQT)=0. Consequently, TQT = QT. (a) Let T=^Xini®ni (b) »=i be the spectral decomposition of T (in the sense of the spectral theorem (3.2)). By (a) and (b), 2 a*ih®0»<=2 *<«?»<) ®»«. (c) »=i »=i and this relation must hold for every orthogonal tensor Q. Let Q be the orthogonal tensor with the following properties: Qn1=n2, Qn^=nz, J?n3=n1. (d) If we operate with both sides of (c) on 1¾ and use (d) and the fact that n^ify = <5<;-, we find that ^2 **2 = /3 Hj, which implies that A2 = A3 = 0. Similarly, ^=0. Thus T = 0 and (ii) holds. Assume now that (i) and (ii) hold. Let T be as before. Then T = 0 and O^TQT=Jp®Qsda + fp®Qbdv+Z(L-0)®Qln. (e) Se B n=l If we take the skew part of (e), we are led, at once, to (A2). On the other hand, (At) is an immediate consequence of (¾. □ In view of (9), the mean stress theorem (5) has the following interesting consequence. (10)2 The mean stress corresponding to an admissible stress field that satisfies the equation of equilibrium vanishes if and only if the associated surface traction and body force fields are in astatic equilibrium. 19. Consequences of the equation of motion. In this section we study properties of solutions to the equation of motion div S+b=QU on a given time interval [0, t0), assuming throughout that a continuous and strictly positive density field q is prescribed on B. Given a dynamical process3 [tt, S, b], we call K=% / Qti2dv B 1 This proof differs from that given by Berg [1969, T\. 2 Signorini [1932, 5]. 3 See p. 49-
Sect. 19. Consequences of the equation of motion. 65 the kinetic energy and fS-Edv B the stress power; here E is the strain field associated with u. (1) Theorem of power expended.1 Let [u^S.b] be a dynamical process. Then fs-iida+fb-iidv = fS- E dv+K. dB B B Proof. The proof follows from the theorem of work expended (18.2) with b replaced by b — qu and u replaced by u. □ Theorem (1) asserts that the rate of working of the surface tractions and body forces equals the stress power plus the rate of change of kinetic energy. If m(.,0) = u(-,t), then, by (1), T T T . / f s • iida dt+ // b ■ iidv dt= / f S • E dv dt; 0 SB OB OB i.e., when the initial and terminal velocity fields coincide, the work done by the external forces is equal to the work done by the stress field. As we shall see later, in a homogeneous deformation of a homogeneous body the stress and strain fields S and E are independent of position. In this instance b=Qti and (1) implies S-.13=-7^- ( suda; dB i.e., the stress power density is equal to the rate of working of the surface tractions per unit volume.2 The next .theorem will be of use when we discuss variational principles for elastcdynamics; it shows that the equation of motion and the appropriate initial conditions are together equivalent to a single integral-differential equation. Let i be the function on [0, t0) defined by i(t)=t. (2)3 Let bbea continuous vector field on Bx [0, t0), let u be an admissible motion, and let S be a time-dependent admissible stress field. Further, let u0 and v0 be vector fields on B, and let f be defined on Bx [0, t0) by f(x, t) =i*b(x, t) +q(x) [u0(x) +tv0(x)]. Then [u, S, b] is a dynamical process consistent with the initial conditions tt(.,0)=tt0, tt(.,0)=w0 if and only if i*div S+f — QU. (a) 1 Stokes [1851, 2], Umov [1874, 2]. Cf. also v. Mises [1909, 11, Truesdell and Toupin [1960,i7], §217- 2 Cf. Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], Eq. (18.7). 8 Gurtin [1964, 8], Theorem 3.1. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 5
66 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 19. Proof. If the equation of motion and the initial conditions hold, then t i* [div S + b] (x, t) =q (x) / (t — r) it (x, r) dr 0 = q (x) u (x, t)—q (x) [tv0 (x) + u0 (as)], which implies (a). The converse is easily established by reversing the above argument. □ The next lemma, which is a counterpart of (18.1), will be extremely useful in establishing variational principles for elastodynamics. (3) Lemma. Let w be an admissible motion and S a time-dependent admissible stress field. Then { s*wda— f w*divS dv-\- f S*Vw dv. dB B B Proof. By (18.1), t f s*w da= f / s(x,t — r) • w(x, r) dadr d'B 6 dB t ^ = // [div S(x,t — r)-w (x, r) + S(x, t — x) ■ Vw (x, r)] dv dr 0 B = / divS*wdv-\- f S*Vwdv. □ B B When u0 and v0 are the initial values of u and u, we call the function f defined in (2) the pseudo body force field. Our next theorem gives an analog of the theorem of work expended (18.2). (4) Let [u, S, b] be a dynamical process, let f be the corresponding pseudo body force field, and let w be an admissible motion. Then i* / s*w da-\- / f*w dv=i* f S*Vio dv + / qu*w dv. dB B B B In particular, when w=u, i*Js*uda->rJf*udv=i*jS*Edv-\- / qu*udv. dB B B B Proof. By (2) and (3), i* / s*w da= f (i*div S)*w dv-\-i* / S*Vw dv dB B B = / {QU—f)*w dv-\-i* / S*Vw dv. □ B B (5) Reciprocal theorem.1 Let [u, S, b] and [u, S, b] be dynamical processes, and let f and f be the corresponding pseudo body force fields. Then i* / s*uda-\- f f*udv —i* / S*E dv dB B „ B (a) = i* f s*u da -\- f f*u dv — i* f S*E dv, dB B B / s*iida-\- / b*udv— / S*Edv-\- / q(u0 ■ u-\-v0 ■ ft) dv dB B B B ftA = f s*uda+ f b*udv — f S*Edv + f q(u0- ii + v0- u) dv. dB B B B 1 This theorem, which appears for the first time here, is based on an idea of Graffi [1947, 2], [1954, 6], [1963, 8] (see Sect. 61 of this article).
Sect. 20. The elasticity tensor. 67 Thus if u0=v0=u0 = v0— 0, then / s*uda-\- f b*udv — / S*E dv = / s*uda-\- fb*udv — f S*E dv. (c) SB B B SB B B Proof. The relation (a) follows from (4) and the fact that fqu*udv = /qu*udv. B B To verify (b) we note first that (vi) of (10.1) implies i*y)—y). (d) Thus, in view of the definition of /, f*u= b*u+ q(u0-u+v0- u). (e) Therefore if we differentiate (a) twice with respect to t using (d), (e), and the analog of (e) for f and u, we arrive at (b). □ Given a time-dependent admissible stress field S and an admissible motion u, let M denote the four-tensor field with space-time partition /S —QU 0 0 J' we call M the associated stress-momentum field. The importance of this field is clear from the following theorem. (6) Balance of momentum in space-time. Let b be a continuous vector field on Bx [0, t0). Further, let S be a time-dependent admissible stress field, let u be an admissible motion, and let M be the associated stress-momentum field. Then [u, S, b] is a dynamical process if and only if f Mnda + fbdv=0 3D D for every regular region D with D in Bx(0, t0). Here n is the outward unit normal to 8D and b = (b,0). Proof. By the divergence theorem (11.2), the above relation is equivalent to / (divwM+b)dv=0. D This equation holds for all regular D if and only if div(4)M+b=0, or equivalently, by the identity (11.1), divS — gii + b = 0. Q III. The constitutive relation for linearly elastic materials. 20. The elasticity tensor. The laws of momentum balance hold in every dynamical process, no matter of what material the body is composed. A specific material is defined by a constitutive relation which places restrictions on the class of processes the body may undergo. Here we will be concerned exclusively 5*
68 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 20. with linearly elastic materials. For such materials the stress at any time and point in a dynamical process is a linear function of the displacement gradient at the same time and place. Moreover, while this function may depend on the point under consideration, it is independent of the time. Therefore we say that the body is linearly elastic if for each xeB there exists a linear transformation Cx from the space of all tensors into the space of all symmetric tensors such that1 S(x)=Cx[Vu(x)-\. We call Cx the elasticity tensor for x and the function C on B with values Cx the elasticity field. In general, Cx depends on x; if, however, Cx and the density q (x) are independent of x, we say that B is homogeneous. We postulate that a rigid displacement field results in zero stress at each point? Let W be an arbitrary skew tensor. Then the field u{x) =W[x — x0] is a rigid displacement field with Vu(x)=W; thus we conclude from the above postulate that Cx[W]=0. Since this result must hold for every xeB and for every skew tensor W, Cu[A]=Cm[symA\ for every tensor A. Therefore Cx is completely determined by its restriction to the space of all symmetric tensors. In particular, our original constitutive relation reduces to 8{x)=Cm[E{x)], where E is the strain field corresponding to Vu. Since the space of all symmetric tensors has dimension 6, the matrix (relative to any basis) of the restriction of Cx to this space is 6x6. For the moment let us write C = CX. Consider an orthonormal basis (¾. e2, eg}, and let CijH denote the components of C relative to this basis: Qi*i = (e,®e;)'C[es®e,]. Then S=C[E] takes the form Moreover, since the values of C are symmetric, and since the value of C on any tensor A equals its value on the symmetric part of A, C»jki = (sym e{ ® e;.) • C[sym eh ® e{\; hence We call the 36 numbers Ciikl elasticities. 1 Thus we have made the tacit assumption that the stress is zero when the displacement gradient vanishes; or equivaleritly, that the residual stress in the body is zero. At first sight it appears that such an assumption rules out elastic fluids, for which there is always a residual pressure. However, if the residual stress is a constant pressure, and if we interpret S(x) as the actual stress minus the residual stress, then all of our results are valid without change, provided, of course, we interpret the corresponding surface tractions accordingly. 2 Poisson 1829 [1831, T\. See also Cauchy [1829, T\. This axiom is discussed in detail by Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], §§ 19, 19A.
Sect. 21. Material symmetry. 69 (1) Properties of the elasticity tensor. For every xeB: (i) Cx [A] — Cx [sym A] for every tensor A; (ii) D • Cx [A] = (sym D) ■ Cx [sym A] for every pair of tensors A and D; (iii) Cijk, = (sym et ® e;) • Cx [sym eh ® e{\, so that Proof. Properties (i) and (iii) have already been established. Property (ii) follows from (i) and the fact that the values of Cx are symmetric tensors. □ If the elasticity tensor is invertible,1 then its inverse K — C-1 is called the compliance tensor; it defines a relation E(x)=Kx[S(x)] between the strain E(x) and the stress S(x) at x. The following definitions will be important in what follows. Consider a fixed point x of the body, and let C = CX denote the elasticity tensor for x. We say that C is symmetric^ . A _ c^ =fi _ c^ for every pair of symmetric tensors A and B, positwe^semi-definite if A- C[A]^0 for every symmetric tensor A, and positive definite if A-C[A]>0 for every non-zero symmetric tensor A. Clearly, C is symmetric if and only if its components obey so that in this instance C has 21, rather than 36, distinct elasticities. Note also that C is invertible whenever it is positive definite. For the remainder of the article we assume given an elasticity field C on B. \21. Material symmetry. Assume that the material is linearly elastic in the sense of the stress-strain relation S = CX[E] discussed in the previous section. In order to specify the symmetry properties of the material, we introduce the notion of a symmetry group. Our first step will be to motivate this concept. Let x be a ftm? point in jg, let u and u* be smooth vector fields whose domain is a neigE5brHood of x, and suppose that u* is related to u by an orthogonal tensor Q: u*(y*)=Qu(y) whenever y* = Q(y—x)+x. (a) 1 By this statement we mean: "if the restriction of the elasticity tensor to the space of all symmetric tensors is invertible." The elasticity tensor, when regarded as a linear transformation on the space of all tensors, cannot be invertible since its value on every skew tensor is zero.
70 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 21. Roughly speaking, (a) asserts that if the point y* is obtained from y by a rotation Q about x, then the displacement u*(y*) is simply the displacement u (y) rotated by Q. If for every such u and u* the corresponding stresses satisfy -.Cx [«(*)], S*=Cx[E*(x)] S*=QSQT, (b) (c) then we call Q a symmetry transformation for the material at x. Condition (c) is slightly more transparent when phrased in terms of the surface force vectors s„=Sn, s£*=/S*n"; indeed, (c) is equivalent to the requirement that (see Fig. 9). s»» = J?s„ whenever n*=Qn By (a) Fig. 9. Vu*(x)=QVu(x)QT, and hence the corresponding strain tensors are related by E*(x)=QE(x)QT. (d) It follows from (b), (c), and (d) that a sufficient condition for an orthogonal tensor Q to be a symmetry transformation is that QCm[E]QT = Cm[QEQT] (e) for every symmetric tensor E. That this condition is also necessary can be easily verified using displacement fields which are pure strains from x. Thus we have motivated the following definition:1 the symmetry group %. for the material at x is the set of all orthogonal tensors Q that obey (e) for every symmetric tensor E. 1 Our definition is consistent with the notion of symmetry group (isotropy group) as employed in general non-linear continuum mechanics (see, e.g.,TRUESDELL and Noll [1965,22], § 31). Since the symmetry group of a solid relative to an undistorted configuration is a subgroup of the orthogonal group, our treatment is sufficiently general to include elastic solids of arbitrary symmetry. While we do not rule out non-orthogonal symmetry toansformations, WfijiCLJKlt^tudjutheiiu, The treatment of more general symmetry groups is essential to a systematic study of fluid crystals (see, e.g., Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § 33 bis.).
Sect. 21. Material symmetry. 71 To show that the above definition is consistent, i.e. that (SX really is a group, it is sufficient to verify that Q,P^X^QP^X. Note first that (e) can be written in the form CX[E]=QTCX[QEQT]Q. (f) If 06¾. then, since 00r = l. (f) applied to the symmetric tensor QTEQ yields cm[QTBQi=QTc*[Q(QT'SQ)QT]Q = QTc*mQ- Thus we conclude from (e) that QT = Q'1 belongs to %.. Next, if Q, P£@x, then two applications of (f) yield Cx [E] = PTCX [PEPT]P=PTQTCX [Q(PEPT) QT] QP = (QP)TCX[(QP)E(QP)T]QP; thus QPe@x. Therefore @x is, indeed, a group. , (1) Let Cx be invertible, and let Kx be the corresponding compliance tensor. Then QKX[S]QT=KX[QSQT] for every 06¾ and every symmetric tensor S. Proof. Choose S arbitrarily, and let E = KX[S\. Then S = Cx[E] and QSQT = CX[QEQT], therefore QEQT = Km[QSQT], or equivalently, QKm[S]QT = Km[Q8Q^]. D We say that the material at x is isotropic if the symmetry group <SX equals the orthogonal group, anisotropic if ^x is a proper subgroup of the orthogonal group. Clearly, &x always contains the two-element group { — 1,1} as a subgroup. In fact, ^x is the direct product of this two-element group and a group ?SX which consists only of proper orthogonal transformations; hence the syjnmetry of Jthe material is completely characterized by_the_grqup 5¾.. In particular, the material at x is isotropic or anisotropic according as <&x equals or is a proper subgroup of the proper orthogonal group. Although there are an infinite number of subgroups of the proper orthogonal group, twelve of them seem to exhaust the kinds of symmetries occurring in theories proposed up to now as being appropriate to describe the behavior of real anisotropic elastic materials. The first eleven of these subgroups of the proper orthogonal group correspond to the thirty-two crystal classes.1 We denote~Tfaese subgroups by ^, ...,¾^. Table 1, which is due to Coleman and Noll,2 lists the generators of each of these groups; in this table {fe, I, m} denotes a right-handed orthonormal basis, q= j/f (fe + Z+m), and Rg is the orthogonal tensor corresponding to a right- 1 The thirty-two crystal classes are discussed by Schoenfliess [1891, 1], Voigt [1910, 1], Flint [1948, 4], Dana and Hurlbut [1959, Z], Smith and Rivlin [1958, 16], Coleman and Noll [1964, 5], Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], Burckhardt [1966, 5]. 2 [1964, 5].
72 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 21. handed rotation through the angle cp, 0< cp<2n, about an axis in the direction of the unit vector e. The last type of anisotropy, called transverse isotropy (with respect to a direction m), is characterized by the group ^12 consisting of 1 and the rotations R$n, 0<cp<2n. Transverse isotropy is appropriate to real materials having a laminated or a bundled structure. A material is called orthotropic if its symmetry group contains reflections on three mutually perpendicular planes. Such a triple of reflections is — R%, —JRf, -¾.] Since RgRf =¾ and (Rly=R%, it follows that the groups ^3> ^6 > ^6 > and ^7 correspond to orthotropic materials. Table 1. Crystal class Group Generators of #„ Order of #„ Triclinic system all classes Monoclinic system all classes Rhombic system all classes Tetragonal system tetragonal-disphenoidal tetragonal-pyramidal tetragonal-dipyramidal tetragonal-scalenohedral di tetragonal-pyramidal tetragonal-trapezohedral ditetragonal-dipyramidal Cubic system tetartoidal diploidal hexatetrahedral gyroidal hexoctahedral Hexagonal system trigonal-pyramidal rhombohedral ditrigonal-pyramidal trigonal-trapezohedral hexagonal-scalenohedral trigonal-dipyramidal hexagonal-pyramidal hexagonal-dipyramidal ditrigonal-dipyramidal dihexagonal-pyramidal hexagonal-trapezohedral dihexagonal-dipyramidal We say that the material at x has ^n-symmetry if ^„ is a subgroup of %.. We call two groups <€m and e6n equivalent if given any symmetric elasticity .tensor Cx, *« = «.«**»= %■ ( A group $fB is distinct if there is no c€m (m=^n) equivalent to e&n. It will be clear —>| from the results of Sect. 26 that ^, ^, ^3, ^4, ^B, ^8, and ^9 are distinct; ^6 j and c€1 are equivalent; ^10, ^11( and $flg are equivalent. By definition, the sym- ' metry group ¾ is a maximal group of symmetry transformations; thus the groups 1 Run Ru.Ri R%*tl R%. Ri, R*q Bin nln jiln r%,r\Z, /lin Rk,R% 12 24 12
Sect. 21. Material symmetry. 73 ^6 > ^7» ^io < ^ii > ^12 cannot be symmetry groups, since invaxiance with respect to one of these, <£„ say, implies invariance with respect to another group which contains elements not in c€n. A unit vector e is called an axis of symmetry (for the material at x) if Qe=e for some Q<c%, with Q 4= 1. Thus e is an axis of symmetry if and only if one of the symmetry transformations is a rotation about the axis spanned by e; i.e., if and only if R%£% for some <p (0<<p<2ri). Consider now the stress S due to a uniform dilatation E=el: S = C[«1], where C = Cx. Then QSQT = C[eQlQT]=C[el] = S or QS=SQ for every Q&%.', i.e. S commutes with every Q in ^,. But by the commutation theorem (3.3), a symmetric tensor S commutes with an orthogonal tensor Q if and only if Q leaves each of the characteristic spaces of S invariant. The_only subspace of V" invariant, under. all.i3rtJfa>o^ is the full vector^ space^'ftself. Thus if the material at x is isotropic, then every vector in ~if is a principal direction of S. Therefore it follows from the spectral theorem (3.2) that the response to a uniform dilatation is a uniform pressure, i.e. q>i]=ai. Now assume: tha^the^material at x is anisotropic and again consider the stress S = C[el] due to a uniform dilatation. If (p^n, the only spaces left invariant by the rotation R% are the one-dimensional space spanned by e, the two-dimensional space of all vectors perpendicular to e, and the entire space y. The rotation JR™ leaves invariant, in addition, each one-dimensional space spanned by a vector perpendicular to e. These facts, the spectral theorem (3.2), and the commutation theorem (3.3) enable one to establish easily the results collected in the following table.1 Table 2. Type of symmetry Triclinic system (¾) Monoclinic system (¾^) Rhombic system (¾) Tetragonal system (#4, #5) Hexagonal system (<?8, #9, #10, ^fjj) Transverse isotropy C^la) Cubic system (#6, #7) Isotropy Restriction on the stress S due to a uniform dilatation E= e 1 no restriction m is a principal direction of S ft, I, m are principal directions of S S = al +§m® m S = al 1 Coleman and Noll [1964, 5].
74 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 22. Of future use is the following > ^X (2) Identity. Given any two vectors a, b, let A{a, b) = %(a®b+b®a). Th&yi C[A(m, n)] • A(a, b) =C[A(Qm, Qn)] ■ A(Qa, Qb) for all vectors a, b, m, n and every Q£@x. Here C = CX. Proof. Since Q(m®n)QT = (Qm)®{Qn), it follows that QA{m, n) QT =A{Qm, Qn), and thus QC[A(m, n)] QT = C[A(Qm, Qn)] (a) for every 06¾. Next, in view of the identity T ■ (u®v)=u ■ Tv, (QBQT) ■ (Qa®Qb)=Qa ■ QBQTQb=a ■ Bb = B ■ (a®b); therefore if we let B = C[A(m, n)] and use (a) and (ii) of (20.1), we arrive at the desired identity. □ In view of (iii) of (20.1), Ciju=A-{eit e,-) • Cx[A(ek, e,)], and we conclude from the identity (2) that for an isotropic material the components of Cx are independent of the orthonormal basis {e1,e2, e3}. 22. Isotropic materials. In this section we shall determine the restrictions placed on the constitutive relation S=CX[E] when the material at x is isotropic; i.e. when the symmetry group @x equals the full orthogonal group. In a later section we will discuss the form of the elasticity tensor for various anisotropic materials. n ^s (1) Theorem on the response of isotropic materials. Assume that the material at x is isotropic. Then: (i) The response to a uniform dilatation is a uniform pressure, i.e. there exists a constant k, called the modulus of compression, such that c*[i]=3*i- (ii) The response to a simple shear is a pure shear; i.e. there exists a constant p, called the shear modulus,1 such that Cx [sym (m ® n)] = 2/j, sym (m ® n) whenever m and n are orthogonal unit vectors. (iii) If E0 is a traceless symmetric tensor, then Cx[E0] = 2fiE0. Proof. Assertion (i) was established in the previous chapter (see the remarks leading to Table 2). v To establish (ii) let ^- A(m, n) =syia(tn®n), 1 The shear modulus is often denoted by G.
Sect. 22. Isotropic materials. 75 where m and n are orthogonal unit vectors, let e=mxn, and choose Q such that Qm = — m, Qn = —n, Qe — e, i.e. Q is a rotation about e of 180°. Then, writing C = CX, we conclude from the identity (21.2) with a=m and 6 =e that C[i4(m, n)] • A(m, e) = — C[i4(m, n)] • A(m, e), and hence C[A(m, n)] • .4(m, e) =0. (a^ Similarly, C[.4(m, n)] • A(n, e) =0. (a2) Next, if we choose Q such that Qm=m, Qn = —n, Qe=e, and take a —b =m, n, or e, we conclude from (21.2) that C[^l(m, n)] • .4 (a, o) =0 for a=m,n, ore. (ag) Now let (i = C[A(m, n)] • .4(m, n). (b) In view of (3.1), the six tensors ]/2A(m, n), ^2A(n, e), ^2A{m, e), V2A(m, m), y2A(n, n), y2A(e, e) form an orthonormal basis for the space of all symmetric tensors. By (a) and (b), the only non-zero component of C[A(m, n)] relative to this basis is the component j/2^ relative to ^2A{m, n); thus C[A(m, n)] = 2fiA(m, n). (c) Now let u and v be orthogonal unit vectors and choose Q such that Qm—u, Qn—v. Then (21.2) with a=m, b=n implies C[A(m, n)] • 4(m, n) = C[A(u, »)] • 4(m, »), and thus the scalar (i in (c) is independent of the choice of m and n. To establish (iii) let E0 be a traceless symmetric tensor. By (13.7) there exist scalars ^,¾.¾ and an orthonormal basis e^ e2, e3 such that JS0 = ^ 4(¾. e2) +¾ 4(e2, eg) +xzA{ez, ej; thus (ii) and the linearity of C imply ^[«01 = 21««,. D
76 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 22. V- U- (2) Theorem on the elasticity tensor for isotropic materials. The //■' material at x is isotropic if and only if the elasticity tensor C — Cx has the form1 C[JB] = 2|»B + A(trB)l for every symmetric tensor E; the scalars /j,=/j,(x) and X=X(x) are called the Lame moduli.2. Moreover, /jl is the shear modulus and X =k —§ jx, where k is the modulus of compression. Proof. We first assume that C[E] = 2/*E+X(txE)l. Let Q be orthogonal. Then ti(QEQT)=tr(QTQE)=txE, and therefore QC[E]QT=2/,QEQT+l.(tiE)QlQT = 2fiQEQT +X[ti(QEQT)]l = C[QEQT]. Thus the material at x is isotropic. Conversely, assume that the material at x is isotropic. Let E be an arbitrary symmetric tensor. Then E admits the decomposition E=E0 + i(trE)l, tvE0 = 0, and (i) and (iii) of (1) yield C[E] = 2/*E0 + k{tiE)l. But since E0=E — ^(trE)l, if we let X=k— %/x, we arrive at the desired result. □ Note that the isotropic constitutive relation S = 2f*E+X(trE)l takes the form Sij = 2fiEij + XEkkdij when referred to cartesian coordinates. When the material is isotropic, (1) implies that C maps multiples of the identity into multiples of the identity and traceless tensors into traceless tensors. The next proposition shows that those are the only two tensor spaces that are invariant under C. \" (3) Characteristic values of the elasticity tensor. Assume that the material at x is isotropic with 2^=4=3^- Then the linear transformation* C = CX has exactly two characteristic values: 3& and 2ft. The characteristic space corresponding to 3 & is the set of all tensors of the form ocl, where a is a scalar: the characteristic space corresponding to 2fi is the set of all traceless symmetric tensors. Proof. By (i) and (iii) of (1), 2(i and 3^=2^ + 3^ are characteristic values of C. Further, if C[E]=fiE, then (2) implies that (2p-p)E + X(trE)l=0; (a) thus (for E 4=0) P=2fi^trE=0. (b) 1 The basic ideas underlying this constitutive relation were presented by Fresnel [1866, 1] in 1829. This form of the relation with fi = X was derived from a molecnlar model by Navier [1823, 2], [I827, 2] and Poisson [1829, 2]. The general isotropic relation is due to Cauchy [1823, 1], [1828, 1], [1829, 1], [1830, 1]. Cf. Poisson [1831, 1]. 2 Lame [18S2, 2]. 3 Here C is considered as a linear transformation on the space of symmetric tensors. h
Sect. 22. Isotropic materials. 77 (Note that A 4=0, since 3^4=2^.) On the other hand, if tr 22=4=0, then (a) yields |8 = 2^ + 3A<^JS = i(trB)l. (c) Therefore the two spaces specified in (3) are characteristic spaces of C. Taking the trace of (a), we see that (2^t + 3A—j8)trJS = 0. Thus either /9 = 2^+3A or tr E = 0. If trJ3=0, then (a) implies that /5 = 2/«. Thus 2^+3^ and 2[i are the only characteristic values of. C. □ Note that if 2/* = 3k, so that X = 0, then every symmetric tensor is a characteristic vector for C. Assume now that the material at x is isotropic, so that S = 2(iE + k{trE)l. (I) C1Carly' trS = (2^ + 3A)trE. Thus if we assume that /jl 4= 0, 2/jl + 3 X 4= 0, then E: -s- (trS)l, 2,U '" 2^(2^ + 3¾ and we have the following result. /,\ (4) If the material at x is isotropic, and if fi 4=0, 2//4-3^4=0, then C is in- vertible, and the compliance tensor K = C"1 is given by (2^ + 3¾ (trS)l K[S] = -£-|s. /or «/ery symmetric tensor S. Let ej, e2, eg be an orthonormal basis and consider the following special choices for S in the relation E = K[S]: (a) Pure shear. Let the matrix [S] of S relative to this basis have the form [S] = 0 T .0 T 0 0 0 0 0. Then [E] = "0 X 0 h 0 0 0" 0 0. with i.e. E is a simple shear of amount x = —-- t; 2[t 2[t with respect to the direction pair (e1, e2). Conversely, if E is a simple shear of amount x, S is a pure shear with shear stress r=2fix. (b) Uniform pressure. Let S correspond to a uniform pressure of amount p; i.e. let S = -pl. Then E is a uniform dilatation of amount -I*-*
78 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 22. with Clearly, :/»+*. p = -k(tiE). Conversely, S is a uniform pressure whenever E is a uniform dilatation. (c) Pure tension. Let S correspond to a pure tension with tensile stress or in the e1 direction: Then [U] has the form with and [SI- [E] = e = ja, "or 0 .0 0 0 0 0" 0 0. ~e 0 .0 0 I 0 0" 0 I —pa=-ve, ^ li + l ' = A " 2(fl + X) - The modulus 6 is obtained by dividing the tensile stress or by the longitudinal strain e produced by it. It is known as Young's modulus.1 The modulus v is the ratio of the lateral contraction to the longitudinal strain of a bar under pure tension. It is known as Poissons' ratio.2 Table 3 gives the relations between the various moduli- o o If we write E and S for the traceless parts of E and S, i.e. E=E — l(trE)l, S=S-i{trS)l, then the isotropic constitutive relation (I) is equivalent to the following pair of relations3 S = 2/iE, trS=ktrE. Another important form for the isotropic stress-strain relation is the one taken by the inverted relation (4) when Young's modulus /S and Poisson's ratio v are used: E = J-[(l+v)S-v(trS)l]. 1 Young neither defined nor used the modulus named after him. In fact, it was introduced and discussed by Euler in [1780, 1] (cf. Truesdell [I960, IS], [i960, 16], pp. 402-403) and, according to Truesdell [1959,17], was used by Euler as early as 1727. In most texts Young's modulus is designated by E. 2 Poisson [1829, 2]. Poisson's ratio is often denoted by a. 3 Stokes [l 845, 1] introduced the moduli fi and k and noted that the response of an isotropic elastic body is completely determined by its response to shearing and to uniform compression.
Sect. 22. Isotropic materials. Table 3- 79 A, ,u X,p A,v A, ft P.P /X,V /X, k P,v p,k V, A A {2/i-pL, 2/tv (1 — 2v) 3k-^2/1 3 (l+v)(l —2v) 3ft (3ft-0) 9k-p 3kv i+v /" // {P -3/.) + V'(/9 —3A)2+8A/5 4 A(l-2v) 2v 3 (A-A) 2 /^ /^ ^/^ 2(1 +V) 3Pk 9k-p 3ft(l-2j>) 2 (!+»>) P /i(3X + 2/i) A(1+v)(1-2v) V 9ft (ft-A) 3k--). 2,u(l+v) 9ft,« 3k+/t // n /^ 3k{\ — 2v) V A 2(A+/u) -Q?+A) + V(i?+~A)2+8A2 4 A A "3*-A" P-2/* 2/1 // 1 2 3k —2/1 3k+/i ] ^/ 1 2 \3k-p~l l 3ft J A 3A + 2/1 3 (3A+j?) + f(3"A+i?)2-TA7 6 A (i+v) 3r ^/ 3(3A«-/3) 2,u(l+v) 3(1- 2v) ^/ P_ 3(l-2v) Since an elastic sohd should increase its length when pulled, should decrease its volume when acted on by a pressure, and should respond to a positive shearing stress by a positive shearing strain, we would expect that /?>0, k>0, [t>0. Also, a pure tensile stress should produce a contraction in the direction perpendicular to it; thus r>0. Even though the aboveJnegualities„axe„ph^sically well., motivated, we will not assume that they hold, for in many circumstances other (somewhat weaker)
80 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 2js. assumptions are_more natural. Further, these weaker hypotheses are important to the study of infinitesimal deformations superposed on finite deformations. Finally, we remark that Gazis, Tadjbakhsh, and Toupin1 have established a method of determining the isotropic material whose elasticity tensor is nearest (in a sense they make precise) to a given elasticity tensor of arbitrary symmetry. -/■ 23. The constitutive assumption for finite elasticity. In this section we will show that the linear constitutive assumption discussed previously is, in a certain sense, consistent with the finite theory of elasticity provided we assume infinitesimal deformations and a stress-free reference configuration. In the finite theory the stress S at any given material point as is a function of the deformation gradient F at x: 8= 8(F). (a) The function S is the response function for the material point x. In view of (o) in Sect. 16, we assume that S{F)FT=FS(F)T (b) for every invertible tensor F; this insures that the values of S are consistent with the law of balance of angular momentum. In addition, we assume that S is compatible with the principle of material frame indifference; this is the requirement that the constitutive relation (a) be independent of the observer.2 During a change in observer F transforms into QF and S into QS, where Q is the orthogonal tensor corresponding to this change.3 Since S must be invariant under all such changes, it must satisfy4 S(F)=QTS(QF) (c) for every orthogonal tensor Q and every F. By the polar decomposition theorem,5 F admits the decomposition F=RU, (d) where R is orthogonal and U={FTF)i. (e) Choosing Q in (c) equal to RT, we arrive at the relation S = RS{U), or equivalently, using (d), 8=FU-18(V). (f) If we define a new function S by the relation S(D) = U*S(U), where D is the finite strain tensor D=Js(U*-l)=%(FTF-l), •X1 [1963, 7]. 2 See, e.g., Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], §§ 19, 19A. 3 See, e.g., Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], § 19. The transformation rule for F is an immediate consequence of their Eq. (19.2^. The rule for the Piola-Kirchhoff stress S follows from the law of transformation for the Cauchy stress T [their Eq. (19.2)2] and (r) of Sect. 16 relating S to T and F. 4 Cf. Truesdell and Noll [1965, 22], Eq. (143.9). 5 See, e.g., Halmos [1958, 9], § 83.
Sect. 24. Work theorems. Stored energy. 81 then (f) reduces to S=FS(D). (g) On the other hand, it is not difficult to verify that the constitutive relation (g) is consistent with (c). Further, (g) satisfies (b) if and only if FS(1))FT=FS(D)TFT, or, since F is invertible, S(D) = S(Df, (h) so that the values of S are symmetric tensors. It is important to note that the concept of strain arises naturally in the study of restrictions placed on constitutive relations by material frame-indifference. It is possible to derive other constitutive relations involving other strain measures; we chose one involving D because it simplifies the discussion of infinitesimal deformations. Let S be differentiable at 0. Then S(D)=S(0)+C[D]+o(\D\) as |D| ->0, where C is a linear transformation which, by (h), maps symmetric tensors into symmetric tensors. When F = l, D = 0; thus S(0) represents the residual stress in the reference configuration. We now assume that this residual stress vanishes;1 hence S(D)=C[D]+o(\D\). (i) Let d = \Vu\. Then (c), (e), and (f) of Sect. 12 yield F = 1+0(6), D=E+0(62) =0(6) as <5->0, and we conclude from (g) and (i) that S=C[E] + o(d) as 6^0. Therefore if we assume that the residual stress in the reference configuration vanishes, then to within terms of o(6) as <5->-0 the stress tensor is a linear function of the infinitesimal strain tensor. Further, since E = 0 when Vu is skew, to within terms of o (6) the stress tensor vanishes in an infinitesimal rigid displacement. These remarks should help to motivate the constitutive assumptions underlying the infinitesimal theory. 24. Work theorems. Stored energy. In this section we establish certain conditions, involving the notions of work and energy, which are necessary and sufficient for the elasticity tensor to be symmetric and positive definite. Thus we consider a fixed point x of the body, and let C=CX denote the elasticity tensor for x. 1 This assumption, while basic to the theory presented here, is not satisfied, e.g., by an elastic fluid. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 6
82 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 24. By a strain path rE connecting E0 and Et we mean a one-parameter family ^(a)» Oo = a = ai» °f symmetric tensors such that E(») is continuous and piecewise smooth and E(a„)=E0, E(<x1)=E1. We say that rB is closed if Clearly, the strain path rE determines a one-parameter family of stress tensors S(a) = C[E(a)], 0¾ ^ a ^ 0¾; the work done along rB is defined to be the scalar W(rE)=/s(a)-^-ia. a. In view of the discussion following (19.1), we have the following interpretation of w (rE): Consider a homogeneous elastic body with elasticity tensor C; w(rE) is the work done (per unit volume) by the surface tractions in a time-dependent homogeneous deformation with strain E. y By a stored energy function* we mean a smooth scalar-valued function e on the space of symmetric tensors such that e(0) =0 and2 C[E]=VEe(E) for every symmetric tensor E. An immediate consequence of this definition is the following trivial proposition. (1) If a stored energy function exists, it is unique, and w (rE)=e(iy-e(ig for every strain path rE connecting E0 and Et. The next theorem supplies several alternative criteria for the existence of a stored energy function. Y (2) Existence of a stored energy function.* The following four statements are equivalent. (i) The work done along each closed strain path is non-negative. (ii) The work done along each closed strain path vanishes. (iii) C is symmetric. (iv) The function s defined on the space of symmetric tensors by e(E)=$E-C[E] is a stored energy function. Proof. We will show that (i) => (ii) => (iii) =½ (iv) =½ (i). Assume that (i) holds. Let rE be an arbitrary closed path, and let rE* denote the closed path defined by E*(a.)=E(oL0-\-ci1—a.), 0^^0.^0^. 1 The notion of a stored energy function is due to Green [1839, 1], [1841, J]. 2 The gradient p£;e(jE) of s at E is defined in a manner strictly analogous to the definition given on p. 10 of the gradient of a scalar field on S. Note that VEs(E) is a symmetric tensor; in components 3 Green [1839, 1], [1841, i] proved that (iii) O (iv), Udeschini [1943, 3] that (i) O (iv).
Sect. 24. Work theorems. Stored energy. 83 Then a simple computation tells us that w(rE) = -w(rE.). But (i) implies that w(rE) and W(rE*) must both be non-negative. Hence w(rE) = 0, which is (ii). To see that (ii) => (iii) let A and B be symmetric tensors, and let rE be the closed strain path defined by 22(a) =(cosa — 1) ^ + (sina) B, 0^a^27i. Then C \E (a)] • —J£ - = (sin a - sin a cos a) A ■ C [A] + (cos2 a — cos a) B ■ C [A] - (sin2 a) A ■ C [B] + (sin a cos a) B • C [JB] and »(ii) = / C [£(«)] • ^°0■ ia = »(B • C [Jl] -A ■ C [B]). o Hence (ii) => (iii). Next, define e(E)=kE-C[E]. Since the gradient VEe(E) can be computed using the formula1 VBe(E).A = -£lB(E + XA)\M, it follows that VBe(E)'-A = ± ^{E ■ C[E] +XE ■ C[A] +XA ■ C[E] +VA ■ C[A]}X=0 = ±-{E.C[A]+A-C[E]}. Thus (iii) implies VEe{E)-A=A-C[E] for every symmetric tensor A, which yields (iv). Finally, by (1), (iv) implies (i). □ If C is symmetric, a stored energy function e exists, and the constitutive equation S = C[E] may be written in the form S = VEe(E). Let C be invertible, and let e{A)=kA-K[A] for every symmetric tensor A, where K is the compliance tensor. In view of the symmetry of K (which follows from the symmetry of C), rae{S)=K[S], and the above constitutive relation takes the alternative form E = Vae{S). Moreover, B{S)=kC[E].K[C[E]], 1 Cf. p. 10. 6*
84 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 24. and, since K is the inverse of C, e(S)=e(E). The next two theorems give a physical motivation for some of our future assumptions concerning the elasticity tensor. (3) The work done along each strain path starting from E = 0 is non-negative if and only if C is symmetric and positive semi-definite. Proof. Assume that the work done along each strain path starting from 0 is non-negative. Let 7¾ be an arbitrary closed strain path starting from E0, and let E*(a) =E(a) —E0, 0,,^0^0¾. Then 7¾. is a closed strain path starting from 0 and 0^/c[B*(«)].-^i«. a0 Thus, in view of the linearity of C, 0 =g f C [£(«)] • -*JM. da _ c [E0] ■ {E («,) -£(«„)}. But 12(0¾) =£(00), since 7¾ is closed. Thus the work done along each closed strain path is non-negative. Thus we may conclude from (2) that C is symmetric and, in addition, that there exists a stored energy function. Let A be a symmetric tensor, and let TE be the strain path defined by E(d)=a.A, O^a^l. Then by (1) and (iv) of (2), 0^w(ii) =8(-4)-6(0) =M-C[4]; hence C is positive semi-definite. Conversely, if C is symmetric, then (1) and (2) imply that given any path rE connecting 0 and Elt Thus if C is positive semi-definite, w (7¾) ^ 0. □ (4) The work done along each non-closed strain path starting from E = 0 is strictly positive if and only if C is symmetric and positive definite. Proof. Assume that the former assertion holds. Let rE defined by E(cn.), 0¾ 550^0¾. be an arbitrary closed strain path with B(oo)=B(oO=0- If E(<x) = 0 for all a, then w (7¾) = 0. Assume E{a) 4= 0 for some a, and let a = sup{a:E(a)4=0}. Then -(rE) = /c[E(a)].^ia = lim/c[E(a)] ■ *£U«. OCq OCo
Sect. 24. Work theorems. Stored energy. 85 Since E(a) (a05Sa5ja*) for a*<a but sufficiently close to a defines a non-closed strain path starting from 0, /c[£(a)].^ia>0; a, hence Thus the work done along each strain path starting from 0 is non-negative, and we may conclude from (3) that C is symmetric. The remainder of the argument is the same as the proof of the analogous portions of (3). □ sX (5) If the material is isotropic, then C is symmetric, e{E)=fjL\E\* + \-{txE)\ and the following five statements are equivalent: (i) C is positive definite; (ii) /li>0, 2/a+3/l>0; (iii) fi>0, k>0; (iv) /li>0, —\<v<\; (v) /?>0, —\<v<k- Proof. The symmetry of C and the above formula for e(E)=^E ■ C[E] follow from (22.2). That (i)<=>(iii) is an immediate consequence of (22.3) and the sentence following its proof. Finally, the equivalence of (ii)-(v) follows from the relations given in Table 3 on p. 79- □ Let E=E + i(trE)l (trE=0). Then |E|2 = |E|2 + i(trJS;)2 and This alternative form for e yields a direct verification of the implication (i)<=>(iii) in (5). At the end of the last section we gave physically plausible arguments to support the inequalities: /?>0, &>0, /a>0, v>0. It follows from (5) that these inequalities are more than sufficient to insure J^sitiw^efuuteness. On the other hand7Bfiaf Cis positive "defimteTmplies fl> 6,k>0,/i> 0, but does not imply v>0. Assume that C is symmetric and positive definite. Then the characteristic values of C (considered as a linear transformation on the six-dimensional space of all symmetric tensors) are all strictly positive. We call the largest characteristic value the maximum_ela^Hci tnod^JMS, the smallest the minimum elastic modulus.1 The following trivial, but useful, proposition is a direct consequence of this definition and (22.3). vt y (6) Let C be symmetric and positive definite and denote the maximum and minimum elastic moduli by /uM and (im, respectively. Then frW^E ■ C[B] ^M|E|2 1 Cf. Toupin [1965, 21].
86 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 25. for every symmetric tensor E. If, in addition, the material is isotropic wUh^strictly positive Lame moduli /u and X, then Pm = 2^+3^, fJ.m=2fJ,. Of course, if /u>0 and X—0, then ^=^ = 2/«; if /i>0 and X<0 (but 2/a+3A>0 so that C is positive definite), then /j,m = 2/j, and ^ = 2^+3^- 25. Strong ellipticity. In this section we relate various restrictions on the elasticity tensor C = CX at a given point xiB. We say that C is strongly elliptic if A-C[A]>0 whenever A is of the form A=a®b, a=t=0, 6=(=0. This condition is of importance in discussing uniqueness and also in the study of wave propagation. By (20.1) A-C[A]= (symA) ■ C[sym A]; thus Cpositive definite => C strongly elliptic. The f§£Lth^jth^_cony£rse assertion is not,true is_apgarent from the_nextj>ro- posijkm. &" (1) Suppose that the material is isotropic. Then C strongly elliptic 4=>/a>0, A + 2/a>0, — C strongly elliptic <=>/j,<0, A + 2/a<0, where (i and X are the Lame moduli corresponding to C. 7« ferns o/ Poisson's ratio v, C strongly elliptic <s=> /j, > 0, i>€ [$, 1], — C strongly elliptic «=> ^ <0, i>€ [J, 1], provided ^+^=^0- Proa/. By (i) of (20.1) and f22.2), (a®6) • C[a®6] = (a®6) • C[syma®6] = (a®6) • |>(a®6 + 6®a)+A(a-6) 1] =/*a2 62 + (X +/li) (a • 6)2 =/i [a2 62 - (a • 6)2] + (X + 2/i) (a • 6)2. Since (a • 6)2^a262, /u>0 and A + 2^t>0 imply that C is strongly elliptic. Conversely, if C is strongly elliptic, then X + 2^ > 0 follows by taking a = 6, ^ > 0 by taking a orthogonal to 6. The assertion concerning — C follows in the same manner. Finally, the last two results are consequences of the relation:
Sect. 26. Anisotropic materials. 87 These results, as well as some of the results established in (24.5), are given in the following table: Table 4. Condition Restrictions on the moduli Positive definite /*>0, 2/i + 3A>0 or ^,^¾. =*> S^fikyK M>0, ^6(-1,¾ or 0>O, ve(-i.i) Strongly elliptic /i>0, A + 2/i>0 or H>0, vUi, 1] > 26. Anisotropic materials. In this section we state the restrictions that material symmetry places on the elasticity tensor C = Cm at a given point x. Let {ej be a given orthonormal basis with 63=^X63, and let Cijkl denote the components of C relative to this basis: Cijhi = Cjiki = 0^ih = (sym e{®e?) • C[sym ek® e,]. We assume throughout this.section that a stored energy function exists, so that C is symmetric; thus Ci)kI=Cklij- For the triclinic system (^-symmetry) there are no restrictions placed on C by material symmetry. For the monoclinic system ($i-symm.ttvy) let the group #2 be generated by fl*. By identity (21.2), Ciiki=sym{Qet®Qef) ■ C[sym(<?eft<g)0e,)] for every 06¾. If we take Q = —R%,, then (?«! = %, 0e2 = e2, 0e3 = -e3, and the above identity implies ^1128 ==^'1181=:^2228==^'2281==^8328==^3881==^2812=:^3112=::0• In the same manner, results for the other symmetries discussed in Sect. 21 can be deduced.1 We now list these results, which are due to Voigt.2 For convenience, the 21 elasticities will be tabulated as follows: ^1111 C-1122 ^2222 ^-1183 ^2288 ^-8888 r ^1128 C-2228 ^3323 ^2323 ^-1131 t-2231 ^3331 t-2331 ^-3131 ^1112 t-2212 ^3312 ^-2312 ^3112 ^1212 1 They can also be deduced using the results of Smith and Rivjlin [1958, 16], Sirotin [i960, 11]. 2 Voigt [1882,1], [1887,3], [1900,6], [1910,1], §287. See also Kirchhoff [1876, 1], Minnigerode [1884, 1], Neumann [1885, 3], Love [1927, 3], Auerbach [1927, 1], Geckeler [1928, 2]. A discussion of methods used to measure the elastic constants of anisotropic materials, as well as a tabulation of experimental values of these constants for various materials, is given by Hearmon [1946, 2].
88 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 26. Monoclinic system (all classes) <^2 generated by ft£ (13 elasticities) ^1111 C1122 C-1133 0 0 ^1112 ^2222 ^"2233 0 0 ^2212 ^-3333 0 0 ^3312 ^2323 ^2331 ^ C3131 0 Cl212 Rhombic system (all classes) ^ generated by ft* , ft£a (9 elasticities) t-im c1122 c1133 0 0 0 ^2222 ^2233 0 0 0 c3333 0 0 0 ^2323 0 ^ C3131 0 ^1212 Tetragonal system (tetragonal-disphenoidal, tetragonal-pyramidal, tetra- gonal-dipyramidal) <gi generated by ft*'2 (7 elasticities) ^1111 ^-1122 ^-1111 ^-1133 ^-1133 C-3333 0 0 0 t-2323 0 0 0 0 C2323 ClH2 ^-1112 0 0 0 ^-1212 Tetragonal system (tetragonal-scalenohedral, ditetragonal-pyramidal, te- tragonal-trapezohedral, ditetragonal-dipyramidal) <€6 generated by ft*'2, ft* (6 elasticities) t-llll ^-1122 ^-1133 0 ^1111 ^-1133 0 ^-3333 0 c ^2323 0 0 0 0 C2323 0 0 0 0 0 ^-1212 Cubic system (tetartoidal, diploidal) ^6 generated by ft*,ft*,ft^8, q=yi{€,+€,+ ■«*); (hexatetrahedral, gyroidal, hexoctahedral) % generated by ft*(2, IJ£(2, ft*{2 (3 elasticities) t-1111 c1122 c1122 0 t-1111 ^1122 0 Qui 0 r ^2323 0 0 0 0 ^2323 0 0 0 0 0 ^-2328
Sect. 27. The fundamental system of field equations. 89 Hexagonal system (trigonal-pyramidal, rhombohedral) ^s generated by R%"JS (7 elasticities) £-1122 ^1111 ^-1133 ^-1133 C3333 ^-1123 ^-1123 0 r u2323 ^-1131 ^-1131 0 0 c u2323 0 0 0 ~~ ^1131 ^-1123 ^"(Cllll 'C1122) Hexagonal system (ditrigonal-pyramidal, trigonal-trapezohedral, hexag- onal-scalenohedral) ^9 generated by R%^3, iJ£ (6 elasticities) r u1122 t-1111 ^-1133 C1133 ^3333 ^1123 — ^-1123 0 t-2323 0 0 0 0 ^2323 0 0 0 0 ^-1123 ¢(£-1111- t-1122) 0 0 0 0 C-2323 0 0 0 0 0 3"(^1111 ^1122) Hexagonal system (trigonal-dipyramidal, hexagonal-pyramidal, hexago- nal-dipyramidal) ^w generated by B%&; (ditrigonal-dipyramidal, dihexagonal- pyramidal, hexagonal-trapezohedral, dihexagonal-dipyramidal) #u generated by Re?> R%,'y and transverse isotropy e&12 generated by R%t, 0<<p<2n (5 elasticities) ' Cim c1122 c1133 0 £-1111 C-1133 0 £-3333 0 £-2323 In view of (21.1), if the elasticity tensor C is invertible, then the components of the compliance tensor K = C_1 will suffer restrictions exactly analogous to the ones tabulated above. D. Elastostatics. I. The fundamental field equations. Elastic states. Work and energy. 27. The fundamental system of field equations. The fundamental system of field equations for the time-independent behavior of a linear elastic body consists of the strain-displacement relation E = Vu = k{Vu + VuT), the stress-strain relation S = C[E],
90 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 27- and the equation of equilibrium1 div S+ 6=0. Here, u, E, S, and 6 are the displacement, strain, stress, and body force fields, while C is the elasticity field. By (i) of (20.1), C[Vu]=C[Vu]; thus when the displacement field is sufficiently smooth, the above equations imply the displacement equation of equilibrium divC[F«]+6 = 0. Conversely, if u satisfies the displacement equation of equilibrium, and if E and S are defined by the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations, then the stress equation of equilibrium is satisfied. In components the displacement equation of equilibrium has the form (C</*j«*.j),/ + &< = 0. We assumefor Jhe^emainder of this section that the material is isotropic. Then S=2/iE + X(tiE) 1, where (i and X are the Lame moduh. Of course, (i and 1 are functions of position x when the body is inhomogeneous. Therefore, since div (jj,Vu) —pA u + (Vu)V/j,, div (jj, VuT) =^ V div u + (Vu)T V/j,, div [X (div u) 1] = I Pdiv u + (div u) VI, the displacement equation of equilibrium takes the form /iAu + {X+/A Vdivu + 2(Vu) F7^ + (div«) VX + b = 0. Suppose now that the body is homogeneous. Then Vfi = VX= 0, and the above equation reduces to Navier's equation2 fiAu + (X+/j)Vdivu + b=0, (a) or equivalently, Au -1 V Vdiv u + -6=0, 1 — 2v n in terms of Poisson's ratio Next, by (3) of (4.1), Au = Fdiv u—curl curl u, 1 Since the values of C&l'] are assumed to be symmetric tensors, the requirement that S = ST is automatically satisfied. 2 This relation was first derived by Navier [1823, 2], [1827, 2] in 1821. Navier's work, which is based on a molecular model, is limited to materials for which ft = A. The general relation involving two elastic constants first appears in the work of Cauchy [1828, 1]. Cf. Poisson [1829,2], Lame and Clapeyron [1833,-?], Stokes [1845, i]. Lame [1852,2], §26. The analogous relation for cubic symmetry was given by Albrecht [1951, i].
Sect. 27. The fundamental system of field equations. 0,1 and thus (a) yields1 (A + 2[a) Fdivu—fj, curl curl u + 6 = 0. Operating on (a), first with the divergence and then with the curl, we find that (A+2^)4 divu =-div 6, pA curlu = —curl 6. If (A -f 2/j) =)= 0, /j, =)= 0, and div 6 and curl 6 vanish, then ^divi« = 0, Acurlu = 0. Thus, in this instance, the divergence and curl of u are harmonic fields. Trivially, these relations can be written in the form div^M=0, curl^u = 0; |-> CA*]^ " ffi > ^v^ 4 and since a vector field with vanishing divergence and curl is harmonic, we have the following important result:3 'Ji» 4- div6=0, curl6=0 =>AAu = 0. a.[a Thus if the body force field 6 is divergence-free and curl-free, the displacement field \ is biharmonic and hence analytic on B. To prove this we have tacitly assumed that it is of class C4; in Sect. 42 we will show that these results remain valid when u is assumed to be only of class C2. Another interesting consequence of the displacement equation of equilibrium may be derived as follows: Let v =/liu + £(A +p) p div u, p(x)~x — Q. Then Av—pAu + (h+/j.){Vdivu-\-?pA divt*}, and (a) and (b) imply A v = - 6 - ----,4-¾ v P div b. 2(/ + 2/1) r Thus we arrive at the following result of Tedone: 4 if the body force field vanishes, then Av = 0. Assume, for the time being, that the body force field 6 = 0. A field u that satisfies . Navier's equation (a) for all values of p and X is said to be universal. Since &iield~. of this type is independent of the elastic constants p and X, it is a possible displacement field for all homogeneous and isotropic elastic materials. Clearly, u is universal if and only if5 "^ " Au=0, Fdivi«=0; 1 Lame and Clapeyron [1833, i]. Lame [1852, 2], § 26. 2 The first of these relations is due to Cauchy [1828, I]. See also Lame and Clapeyron [1833, 1], Lame [1852, 2], § 27. 8 Lame [1852, 2], p. 70. 4 [1903, 4], [1904, 4]. See also Lichtenstein [1924, 1]. 5 Truesdeix [1966, 28], p. 117-
92 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 27. i.e., if and only if u is harmonic and has constant dilatation. Important examples of universal displacement fields are furnished by the Saint-Venant torsion solution.1 If/a=|=0,j'=t=— 1, the stress-strain relation may be inverted to give 2fl S_ ?--(trS)l By (14.3) we can write the equation of compatibility in the form S?(E)=AE + VV(trE)-2pdivE=0. (c) Therefore 0 = jS?(2/M B) =J2?(S) - -^-jS?[(tr S) 1]. (d) But JS?[(tr S)1]=A (tr S) 1 + FT(tr S), (e) and by (c) with E replaced by S in conjunction with the equation of equilibrium, &{S)=AS + W{tiS)+2pb. (f) Eqs. (d)-(f) imply that AS + -[^VV(trS)-iv+vA(tTS)l+2Vb=0, (g) and taking the trace of this equation, we conclude that \-VvA(trS) = -diVb. (h) Eqs. (g) and (h) yield the stress equation of compatibility:2 AS + —— FT(tr S) +2Vb + --- - (div 6) 1 =0, which in the absence of body forces takes the simple form 4S+~-FF(trS)=0. On the other hand, if S is a symmetric tensor field on B that satisfies the equation of equilibrium and the stress equation of compatibility, and if E is defined through the inverted stress-strain relation, then E satisfies the equation of compatibility. Thus if B is simply-connected, there exists a displacement field u that satisfies the strain-displacement relation. In view of the stress-strain and strain-displacement relations, S=fi{Vu + VuT) + A (div u) 1, and the corresponding surface traction on the boundary 8B is given by s = Sn = fi(Vu + VuT) n + A(divw) n. 1 See, e.g., Love [1927, 3], Chap. 14; Sokolnikoff [1956, 12], Chap. 4; Solomon [1968, 12], Chap. 5. 2 This equation was obtained by Beltrami [1892, 1] for 6==0 and hy Donati [1894, 2] and Michell [1900, 3] for the general case. It is usnally referred to as the Beltrami-Michell equation of compatibility although Donati's paper appeared six years before Michell's. The appropriate generalization of this equation for transversely isotropic materials is given by Moisil [1952, 3], for cubic materials by Albrecht [1951, 1].
Sect. 27. The fundamental system of field equations. 93 Let du/dn be defined by then But 8-=(Vu)n; s=2fi -.-- +/i(VuT — Vu) n + A(div w) n. (Fm2" — Vu) n=nxcurlm; thus we have the following interesting formula for the surface traction:1 s = 2fi g-—h/«wxcurlM+A(divM) n. We close this section by recording the strain-displacement relations and the equations of equilibrium in rectangular, cylindrical, and polar coordinates, using physical components throughout.2 (a) Cartesian coordinates (x, y, z). The strain-displacement relations reduce to E - 8^- £«~ 8z F — ^xx F = F — 8ux 8x ' 1 /8ux 2 \ 8y 1 1 8us "2 \ 8x~ F — Vyy . 8Uy 8x~ 4. 8V "•" 8z , 8Uy 8y )• !■ and the equations of equilibrium are given by 8SXX I 8S*V |_ 8Sxz 9* ^ 8y ^ 8z ^u* v' 8S*y 1 8Syy 1 8Sya \h—n 8x + 9;>>""~r~9T~ -r°y-u' Is*.: + Ihu + i?». +6=0. 9* ^ 9;y ^ 9* ^ * u (b) Cylindrical coordinates (r, 0, z). The strain-displacement relations have the form p _ 8ur p — J_ 8m0 1 ur p _ 8m* £rr —-3--. ^ee- , -gT^T' r'"~'8z ■ P 1/1 9wf 9we we 'e ~ 2" It ~w + "a? r p = J / 8ml _i_ 8M p _ 1 /8^°. 4- J _8m*^ " 2\'8z ~^~ 9*-/' e* 2^0* "•" >- 90 J' while the equations of equilibrium reduce to 0?rr 1 J. 8SrO 1 8Srz 1 SJil~lM. Mh —fl 9»- "^ / 90 ^ 8z + r -T-"r-v> 8Srg , 1 8Sgg 8SBt ,2-, _ -9/' + T 90" + -07-+ T^e+6e-°> 9r ^ r 90 + 9* + r ^"^^ u> 1 Betti [1872, i], § 10, Eq. (53). See also Somigliana [1889, 3], p. 38, Korn [1927, 2], p. 13, Kupradze [1963, 17, IS], p. 9. 2 See, e.g., Ericksen [i960, 6], §§ 11-13.
94 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 28. (c) Spherical coordinates (r,d,y). The strain-displacement relations become F _ 8ur J? _ * 8u6 I Mr ^^ - 8y . *ee — -r fa -I--7 - £. _ 1 9«y , «, , Me cot 0 + ^f + p 1 ( 1 9m, My . 8uy\ "v ~~ 2" iTsin 6 8y V + ~9^j ' F = 1 /1 gwf «e_ , _d«e 'e 2 U 96 >• "•" Sf" p _ 1 /_1_ 9«y _ My COt 0 . i 9ttfl \ ^ — 2~ 1.7" "90 P ■" 7sin"0 "g^T/ ' and the equations of equilibrium are given by 8Sfr 1 8Sry 1 dSrl) 2Srr-SyY-Sm + Srg cote , 9>- lysine 8y"" "^ r 86 ^ r " ^ ' U' 8Sry 1 85yy , 1 8Syp 3 5fy + 2 Syfl cot 8 , _ 0r ~r rsin0 3y +7 30 " "^ " r i-Oy—U2 dSry , 1 8Sy6 1 9Sp8 35,a + {Sge — Syy) cot 8 , _ 9»-' "^ >-sin0 8y ^r 86 ^ " r -|-0<,—U. 28. Elastic states. Work and energy. Throughout this section we assume given a continuous elasticity field C on B. We define the strain energy U{E} corresponding to a continuous strain field E on E by •U{E}=$fE-C[E]dv. B Note that when a stored energy function e exists, its integral over B gives the strain energy: U{E} = fe{E)dv. B For future use we now record the following (1) Lemma. Let C be symmetric, and let E and E be continuous symmetric tensor fields on B. Then U{E +E} = U{E} + U{E} + JE-C[E] dv. B Proof. Since C is symmetric, E-C[E]=E-C[E]. Thus (E +E) ■ C [E +E] =E -C[E]+E-C [E] +2E-C[E], which implies the desired result. □ By an admissible state we mean an ordered array a = [u, E, S] with the following properties: (i) m is an admissible displacement field;1 (ii) E is a continuous symmetric tensor field on B; (iii) S is an admissible stress field.1 1 See p. 59.
Sect. 28. Elastic states. Work and energy. 95 Note that the fields u, E, and S need not be related. Clearly, the set of all admissible states is a vector space provided we define addition and scalar multiplication in the natural manner: [a, E, S] + [«, E, S] = [u + u, E + E, S +S], a [m, E, S] = [aw, a.E, aS]. We say that <s = [u,E,S] is ar^_elastic_§taisL (on jg)LCorresrjondingJ;o the body force field 6 if o is an admissible state and r ' "" "" ~E = i{Vu + VuT), \ S = C[E], \ divS+6=0. \ The corresponding surface traction s is then defined at every regular point of dB by s(x) =S(x) n(x), where n (x) is the outward unit normal to dB at x. We call the pair [6, s] the external force system for o. When we discuss the basic singular solutions of elastostatics, we will frequently deal with elastic states whose domain of definition is a set of the form D=B—F, where F is a finite subset of B. Wjj_say_that t = \u, E, S] is an elastic state on D corresponding to 6 if u, E,J^jndJtJ^e Junctions, on D and given any closed regular subregion PcD, the restriction of d to P is an elastic state on P corresponding to the restriction of 6 to P. When we omit mention of the domain of definition of an elastic state, it will always be understood to be E. K (2) Principle of superposition for elastic states. If [u, E, S] and [u, E, S] are elastic states corresponding to the external force systems [6, s] and [6, s], respectively, and if a and x are scalars, then a [it, E, S] +t[m, E, S] is an elastic state corresponding to the external force system a [6, s] +t[6, s], where a [6, s] +t[6, s] =[<x&+t6, ocs + tS]. A direct corollary of (18.2) is the X (3) Theorem of work and energy.2 Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to the external force system [b, s]. Then fs-uda + fb-udv = 2U{E}. P*» CUv»i»<>"> dB B l The quantity on the left-hand side of this equation is the work done by the external forces; (3) asserts that this work is equal to twice the strain energy. ^ P" (4) Theorem of positive work. Let the elasticity field be positive definite. " JT Then given any elastic state, the work done by the external forces is non-negative and np vanishes only when the displacement field is rigid. Proof. If C is positive definite, then U{E} 5:0, and the work done by the external forces is non-negative. If U{E} = 0, then E • C[E] must vanish on B. Since Cis positive definite, this implies Ee=Q; hence by (13.1) the corresponding displacement field is rigid. □ 1 This notion is due to Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13]. 2 Lame [1852, 21.
96 M. E. Gortin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 29- The following direct corollary to (4) will be used in Sect. }2 to establish an important uniqueness theorem for elastostatics. (5) Let the elasticity field be positive definite. Further, let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to vanishing body forces, and suppose that the surface traction s satisfies s-u = 0 on 8B. Then u is a rigid displacement field and E == S ==. 0. The next theorem, which is extremely important, shows that the Z,2 norm of the displacement gradient is bounded by the strain energy. (6) Alternative form of Horn's inequality.1 Assume that C is symmetric, positive definite, and continuous on B. Let u be a class C2 displacement field on B, and assume that either (a) or (/3) of (13.9) holds. Then f\Vu\*dv^K0U{E}, B where E is the associated strain field and K0 is a constant depending only on C and B. Proof. Let /im (x) denote the minimum elastic modulus for Cx .2 By hypothesis, fim (x) is bounded from below on B. Hence T = supi ,--: xeB> <oo, and we conclude from (24.6) that \E\^xE-Cx[E] for every xaB and every symmetric tensor E. This inequality and (13.9) yield the desired result. □ II. The reciprocal theorem. Mean strain theorems. 29. Mean strain and mean stress theorems. Volume change. In this section we establish some results concerning the mean values B B of the stress and strain fields when the body B is homogeneous. ■j: (1) Second mean stress theorem. The mean stress S corresponding to an elastic state [u, E, S] depends only on the boundary values of u and is given by S(B)=^c\Ju®nda L3B Thus for an isotropic body, S(B)= vjp- f{/i(u®n+n®u)+X(u-n)i}da. dB Proof. Since B is homogeneous, C is independent of x and *w=ik!cwi*=c\ik!Biv B L B = C[E(B)]. 1 See footnote 1 on p. 38. See also HlavA6ek and Ne6as [1970, 2]. 2 See p. 85.
Sect. 29. Mean strain and mean stress theorems. Volume change. 97 The first of the relations in (1) is an immediate consequence of this result, the mean strain theorem (13.8), and (i) of (20.1), while the second follows from (22.2). □ The above theorem shows that the mean stress is zero when the surface displacements vanish, independent of the value of the body force field. -7 (2) Second mean strain theorem.1 Supjwse that the elasticity tensorjC_.is invertihle with K = C'1. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to the external foTce'syslem'J\U7s\'.~Then the mean strain depends only on the external force system and is given by E{B)= vX(B) K\ fp®sda+ fp®bdv . Thus for an isotropic body, V8S B ' ' Proof. The first result follows from the mean stress theorem (18.5), since E(B)=K[S(B)]; the second result follows from (22.4). □ Note that balance of forces /sda+ J bdv =0 dB B insures that the above formulae are independent of the choice of the origin 0, while balance of moments in the form skw I [ p®sda-\- J p®b dv]=0 IdB b 1 idB insures that the right-hand side of each of the expressions in (2) is symmetric. (3) Volume change theorem.2 Suppose that the elasticity tensor C is symmetric and invertihle. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to the external force system \b, s]. Then the associated volume change dv(B) depends only on the external force system and is given by dv{B)=K[l]- { fp®sda+ (p®bdv\, Us B ) where K = C1 is the compliance tensor. If, in addition, the bodyisisotro^ic, then dv{B) = -*k-l f p-sda+ j'p-bdv\, 'as b ' where k is the modulus of compression. 1 Betti [1872, 1], § 6 for the case in which 6 = 0. The terms involving the body force were added by Chree [1892, 2], who claimed that his results were derived independently of Betti's. See also Love [1927, 3], § 123; Bland [1953, 5]. 2 Betti [1872, 1], § 6; Chree [1892, 2]. Handbuchder I'hysik, Bd. VIa/2. 7
98 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 30. Proof. Let D= Jp0sda + /p®6 dv. SB B Given any tensor A, tiA=l-A. Thus the remark made in the paragraph preceding (13.8), (2), and the symmetry of K imply that dv{B)=v{B)tiE{B)=trK[D]=l-K[D] = K[l]'D, which is the first result. For an isotropic material, (22.4) and Table 3 on p. 79 imply that hence the second formula for dv (B) follows from the first and the identity 1 • (o(g)c) =tr(o®c) =o-c. □ Assume that the body is homogeneous and isotropic. Then, as is clear from (3), a necessary and sufficient condition that there be no change in volume is that fp-sda-\-fp-bdv=0. SB B oi { Thus a solid sphere or a spherical shell under the action of surface tractions that are I tangential to the boundary will not undergo a change in volume. Recall from Sect. 18 that the force system [6, s] is in astatic equilibrium if JQsda+ fQbdv = 0, SB B / pxQsda + / pxQbdv = 0, dB B for every orthogonal tensor Q. We have the following interesting consequence of (2) and (18.10). (4)x Assume that the elasticity tensor is invertible. Then a necessary and sufficient condition that the mean strain corresponding to an elastic state vanish is that the external force system be in astatic equilibrium. It follows as a corollary of (4) that the volume change vanishes when the external force system is in astatic equilibrium. 30. The reciprocal theorem. Betti's reciprocal theorem is one of the major results of linear elastostatics. Ii^ssjenceJ.it,expressesjthe fact that the underlying system of field equations is self-adjoint. Further, it is essential in establishing integral representation theorems for elastostatics. In this section we will estabUsh Betti's theorem and~discuss~some oTTts consequences. We assume throughout that C is smooth on B. (1) Betti's reciprocal theorem.2 Suppose that the elasticity field C is symmetric. Let [u, E, S] and [it, E, S] be elastic states corresponding to external force systems [6, s] and [6, s], respectively. Then f s-uda-\- fb-udv=Js-uda + fb-udv=fS-Edv— f S-E dv. dB B dB B B B 1 Berg [1969, 1]. 2 Betti [1872, 1], § 6, [1874, 1]. See also L£vy [1888, 3]. An extension of Betti's theorem to include the possibility of dislocations was established by Indenbom [I960, 8]. For homogeneous and isotropic bodies, an interesting generalization of Betti's theorem was given by Kupradze [1963, 17, 18], § 1.1. See also Beatty [1967, 2].
Sect. 30. The reciprocal theorem. 99 Proof. Since C is symmetric, we conclude from the stress-strain relation that S-E = C[E]-E = C[E]-E=S-E. Further, it follows from the theorem of work expended (18.2) that fs-uda+fb-udv — f S- E dv, SB B B Js-uda+fb-udv = JS-Edv, dB B B and the proof is complete. □ Betti's theorem asserts that given two elastic states, the work done by the external forces of the first over the displacements of the second equals the work done by the external forces of the second over the displacements of the first. The next theorem shows that the assumption that C be symmetric is necessary for the validity of Betti's theorem. (2)1 Betti's reciprocal theorem is false if C is not symmetric. Proof. If C is not symmetric, then there exist symmetric tensors E, E such that E-C[E]+E-C[E]. Let u=Ep, S = C[E], 6 = -divS, ft=jEp, S = C[E], 6 = -divS. Then [u, E, S] and [ft, E, S] are elastic states corresponding to the body force fields 6 and 6 and / S-Edv + / S-Edv. □ The following elegant corollary of Betti's theorem is due to Shield and Anderson.2 (3) Suppose that C is symmetric and positive semi-definite. Let [u, E, S] and [ft, E, S] be elastic states corresponding to external force systems [6, s] and [6, s], respectively. Then U{E} ^ U{E} provided /s • (m —ft) da-\- J 6 • (u — ft) dv^O dB B or J {s—s) -uda-\- / (6 — 6) -udvsSO. dB B Thus, if £^[ and £?% are complementary subsets of dB, u—u s = 0 6=0 ii=0 s = s 6=6 on Sfx on y% on B on &[ on ,9"2 on B v*- ■^U{E}^U{E}, ■=>U{E}^U{E}. 1 Truesdell [1963, 24]. See also Burgatti [1931, 1], P- 152. 2 [1966, 23]. 7*
100 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 30. Proof. By the principle of superposition (28.2), [u — u,E — E,S—S] is an elastic state corresponding to the external forces [6 — b, s — s]. By (28.1) with E replaced by E — E, U{E} = U{E} + U{E -E} + JE-(S-S)dv, and by Betti's theorem, B f E-(S-S)dv= f (b-b)-udv + f (s-s)-uda B B dB = / 6 • (w —u) dv + / s • (it —u) da. B dB Thus, since U{E — E] ;> 0, we have the inequalities U{E}^ U{E} + /(6 -6) • udv + f (s-s) • u da, B dB U{E}^U{E}+ fb-{u-u)dv + Js-{u-u)da. B dB The remainder of the proof follows from these inequalities. □ y I Theorem (3) may be called a least work principle,, since by (28.3) (1^ ^,. I U{E} 5S U{E} if and only if the work done by the external forces corresponding n,te f| to [it, E, S] is less than or equal to the work done by the external forces of & , (4)1 Suppose that Cis symmetric and positive semi-definite. Let [it, E, S] and [u, E, S] be elastic states corresponding to external force systems [6, s] and [6, s], respectively. Let S^0, £flt ..., SPN be complementary regular subsurfaces of dB, and su^oseJhaL4o^-eaclLM=\,2, ...,N, the restriction o£uto< £^ is a rigid_displacfi- ment of £fn. Then s = s on S?0 f (s—s) da= f px(s—s) da = 0 >U{E}^U{E}. n = \,2,...,N 6=6 on B Proof. By (3) it is sufficient to show that /=/ (s—s)-uda+ / (6— 6) -udv=0. dB B Since s=s on 5P0 and b—b on B, /=24. I„=f{s-s)-uda. «-i srn Further, as the restriction of u to each S?n, n =1, 2, ..., N, is rigid, there exist vectors v1, v2, ...,vn and skew tensors Wj, W2,..., WN such that u = Wnp+vn on Sfn. Thus In = / (s-s) • vn da + / (s-s) -Wnpda, 1 Shield and Anderson [1966, 23],
Sect. 30. The reciprocal theorem. 101 and since vn and Wn are constant and (s— s) ■Wnp = Wn- [(s — 5)®p], this expression reduces to In=vn- f {s—s)da + Wn- f (s—s)®pda. (a) But J (s — s) da = f px(s—s) da = o. (b) The second relation in (b) implies that the tensor A= J (s — s)<S>p da is symmetric. Thus, since Wn is skew, Wn -A =0, and it follows from (a) and the first of (b) that I„ — 0 for each n. Therefore /=0. □ Theorem (29.3) can also be established using Betti's theorem. Indeed, the volume change dv(B) is given by dv{B) = jtvEdv. B If we assume that B is homogeneous and define S = l, B = K[1], u=Ep, then [u, E, S] is an elastic state corresponding to vanishing body forces, and we conclude from Betti's theorem (1) that fS-Edv=Js-uda + Jb-udv, B SB B = fs-Ep da+ f b-Ep dv. dB B Since S-E = l-E = trE, a • Ep —E • (a0p) for any vector a, and E = K[l] is constant and symmetric, it follows that dv(B)=K\l\- {fp®sda+fp®bdv\. dB B The following generalization of Betti's theorem holds even when C is not symmetric. " """ " ~ * (5) Reciprocal theorem. Let [u,E,S] and [u,E,S] be elastic states corresponding to external force systems [6, s] and [6, s], respectively, and let [«, E, S] correspond to the elasticity field C, [u, E, S] to the elasticity field C = CT. Then fs-uda+fb-udv==fs-uda+fb-udv={S-Edv=fS-Edv. dB B dB B B B Proof. We will prove that S • E=S- E; the remainder of the proof is identical to the proof of Betti's theorem (1). Since C = CT, S-E = C[E]-E=E-CT[E]=E-C[E]=E-S. Q
102 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 31. III. Boundary-value problems. Uniqueness. 31. The boundary-value problems of elastostatics. Throughout the following six sections we assume given an elasticity field C on B, body forces b on B, surface displacements u on &\, and surface forces s on £f2, where ,¾ and_<%, are complementary, regular subsurfaces oidB. Given the above data, the mixed problem of elastostatics1 is to find an elastic state [u, E, S] that corresponds to b and satisfies the displacement condition M=fi on &[ and the traction condition s=Sn =8 on £f2. We will call such an elastic state a solution of the mixed problem.2 When Sf2 is empty, so that ^ = dB, the above boundary conditions reduce to u=u on dB, and the associated problem is called the displacement problem.3 If .5^ = dB, the boundary conditions become s=s on dB, and we refer to the resulting problem as the traction problem.* To avoid repeated regularity assumptions we assume that: (i) C is smooth on B; (ii) b is continuous on B; (iii) it is continuous on £^; (iv) s is piecewise regular on £^2. 1 There are problems of importance in elastostatics not included in this formulation; e.g., the contact problem, studied in Sect. 40, in which the normal component of the displacement and the"tarigehtial component of the traction are prescribed over a portion of the boundary. Another example is the Signorini problem [1959, 13] in which a portion £?3 of the boundary rests on a rigid, frictionTess "surface; but is allowed to separate from this surface. Thus s is perpendicular to £fz and at each point of ,5^ either u-n = o, s-n^o, or u-n<o, s • n = o. A detailed treatment of this difficult problem is given by Fichera [1963, 6] and in an article following in this volume. 2 Our definition of a solution, since it is based on the notion of an elastic state (§ 28), does! not cover certain important problems. Indeed, as is well known, there exist genuine mixed ' r problems (,5^ o y2 4= 0) and problems involving bodies with reentrant corners for which the ,.s corresponding stress field isunbounded. For such problems the classical theorems of elastostatics, N as presented here, are vacuous. Fichera [1971, 1], Theorem 12.IV has shown that in the case of .- the genuine mixed problem with C00 boundary, C°° body force field, C00 positive definite and ^ symmetric elasticity field, and null boundary data the displacement field u belongs to H1 (B) a and is C00 on B —^¾^¾ ■ \Hl (B) is the completion of C1 (B) with respect to the norm defined \ , by ||tt||2 = ||u|f+Ypttf§rwhere || • ||2 is the usual L2 norm.] It is possible to establish minor > variants of most of our results assuming only that ueH1 (B), but this would require analytical machinery much less elementary than that used here. (In this connection see the article by Fichera [1971, 1].) Finally, Fichera [1951, 6], [1953, 11] has_shown that for the genuine mixed problem u will not be smooth, on B unless the. boundary data obey certain hypotheses. 3 Sometimes called the first boundary-value problem. 4 Sometimes called the second boundary-value problem. '
Sect. 31- The boundary-value problems of elastostatics. 103 Assumptions (ii)-(iv) are necessary for the existence of a solution to the mixed problem. In the definition of a solution [u, E, S], the requirement that S be admissible1 is redundant; indeed, the required properties of S follow from (i), (ii), the admissibility of u, and the field equations. By a displacement field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem we mean a vector field u with the property that there exist fields E, S such that [m, E, S] is a solution of the mixed problem. We define a stress field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem analogously. (1) Characterisation of the mixed problem in terms of displacements. Let u be an admissible displacement field. Then u corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem if and only if divC[Fw]+b=0 on B, u = u on £^, C[Vu] n = s on £f2. Further, when B is homogeneous and isotropic, these relations take the forms2 /iAu + (X+/i) FdivM + b=0 on B, u — u on 6^, fi(Vu + VuT) n+A(divti) n = s on £^. Proof. That the above relations are necessary follows from the discussion given at the beginning of Sect. 27. To establish sufficiency assume that u satisfies the above relations. Define E through the strain-displacement relation and S through the stress-strain relation. Then, since u is admissible, E is continuous-on B, and, by assumption (i), S is continuous on B and smooth on B. In addition, div S+6=0 on B, (a) Sn=s on £f2. Further, (a) and assumption (ii) imply that div S is continuous on B; thus S is an admissible stress field. Therefore [u, E, S] meets all the requirements of a solution to the mixed problem. When B is homogeneous and isotropic, the last three relations are equivalent to the first three, as is clear from Sect. 27. □ In view of the discussion given at the end of Sect. 27, the boundary condition in (1) on .9^ for isotropic bodies may be replaced by 2/*-7j h [iny. curl w+ A (div u) n = s on ,9"2. (2) Characterisation of the traction problem in terms of stresses. Suppose that the elasticity field is invertible with class C2 inverse K on B. Lej,,B_be_ sim^ly^£onn£ciid, and let S be an admissible stress field of class C2 on B. Then S corresponds to a solution of the traction problem if and only if divS + b=0l \ on B, curlcurlK[S]=Oj Sn = s on dB. 1 See p. 59. 2 Lodge [1955, 9] has given conditions under which the basic equations of elastostatics for an anisotropic material can be transformed into equations formally identical with those for an isotropic material. See also Kaczkowski [1955, 6].
104 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 32. When B is homogeneous and isotropic, these relations are equivalent to divS + b AS+~ilv VV(trS)+2Vb + wv_v (div b) 1 Sn Proof. Let E = K[S]. Then E is of class C2 on B and curl curl E — 0. Thus, by the compatibility theorem (14.2), there exists a class C3 displacement field uon B that satisfies the strain-displacement relation. Moreover, we conclude from (14.4) that u is of class C3 on 5. When B is homogeneous and isotropic, the last three relations are equivalent to the first three, as is clear from the remarks given at the end of Sect. 27. □ 32. Uniqueness.1 In this section we discuss the uniqueness question appropriate to the fundamental boundary-value problems of elastostatics. We say that two solutions [w, E, S] and [u, E, S] of the mixed problem are equal modulo a rigid displacement provided [u,E,S]=[u+w,E,S], where w is a rigid displacement field. av (1) Uniqueness theorem for the mixed problem.2 Suppose that the elasticity jidd is positive definite. Then any two solutions of the mixed problem are equal modulo a rigid displacement. Moreover, if ^ is non-empty, then the mixed problem has at most one solution. Proof. Let 6 = [u, E, S] and % = [u, E, S] be solutions of the mixed problem, and let [u,E,S]=[,E,S]-[u,E,S]. Then, by the principle of superposition (28.2), [it, E, S] is an elastic state corresponding to zero body forces. Moreover, it = 0 on 6^, s=0 on £f2; thus, since ^ and SP2 are complementary subsets of dB, s • u = 0 on dB, and we conclude from (28.5) that u is rigid. Thus E=S =0, and the two solutions a and 5 are equal modulo a rigid displacement. &\, since it is a regular surface, if non-empty must contain at least three non-collinear points. Thus, in this instance, since u =0 on £flt u must vanish identically. □ It is clear from the proof of (1) that the smoothness assumptions tacit in the definition of a solution are more stringent than required. For the purpose of this theorem it is sufficient to assume that a solution [w, E, S] is a triplet of fields 1 This subject is discussed at great length in the tract by Knops and Payne [1971, 2]. 2 Kirchhoff [1859, 11, [1876, 1]. See also Clebsch [1862, 7]. = 0 on B, = 0J = s on dB.
Sect. 32. Uniqueness. 105 on B with the following properties: (i) u, E, and S are continuous on B; (ii) u and /S are differentiable on B; (iii) u, E, and S satisfy the field equations and boundary conditions. The last theorem implies that uniqueness holds for the displacement and traction problems provided the elasticity field is positive definite. When B is homogeneous, we can prove a much stronger uniqueness theorem for the displacement problem. ^ (2) Uniqueness theorem for the displacement problem.1 Let B be homo- geneous, let C be symmetric, and assume that either C or — Cjs_$trongly.dlipiiG,. Then theliisplacement problem has at most one solution with smooth displacements on B. Proof. By the principle of superposition, it suffices to show that 6=0on5 and u=0 on 8B (a) imply u e= 0 on B. Thus assume that the body forces and surface displacements are zero. Then by (28.3) 2U{E} = jE-C[E]dv=0, (b) B and, since E = Vu, (ii) of (20.1) implies 2U{E} = fVu-C[Vu]dv. (c) B Let us extend the definition of u from B to all of S by defining w = 0 on S—B. ' (d) Then by (a) u is continuous and piecewise smooth on S, and Vu has discontinuities only on 8B. Thus u and Vu are both absolutely and square integrable over $ and possess the three-dimensional Fourier transforms a and A defined on £ by s a (*)=(~2ys/eip[x) 'p(v) vu ^ dv» • <f) s where p(x) =x— 0. Using (d)-(f) and the divergence theorem, we obtain A = —ia®p. (g) 1 E. and F. Cosserat [1898, 1, 2, 3] proved^ that^ strong^eHigticity implies uniqueness for the dispiacenSnFpTo^fem m'aTMmogeneous and isotropic body. (See alsoTredholm [l9067 3], B6«ST6~[T9077 J]Y aiid Sherman [1938, 2]'.) TKiFresult can" also be inferred from the earlier work of Kelvin [1888, 4']. For a homogeneous but possibly anisotropic body, theorem (2) follows from the work of Browder [1954, 4] and Morrey [1954, 14]. The proof given here, witicfi^jBjbase5^m_the work of Van Hove [1947^ 9], was Jurnished by R. A. Toupin (private communication in 1961). A slightiy more general theorem was established by Hill [1957, 8], [1961, 12, 13], who noted that uniqueness holds provided J7{u}>0 for all class C2 fields u that vanish on 8B but are not identically zero. Hill's result is not restricted to homogeneous bodies. Hayes [1966, 9] established a uniqueness theorem for the displacement problem under a slightly weaker hypothesis on C, which he calls moderate strong elhpticity. It is not difficult to prove that moderate strong ellipticity and strong ellipticity are equivalent notions when the body is isotropic. Additional papers concerned with uniqueness for the displacement problem are Muskhelishvili [1933, 2], Misicu [1953, IS], Ericksen and Toupin [1956,3], Ericksen [1957,5], Duffin and Noll [1958, S], Gurtin and Sternberg [i960, 7], Gurtin [1963, 10], Hayes [1963, 12], Knops [1964, 13], [1965, 12, 13], Zorski [1964, 24], Edelstein and Fosdick [1968, 4], Mikhlin [1966. 16].
106 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 32. Since B is homogeneous, a fundamental theorem of Fourier analysis1 yields JVu-C [Vu] dv = Cijkl J uitj ukil dv=CilHi f A^A^ dv = JA-C [A] dv, (h) where A is the complex conjugate of A. If we write A^AR+iAt, a=aR -\-iaJt then (g) implies that AK=ajiSp, AI = -aK^>p. (i) On the other hand, we conclude from the symmetry of C that A-C[A]=AR-C[AK]+ArC[Al]. (j) By (c), (d), and (h)-(j), 2 U{E} = f (aR ®p) • C [aR ®p] dv + f (at ®p) • C [a, ®p] dv. (k) s s Assume that u does not vanish identically on B. Then by the uniqueness of the Fourier transform, a cannot vanish identically on i, and we conclude from (k) that if C is strongly elliptic, U{E}>0, which contradicts (b). We also arrive at a contradiction if — C is strongly elliptic. Thus u = 0 on B. □ For homogeneous and isotropic bodies, a converse to the uniqueness theorem (2) is furnished by the if" (3) Cosserat-Ericksen-Toupin theorem.2 Suppose that the material is hoimgeneous_anA.isQtrQpic, and thatjn^ther the elasticity^tensor nor it&..negativ.e is tylty&y...?Mptic- Then there exists a hody.B~and.an elastic, state <>= [m, E, S] on J3 with the following properties: 6 corresponds to. zero..body forces and satisfies the.null boundary condition m_=_0 _on,j9Z?, and u is not identically zero. Proof. By (25.1) we have only three cases to consider: ju=0, 2 + 2^=0, [X+2fj) /lc<0. In view of (31.1), it is sufficient to exhibit a body B and a non-trivial class C2 displacement field n on B that satisfies (iAu + {?l+ix) Fdivu = 0, (a) u = 0 on dB. (b) (i)3 Assume X + 2/lc = 0. Then (a) is satisfied by any displacement field of the form u = V<p. Thus we have only to exhibit a body B and a scalar field <p of class C3 on B such that F9> = 0 on dB. 1 See, e.g., Goldberg [1961, 9], Theorem 13E. 2 Cosserat [1898,2,3], Ericksen and Toupin [1956,3], Ericksen [1957,5]. See also Mikhlin [1966, 16]. 3 Ericksen and Toupin [1956, 3]. See also Hill [1961, 13].
Sect. 32. Uniqueness. 107 We take B equal to the open ball of unit radius centered at the origin 0, and cp(x)=r3(r — l)3, r = |a? —0|. (ii)1 Assume f/,—0. Then it suffices to find a displacement field u that satisfies div u = 0 (c) and (b). The field u = curl w obeys (c). Thus it suffices to exhibit a vector field w satisfying curlM> = 0 on dB. (d) Let B be as in (i) and take w(x) —r3(r — i)3e, where e is a unit vector. Then it is easily verified that w satisfies (d). (iii)2 Assume (A + 2/lc) fi < 0. Let % (x) = 2/i x\ — (A + 2fi) (x\ + x\) —/*, u2(x) — u3(x) = 0. Then it satisfies (a) everywhere and vanishes on an ellipsoid. □ y That the assumption of homogeneity is necessary for the validity of theorem (2) is clear from the following counterexample of Edelstein and Fosdick. 3 They take B to be the spherical shell B={x: n<\x — 0| <2n} composed of the inhomogeneous but isotropic material defined by M') = ;~{> +ln ~}, A(r) =-^ -2^(r). Since /lc>0 and k + 2ft>0, the elasticity field is strongly elliptic on B. They show that the displacement field u defined in spherical coordinates by u,(r) = sin r, ue—uY—0, satisfies the displacement equation of equilibrium with zero body forces and vanishes on the boundary of B (i.e. when r = n or r = 2n). (4) Uniqueness theorem for the traction problem for star-shaped bodies/ Suppose that the body is homogeneous, isotropic, and star-shaded, and let the Lame moduli /j, and X satisfy ___ _ (A + 2/a)/a<0. ^dth^mi'1"' 1 Ericksen and Toupin [1956, 3]. See also Mills [1963, 20]. 1 Cosserat [1898, 2]. This solution was discovered independently by Erick§ijn [1957, 5]. 3 [1968,4]. -- '"" ' ' 4 Bramble and Payne [1962, 4~\. In terms of Poisson's ratio v (v4=i), theorems (J) and (4) imply tfitCTTor a star-Shaped body uniqueness holds for the surface force problem provided /«4=0 and — \<v< 1. The question of whether or not one can drop the hypothesis that B be star-shaped is open. A partial answer was supplied by Bramble and Payne [1962, 3], who have shown that uniqueness holds if — 1< v < 1 — iK(i + K)'1, where K is a non-negative constant that depends on the shape of the body. (See also Hill [1961, 13].) A counterexample by E. and F. Cosserat [1901, 3] (see also Bramble and Payne [1961, 3]) establishes lack of uniqueness for — 00 < v < — 1, while counterexamples by E. and F. Cosserat [1901, 2, 4] and Bramble and Payne [1961, 3] indicate non-uniqueness for a countable number of discrete values of Poisson's ratio in the interval [1, 00). See also Mikhlin [1966, 16]. For the plane traction problem Sherman [1938, 2] has shown that uniqueness holds if »»#= 1, /a, 4= 0. That these conditions are also necessary follows from counterexamples of Hill [1961, 13] and Knops [1965, 12].
108 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 32. Then any two solutions of the traction problem with class C2 displacements on B are equal modulo a rigid displacement. Proof. It is sufficient to show that 6=0 on B, s=0 on 8B (a) imply JS = 0 on B. Thus assume (a) holds. Then (24.5) and the theorem of work and energy (28.3) yield U{E} = f[M\E\*+l(trE)* dv = 0. Recall Navier's equation Au+yVdivu — 0, (b) (c) Since B is star-shaped, it follows from (5.1) that there exists a point in B, which we take to be the origin 0, such that p-n>0 at every regular point of dB. Consider the identity f [Au+yVdivu]-(Vu)pdv = - f s-(Vu)pda + 1 U{E} dB -yVn)[|JSp+y2-1-(divw)' dB (d) (e) da, which can be established with the aid of the divergence theorem, the stress equation of equilibrium div S =0, and the stress-strain relation in the form S=2ju By (a), (b), and (c), (e) reduces to E + ^- 1 (div w) 1 / (P •») dB y-\ |^|2+— ---(div u)2 ia=0. (f) (g) Since n • Sn =0 on dB, (f) implies (y — i) div w = — 2n- En. Thus, f or y =(= 1, (g) becomes jVn)[|E|» + -f--(n-En)« dB The inequality (A + 2/lc) /lc<0 implies y < — 1; hence da =0. — f >0. y-i (h) W Therefore (h) may be rewritten as f (p-n) E—U + l/-^--) (n-Enjn® dB n ' da=0,
Sect. 33. Nonexistence. 109 and by (d) this implies E={\ +1/-^~)(n-£n)n<8)n on dB. (j) In view of (i) and (j), n-En=0 on dB, and hence by (j) E=0 on dB. This implies that div u = tr JS = 0 on dS. But div u is harmonic;* hence div u = 0 on S, and we conclude from (b) that J3 = 0. □ ^ 33. Nonexistence. For the traction problem a necessary condition for the ^existence of a solution is that"the external forces be in equilibrium, i.e. that J s da+ f b dv=0, dB B f pxsda + f pxb dv=0. dB B A deeper result was established by Ericksen2, who proved that, in general, lack of uniqueness implies lack of existence, or equivalently, that existence implies uniqueness.3 Suppose there were two solutions to a given mixed problem, and that these solutions were not equal modulo a rigid displacement. Then their difference [w, E, S] would have E^O, would satisfy u = 0 on S^, s=Sn=0 on ,9%, (N) and would correspond to vanishing body forces. We call an elastic state [w, E, S] with the above properties a non-trivial solution of the mixed problem ivith null data. (1) Nonexistence theorem.* Let the elasticity field be symmetric. Assume tha^ there exists a non-trivial solution of the mixed problem with\ null data. Then there exists a continuous body force field b on B. of. class C2 on B with the following properly: the mixed problem corresponding to this body force field and to the null boundary condition (N}_has no solution. Further, if Sfx is empty, then b can be chosen so as to satisfy fbdv=0, J pxb dv=0. B B Proof. Let 3 = [u, E, S] be a non-trivial solution of the mixed problem with null data. Then if 6 = [u, E, S) is any other elastic state with b the corresponding bodyTorce field, Betti's theorem (30.1) implies / S ■ u da = J s ■ ii, da + / b • u dv, yt & b where we have used the fact that 1 corresponds to null data. Nowichoose b = w, and suppose that a satisfies thejniU^mmdaxy__TOn^tions_(N). Then the above relation implies f\u\2dv = 0, B 1 This will be proved in Sect. 42. 2 Ericksen [1963, 4], [1965, 7]. 3 This result is a direct analog of the Fredholm alternative for symmetric linear operators on an inner product space. 4 The basic idea behind this theorem is due to Ericksen [1963, 4], who established a theorem similar to (1) for the traction problem and asserted an analogous result for the displacement problem. Cf. Fichera [1971, 1], Theorem 6.IV (with A = 0).
110 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 34 which yields u = 0, and we have a contradiction. Thus there cannot exist an elastic state <f with the above properties. ^ ^ Now assume that ^=0. Clearly, if [w, E, S] is a non-trivial solution of the surface force problem with null data, then [u+to, E, S] also has this property for every rigid displacement field w. Thus to complete the proof it suffices to find a rigid displacement w such that J (u-\-w) dv = 0, J j)X(u+w) dv =0. (a) B B Let c denote the centroid of B and I its centroidal inertia tensor; i.e. if pc(x)=x~c, then / pcdv = 0, B B Let w denote the rigid displacement field defined by w=a-\-<oxpc, a = ~ I udv, (o = —I'x I pcxndv. B B Then a simple computation based on the identity /pcx(coxpc) dv=I(o B yields / (w+to) dv = 0, f pcx(u+w) dv—0, B B which is equivalent to (a). □ The non-existence theorem (1) has the following immediate corollary: If the mixed problem with nidi boundary data has a solution whenever the body force field is sufficiently smooth, then there is at most one solution to the mixed problem. IV. The variational principles of elastostatics. 34. Minimum principles. In this section we will establish the two classical minimum principles of elastostatics: the principle of minimum potential energy and the principle of minimum complementary energy.1 These principles completely characterize the solution of the mixed problem discussed previously. We assume throughout that the data has properties (i)-(iv) of Sect. 31, and, in addition, that (v) the elasticity field C is symmetric and positive definite on B. Let E and S be continuous symmetric tensor fields on B. For convenience, we now write UC{E}, rather than U{E), for the strain energy: Uc{E}=%f E C[E]dv. B 1 The treatment of the minimum principles (1) and (3), which is based on the notion of an elastic state, was furnished by E. Sternberg (private communication) in 1959.
Sect. 34. Minimum principles. Ill Further, we define the s'*^£J^*^</2/ %{S} by UK{S}=%fS-K[S]dv, B where K = C~l is the compliance tensor. In view of the remarks made on p. 84, UK{S} = UC{E} provided S — C[E]. By a fe»*£*!H?^i?JL^J2???^^^^??^e we mean an admissible state that satisfies the strain-displacement relation, the stress-strain relation, and the displacement boundary condition. " '?<""<. r^o-J\ z*x*. (1) Principle of minimum potential energy.1 Let s# denote the_ set of^all kinematicall_Yadmissible_siaies, and let 0 be the functional on stf defined by #{d} = UC{E} — f b -udv — f s-uda B ^ for every 4 = [u, E, S] €jj/. Further, let 4 be a solution of the mixed problem. Then 0{d}^#{d} for every Ht-stf, and equality holds only if 4=4 modulo a rigid displacement. Proof. Let 4, 4 ts# and define 4'=4—4. (a) Then 4' is an admissible state and \ rwx no** E'=%(Pu'+Pu'T), S'=>C[E'], u' — Q on £fx. Moreover, S = C[E], since 4£s/; thus (28.1) and (c) imply UC{E} - UC{E} = UC{E'} + JS-E'dv. (b) (c) (d) (e) Next, if we apply (18.1) to S and u', we conclude, with the aid of (b) and (d), that f /S • E'dv— f s ■ u' da— f u'■ 6xv S dv. b &, B 1 It is somewhat difficult to trace the history of this and other variational and minimum j principles, since in the older work the nature of the allowed variations was often left to be 1 inferred from the result. The basic, ideas appear in the work of Green [1839, 1], pp. 253-256, ! Haughton [1849, 1], P- 152, Kirchhoff.[1850,1], §'i/Kelvin"[i8'6*3, 3], §§61-62, Donati [1894, 2]. J^agrgyeitheoremitappears.tp„hayefirstbeen giyei.Ej:i.iiyE,[19Q6ll], § 119for the displacemeivFprpblem, by Hadamard [-1903,3], §264, Colonnetti [1912,1 J, and Prange [1916, 1], PP- 5154 for the traction problem, and by Trefftz [1928, 3], § 18 for the mixed problem. An extension to "exterior domains was given by'Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11], Theorem 6.5. Variants of this theorem, which are useful in the determination of bounds on effective elastic moduli for heterogeneous materials, are contained in the work of Hashin and Shtrikman [1962, 9], Hill [1963, 13], Hashin [1967, 8], Beran and Molyneux [1966, 3], and Rubenfeld and Keller [1969, 6]. For the displacement problem, the hypothesis that £ be positive definite, is not necessary I for the validity of the principle of rmnmimrr"potential energy. This fact is clear from the 1^- work of Hill [1957, 8], Gurtin and Sternberg [i960, 7], and Gurtin [1963, 10]. > For various related references, see Prager and Synge [1947, 6], Synge [1957, 15], Mikhlin [1957, 10], and Oravas and McLean [1966, 19].
112 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 34. Thus ¢{3} - #{«} == UC{E'} - / (div 8 + 6) • W dv + / (s - s) ■ W da, (f) b sez and since <) is a solution of the mixed problem, (f) implies &{Pf-&{4} = Uc{E'}. Thus, since C is positive definite, 0{<)}^0{3}, 0{o} = ¢{3} <=>£',= £-£=(). Moreover, since <) and 5 are kinematically admissible, E=E only when <j=3 modulo a rigid displacement. □ In words, the principle of minimum potential energy asserts that the difference between the strain energy and the work done by the body forces and prescribed surface forces assumes a smaller value for the solution of the mixed problem than for any other kinematically admissible state. The uniqueness theorem (32.1) for the mixed problem follows as a corollary of the principle of minimum potential energy. Indeed, let o and 2 be two solutions. Then this principle tells us that 0(4^ 0{3}, 0{3}^0{o}. Thus 0{a} = 0{3}, and we conclude from (1) that o and Z must be equal modulo a rigid displacement. By a kinematically admissible displacement field we mean an admissible displacement field that satisfies the displacement boundary condition, and for which div C[Ptt] is continuous on B. The corresponding strain field is then called a kinematically admissible strain field. If [«, E, S] is a kinematically admissible state, then u is a kinematically admissible displacement field. Conversely, the latter assertion implies the former provided E and S are defined through the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations. In view of these equations, 0{<s} can be written as a functional &{u} of u: 0{u} = £ f Vu ■ C[Vu] dv—Jb-udv—fs-u da; b is SP, therefore we have the following partial restatement of (1) (2) Let u correspond to a solution of the mixed problem. Then 0{m}^0{«} for every kinematically admissible displacement field u. By a statically admissible stress field we mean an admissible stress field that satisfies the equation of equilibrium and the traction boundary condition. (3) Principle of minimum complementary energy.1 Let srf denote the set of all statically admissible stress fields, and let ¥ be the functional on s/ defined by V{$) =UK{S} -fs-uda 1 The basic ideas appear in the work of Cotteriix [1865, 1] and Donati [1890, 1], [1894, 2]. As a proved theorem it seems to have first been given by Colonnetti [1912,1] and Prange [1916, T\ for the surface force problem and by Trefftz [1928, S], §19 for the mixed problem. See also Domke [1915, T\.
Sect. 34. Minimum principles. 113 for every S^jtf. Let S be a stress field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem. Then for every Sts/, and equality holds only if S=S. Proof. Let [u, E, S] be a solution of the mixed problem, let S(^/, and define S' = S-S. (a) Then S' satisfies divS'=0 on B, s'=S'n==0 on ^. (b) Since E = K[<S], (a) and an obvious analog of (28.1) imply UK{S}-UK{S} = UK{S'} + fS'-Edv. (c) B Further, in view of (b) and (18.1), J S' ■ E dv = f s' -uda. b se, Thus, since u— u on ,9\, ¥{S}-V{S} = UK{S'}. Therefore, since K is positive definite, ¥{S} ^ ¥{§}, and W{S} = lF{S} only if The principle of minimum complementary energy asserts that of all statically admissible .stress fields, the one belonging to a solution of the mixed problem renders a minimum the difference between the stress energy and the work done over the prescribed displacements. We shall now use the foregoing minimum principles to establish ^/(4) Upper and lower bounds for the strain energy.1 Let U be the strain energy associated with a solution of the displacement problem. Assume thatjhebody forces vanish. Then / s • u da - UK{S} ^U£ UC{E}, dB where E is a kinematically admissible strain field, S a statically admissible stress field, and s the corresponding surface traction. On the other hand, let U be the strain energy corresponding to a solution of the traction problem. Then Jb-udv+ fs-uda- UC{E} ^ U g UK{S}, B oB where u is a kinematically admissible displacement field, E the corresponding strain field, and S a statically admissible stress field. Proof, Let 6 = [u, E, S] be a solution of the displacement problem with b =0, and let U be the associated strain energy: U = UC{E} = UK{S}. 1 Cf. Aymerich [1955, 1] who obtains upper and lower bounds on the strain energy by embedding the body in a larger body. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 8
114 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 34. Then, since Sf% — 0, we conclude from the principle of minimum potential energy that U^UC{E}^UC{E}. On the other hand, since S^ = dB, it follows from the principle of work and energy (28.3) that the last term in the expression for *F{S} in (3) is equal to — 2*7. Thus ¥{$} = -U, and (3) implies U^ f s-uda-UK{S}. 8B Next, let o be a solution of the surface force problem. Then 5? = 0, and the principle of minimum complementary energy yields U^UK{S}. Moreover, since S^ = dB, we conclude from (28.3) that the last two terms in the expression for 0{o} in (1) are equal to —2U. Thus #{<.} = -C7, and (1) implies U^ fb-udv + fs-iida-Uc{E}. □ B dB Using (18.2) we can write the inequalities in (4) in the following forms: / S • {E - %K[S]} dv ^ U ^ UC{E}, B f E ■ {S- 1C[#]} dv^U^UK{S}. B By a statically admissible state we mean an admissible state [«, E, S] with <S a statically admissible stress field. For convenience, we now define W on f ^j the set of all statically admissible states o — [u, E, S] by writing !F{<j} =^(8}. .« Clearly, an admissible state o is a solution of the mixed problem if and only ; = |Cf 3 • i if 6 is both kinematically and statically admissible. We shall tacitly use this fact I in establishing the next theorem, which furnishes an interesting relation between *the functionals 0 and W. i \ (5) Let o be a solution of the mixed problem. Then 0{<i} + W{<s}=O. Proof. In view of the definition of 0 and W, 0{o} + ¥{<>} = UC{E} + UK{S} -fb-udv-fs-uda-fs-uda B *i SPX = 2UC{E} — f b • u dv — f s ■ uda, B 8B and the desired result follows from the principle of work and energy (28.3). □ If we assume that the mixed problem has a solution, then the preceding theorem has the following corollary. £> (6) Let 4 and 4 be admissible states with Z kinematically admissible and a statically admissible. Then 0{4}+W{t}^O.
Sect. 35- Some extensions of the fundamental lemma. 115 Proof. Let o be a solution of the mixed problem. Then the principles of minimum potential and complementary energy imply that Thus 0{3} + TO^W + TO=O. □ 35. Some extensions of the fundamental lemma. In this section we shall establish three lemmas whose role in elastostatics is analogous to the role of the fundamental lemma in the calculus of variations. Let dB(x0, h) denote the intersection of dB with the open ball Eh (x0) of radius h and center at x0, and let <&h(x0) denote the set of functions defined in Sect. 7. (1) Let W be a finite-dimensional inner product space. Let w: S/'^-^-'W be piecewise regular and satisfy J w -v da=0 for every class C°° function v: B ~>Wthat vanishes near ^. Then w=0 on £f2. Proof. Let e,, e2,..., eB be an orthonormal basis for W, and let H »=i Assume that for some regular interior point x0 of S^ and some k, wk (x0) > 0 (say). Then there exists an h>0 such that dB(x0,h) is contained in S^2 and wk>0 on dB(x0,h). Let v = q>ek with q>€&h(x0). Then v is of class C°° and vanishes near S^. In addition, f w -v da>0, which is a contradiction. Thus w(x0) =0 at every regular interior point x0 of y%. But since w is piecewise regular, this implies w=0 on £f2. □ (2) Let u be a piecewise regular vector field on £flt and suppose that f (Sri) -uda=0 for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on B that vanishes near £?%. Then u = 0 on S^. Proof. Since S is symmetric, (Sri) u=S- (u®n)=S-T, where T is the symmetric part of u®n: T = £ (u <g) n +n <g) u). Therefore jS-Tda=0 whenever S satisfies the above hypotheses. Consequently, letting #"in (1) be the space of all symmetric tensors, we conclude from (1) that T = 0 on 9{, 8*
116 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 36. and hence that 2Tn=w+n(u • n) =0 on yx. Taking the inner product of this relation with n, we find that u ■ n = 0 on Sflt and this fact and the above relation imply «=0on^, □ (3) Let ube a piecewise regular vector field on SP2 • an^ suppose that f u ■ div S da =0 for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on B. Then «=0 on Sf%. Proof. Let v be an arbitrary class C°° vector field on B which vanishes near ,¾. Then by (6.5) there exists a class C°° vector field g on B with the property that Ag =v. Let1 S=Vg + FgT-ldivg. Then <S is a class C°° symmetric tensor field on B, and hence / u ■ divSi«=0. But a simple calculation yields div<S = Ag =v. Thus / u- v da=0 for every class C°° vector field v on B which vanishes near 6^, and the desired result follows from (1). □ 36. Converses to the minimum principles. In this section we shall use the results just established to prove converses to the principles of minimum potential and complementary energy. We continue to assume that hypotheses (i)-(v) of Sects. 31 and 34 hold. Our first theorem shows that if a kinematically admissible state minimizes the functional 0, then that state is a solution of the mixed problem. Lf- (1) Converse of the principle of minimum potential energy. Let 4 be a kinematically admissible state, and suppose that for every kinematically admissible state 3. Then 6 is a solution of the mixed problem. Proof. Let u' be an arbitrary vector field of class C°° on B, and suppose that h' vanishes near S^. Further, let 0' = [«', E', S'], where E'=^(Fu' + Fu'T), S'=C[E']. Then 3 = 0 + 4' is kinematically admissible, and it is not difficult to verify that (f) in the proof of (34.1) also holds in the present circumstances. Thus, since 0^Uc{E'}- f (div S + b) -u'dv + f(s-s) u' da. 1 Cf. the remarks following (17.8).
Sect. 36. Converses to the minimum principles. 117 Clearly, this relation must hold with u' replaced by aw' and E' by «.E'; hence 0 ^«?UC{E'} -a / (div S +b) ■ u' dv + a / (s - s) • u' da b y, for every scalar a, which implies — / (div S + 6) • u' dv + / (s — s) • w' rfa =0 (a) for every C°° vector field u' that vanishes near S^. If, in addition, u' vanishes near dB, then .,,. „ , ,. /(divS + b) w' dv=0, B and we conclude from (7.1) with #"= y that divS + b=0. (b) By (a) and (b), ., ^. for every C°° field w' that vanishes near <ylt and (35.1) with #^= y yields s = s on S?2. (c) Thus a is a kinematically admissible state that satisfies (b) and (c); hence a is a solution of the mixed problem. □ Note that (1) does not presuppose the existence of a solution to the mixed problem. If onelthows a priori that a solution ? exists,1 then it follows from (34.1) tnat any kinematically admissible state o that minimizes 0 must be equal to 1, and hence must be a solution. Indeed, if ? minimizes 0, then 0{?}^0{a}; but (34.1) implies 0{<S}^0{4}, so that 0{«}=0{3}, and we conclude from (34.1) that d=7 (modulo a rigid displacement). The next theorem yields a converse to the principle of minimum complemen-. tary energy. Toj3roye„iMs„theo^ and convex with respect to S/\ (when ^4^3). In view of the discussion given in[ the preceding paragraph, if B and the boundary data are such that existence holds for the corresponding mixed problem,1 then this converse follows trivially without the above assumptions concerning B. (2) Converse of the principle of minimum complementary energy.2 Assume that B is simply-connected and convex with respect to £/^ and that K is of class C2 on B. Let S be a statically admissible stress field of class C2 on B, and suppose that „ for every statically admissible stress field S. Then S_is.Q stress field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem. Before proving this theorem we shall establish two subsidiary results; these results are not only basic to the proof of (2), but are also of interest in themselves. 1 Existence theorems for the mixed problem are given, e.g., by Fichera [1971, 1], § 12. 2 The basic ideas behind this theorem are due_to_CP-TTERILL [186;;, 1], Donati [1890, 1], [1894,2], Domke [1915,-Z], Southwell [193673]T[1938, 5], Locatelli [1940,3,4], Dorn and Schild [1956, 1]. As a proved theorem it seems to have first been given by Sokolni- koff [1956, 12] for the traction problem and by Gurtin [1963, 11] for the mixed problem.
118 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 36. (3)1 Let w be a continuous vector field on a regular subsurface Sf of dB, and let B be convex with respect to Sf'. Further, suppose that f (Sri) ■ wda = 0 for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on B that vanishes near dB — Sf and satisfies divS = 0. Then w is a rigid displacement field. Proof. Let x and x be regular points of Sf, and choose a cartesian coordinate system such that the coordinates of x are (0, 0, 0) and those of x are (0, 0, xa). Let De be the closed disc in the x1, %,-plane with radius e > 0 and center at (0, 0), and let fe be a class C00 scalar field on the entire xlt %-plane with the following properties: («) /e^o; (/3) /,=0 outside D,; (?) //.<*« = !• Such a function is easily constructed using the procedure given in the first paragraph of Sect. 7. Clearly, the symmetric tensor field S on E defined by [«(*)] 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 /,(¾. *,) has zero divergence. Let C, be the infinite solid circular cylinder whose axis coincides with the and whose cross-section is De. Then the assumed con- 1 Gurtin [1963,11]. Fig. 10.
Sect. 36. Converses to the minimum principles. H9 vexity of B with respect to £f and the regularity of Sf imply that for all sufficiently small e there exist disjoint subregions SPe and 5^ of Sf such that (see Fig. 10) xe^s, xa<$?e, Ct^dB = £yj&t. Thus S vanishes near dB —,SP and 0=/ (Sn) w da = f few3n3da-\- f few3n3da. (a) Next, by property (y) of fe, ffen3da = ffeda=\, j, & c° r f fEn3dar=- f feda = -\. Thus if we let e->0 in (a) and use property (a) of fe in conjunction with the mean- value theorem of integral calculus, we conclude that w3(x)-w3 (2)=0, or equivalently that [w(x) —w(x)] ■ [■*—*] =0. Since x and x are_ arbitrary regular points of y, and since 145 is continuous on ^w has the projection property.on £f. Moreover, from our hypotheses it follows that SP is a non-coplanar point set; hence we conclude from (13.3) that w is rigid. Q , (4)1 Let it be a continuous vector field on a regular subsurface £P of dB, and let B be simply-connected and convex with respect to £f. Let E be a symmetric tensor field that is continuous on B and of class C2 on B. Further, suppose that f (Sn) -uda = f S-Edv ST B for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on B that vanishes near dB —£f and satisfies divS = 0. Then there exists an admissible displacement field u such that j E = %(Vu + VuT), ■ \u — u on Sf. Proof. Let Q> denote the set of all class. C°° symmetric tensor fields on B that satisfy divTT^T'By "hypothesis fS-Edv=0 B for every ScS> that vanishes near dB. Thus we conclude from Donati's theorem (18.8) that E satisfies the equation of compatibility. In view of the compatibility theorem (14.2), this result and the fact that B is simply-connected imply the existence of an admissible disp^cemelrFfieTajir"such"that E and u' satisfy the 1 For the case in which Sf=dB this theorem is due to Dorn and Schild [1956, 1]. The present more general case is due to Gurtin [1963, 11].
120 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 37. g^-arn-Hjcplarprnpnt relation. Thus we conclude from the present hypotheses and (18.1) that for every St@> which vanishes near dB — £f, f (Sn) -u'da= f (Sn) u' da = f S ■ Edv = f (Sn) -uda. if 8B b se Therefore if we let w = u — u', then J (Sn) -wda—0 sr for every Se@ that vanishes near dB —SP. Thus we may conclude from (3) that w is the restriction^to SP of a rigid displacement field w, and the displacement field u defined on B through u=u' -\-w has all of the desired properties. □ We are now in a position to give the Proof of (2). Let S'a@ vanish near Sf2- Then S=S-\-S' is a statically admissible stress field, and ¥{&}£¥{§}. (a) Let E = K[S]. Then (c) in the proof of (34.3) holds in the present circumstances, and we conclude from this result, (a), and the definition of IF given in (34.3) that 0^W{S}-W{S} = UK{S'}+ f S'-Edv- fs'-uda. (b) B S^ The inequality (b) must hold for every S'e@ that vanishes near £f2. If we replace S' in (b) by a<S', where a is a scalar, we find that f S' -Edv=f s'-uda B y, for every such field S'. Thus we conclude from (4) that there exists a vector field u such that \u, E, S] is a solution of the mixed problem. □ ■QvJ/37. Maximum principles.1 The principles of minimum potential and complementary energy can be used to compute upper bounds for the "energies" ¢{0} and ^{0} corresponding to a solution 4. In this section we shall establish two maximum principles which allow one to compute lower bounds for ¢{0} and lF{o}. We continue to assume that the hypotheses (i)-(v) of Sects. 31 and 34 hold. As our first step, we extend the domain of the functionals 0 and W to the set of all admissible states in the obvious manner: ¢{0} = UC{E} — / b -udv — f s -uda, b st, W{<i} = UK{S}-fs-uda for every admissible state a = [u,E,S]. 1 Tig_basic ideas underlying these principles are diifi_ta_TREFFTZ [1928, 4], who estab- \ lished analogous results for boundary-value problems associated with the equations A u = 0 "">and AAu = 0. See also Sokolnikoff [1956,12], § 118 and Mikhlin [1957, 10], §§55, 57, 59-
Sect. 3 7. Maximum principles. 121 (1) Principle of maximum potential energy.1 Let 0 be a solution of the mixed problem, and let 3 be an elastic state that satisfies f s • (u—u) daT^O, »\ s = s on £?%. Then and equality holds if and only if 0 = 3 modulo a rigid displacement. Proof. Let o' = <i — 3. Then (28.1) and the fact that S = C[E] imply UC{E} - UC{E} = UC{E'} +JS-E' dv. B Next, if we apply the theorem of work expended (18.2) to S and u', we find that f S ■ E' dv — f b ■ u' dv-\- f s ■ u' da. B B dB Thus, since u = u on Sfx and s = s on £f2, #{«} - ¢{3} = UC{E'} +fs-{u-u)da. This completes the proof, since C is positive definite and the last term non- negative. ' □ It is clear from this proof that (1) continues to hold even when 4 is required only to be kinematically admissible. Note that in the principle of minimum potential energy the admissible states were required to satisfy, in essence, only the displacement boundary condition. On the other hand, the "admissible state" 3 in the principle of maximum potential energy is required to satisfy all of the field equations, the traction boundary condition, and a weak form of the displacement boundary condition. (2) Principle of maximum complementary energy. Let 0 be a solution of the mixed problem, and let 3 be an elastic state that satisfies u = u on S^, f (s — s) ■ u, da'StO. sr. Then «F{<i}^«F{3}, and, equality holds if and only if ¢ = 2 modulo a rigid displacement. Proof. Let <(' = <> — 3; then 0' is an elastic state corresponding to zero body forces. As before, UK{S} - UK{$} = UK{S'} +fS'-Edv, B 1 COOPERMAN [1952, 1].
122 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 38. and by (18.1) and the fact that div S' = 0, f S' • Edv = f s' ■ uda. B SB Thus, since ii = u on S^_ and s = s on Sf_, W{i}-W{i) = UK{S'} + f(s-s)-u da, which, in view of our hypotheses, implies the desired result. Q Note that (2) remains valid under the weaker hypothesis that 4 be statically admissible. ^\ 38. Variational principles. The admissible states appropriate to the minimum principles of elastostatics are required to meet certain of the field equations and boundary conditions. Injwrneji£gliciitia^ use variational principles in which the~aHrn5sible states satisfy as few constraints~as~possTBle. IrTtKs'sectibn'we establish two such principles.* We continue to assume that the data has properties (i)-(iv) of Sect. 31, but in place of (v) of Sect. 34 we assume that (v') the elasticity field C is symmetric. The two variational principles will be concerned with scalar-valued functionals whose domain of definition is a subset s4 of the set of all admissible states. Let A be such a functional, let 4 and 3 be admissible states, (a) 4-\-Xt e.s/ for every scalar A, and formally define the notation d7A{4} = d\A{4 + M}U=0. Then we write if 32A{4^xists_and equals zerojor every choice pLl-consistent-wit-h (a). We begin with a variational principle in which the admissible states are not required to meet any of the field equations, initial conditions, or boundary conditions. (1) Hu-Washteu principle.2 Let jj/ denote the set of all admissible states, and let A be the functional on jj/ defined by A{<s} = Uc{E}- JS-Edv- f (divS + b) -udv B B + f s ■ uda-\- f (s — s) -uda _____ s\ -si 1 The basic ideas behind_these.Ennciples are contained in. the. yrQric._fflLBQim [1906, 1], pp. 91—97, who established analogous_results. for t.he„plane.elastica^.Born was cognizant of the fact thatTus-results applied to elasticity theory, as is clear from bis statement (p. 96): „Ich will hier bemerken, daS sich der Vorteil dieser Darstellung eigentlich erst zeigt, wenn man sie auf die allgemeine Elastizitatstheorie anwendet." See also Oravas and McLean [1966, 19], pp. 927-929 for a detailed study of the early historical development of these principles. 2 Hu [1955, 5],Washizu [1955,-74], [1968,25], § 2.3. See also de Veubeke [1965,6],Tonti [1967, 16, 17], and HlAvaCek [1967, 6, 7]. An extension valid for discontinuous displacement and stress fields was given by Prager [1967, 11], and one in which the stress fields of the admissible states are not required to be symmetric was given by Reissner [1965, 16].
Sect. 38. Variational principles. 123 for every 4 = [u, E, S] £s/. Then (5/l{o} = 0 at an admissible state 4 if and only if 4 is a solution of the mixed, problem. Proof. Let 4 = [u, E, S] and 5 = [u, E, S] be admissible states. Then 4 + X 4 is/ for every scalar X, and in view of (28.1) and the symmetry of C, UC{E + IE) = C7C{£;} + A2 C/c{£} + A / B • C [E] dv. Thus, since d7A{4}=-^A{4+X~4}\^0, it follows that d7A{4}=J{(C[E]-S) ■ E-(div S + b) ■ u-S ■ E -u ■ div §} dv B -\- f s ■ u da -{- f {s • u + (s — s) ■ u} da. If we apply (18.1) to S and u, we find that / u • divSdv= f u -sda— f £(Vu + VuT) ■ Sdv; B dB B thus d~tA{4) = f {C[E] -S) -Edv-f (div S + b)-udv B B + f{i(Vu + VuT)-E}-Sdv+f(u-u)-sda (a) B S^ + f (s — s) ■ uda. If 4 is a solution to the mixed problem, then (a) yields (5y/4{<f}=0 for every 3€j2/, (b) which implies (5/1(4=0. (c) To prove the converse assertion assume that (c), and hence (b), holds. If we choose 3 = [u, 0, 0] and let u vanish near dB, then it follows from (a) and (b) that /(divS + b) -udv=0. B Since this relation must hold for every such u of class C1 on B, we conclude from the fundamental lemma (7.1) that div-S + b=0. Next, let 3 = [u, 0,0], but this time require only that u vanish near &[. Then (a) and (b) imply that / (s — s) • uda=0, sr, and we conclude from (35.1) that s —s on ,¾. Now, let 3 = [0, E, 0] and suppose E vanishes near dB. Then by (a) and (b), / (C[E]-S)-Edv=0. B Thus, since C[E]—S and E are symmetric tensor fields, it follows from (7.1) with W equal to the set of all symmetric tensors that S = C[E]. In the same
124 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 38. manner, choosing 2 = [0, 0, S], where S> vanishes near dB, we conclude that JB= ^(Vu-\-VuT). Finally, if we drop the requirement that S vanish near dB, we conclude from (a) and (b) that f (u—u) ■ (Sn) da = 0 for every class C1 symmetric tensor field S on B, and it follows from (35.2) that u=u on S^. Thus 4 = [u, E, S] is a solution of the mixed problem. □ (2) Hellinger-Prange-Reissner principle.1 Assume that the elasticity field is invertihle and that its inverse K is smooth on B. I^e^_^_denotethesetof_all admis0M£^totesJhgi,£gtisly_J}}e strain^dis^lacement relation, and let 0 be the functional on s/ defined by ~~ ©{4} = UK{S} — f S • Edv + f b -udv + f s ■ (u—u) da-\- fs -uda b b srt srt for every <s = [u, E, S] {.stf. Then at ids/ if and only if <s is a solution of the mixed problem. Proof. Let <s = [w, E, S] and 3 = [ft, E, S] be admissible states, and suppose that <f + A3c.K/ for every scalar X, or equivalently that 4, i£s4. Then, in view of the symmetry of C, K is symmetric and d7 &{<>} = f {(K [S] -E)-S-S -E + b-u}dv B + / {s • (u—u) +s • u} da-\- f s ■ uda. If we apply (18.1) to S> and u and use the fact that E and u satisfy the strain- displacement relation, we find that fS-Edv = fs-uda— f u, • div S dv; B dB B thus 676{i) = f (K[S] -E)-Sdv+ f (div S + b) ■ u dv B B + / (u—u) ■ s da + / (s — s) • u da. (a) If 4 is a solution of the mixed problem, then, clearly, <5<6>{<)}=0 for every ^Gk/, (b) which implies 66(4) =0. On the other hand, (a), (b), (7.1), (35.1), (35.2), and the fact that 4 satisfies the strain-displacement relation imply that 4 is a solution of the mixed problem. □ Let 4 = [u, E, S] be kinematically admissible. Then we conclude from (18.1) that / u • div Sdv = f s • uda-\- f s uda — f S • Edv. B if\ £^2 B 1 The basic idea is contained in the work of Heixinger [1914, 1]. As a proved theorem it was first given by Prange [1916, 1], pp. 54-57 for the traction problem and Reissner [1950,20], [1958, 14], [1961, 18] for the mixed problem. See also RUdiger [1960,20], [1961, 19], HlAvaCek [1967, 6, 7], Tonti [1967, 16,17], Horak [1968, 8], Solomon [1968,12].
Sect. 39. Convergence of approximate solutions. 125 Thus, in this instance, A{i}, given by (1), reduces to 0{<s}, where 0 is the functional of the principle of minimum potential energy (34.1). Also, when i is kine- matically admissible, tfS-Edv.-=Uc{E} = UK{S}, m and 0{<s} given by (2) reduces to — 0{<f}. On the other hand, if <f is a statically admissible state that satisfies the stress-strain relation, then A{o} reduces to — ^{i}, where *P is the functional of the principle of minimum complementary energy (34.3); if i is a statically admissible state that obeys the strain-displacement relation, then 0{<s} reduces to ^(<f}. Table 5 below compares the two variational princi£les_established here|_with_the minimum principles discussed "previously. Table 5. Principle Minimum potential energy Minimum complementary energy Maximum potential energy Maximum complementary energy Hu-Washizu Hellinger-Prange-Reissner Field equations satisfied by the admissible states Strain-displacement stress-strain Stress equation of equilibrium All All None Strain-displacement Boundary conditions satisfied by the admissible states Displacement Traction Traction, weak form of displacement Displacement, weak form of traction None None ^ 39. Convergence of approximate solutions. Recall that the functional of the principle of minimum potential energy (34.2) has the form where 0{u) = U{u} — / b -udv — f s -uda, U{u} =½ f Vu ■ C[Vu] dv (a) is the strain energy written, for convenience, as a functional of the displacement field. The standard method of obtaining an approximate solution to the mixed problem is to minimize the functional 0 over a restricted class of functions.1 That is, one assumes an approximate solution uN in the form ;«jv + ZX/»' (b) where /i,/2, •••,/# are given functions that vanish on £flt and uN is a function that ^approximates the boundary data_w on 5^. Of course, the teimu^'is omitted when ,¾ is empty. The constants a1( a2,..., a.N are then chosen so as to render ¢{^} a minimum. Indeed, if we write 0(^,0^,...,0^)=0(¾}. 1 This idea appears first in the work of Rayleigh (1877) [1945, 6] and Ritz [1908, 2]; the method is usually referred to as the Rayleigh-Ritz method.
y~ -126 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 39. where uN is given by (b), then (assuming that C is symmetric) N N 0(^,0.2, ...,0CN)=a + l 2 Dmn<*-m<*-n + 2 4¾. m, k=1 n=l where 0-,.=/ FA.-ciy/jif,, (c) a — U{uN} — / b -uNdv — f s • uN, b £ dn=JVuN ■ C[Vfn] dv-fb-fndv-fs.f„da. (d) B S Sf, If ^ is empty, the above relations still hold, but with uN = 0, so that a=0, d„ = - fb-fndv- fs-f„da. (e) B dB If C is positive semi-definite, the matrix [Dmn] will be positive semi-definite, and ¢(0¾. a2,..., oln) will be a minimum at 0^ = 0¾. a2=a2, ..., v.s = v.N if and only if 6¾. bt2,..., a a- is a solution of the following system of equations: 2A»»«. = -4. (m=H, 2,...,iV). (f) »=1 We will now estabHsh conditions under which solutions of (f) exist, and under which tHe~resuTting approximate solutions uN converge in energy to the actual solution as N'->66.' We assume for the remainder of this section that C is symmetric and positive definite, and that hypotheses (i)-(iv) of Sect. "}i hold. We write #„ for the set of all continuous and piecewise smooth vector fields on B. ~= (1) Existence of approximate solutions. Let ^j^be an ^-dimensional sub- space of #„ with the property that each /&^jv vanishes on Sfx, (i) If ^ 4= 0, let uN be a given function in #„, and let £FN be the set of all functions f of the form f=g+uN, g^N. (ii) If ^ = 0, let #N = &N. Then there exists a function uNd3FN such that ¢ {uN} sS ¢ {»} for every ve^N. (g) If 5^4=0, then uN is unique; if ^=0, then any two solutions of (g) differ by a rigid displacement. Finally, uN is OjpJimalinJhe following, sense: If u is the displacement field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem, then1 U{u — uN} = inf U{u — v}. (h) Proof. Let/1,/2, ...,fN be a basis for 3FN, and let Dmn and dn be defined by (c), (d), and (e). Then, clearly, to estabHsh the existence of a solution uN of (g) it suffices to estabHsh the existence of a solution 0¾, a2,..., aN of (f). 1 Cf. Schultz [1969, 7], Theorem 2.4.
Sect. 39. Convergence of approximate solutions. 127 Since C is positive definite, we conclude from (c) that N 2 A»»«,»a»^0 (i) for any iV-tuple (¾. a2,..., a^). Assume that A7 2 A»»oc»a» = 0, (j) m, «=1 AT /=20»/»- (k) and let n=l Then it follows from (c) and (j) that fVf.C[Vf]dv^O, B and since C is positive definite, this, in turn, implies that / is rigid. Assume first that 5^4=0. Then /sO, since it is rigid and vanishes on 3^- Consequently, as /i . /a» • • •. /w is a basis for 3PN, this implies that ai = aa= -•• =ajv=0. (1) Therefore, if ^4=0, then (j) implies (1), and we conclude from (i) that the matrix [Dmn] is positive definite 'L hence in this instance"^has~a unique solution. Assume next that S^ — 0. Suppose that N ZDmn*n = 0'> (m) »=1 then (j) holds, and hence f defined by (k) is rigid. Thus any two solutions of (g) (if they exist) differ by afigicl displacement. Next, by (e) and (k), N 2^4=-/ b -fdv — f s -fda, «=1 B dB and it follows1 from (18.3) that N 2«»^„=o. »=1 Thus \^i,dz,..., dN) is orthogonal to every solution («x, a2, •••, a#) of the homo- geneous_eci.Tja.tiQn (m),. and. we conchide from the Fredholm alternative that the inriornogeneous equation (f) has a solution. We have only to show that 1% is optimal. To facilitate the proof of this assertion, we now establish the following (2) Lemma.2 Let [u, E, S] be a solution of the mixed problem. Then 0{v} — <P{u} = U{v —u} + / s-{v—u)da for every ve^0. Proof. Let ^ u' = v— u, E'=Vu'. 1 Here we tacitly assume that (when £^ =0) the external force system [6, s] is in equilibrium. 2 Cf. Tong and Pian [1967, 15], Eq. (2.16).
128 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 39. Then by (28.1), U{v} - U{u} = U{u'} + fS-E'dv. B Further, since div S + b = 0, we conclude from (18.2) that f S ■ E' dv — f s u' da + / b ■ u' dv. B SB B The last three equations and (a) imply the desired result, since u=u on 5^ and s = s on Sf2. □ It is of interest to note that the principle of minimum potential energy in the form (34.2) follows as a direct corollary of this lemma. Indeed, if v is kinematically admissible, then »=uon £fx, and (2) implies that 0{v}^. &{u). We are now in a position to complete the proof of (1). Assume that 5jH=0. By hypothesis, every ve^N satisfies v =uN on SP-l- Thus, since uNe^N, it follows from (2) and (g) that U{uN — u} = &{uN) — 0{u} — f s ■ (uN — u) da ^0{v} — 0{u} — / s • (uN—u) da = U{v—u} for every ve&N. Thus U{uN — u} <L U{v — u}, which implies (h). The proof when S^ =0 is strictly analogous. □ We now establish the convergence of the approximate solutions established in (1). Thus for each N=i, 2, ... let uN and 3FN satisfy the hypotheses of (1). We assume that every sufficiently smooth function that satisfies the displacement boundary condition can be approximated arbitrarily closely in energy by a sequence of elements of &\, &2, More precisely, we assume that (A) given any kinematically admissible displacement field u, there exists a sequence {vN} with vNe&N such that U{u— »jv}->-0 as iV-»-oo. (n) (3) Approximation theorem.1 For each N= 1, 2,... let uN and SFN satisfy the hypotheses of (1), and assume thatj^yjiqld.s. Let {uN} be ~a~sequence of approximate solutions, i.e. solutions of (g), and let u be the displacement field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem. Then U{u—uN}^~0 as JV^-oo. (o) 1 Most of the ideas underlying this theorem are contained in the following works: Courant and Hilbert [1953, 8], pp. 175-176; Mikhlin [1957, 10], pp. 88-95; Friedrichs and Keller [1965, 8]; Key [1966, 11]; Tong and Pian [1967, 15]. These studies contain general results on the convergence of the Rayleigh-Ritz and finite element methods. In the usual applications of the Rayleigh-Ritz procedure &it<#it+i- (*) The abstract formulation given here also includes the finite element method (see, e.g., Zienkiewicz and Cheung [1967, 19], Tong and Pian [1967, 15], Zienkiewicz [1970, 4]) for which (*) is not necessarily satisfied.
Sect. 40. Statement of the problem. Uniqueness. 129 Proof. By (A) there exists a sequence {vN} with vNiJ^N such that (n) holds. On the other hand, (h) and the fact that C is positive definite imply 0 ^ U{u — uN} sg U{u — vN}, and the desired result is an immediate consequence of (n). □ v V. The general boundary-value problem. The contact problem. 40. Statement of the problem. Uniqueness. In the contact problem of elasto- statics1 the normal component of the displacement and the tangential component of the surface traction are prescribed over a portion 5¾ of the boundary: u-n=u and s — (s-n)n=s on £f3, where u and s are prescribed with s tangent to £f3. These relations can also be written in the alternative forms: (n®n)u=un and (1—n®n)s=s on S^3. We now generalize this boundary condition as follows. We assume given a tensor field P on 8B whose value P(x) at any xtdB is a perpendicular projection. The generalized boundary condition then takes the form: Pu—u and (1— P)s=s on dB, where u and s are prescribed vector fields. Since2 (1-P)P=P(1-P)=0, u and s must satisfy the consistency condition (1—P)u = 0 and Ps = 0 on dB. At a point * for which P(x) =1 we have u(x) =u(x), and no restriction is placed on s(x). Thus displacements are prescribed over the subset of dB on which P = 1; similarly, surface tractions are prescribed over the subset for which P = 0. The mixed problem therefore corresponds to P = l on ,9^, P = 0 on £f2, where &[ and 5P2 are complementary subsets of dB. If P=n(g)n at a point, then the normal displacement and the tangential traction are prescribed. Thus the contact problem corresponds to situations in which P = l on £^, P = 0 on Sfit P=n®n on Sf%, where £^, £"2, and 6^ are complementary subsets of dB. In view of the preceding discussion, the general problem may be stated as follows: given an elasticity field C and a body force field b on B together with P, u, and s on 8B; find an elastic state [u, E, S] that corresponds to b and satisfies the generalized boundary condition. We call such a state a solution of the general problem. 1 Sometimes called the mixed-mixed problem. 2 See p. 9- Handbuch dcr Physik, Bd. VIa/2. 9
130 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 41. (1) Uniqueness theorem for the general problem.1 Assume that the elasticity field is positive definite. Then any two solutions of the general problem are equal modulo a rigid displacement. Proof. Let 3 and ? be solutions of the general problem, and let <s = [u,E, S]=? —?. Then <s is an elastic state corresponding to zero body forces. Moreover, Pw = (l-P)s = 0 on dB; thus on dB s-u = [(l-P+P)u] • [(1-P+P)s] = [(l-P)u] -Ps = [P(l—P)u] • s = 0. Therefore we conclude from (28.5) that u is rigid and E =S = 0. □ Of course, (1) yields, as a corollary, the uniqueness theorem (32.1) for the mixed problem. 41. Extension of the minimum principles. The minimum principles established in Sect. 34 are easily extended to the general problem stated in the previous section.2 For example, if we define a kinematically admissible state to be an admissible state [u, E, S] that satisfies the strain-displacement relation, the stress- strain relation, and the boundary condition Pu=u on dB, (a) then the principle of minimum potential energy (34.1) remains valid for the general problem provided we let <&{4} = UC{E}— J b -udv — /s-uda. B dB In view of the consistency condition and the remarks on p. 9, s-u = (l-P)s-u = (l-P)s- (1-P)u, and the integral over 8B can also be written in the form: f(l-P)s-(l-P)uda. (b) dB For the mixed problem (P = l on Sfx, P = 0 on £?2) the boundary condition (a) reduces to u = u on ^, and the integral (b) reduces to an integral over y2. Thus in this instance the extended minimum principle is nothing more than the traditional theorem (34.1). On the other hand, if we define a statically admissible stress field to be an admissible stress field S that satisfies the equation of equilibrium and the boundary condition (l-P)Sn = s on dB, then the principle of minimum complementary energy (34.3) remains valid for the general problem3 provided we let W{S} = UK{S}-fs- uda, dB 1 Cf. Sternberg and Knowles [1966, 24]. Other uniqueness theorems which are not special cases of (1) are given by Bramble and Payne [1961, 5] and Knops and Payne [1971,2]. 2 Cf. Rudiger [I960, 10], Prager [1967, 11], HlavaCek [1967, 7]. 3 An extension of the principle of minimum complementary energy to the mixed-mixed problem was given by Sternberg and Knowles [1966, 24]. See also Hlavacek [1967, 7]. The result stated here includes, as a special case, the theorem of Sternberg and Knowles.
Sect. 42. Properties of elastic displacement fields. 131 or equivalently, >P{S} = UK{S} -fPs-Puda. dB In a similar manner, the maximum principles discussed in Sect. 37 and the variational principles given in Sect. 38 can be extended to the general problem. VI. Homogeneous and isotropic bodies. "^ 42. Properties of elastic displacement fields. As we saw in Sect. 27, when the divergence and the curl of the body force field vanish, the displacement field u is biharmonic, while div u and curl u are harmonic. To prove this we tacitly assumed that u is of class C4. We now show that this somewhat stringent assumption is unnecessary; we will establish the above assertions under the assumption that u is of class C2. By an elastic displacement field corresponding to the body force field b we mean a class C2 vector field u on B that satisfies the displacement equation of equilibrium Au-\ Fdivu+ —6=0. 1 — Iv /1 We assume that Poisson's ratio v is not equal to f or 1, and that ^4= 0. £ (1) Analyticity of elastic displacement fields.1 Let u be an elastic displacement field corresponding to a smooth body force field b on B that satisfies divb=0, curlb = 0. Then u is analytic. Proof. 'The proof is based on the following notion, due to Sobolev2 and Friedrichs.3 A system of mollifiers is a one-parameter family of functions q8, 5>0, such that for each fixed <3: (i) qs is a C°° scalar field on V;4 (ii) j^Oonf; (iii) q8 (v) = 0 whenever |»| ^ d; (iv) / q8dv = \. ■r An example is furnished by \v\<6 with Ag chosen such that (iv) is satisfied. Let D be a regular region, and let f be a continuous scalar, vector, or tensor field on D. Then the system of mollified functions f, 3 > 0, is defined on $ by the transformation f{x) = fe>(x-y)f<u)dvw. D Clearly, (v) each f is a class C°° function on S. 1 Friedrichs [1947, 1}. See also Duffin [1956, 2], whose proof we give here. 2 [1935, 6], [1950, U}. 3 [1939,2], [1944,2], [1947, I]. 4 Recall that y"is the vector space associated with S. 9*
132 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 42. By (ii), (iii), and (iv), \f{x)-f{x)\ = \ J e*(x-y)[f(y)-f(x)]dvJ ^suV{\f(y)-f(x)\:ytZs(x)}, for sufficiently small d, where £a (a?) is the open ball withradius #3;nd centa_at x. Hence ——— N(vi) f -> f as d -> 0 uniformly on every closed subregion of D. Assume now that / is of class C1 on D and, for convenience, that / is scalar- valued. Let Ds={xeD:Ud{x)CD}. In view of the divergence theorem, Vmf (x) = fv*es(*-y)f(y)<iv«=-f W* es (» - »)] / to) <*% Z) D = -/ 0tf(*-0) /(») n(y) ^%+ / Qs{x-y) Vyf{y) dvy. 3D D But (iii) implies that os{x—y)=0 for x e Ds and ye 3D. Thus we have the following result: (vii) Vjfl={7fy on Ds. \ Of course, (vii) also holds when / is a vector or tensor field. We are now in a position to complete the proof of the theorem. Let u be an elastic displacement field; let D be a regular region with DcB; let qs (8> 0) be a system of mollifiers; let us and bs (8> 0) be the systems of mollified functions corresponding to u and 6: us(x) = / e'(x -y) u(y) dvy, D b8(x)=fe8(x-y)b(y)dv„. D Then, by (v), us and bs are of class C°°, and, by (vii), us is an elastic displacement field on Ds corresponding to bs. Further, bs is divergence-free and curl-free on Ds. Hence we conclude from the results of Sect. 27 (which hold in the present circumstances) that us is biharmonic. Next, let h=Au. Then (vii) implies that hs = (Au)s =A{us) on Ds. Therefore, since us is biharmonic, Ahs = 0 on Ds, and we conclude from (vi) that hs-+h uniformly on every closed subregion of D. The last two results and Harnack's convergence theorem (8.2) imply that h is harmonic. But Ah=AAu;
Sect. 43. The mean value theorem. \XX thus to prove that u is biharmonic we have only to show that u is of class C4. But since Au is equal to a harmonic function, (6.5) and f8.1) imply that u is of class C°° on Z). Therefore w is biharmonic and, by (8.1), analytic on D. But D was chosen arbitrarily. Thus u is analytic on B. □ In view of the results given in Sect. 27, we have the following immediate corollary of (1). (2) Properties of elastic states. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to a smooth body force field b on B that satisfies div6=0, curl 6=0. Then: (i) u, E, and S are biharmonic; (ii) div u, curl u, tr E, and tr S are harmonic. The next proposition will be of future use. (3) If u is an elastic displacement field corresponding to null body forces, then so also is u h = dw\dxh. Proof. Since u is an elastic displacement field, u is analytic; therefore 0 = (^ + tzW ?div ")* =A{u-k) + T~2v Fdiv(M-*) • Thus u>k is an elastic displacement field. □ Under-certain restrictions on the boundary of B, Fichera1 has established the following important result: If u is an elastic displacement field that is continuous on B and corresponds to zero body forces, then sup \u\^H sup \u\, Wv^i, M-^ B 8B where the constant H depends only upon v and the properties of dB. We omit the proof of this result, which is quite difficult. Fichera1 has also established the inequality J\s\da^Hf\b\dv, dB B where s is the surface_traction and 6 the body force field of a smooth elastic displacement field on B that vanishes on dB. ~~ 43. The mean value theorem.3 The mean value theorem for harmonic functions3 asserts that the value of a harmonic function at the center of a sphere is equal to the arithmetic mean of its values on the surface of the sphere. In this section we derivejimiiar.xesuitsJQr the displacement,,.gtrajn>.and stress iidds-belonging to an dastic state^Jn particular, we show that the values of these fields at the center of a sphere are. jqjial to certain weighted averages of the displacement..on the surface of the sphera We also establish a similar result for the stress field in terms of its surface tractions. 1 [1961, «]. See also Adlkr [1963, 11, [1964, J]. 2 Our presentation follows that of Diaz and Paynb [1958, 61. 3 See (l) of (8.3).
134 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 43. (1) Mean value theorem.1 Assume that the body is homogeneous and isotropic with shear modulus /j, and Poisson's ratio v, and assume that ' Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state^ corresponding to zero body forces. Then given any ballSe=Se\y)inB, ~~ "^ = 76^7/(2-3,)/^ (M " n) n + (1 ~4v) M} da' (1) E(y) 8jre3(7 - -r- — lOv / (u®n+n®u) da — iov) ./ + 7 / (m -n){5n(g)n — 1} da S(^ = T^77-7o7) -iO»j"(H®n+n®H)i« + / (u -n){35n(g)n— <xl}i« 0i'p 20V2 — 28v + 7 (2) (3) 1 —2v 3 ^ = -8^77+5^ /Oo^sfgmJ+yls-n^nfgin-l]}^, (4) s=Sn. Proof.2 Since the body forces vanish, the displacement equation of equilibrium has the form Au-\-y Fdivu = 0, (a) where y = - — . (b) ' 1— 2j> v ' Let r(x)=x—y, r = \r\, and notice that (c) n- on 3¾. Then (a), (b), (c), and the divergence theorem imply that 0 = J r*[Au +yFdiv «] rfi> = / 0a[C7") n + 7 (div u)n]da — 2f [(Vu) r +y (div u) r] rf». (d) dSp Up 1 Relation (l) is due to Aquaro [1950, 1], Eq. (13) and Synge [1950, 12], Eq. (2.36); see also Sbrana [1952,4], Mikhlin [1952, 2], pp. 206-207, Garibaldi [1957, 1» Diaz and Payne [1958, 6, 7], Bramble and Payne [1964, 4]. Relations (2) and (3) are due to Diaz and Payne [1958, 6], Eqs. (4.11), (4.16). Relation (4) is due to Synge [1950, 12]; see also Diaz and Payne [1958, 6], Eq. (5.21). Diaz and Payne [1958, 6], [1963, 3] and Bramble and Payne [1964, 4], [1965, 2] have obtained a number of mean value theorems giving the displacement and stress at the center of a sphere in terms of integrals over the surface of various combinations of normal and tangential displacements and tractions. A mean-value theorem for plane stress was given by Foppl [1953, 12]. 2 The proof given here is that of Diaz and Payne [1958, 6].
Sect. 43- The mean value theorem. 135 The surface integral in (d) is zero, since 0a/ [{Vu)n+y(divu)ri] da=g2 f [Au+yVdivu] dv=0. dZp If we use the divergence theorem on the remaining integral in (d), we conclude, with the aid of (c), that 6 I [u+y{u ■ n) n] da — / (3 -\-y) udv=0. (e) dZp Zp On the other hand, by (4) of the mean value theorem (8.3), zp dip J If we eliminate the integral of u over Ze between (e) and (f), and use (b), we arrive at the first relation in (1). Our next step is to derive (2). Since u is biharmonic, Vu is biharmonic, and we conclude from (4) of (8.3) that F«w = M5»fVuiv-i>fVuda]' {g) L Zx dZx where 0< A Sag. Using the divergence theorem, we can rewrite (g) as follows: Vu{y) = -^\l3 ju®nda-± j Vudc If we multiply this relation by A4 and integrate from A = 0 to A = q, we find that e* Vu(y) = ~-\$ fu®rdv- f r* Vu dv . (h) By the divergence theorem, J>3 Vudv =g3/M(g)n da — 2 j u®r dv, Xp dZp i'p and (g), (h), and the strain-displacement relation imply that e-E(y) = -|—|7 f (u®r+r®u) dv—g2 f (w (g) n + n (g) w) dc (i) (i) Next, we will eliminate the integral in (j) over Ue. By (42.3), uh, for each fixed k, satisfies the displacement equation of equilibrium. Thus (e) holds with u replaced by u>k, and we are led to the relation I Vudv = - I [\+yn®n]Vuda, z*. szx which can be written, with the aid of the divergence theorem, in the form / M®nd« = - — / [l+yn<gm] Vuda. )z*. dzx
136 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 43. If we multiply this relation by X, use the fact that n = r/X on 327,, and integrate from A =0 to X = q, we arrive at I u®r dv = — - [>3l+y r(g)r] Vudv. sP sp Applying the divergence theorem to the right side of (k), we are led to / u®rdv = - —(q2 I [u0n+y(u-n)n0n]da — / [2M®r+yr(g)M+y(r • m) 1] dv\. If we add this equation to its transpose and rearrange terms, the result is / (u®r +r(g>w) dv = -- — (g3 / [u®n+n®u + 2y(u-n)n®ri]da — 2yl J (r -u) dv ^ dZp zP Taking the trace of this equation, we obtain r ■ u dv = ~ u ■ n da, and the last two equations yield / (u®r + r®u) dv (k) J M(g)n+n(g)M + 2y(u-n)(n®n—^ l) azp 5+2y If we combine (j) and (1) and use (b), the result is (2). Since div u is harmonic, (2) of (8.3) implies that (1) da. div w(ty) =-—- / divudv= -—5- u • n da. vi" An q3 J An q3 J (m) The relation (3) follows from (2), (m), and the stress-strain relation in the form S = 2p E + --1^. (tr E) 1 = 2p B + -^- (div u) 1 Since [u, E, S] is an elastic state corresponding to zero body forces, the stress field S satisfies the equation of equilibrium divS=0 (n)
Sect. 43. The mean value theorem. and the compatibility equation1 AS+r]VF(tvS)=0, 1 where Jj: i+v 137 (0) (P) Further, by (42.2), S is biharmonic and tr S harmonic. Thus we may conclude from the mean value theorem (4) of (8.3) that By the divergence theorem and (n), fs(n®n) «*« = -* f S(n®r)da= £ fsdv, (q) M 8S*. 3¾ and (q), (r) imply that S(y) = ~^~ JS(n®n) da- Ij JSda dZx dZx If we multiply this equation by A4, integrate from A = 0 to A = g, and solve for S(y), the result is S(y)=-£^ jS(r®r) dv- fr*Sdv . On the other hand, the divergence theorem and (n) imply / g3S(n®n)da = f g*S(n®r)da = f r*S dv + 2 f S{r®r) dv; (s) dZ„ thus Further, since where it follows that S (y) = T_~ 5\7 j S (r ® r) dv - q* f S (n ® n) da L 2P dip S(n®n) = (Sn)®n = s®n, s = Sn, S(y)=-~eY\7f S(r®r) dv-g* js®nda (t) (u) To complete the proof we have only to transform the first integral in (u) into terms involving surface tractions. By the divergence theorem and (o), / [(PS) n +r) (Ftr S) ® n] da = 0, and using this indentity, (o), and two applications of the divergence theorem, we see that 0 = fr*[AS +r)PP(tr S)] dv = -2 J [{VS) r +rj(Ptr S) ®r] rf» = -2fA/ [S+J?(trS)n®n] rf«- / [3S+?y(tr S) 1] <*» 1 See p. 92.
138 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 44. Taking the trace of (r), we obtain JtrSdv= A f S ■ (n®ri) da, Si. dhx and the last two equations with (r) yield J[r2S+r](trS)r®r]da= f tfS(r®r) +r)(r ■ Sr) I] da. If we integrate this relation from A = 0 to A = q, we arrive at / 03 S +j;(tr S) r®r] dv = / [3 S(r <g) »•) +jj(r • Sr) 1] iw. A simple computation based on (n) and (0) shows that r ■ Sr is biharmonic; thus (4) of (8.3) implies e3 ■ I r • Sr dv= I 8 -n da. £p dSp By the last two relations, (s), and (t), 5 / S(r®r) dv=g3 / \s®n— v-(s -n) 1 da+rj f (trS)r®r dv. (v) In view of the identity and the symmetry of S, the volume integral in the right side of (v) takes the form / (tr S) r®rdv = Q3J(s-n)n®nda~f[S(r®r)+(r®r)S]dv. (w) Ep dSp i:p On the other hand, if we multiply (r) by A3 and integrate with respect to A from 0 to g, we arrive at fS(r®r)dv = /A/ SdvdX. (x) Sp 0 2*. Since S is symmetric, the left-hand side of (x) is symmetric. Thus the volume integral in the right side of (w) is equal to twice the volume integral in the left side of (v); hence (v) and (w) imply that I S(r®r) dv = -<[— \s®n+rj(n®n—l~l)(s-ri)da. (y) Sp dSp Eqs. (y), (u), and (p) yield the desired result (4). □ 4>J 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. In this section we study certain general solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium Au+ — - Vdivu+ 1 6=0 1-2j> fi assuming throughout that the body force 6, the shear modulus /j,, and Poisson's ratio v are prescribed with /j, 4= 0 and v 4= \, 1 • Recall that a solution u of c]a§5 C2 is referred to_as_.an elastic.displacement field corresponding to b.
Sect, 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. 139 (1) Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution.1 Let u=w- 7(-/.:^- F(P-V> + <P)> (pi)2 where y and xp are class C3 fields on B that satisfy AV = -[b, Acp^^p-b. (P2) 7¾½ m is an elastic displacement field corresponding to b. Proof. Clearly, A Au + Fdiv u 1 1 — 2l> =AV + -_1~FdivV- 4~-v) [/117^-^ + ^)+ -L-vVA{p-ip + cp) . Since AV=VA and zl(p -y) =p -A\p-\-2 divip, it follows that ^M+ ^, ^divu=-dv+ i:^-FdivV- 2(T^jv) F(p-dv +zl<p + 2divy). But p-/ly = —zlq? and zl tp = — -6; thus the above expression reduces to -f6. D 1 Elements of this solution appear in the work of Bqussineso, [1878, 1], [1885, !]■ In fact, the difference between the two solutions given by Boussinesq on p. 62 and p. 72 of [1885, 1] yields the special form to which (Pj) reduces in the case of rotational symmetry. The solution (Pj), (P2) with ¢) = 0 is due to Fontaneau [1890, 3], [1892, 3]. The complete solu- \ tion (Pj), (P2) first appears in the work; of Papkovitch [1932, 3, 4]; it jyas later rediscovered by <-A Neuber"'[19347!*]'. According to Papkovitch [1939, 4] (footnote on p. 136),(¾). (P2) should be attributed to Grodski, who arrived at the solution in 1928 (unpublished research), However, it is not clear from the statement of Papkovitch whether or not this work of Grodski includes the scalar field q>; in fact, Papkovitch [1937, 5] claimed that it does not. The complete solution (Pj), (P2) does appear in Grodski's [1935, 1] first published research on the subject. Other references concerning this and related solutions and not mentioned elsewhere in this section are: Boussinesq [1888, 1, 2]. Tedone [1904, 4], Serini [1919, 2], Burgatti [1923, 1], [1926, 1], Timpe [1924, 2], [1948, 6], [1950, 13], [1951, U], Weber [1925, 1], Trefftz [1928, 3], Margubrre [1933, 1], [1935, 3], [1955, H], Biezeno [1934, 1], Sobrero [1934, 6], [1935, 8], Neuber [1935, 4], [1937, 3], Westergaard [1935, 9], Zanaboni [1936, 6], Slobodyansky [1938, 3, 4], [1959, 15], Platrier [1941, 1], Gutman [1947, 3], Shapiro [1947, 7], Ter-Mkrtychan [1947, 8], Krutkov [1949, 5], Blokh [195o, 3], [1958, 2], [1961, 2], Sternberg, Eubanks, and Sadowski [1951, 9], Brdicka [1953, 6], [1957, 3], Churikov [1953, 7], Dzhanelidze [1953,91, Hu [1953, 13], [1954,5], Schaefer [1953, 18], Trenin [1953, 19], Eubanks and Sternberg [1954, 5], Kroner [1954, 11], Ling and Yang [1954, 13], Lur'e [1955, 10], Duffin [1956, 2], Solyanik-Krassa [1957. 13], Solomon [1957, 12], Deev [1958, 5], [1959,3], Hijab [1959, 7], Truesdell [1959. IS], Bramble and Payne [1961, 4], Naghdi and Hsu [1961, 16], Alexsandrov and Solovev [1962, 1], [1964,2], Gurtin [1962, 7], Tang and Sun [1963, 22], Volkov and Komissarova [1963, 25], Herrmank [1964, 9], Alexsandrov [1965,1], Stippes [1966, 25], [1967, 14], Solomon [1968, 12], deLaPenha and Childs [1969, 3], Youngdahl [1969, 9], 2 Recall that p (as) = as — 0.
-140 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 44. As a corollary of this theorem we have the following result. (2) Assume that the body force b is continuous on B and of class CN (N 2_ 2) on B. Then: (i) there exists an elastic displacement field u of class CN on B that corresponds to b; (ii) every elastic displacement field that corresponds to b is of class CN on B. Proof. Let »(#) = — —— / P(y)-b(y) , ^)=4^/- -^ B Then it is clear from the properties of the Newtonian potential (6.5) that <p and \p are of class CN+1 on B and satisfy (P2); thus the field u defined by (P_) is a class CN elastic displacement field corresponding to 6. To prove (ii) let u be an arbitrary elastic displacement field corresponding to 6. By (i) there exists a class CN elastic displacement field u that also corresponds to 6. Let u=u— u. It suffices to prove that u is of class CN. Clearly, ii is an elastic displacement field corresponding to zero body forces; thus, by (42.1), u is of class C°°. □ For the case in which the body-force is the_jgr^iejol.oLa43olejitml, i.e. 6 = Fa, it is possible to construct_jt.mucli_sim.plei- particular..-solution. Indeed, the field u = V<p satisfies the displacement equation of equilibrium provided In the same manner, if then is a solution provided __|m = _ a. T X + 2/J, 6=curlr, u = curl a A Am — T. By Helmholtz's theorem (6.7) we can always decompose the body force as follows: 6 = Fa + curlr. Thus, combining the previous two displacement fields, we arrive at the solution:1 u = Vq>-\-cur\ m, l l Aw = —i-,-r--a, dfl) = T. r A + 2/j, fi 1 Cf. Lam£ [1852, 2], p. 149; Bktti [1872, 1], § 5; Kelvin and Tait [1883, 1], p. 283; Voigt [1900, 5], pp. 417, 432, 439; Tedonk and Timpe [1907, 3],
Sect. 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. 141 This solution, in general, is not complete. Indeed, consider the case in which a = 0. Then div «=zl 99=0; thus, in this instance, the solution can represent at most divergence-free displacement fields. (3) Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution.1 Let u=Ag- 2(i1_y) Vdivg, (¾ where g is a class C4 vector field on B that satisfies AAg = -ifib. (G3) Then u is an elastic displacement field corresponding to b. Proof. Clearly, AuA Fdiv u ' \-2v VdivA g -^- VA div g . " 2(1— v) a\ Since A V—VA and div A =A div, the right-hand side of the above expression reduces to A A g, which by hypothesis is equal to Qu.rili5L^5EJ^A9..e.stab^sh the cpmpleteness of the Boussinesq-Papkoyitch- Neuber^and Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin representatiojis. The notion of completeness is 6T"utmost importance to applications. Indeed, it is concerned with the question: can any (solvable) problem be solved using a given representation; or, in other words, does every sufficiently smooth solution admit such a representation ? (4) Completeness of the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber and Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solutions.2 Let u be an elastic displacement field corresponding to b, and assume that u is continuous on B and of class C4 on B. Then there exists a field g of class C4 on B that satisfies (Gt), (G2); and fields <p, ip of class C2 on B that satisfy (PJ, (P3). Proof. We begin by establishing the completeness of the Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution. Clearly, (Gx) is equivalent to Ag+ 1^Fdivsr+~6 = 0, " 1 — 2v ft 1 This solution is due to Boussinesq [1885, T\, p. 281. It was later rediscovered by Somi- gliana [1889, 3], [1894, 3] and Galkrkin [1930, 2, 3], [1931, 3] and is usually referred to as Galkrkin's solution, although Tedonk and Timpe in their classic article [1907, 3], p. 155 attributed it to Boussinesq. See also Iacovachk [1949, 4], Ionescu [1954, 9], Moisil [1949, 6], [1950, 8], Ionescu-Cazimir [1950, 7], Westkrgaard [1952, 7], Brdicka [1954, 3], Bernikov [1966, 4], 2 Papkovitch [1932, 4] noticed that if a particular solution to the equation of equilibrium exists for arbitrary values of Poisson's ratio and arbitrary body forces, then the Boussinesq- Somigliana-Galerkin solution is complete. An alternative completeness proof for (Gj), (G2) was furnished by Noll [1957, 11]. The proof given here, which is based on Papkovitch's argument, is due to Stkrnberg and Gurtin [1962, 13]. =AAg-—^—-AVdivg+ -\ " 2(1 — v) ** ' \ — 2v
142 M.E. Gurxin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 44. where -flU, v=^—v. Thus the task of finding a class C4 field g that satisfies (Gj) is reducible to finding a class C4 particular solution to the displacement equation of equilibrium corresponding to given body forces that are continuous on B and of class C4 on B. This latter objective is met by (i) of (2). Further, using steps identical to those used in the proof of (3), it is easily verified that (Gx) implies Au-\ — Vdivu=AAq. Thus (Gx) and the displacement equation of equilibrium imply (G2), and we are entitled to conclude the completeness of the Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution (Gx), (G2). Next, following Mindlin,1 we define cp = 2divg— p-Ag, tp=Ag. Then <p and \p are of class C2 on B, and (G2) implies (P2), (Gx) implies (Px). Thus the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution is also complete. □ In cartesian coordinates the solutions (Px), (P2), and (Gx), (G2), as well as the formulae for the corresponding stresses, have the following form: Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution bt xj bt V<M = -~> <P,ii = ^T '*i = V* ~ Ji^vf fa" + *' Vi), i Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution gi.jjkk — — p °i __ 1 sa =f* \ii, jkk +gi, ikk + jzz^ (v&a Sk.h u — 8k,k i,) } • In most applications of elastostatics the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution deserves preference over the Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution.2 Indeed, the transformation (Px) underlying the former is one degree lower than that of (Gx); secondly, (in the absence of body forces) the stress functions involved in the former are harmonic, while those of the latter are biharmonic; and, finally, (Px), (P2) are conveniently transformed into general orthogonal curvilinear coordinates, whereas (Gx), (G2) give rise to exceedingly cumbersome forms when referred to curvilinear coordinates, with the exception of cylindrical coordinates. 1 [1936,2]. 2 Cf. Sternberg and Gurtin [1962, 73].
Sect. 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. 143 Two other complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium (with 6=0) are:1 w=t— „,„ > Va., 2(1 — v) Ja=divT, Jt=0; u=l— curl o), \-2v Aa)=curll, Al = 0. Returning to the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution, we_note that__a given equilibrium displacement field-does. not. .uniquely, determine its generating stressTfunctionlf y and ig. In fact, it is just this lack of uniqueness which, in cer- tain^OTctnnsrarices,' allows the elimination of y or one of the components of \p. Thejiext_the2r£m, which_is duetto Eubanks and Sternberg,2 deals with the possibility^ of setting <p = 0.3 (5) Elimination of the scalar potential.4' Let B be star-shaped with respect to the origin 0. Let u satisfy the hypotheses of (4) with 6=0. Further, suppose that —1 < v < \ with 4v not an integer. Then there exists a harmonic vector field \p on B such that Proof. By (4) and since 6=0, there exist harmonic fields <p and \p such that u=w- 4(11_y) F(p-v + y). Aip = 0, Aq>=0. Thus we must show that there exists a harmonic field \p that satisfies a.tp — V(p • ip) =a.ip — V(p -y> + (p), where «=4(l—i'). By hypothesis, we may confine a to the range 2<<x<8. (a) 1 The first solution, which is apparently due to Freiberger, [1949, 2, 3], is simply a variant of the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution; indeed, take T = y/, 2a = q>-\-p ■ >// in (Pj), (P2). The second solution is due to Horn [1915, 2], who used it t.ojrove existencefpr fhp-ffl5E!2£^-rn^"t prp^'""1. * [1956, 4]. Papkovitch [1932, 3, 4], through an erronoeus argument, was led to claim that q> may be taken equal to zero without loss in completeness, a claim which is reflected in the title of [1932, $}. In a subsequent note [1932, 2], Papkovitch refers to this argument as "artificial". Neuber [1937, 3] asserted that q> may be set equal to zero without impairing the generality of the solution. In his proof of this statement he takes for granted the existence of a function satisfying a pair of simultaneous partial differential equations. Therefore, as was pointed out by Sokolnikoff [1956, 72], p. 331, Neuber's argument is inconclusive. Slobodyansky [1954, 79] proved that the stress function q> may be eliminated, but as was observed by Sokolnikoff [1956,72], p. 331, Slobodyansky's proof is limited to a region interior or exterior to a sphere. 3 The solution (Pi), (P2) with q> = 0 appears in the work of Fontaneau [1890, 3], [1892, 3], and, according to Papkovitch [1937, 5], [1939, 4], p. 130, also in unpublished research of Grodski. 4 This result has been extended by Stippes [1969, 8] to an exterior domain whose complement is star-shaped, and to the region between two star-shaped surfaces.
144 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 44. It is sufficient to establish the existence of a harmonic field 0 such that1 pV0 — a.0 = <p. (b) Indeed, given such a field 0, the function \p=\p + V0 (c) has all of the desired properties. Let (r, 6, y) be spherical coordinates. The function q>, by hypothesis, is harmonic. Hence q> (r, 6, y) admits the following expansion in terms of solid spherical harmonics oo <p{r,Q,y) = ZSn{Q,y)r\ (d) »=o which is uniformly convergent in any spherical neighborhood of the origin. The functions S„ (6, y) are surface harmonics of degree n. Next, define a function F through [<x+l] F(T, 6, y) =<p(r, 6,y)-Z Sn(6, y) r», (e) »=o where [a +1] denotes the largest integer not exceeding a +1. Clearly, F is defined and harmonic on B. Further, by (d) and (e), r-«-ip (r> 0( y) _> 0 as r .+ o. (f) In spherical coordinates (b) has the form r"d'r ~a-0=(P' or by (e) g, [<x+l] ^|(r«$)=F+2S„A (g) Consider the function 0 defined by nr,e,y)=G{r,e,y)+Z^^ »=0 G{r,6,y)=r*jF(£, 6, y) I""-1 if • (h) Since B is star-shaped with respect to the origin 0, and in view of (a) and (f), the relations (h) define 0 on B. Moreover, 0 is of class C2 on B and satisfies (g), and hence (b). It remains to be shown that 0 is harmonic on B. To this end, it suffices to show that G is harmonic. In spherical coordinates the Laplacian operator appears as ^■HIKIm ZlH,=cosec 6 -go-(sin6 -r-A + cosec2 6 ■ -,. 1 Neuber [1937, 3] assumed, without proof, the existence of such a ¢, in the absence of any restrictions on B and v.
Sect. 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. 145 Clearly, r Ai,G=^JAlllF(i,d,r)ra-1di, (i) 0 and, with the aid of two successive integrations by parts applied to the second of (h), we reach the identity a(« + l)G = -(« + 1)f-r-^-+f-/ £[p^^jr-1**. (k) o Substitution of (k) in (j), and use of (i), now yield r*AG=r" f AF(£, 6, y) £---1 if. o But F is harmonic. Hence G and 0 are harmonic on B. □ (6)1 Zfeeorem (5) is false if the hypothesis that 4.v not be an integer is omitted /^. Proof. Suppose that 4v is an integer. Then the modulus a =4(1 — v) is also an integer with 2 < a < 8. Let B be a closed ball centered at 0, and let u be the elastic displacement field (corresponding to 6=0) defined by u = ~V<p, (a) where <p is the solid spherical harmonic V(r,e,y)=r«Sa(0,V). (b) Assume that (5) remains valid. Then there exists a field xp that is harmonic on B and satisfies »=V- I V(p-ip). (c) By (a) and (c), V(p-xp)—a.xp = Vq>, (d) and upon operating on (d) with the curl, we conclude that xp is irrotational. Since B is star-shaped and hence simply-connected, there exists an analytic field 0 on B such that xp = V0; thus we conclude from (d) that p- V0 — a<P = 9P + c1, (e) where cx is a constant. By (e) and (b), _£ (,,-«#) =r-iSaM+Ci. (f) The general solution of (f) is 0(r, 6, y)=raf(d,y)+ f(log r) Sa(6, y) + crr*+i. (g) There is no choice of f (6, y) that leaves 0 without a singularity at the origin. But 0 was required to be analytic on B. Hence (5) cannot be valid in the present circumstances. □ 1 Eubanks and Sternberg [1956, 4]. See also Slobodyansky [1954,79], Solomon [1961, 20]. Even though the potential q> cannot be eliminated when 4i> is an integer, Stippes [1969, 8] has shown that q> can be set equal to a solid spherical harmonic of degree 4(1 —v). Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 10
146 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 44. The next theorem, which is also due to Eubanks and Sternberg,1 deals with the possibility of eliminating one of the components of tp. (7) Elimination of a component of the vector potential. Assume that B satisfies hypotheses (i) and (iv) of (5.2) with M=2 and N—^. Let u be an elastic displacement field corresponding to 5=0, and assume that u is of class C4 on B. Then u admits the representation (P2) with <p and xp harmonic on B and y)3 = 0. Proof. By (4) there exist harmonic fields <p and xp such that where a=4(1— v). Thus we must establish the existence of harmonic fields <p and \p such that ccxp — V(p -tp + q)) — a.xp — V{p • ¢+^), (a) ¥-3=0. (b) It suffices to find a harmonic field H that satisfies2 H,3=y>s, (c) for then the functions \p = \p — VH, <p=<p-\-p-VH—aH will be harmonic and will satisfy (a) and (b). By tracing the_steps in the proof of (4), it is not difficult to verify that \p is of class C2 on B, since u is of class C4 on B. By (a) of (5.2) with M = 2 and iV = 3, there exists a scalar field J of class C2 on B and C3 on B such that /,3=^3- Then (4/)j3 =Zl^3=0, and there exists a continuous function h on B12 that is class C1 on B12 and satisfies ^J(x1,x2,xs)=h(x1,xi). (Recall that B12 = {(x1, x2): ace 5}.) By (6.6) there exists a class C2 scalar field K on B12 such that AK = -h. Thus if we define H on B through Ji(Xi, x2, xs) ==J(x1, x2, x3) -j-K(xlt x2), then H is harmonic and satisfies (c). □ Assume now that the body force 5 =0, and let ...ft Jbfi. a.giKen,.unit-KeGtoEr~If in the Boussinesq-SornlgTIaniPGalerEiirsolution we take 0=ft.r, 1 [1956,4). ' ~~' 2 Nbuber [1934, 4], without restricting B, assumes the existence of such a function.
Sect. 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. -147 then (Gx), (G2) reduces to Love's solution1 u = kA3£- ■-,-■— Vlk ■ VX), (LJ 2(1— v) v v J/l<r=0. (La) On the other hand, if we take ^) = fcyi in the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution (Px), (P2), we arrive at Boussi- nesq's solution:2 u = kxp+ 4{ii_v)-V((P+zf), (Bj) A<p = 0, Af = 0, (B2) where z = k ■ (x — 0) is the coordinate in the direction of k. Both of these solutions are extremely useful in applications involving torsionless rotational symmetry. It is clear from (LJ and (Bx) that these solutions can at most represent displacement fields that satisfy3 fc-curlu = 0. (C) The next theorem shows that under certain hypotheses on B, condition (C) is also sufficient for the completeness of the above solutions. (8) Completeness of Love's and Boussinesq's solutions.* Assume that B satisfies hypotheses (i)-(iv) of (5.2) with M=2 and N—$. Let u be an elastic displacement field corresponding to 6=0 that satisfies (C) with k — ez, and suppose that u is of class C2 on B. Then there exist scalar fields 3C, <p, and %p on B that satisfy (1^), (L2) and (Bj), (B2). Proof. By hypothesis and (42.1), u is of class C°° on B. Since k = es, (C) yields and we conclude from (5.2) with M=2 and N=S that there exists a scalar field t of class C2 on B and C5 on B such that ««=*,«• (a) The displacement equation of equilibrium can be written in the form Aua+yOia=0, (b) Aus+y6>s=0, (c) where 0=divu, (d) y=-—■ . (e) 1 [1927, 3], p. 276. Cf. Michell [1900, 4]. 2 [1885, -?], p. 62 and p. 72. 3 Noll [1957, 11]. 4 The portion of this theorem concerning Love's solution is due to Noll [1957, H], Theorem 2. Under the assumption of torsionless rotational symmetry, Love [1927, 3], pp. 274-276 established the completeness of (LJ, (L2); under the same assumption Eubanks and Sternberg [1956, 4] gave a completeness proof for (1¾). (B2) (see (9)). 10*
148 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 44. Before proceeding any further, recall that B12={(x1,xi):x^B}, B3={x3:xtB}. By (a) and (b), [Ar+yd]ta = 0; thus Ar+yd=X, (f) where X = X (x3) is a class C3 function on B3 that is continuous on B3. Now let q be a solution of it --*■ w and let x(%, x2, x3) =t(^, *2, ^3) +e(*3). (h) Then k is class C5 on 5 and class C2 on 5. By (h) and (a), «a=*,«. (i) and since it follows from (f), (g), and (h) that Ax+y6=0. (j) If we differentiate (j) with respect to x3 and subtract the result from (c), we arrive at A{u3-x>3)=0. (k) Next, by (d) and (i), 0 =M«,a + «3,3 —X,a<x + «3,3 =Ax + (U3 — X3)t3, (1) and (j) and (1) imply (i+y)Ax+y{u3-xt3):3=0. (m) In view of (5.2), there exists a solution 0* of <P*, = x (n) that is class Ca on 5 and C5 on B; thus (m) takes the form [(l+y)A$*+y{u3-xi3)]t3=0. (0) Since B is %-convex, (0) implies that g*=(i+y)A&*+y(u3-x_3) (p) is independent of x3. Moreover, g* is continuous on B12 and class C3 on B12. Thus, in view of the properties of the logarithmic potential (6.6), there exists a class C4 function g on B12 such that g,** = Y+J8*- (q) If we let 0 (%, *2, x3) = 0* (xx ,x2,x3)—g (¾, x2), (r) then 0 is of class C4 on 5 and (p), (q) imply (i+y)A 0+y {u3-x_ 3)=0. (s)
Sect. 44. Complete solutions of the displacement equation of equilibrium. 149 Moreover, (n) and (r) yield <P,8=*. W Finally, using (i), (s), and (t) u = uaea+uzez =x>aea+¾^ = Vx + (% —*,s) es = V0,3-^A0e3, and letting y we arrive, with the aid of (e), at (LJ. Since (Lj) and the displacement equation of equilibrium imply (L2), the completeness of Love's solution is established.1 If we now define2 (p =^1 J, 3 %£ -C33, %p = ./33, then (Bx), (B2) follow at once from (LJ, (L2). □ Let (r, y, z) be cylindrical coordinates with the z-axis parallel to k. We say that a displacement field u is torsionless and rotationally symmetric tcith respect to the z-adds if ut-=ur(r, z), uY = 0, uz — uz{r,z). It is not difficult to show that such displacement fields satisfy (C), and hence, by (8), admit the representation (BJ, (B2). An alternative proof of this assertion is furnished by the following theorem due to Eubanks and Sternberg.3 (9) Suppose that dB is a surface of revolution with the z-axis the axis of revolution. Let u bettor sionfess and~roiaiionally symmetric with respect to the z-axis and satisfy the hypotheses of (4) with 6 = 0. Then there exist scalar fields (p = <p(r, z) and y)=ip(r,z) on B such that (Bx), (B2) hold. Moreover, the functions q> and %p are single-valued and analytic on any simply-connected plane cross-section of B parallel to the z-axis. Proof. By (4) there exist harmonic fields q>' and tp' such that (Px) holds. Let t _ Sjh_ __ 8yt'r lr dr dz ' Jz r Sr V Wr) -t- r Sy -+- Sz ■ Then an elementary computation based on (Px) and the fact that \p' is harmonic and u torsionless and rotationally symmetric confirms that dz dr Thus there exists a field y> such that '' dr' lz dz' 1 The proof up to this point is due to Noll [1957, 11~}. 2 Cf. the last equation in the proof of (4). 3 [1956, 4].
150 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 45. In the same manner, let Then 8lr — 8& -Q "8*' 8f and there exists a field a> such that 9o> dm Now let q> =a>—ztp; then a trivial computation reveals that U=ky)+ V{q>+zxp). □ VII. The plane problem.1 45. The associated plane strain and generalized plane stress solutions. Throughout this section B is homogeneous and isotropic2 with Lame moduli jx and A. Let (x1, x2, #3) be a rectangular coordinate system with origin at 0, and let B be a (not necessarily circular) cylinder centered at J) with generators parallel to Fig. 11. 1 Most of this subchapter was taken from the unpublished lecture notes of E. Sternberg (1959). Extensive reviews of the subject are given by Teodorescu [1964, 22], and Musk- helishvili [1965, IS]. See also the eighth chapter (by Barenblatx, Kalandya, and Mand- zhavidze) of Muskhelishvili's book [1966, 17]. 2 The plane problem for anisotropic media is discussed by Fridman [1950, 5] and Kupradze [1963, 17, 18], Chap. VIII.
Sect. 45- The associated plane strain and generalized plane stress solutions. 151 the and with end faces at x3 = ± h (Fig. 11). Let £^ and S^ be complementary subsets of the set {xedB: x3^±h}. We assume that Sfx and £"2 are independent of x3 in the sense that £fx n £"2 consists at most of line segments parallel to the #3-axis and of length 2h. Given elastic constants fi and X, body forces 6 on B, surface displacements « on ^, and surface tractions s on y2, with 6, u,_a^d.s_mdeQeadstd...aLxa and paralleljto_the_j^,_^-J3lane, the plane problem of elastostatics consists in finding an elastic state [«, E, S] on B that corresponds to the body force field 6 and satisfies the boundary conditions: u — ii on &x, s=s on £fit s = 0 when x3 = ± h. Since the surface displacements, surface tractions, and body forces are all independent of x3 and parallel to the xx, #2-plane, one might expect that the dis- pl_acement_fidd_u_will.also have this property. With this in mind, we introduce the following definition. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state. Then [u, E, S] is a state of plane strain provided ~~^> », = »«fe.*i). w3 = 0. Here and in what follows Greek subscripts range over the integers (1,2). The above restriction, in conjunction with the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations, implies that E =E(x1, x%) and S =S(xlt x2). Further, ■^13 = -^83 = -^33 = 0. Saf) = 2[i Eafj + A.dafl Eyy, -^13 == ^23 =0, J33= Ahxx, and the equation of equilibrium takes the form S«/J,/J+*«=0- A simple calculation based on the above relations yields the important relation ■->33 =*''->aa> where v is Poisson's ratio: A Thus the complete system of field equations consists of •Sa/J=/M(«a,/J+«/J,a)+^^«y,y. supplemented by Si3 = S23=w3 = 0, sss=vSaa; (Pf) while the boundary conditions are ua=ua on ^, S^^n^s,,, on ^, (P2)
152 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 45. supplemented by Si3=S23 = S33 = 0 when xs = ±h. (P2*) Here ^ and ^2 are the intersections, respectively, of £^ and <S^2 with the xx, x2- plane. The system (P^, (P2) constitutes a two-dimensional boundary-value problem. This problem has a unique solution which we call the plane strain solution associated with the plane problem. As is clear from (P^) and (P*), this_,soluMgn actwd]^£di)&sAe~Mm&..prsthkoLQnly..wheiL-iu^Q. or Su +S22 = q. However, the plane strain solution is an actual solution of the modified problem that results if we replace (Pf) by the mixed-mixed boundary condition: S13 = S23 = % = 0 when xz = ±h. For future use, we note here that in terms of jx and v the two-dimensional stress-strain relation s*() = 2/« Eafi + A<5a/! Eyv can be inverted to give 2fiEafi=Safi—v8afiSYy. We turn next to the associated generalized plane stress solution,1 which characterizes the thickness averages of u, E, and S under the approximative assumption : S33 = 0. (A) Thus let \u, E, S~] (no longer assumed to be a state of plane strain) be_a_solution of the plane problem and assume that (A) holds. It follows from the symmetry inherent in the plane problem that Ua\Xl> X2> Xz) = Ua.\X\' X2> X3I' US\X1> X2> X3) = —%(%> X2> Xz) > for otherwise the displacement field u* defined by Ua (Xl> X2> X3I = Ua.\X\> X2' XZ) > US {Xli X2> X3) = — US\X1> X2> — XV would generate a second solution of the plane problem, a situation ruled out by the uniqueness theorem of elastostatics (at least when the elasticity tensor is positive definite). Given a function f on B, let f denote its thickness average: + h f{x1,x2)=—^ I f(x1,x2,xs)ax3. -h Since the thickness average of an #3-odd function is zero, and since the %-deriv- ative of an #3-even function is %-odd, it follows that u3 =h13 =ii23 = ii3 ='->23 = 0. Further, ^n=i(«M+"/i,«). S«p = 2/U Eafi +A.dal!{EYY+ £33), ^33 = 2/M £33 + ^ {Eyy + -E33) • 1 Thickness averages of solutions to the plane problem under the assumption that S33 vanish were first considered by Filon [1903, 2], who derived the results (a)-(c). See also Filon [1930, i] and Coker and Filon [1931, 2]. The term "generalized plane stress" is due to Love [1927, 3], § 94. The assumption S33 = 0 was studied by Michell [1900, 3].
Sect. 45. The associated plane strain and generalized plane stress solutions. 1 53 In view of (A), S33 = 0; thus the above relations imply that ^=/«(«a,P+«P,«)+^^"y,y. (a) where x=-j¥f-. v Further, the averaged equation of equilibrium takes the form Sap,p+K=o, (b) while the boundary conditions become ua=ua on ^, Safin^ = sa on ^. (c) The relations (a), (b), and (c) constitute a two dimensional boundary-value problem. Thisproblem has a unique solution called the generalized plane stress solution associatedwith th¥pJane"'pTo^IelnTlT6^~tirat"tHe relations (a), (b), and (c), which constitute~the generalized" plane"stress solution, are identical to the relations (Px) and (P2) of the plane strain solution provided we replace the Lame modulus X by It must be_emphasized_thal basic^Jo..the.d^xiv^ion^afJ^-is. the. approximative assumption that S33 vanish. The stress-strain relation for generalized plane stress is easily inverted; indeed, where - V v =•• 1+v is the ^ppropjc^^ZE9i?IoT^I3^9ZA9L,K§Pi§T3^zP'^. plane stress. Fig. 12 show? the graph of vjv as a function of v. 1.0 0J3 i*|* 0.8 0.7 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 Oi OS V Fig. 12. Let us agree to call the elastic constants fi and v positive definite if /n>0, -KKf.
154 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 46. This definition is motivated by (iv) of (24.5). Note that — Kv<i« — oo<v<£, (d) so that /u, v positive definite does not imply //,, v positive definite. Note, however, I that |The result (d) will be of importance when we discuss the uniqueness issue appro-!: - > priate to the generalized plane stress solution. '■', 46. Plane elastic states. In tlusjsection we study properties of the plane jBtrain solution associated with the plane problem under the assumption that B is homogeneous and isotropic with ^4=0, v=j=^, i)In addition, we assumejhroughout this section and the next that the body force$~ttfe zero. We write R for the intersection of B with the x1, #2-plane. Further, we let ^ and ^2 denote complementary regular subcurves1 of the boundary curve 8R and write na for the components of the outward unit normal to dR. In view of the discussion given in the previous section, to specify a state of plane strain or generalized plane stress it suffices to specify the plane components ua and Sap of the displacement and stress fields. This remark should motivate the following definition. We say that [ua, Sap] is a plane elastic state corresponding to the elastic constants /u and v if: (i) ua is continuous on E and smooth on R; (ii) Sap is continuous on R and smooth on R; (iii) ua and Sap satisfy the field equations ^0,0 = 0, Since every plane elastic state generates, with the aid of (P*) of Sect. 45, a (three-dimensional) state of plane strain, we have the following direct corollary of (42.1): (1) Let [ua, Sap] be a plane elastic state corresponding to the elastic constants fi and v. Then ua and Sa/8 are analytic on R. Each state of plane strain is an actual solution of the modified plane problem for which the boundary conditions at xs = ± h are replaced by the mixed-mixed conditions •^13 = ^23 = u3 = 0 when x3 = ± h. Therefore, as a consequence of the uniqueness theorem (40.1), we have the (2) Uniqueness theorem for the plane problem.2 Let [«„, SajS] and [ua, Sap] be plane elastic states corresponding to the same elastic constants \i and v, with fi and v positive definite, and let both states correspond to the same boundary data, i.e., ua=ua on &! and Sapnp=Sapnp on<<f2. 1 <Sl and ^2 are assumed to have properties strictly analogous to those of S\ and £^2 given on p. 14. 2 Trivially, this theorem is valid without change when the body forces do not vanish provided, of course, that both states correspond to the same body forces. A computation of the strain energy of a plane elastic state leads, at once, to the conclusion that uniqueness holds under tteJ^g.restri<^yg^:y£oj^esesi/*^p, v < i. In view of (d), this extension is important as"ft assures uniqueness when the plane states correspond to generalized plane stress solutions and when the elastic constants fi and? =v/(1+v) are such that fi andi> are positive definite.
Sect. 46. Plane elastic states. 155 2 Then 5<x/i=Sa,8 on R, and hence the two states are equal modulo a plane rigid displacement. The next theorem shows that for plane states the stress equations of compatibility take a particularly simple form. (3) Characterisation of the stress field. Let [ua, Sai8] be a plane elastic state corresponding to the elastic constants /u and v. Then Sa/8 satisfies the compatibility relation1 ASaa=0. (a Conversely, let Sai8 (=Spa) be of class C2 on R and smooth on R~, and suppose that Sap satisfies (a) and the equation of equilibrium 5./,./, = 0. (b) Assume, in addition, that R is simply-connected. Then there exists a field ua such that [ua t Sap] is a plane elastic state corresponding to //, and v. Proof. Let [ua, Sai8] be a plane elastic state. By (1) the strains Eap corresponding to ua are analytic; thus we conclude from (14.5) that Eap satisfies the compatibility relation 2^12,12 =-^11,22 +^22,11- (c) The stress-strain relation, in conjunction with (c), yields 2^12,12 =Sll, 22 + ^22,11 ~vA3aa, (d) while the equation of equilibrium implies ^12,12 = ^11,11) °12,12— °22,22> hence 2^12,12 = ^11,11 ^22,22- (e) Eqs. (d) and (e) imply (a). On the other hand, let Sai8 satisfy (a) and (b) and define Eap through the stress- strain relation. Then by reversing the above steps, it is a simple matter to verify that (c) holds. Thus (14.5) implies the existence of a class C2 displacement field ua that satisfies the strain-displacement relation, and we conclude from (14.4) that ua is continuous on E. Thus [ua, Sap] has all of the desired properties. □ Theorem (3) remains valid in the presence of body forces provided (a) and (b) are replaced by The next theorem asserts that the stresses corresponding to a solution, of the tractionfroblem are"independent of the elastic constants3 (provided the body is 1 Levy [1898, 7]. 2 Here A is the two-dimensional Laplacian: _82 32 dx\ dx\' 3 This assertion was first made by Levy [1898, 7~\. However, Levy did not require that R be simply-connected, and theoremjf4|Ja-laiaa.JL^?jrestaicMoa.i8_5anitted.._(cf. (47.5) and i (47.6)). The first correct statement is due to Michell [1900, 3], p. 109. Reference should , also be made to a remark by Maxwell [1870, 1], p. 161, who appears to anticipate Levy's claim, but I am unable to follow Maxwell's argument.
156 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 47. simply-connected). Much of the experimental work in photoelasticity.theory is based on this result. ~ (4) Levy's theorem. Assume that R is simply-connected. Let \ua, Sai8] and [ua,Sap} be plane elastic states corresponding to positive definite elastic constants fi, v and fx, v, respectively. Suppose, further, that Sa/8 and 5a/8 are smooth on R and Safi»fi=Safinfi on dR. Then Proof. Clearly, Sai8 satisfies (a) and (b) of (3). Thus there exists a field ua such that [«a,5ajS] is a plane elastic state corresponding to /j, and v. Therefore [ua, Sap] and [ua,Sap] correspond to the same elastic constants and the same surface forces. Thus we conclude from the uniqueness theorem (2) with ^=0 and <ra = dR that SaP =Safi on It. □ 47. Airy's solution. In this section some of the functions we study will be multi-valued. Therefore, for this section only, if a function is single-valued we will say so; if nothing is said the function is allowed to be multi-valued. Thus the assertion "<p is a function of class CN" means that "<p is a possibly multi-valued function of class CN". However, we will always assume that the displacement and stress fields corresponding to a plane elastic state are single-valued. We continue to assume that the body forces vanish. Then, as we saw in the previous section, a plane stress field is completely characterized by the following pair of field equations: Sa0,p=O, ASaa=0. The next theorem shows that these equations can be solved with the aid of a single biharmonic function. (1) Airy's solution. Let <p be a scalar field of class Cs on R, and let •->11 = <P,22< ^22 = 9^,11) S12— —<Pt12- (a) Then Sap.fi = 0. (b) Further, ^5aa=0 (c) if and only if <p is biharmonic.2 Conversely, let Sa/8 ( = Spa) be single-valued and of class CN (N~2z\) on R, and suppose that (b) holds. Then there exists a class CN+2 function <ponR that satisfies (a). Moreover, <p is single-valued if R is simply-connected. Proof. Clearly, (a) implies (b), while cp biharmonic is equivalent to (c). To prove the converse assertion assume that (b) holds. Then (•->ii),i = ( 512)2. ( ^12),1 = (^22),2- 1 This solution is due to Airy [1863, 1]. See also Fox and Southwell [1945, i], Schaeper [1956, 11], Teodorescu [1958, 19], [1963, 23], Strubecker [1962, 15], Schuler and Fosdick [1967, 13]. A generalization for the dynamic plane problem is given by Radok [1956, 10]. See also Sneddon [1952, 5], [1958,17], Sveklo [1961, 21]. 2 Maxwell [1870, 1] was the first to notice that <p is biharmonic. See also Voigt [1882, 1], Ibbetson [1886, 3], [1887, 2], pp. 358-359, Levy [1898, 7].
Sect. 47- Airy's solution. 157 and there exists class CN+1 functions g and h on R such that •->ii=g,2> ^12 — S, 1» S2a = hilt 512= »>2. (d) Hence g,i=A,a. and there exists a class 0^+2 function 97 such that g = <P,i> h = <P,i- (e) Eqs. (d) and (e) imply (a). □ Henceforth, by an Airy function we mean a (possibly multi-valued) bi- harmonic function <p on R with the property that the associated stresses ^11 == 9?, 2 2 > ^22 = ^,11) '->12== ^,12 are_single-va,Lued. For future use we note that these relations can be written in the concise form:1 where sai8 is the two-dimensional alternator. By (a) of (1), any two Airy functions <p and <p generating the same stresses differ by a linear function of position, i.e. (p{x)-q>(x)=kaxa+c, where ka and c are constants and x=(x1, x2). Conversely, we can always add a linear function of position to an Airy function without changing the associated stresses. Further, given a point y = [ylt y2) in R we can always choose the Unear function so that the resulting function <p satisfies 9^)=^(^)=0. The (two-dimensional) ffractjgn_problem\for a simply-connected region consists in finding stresses Sa/8 that satisfy the field equations Sa/U,=0, ^5aa=0, and the boundary condition Safinfi=sa on 8R, where the sa are the prescribed surface tractions. In view of the last theorem, this is equivalent to finding a scalar field <p such that AA<p^=0, e*ifyT<P,iTnp=s* on dR- Thus the traction problem reduces to finding a biharmonic function q> that satisfies the above boundary conditions. Our next theorem, which gives a physical interpretation of the Airy function, allows us to write the boundary condition for <p in a more familiar form. With a view toward a concise statement of this theorem, let r ^{x(a):0^a^a^ 1 Finzi [1956, 5].
158 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 47. ■ be a piecewise smooth curve in R parametrized by its arc length a, and let na ! and ta designate the normal and tangent unit vectors along r, i.e., ; where xa = dxjdo. (2) Physical interpretation of the Airy function.1 Let cp be an A iry function and write <p(a)=<p(x(a)), -8l (a)=(p,a{x(a))na{a) for the values if <p and its normal derivative along the curve r. Assume that 9>(0)=9>,«(0)=0. Then <p(a)=m{o), 2>)—'(*>. where , , ac m(°0 = I e*p[*«(<?') -xa(<?)] Sp{a') da', ^'' ^(,0, * (*) = k W / ** (<?') iff'. w *^T*^ 0 s<x (<r)=Safi(x{a))nfi(a). Proof. By hypothesis s«fi = Baliefir<piXr. (a) Thus, in view of the identity eaxeaT = dlr, (b) the surface force field sa = Sai8 ^ can be written in the form s<x =¾^ epx<piXT np = eaXcpjXtxr. In view of (b), <P, At x* — —EXrsr> and thus da(<P,x) = -eXlsr. (c) Therefore, since <p x{0) =0, <?>»=/», (d) where fxW) = -f BXrsT{a') da'. (e) o On the other hand, since cp (0) = 0, (p(a) = fcp(a') da' = f <p x{p') xx(a') da'. (f) o o If we integrate (f) by parts and use (d), we arrive at <p(<y)=hxx\ao-fh(o')xx(a')da'. o 1 Michell [1900,3], p. 107 was the first to notice that q> and dtpjdn are essentially determined by the surface forces along J1. The relations given here, which follow from a minor modification of Michell's results, are due to Trepftz [1928, 3]. See also Phillips [1934, 5], Sobrero [1935, 8], and Finzi [1956, 5].
Sect. 47. Airy's solution. 159 By (e), fx(0) = 0 and fx — — sXrsr; therefore a a <p(e) = -f xx{a) sXr sr(a') da' + J xx{a') eXr sr{a') da', o o or equivalently <p (a) — m (a). Next, by definition, dm and (d), (e), and (b) imply U («) = -^). D If <p is of class C2 on R, then the results of (2) hold even when F is contained in the boundary of R. If R is simply-connected, its boundary consists of a single closed curve; thus taking; r^d^jjo^^X-^^-^^J^L^?'^^^^^^^^^^^ reduees,-to finding a biharmonic function.<p that satisfies.the "standard" boundary conditions:1 <p = m and -„■ = — I on 32?, where m and I are completely determined by the prescribed surface tractions on dR. If cp and <p a do not vanish at #(0), we can still apply (2) to the Airy function y{x)=cp{x)~ka xa — c, with the constants ka and c chosen so that £(*(0))=£,«(*(0))=0. Thus, in this instance, the relations for <p and dyjdn should be replaced by q> = m+kaxa+c, If R is multiply-connected, its boundary dR is the union of a finite number of closed curves ^,¾. ■■■>^m- ^n this case it is not possible to adjust the Airy function (without changing the stresses) to make <p and cp a vanish at one point on each ^m. Thus relations of the form (*) will hold on each #m; of course, the constants will, in general, be different on each #m: <p=m+ti£xa + c» and |^-= —/ + &"»„ on <6m (m = i, 2, ..., M). In the above relations &„ and cm can be set equal to zero on one of the curves. ^m,' as we shall see, the remaining constants can be evaluated using the requirement that the displacements be single-valued. I With a view toward deriving a relation for the displacement field in terms of the Airy function, we now establish an important representation theorem for the Airy function in terms of a pair of analytic functions of the complex variable z = x1-}- i%z ■ 1 Michell [1900, 3], p. 108.
160 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 47- (3) Goursat's theorem.1 Let <p be biharmonic on R. Then there exist analytic complex functions ip and % on R such that2 <p{x±, x2) = Re{zip(z) +%(*)}, or equivalently, 2<p(Xl, x2)=zip{z) +z^) + %[z) +%{*)■ Conversely, if ip and % are analytic functions and cp is defined on R by the above relation, then cp is biharmonic on R. Proof.3 Assume that cp is biharmonic on R. Since A<p is harmonic, there exists an analytic function / such that A<p is the real part of /. Let ip be a solution of the equation dy) 1 and let a,=V' (a) ?=*(&+*■&). (b) where g1 and g2 are real. Then, since ga is harmonic, A(q> — iga*a)=Aip-U*,a- (C) By the Cauchy-Riemann equations, gl,l=g2,2. (d) and by (a) and (b), gi.i=A<Pl (e) thus (c) implies that A(9-ig.*J=0. (f) Let qi = <p-kgax«- (g) In view of (f), qr is harmonic and hence the real part of an analytic function %. This fact, (g), and (b) imply that <P(*i, %%) =Re{zy){z) +%{z)}. (h) Conversely, let cp be given by (h) with ip and % analytic. Then, by reversing the above steps, it is a simple matter to verify that cp is biharmonic. □ (4) Representation theorem for the displacement field.* Let [ua, Sai8] be a plane elastic state corresponding to the elastic constants /u and v (with ,«4=0). Further, let cp be an Airy function corresponding to Sap, and let 4f{z)=g1(x1,x2)+ig2{x1,x2), where ip is the analytic complex function established in (3) and ga is real. Then where wa is a plane rigid displacement. Conversely, let cp be an Airy function of class C2 on R, let Sa/8 be the associated stresses, and let ua, defined as above, besingle-yalued. Then [ua, Sap] is a plane elastic state corresponding to /x and v. 1 Goursat [1898, 6]. 2 Here Re{ } denotes the real part of the quantity { }, and a bar over a letter designates the complex conjugate. 3 This proof is due to Muskhelishvili [1919, i], [1954, 16], § 31. 4 Love [1927, 3], § 145- See also Clebsch [1862, 1], § 39-
Sect. 47. Airy's solution. 161 Proof. Using (a) of (1) we can write the displacement-stress relations in the form 2/x «M = — q>M + (i~v)A<p, 2/iu22 = — <p22 + (i—v)A<p, (a) Thus we conclude from (d) and (e) in the proof of (3) that 2p Mjj = — <prll + (1 -v) glfl, 2^^2,2 = -^,22 + (^ -^)^2,2.- hence 2/n*a = -(pia-\-(i~v)ga+2fiWa, (b) where ^1,1=^2,2=0. (c) Substituting (b) into the third of (a), we find, with the aid of the Cauchy-Riemann equation Si,z = £2, i> that ^1,2+^2,1=0. (d). By (c) and (d), wa is a plane rigid displacement; thus (b) is the desired representation for ux. To prove the converse assertion we simply reverse the steps (a)-(d). □ The next theorem yields conditions that must be satisfied by the Airy function in order to insure that the corresponding displacements be single-valued. (5) Theorem on single-valued displacements. Let R be multiply-connected, and suppose that M m=l where each ^m is a closed curve. Let <p be an Airy function of class C3 on R, and let u«=tV ^- ^«+(1 ~") g<*] +w«' where wa is rigid and ga is the function defined in (4). Then a necessary and sufficient condition thai the displacement field ua be single-valued on R is that <p satisfy the 3M —3 conditions:1 f /[ Tom 1 These relations are due to Michell [1900, 3], p. 108. Prager [1946,. £| proved that for_a 4SSMZ^~'R§5i24jCSgiPitilese.r|?i^!0fl5.are the natural boundary conditions of a variational principle for the Airy function. ~~HaSabubh aeirTHysiit, Bd. VIa/2."" 11
162 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 47. for m = 2, 3,..., M, where1 and Sa g is the stress field generated by q>. Proof. The field ua will be single-valued if and only if J^«do=0 (m = 2,l,...,M), or, in view of the definition of ua, if and only if /l^^^/^W^ ^ = 2'3 M)- (a) ^m 'Km It is a simple matter to verify that (c) in the proof of (2) is valid in the present circumstances in which <p and <pa do not necessarily vanish at some point on <&„. Thus (a) can be written in the form /-^ = -1¾^ ^ where here and in what follows m is assumed to have the range (2, }, ..., M). Clearly, *£=&*.i>h (c) on <Sm, where x(a)=(x1(a),x2(a)), O^a^a^ is the parametrization for <Sm. Now let P1 and P2 denote the real and imaginary parts of the complex function / established in the proof of (3): f(z)=P1(xl, x2) + iP2{x1, x2). By (a) and (b) in the proof of (3), thus gl,l=Pl> #2,1= A. gl,2 = "2» 82,2="l> and by (c) and (d) the relation (b) is equivalent to (d) f[Ptil + P1i9] da = -^^, Win J[P1i1-P^2]do = --1^vf, (e) ,m) 2 • Integrating the left-hand side of (e) by parts, we arrive at (f) 1 We assume that the parametrization of the ^m are such that na = eap ia coincides with the outward unit normal to 8R.
Sect. 47- Airy's solution. I63 It follows from the definition of the Airy function that P1=A<p is single-valued. Thus for (f) to hold it is sufficient that /l< f dp2 J da dP% dPx 'i~da +X2~da~ dP1 dP,] 1 da %2 da J do=0, 1— V da = --L~/j»> i—v (g) Indeed, the first of (g) asserts that P2 is single-valued, and the second and third of (g) are equivalent to (f) when both Px and P2 are single-valued. Next, by (d) and the definition of ux, ^2=-73^ K,2-«2,i-«]. (h) where co = w12—w2x is constant (since wa is rigid). To prove that (g) is also necessary for (f) to hold it suffices to show that P2 is single-valued whenever ua is single-valued. But this fact follows from (h).1 Finally, the Cauchy-Riemann equations and the relation na = ea/5 x^ imply that j ~ = °2,1 Xl + -^2,2 x2 = -^1,2% + -M.l x2 (i) =^.,-,+3.^=-^=-^(^). In view of (i) and since P1 = A<p, the relations (g) reduce to the desired 3M—3 conditions. □ The next result extends (46.4) to multiply-connected regions. It asserts that the stresses corresponding to a solution of the traction problem with null body forces are independent of the elastic constants if the resultant loading on each boundary curve vanishes. X(6) Michell's theorem.2 Let R be multiply-connected, and suppose that M dR={JVm, m=l where each ^m is a closed curve. Let [wa. Sa/3] and [wa,5a/3] be plane elastic states corresponding to positive definite elastic constants (i, v and jx, v, respectively, and assume that Sa/3 and 5a/5 are smooth on R. Then Safj=Sx/) on R provided both states correspond to the same surface tractions and the resultant force on each ^m vanishes, i.e., Sa/3M/3=Sa/3M/5 = sa on dR and Jsada=0 (m = i, 2,...,M). 1 Since ua is analytic, uaa is single-valued whenever ua has this property. 2 [1900, 3], p. 109. 11*
164 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 47- Proof. By (1) there exists an Airy function y generating 5a/3. Moreover, <p is of class C3 on R, since 5a/5 is smooth there. Since [wa, 5a/3] is a plane elastic state, we conclude from (4) that with K>a rigid. Moreover, since ua is single-valued, and since the resultant force on each ^, vanishes, it follows from (5) with /£"' =0 that (a) form = 2, 3, . 11^ j\Xl-ln{A<p) + x2^a{Acp) j\Xl-l(A<p)-x2-l-(A<p) da = 0, da = 0, da = 0, ., M. Now let K= i-l-V.ai+ii—v) &]• By (a) and (5), ua is single-valued, and hence the converse assertion in (4) implies that [ua, Sa/3] is a plane elastic state corresponding to /i and v. Therefore [ua, Sa/}] and [ua, Sa/5] correspond to the same elastic constants and the same surface forces. Thus we conclude from the uniqueness theorem (46.2) that 5a/; =3a/5 on K. □ (7) Kolosov's theorem.1 Let [ua, Sa/5] be a plane elastic state corresponding to the elastic constants fi and v. Then there exist complex analytic functions tp and % on R such that2 l u1(xi,x2)+iu2(x1,x2)= 2fi [0-4v)f(z)-Zf'(z)—yjzJ]+w(z), 5u(%. x2)+S22(x1, x2) =4Re{y (*)}, 5n(%. x2)-S22{xlt x2)+2iS12{x1, x2) = 2\zy>"(z) + %'(*)], where w is a complex rigid displacement. Conversely, let y> and % be complex analytic functions on R, and let ua and Sa/5 be defined by the above relations. In addition, assume that ua is single-valued and ua and Sap continuous on R. Then [ua, Sa/5] is an elastic state corresponding to fi andv. Proof. Let q> be an Airy function generated by Sa/5. By Goursat's theorem (3), there exist analytic complex functions f and % such that <p(¾, x2) = Re{i f (z) + x(*)}■ (a) A simple calculation shows that q>,i(x1,x2)+i<pt2(x1,x2)=tp{z)+z^)+YWJ. (b) 1 Kolosov [1909, 2], [1914, 2], [1935, 2]. A related complex representation theorem was established earlier by Filon [1903, 2]. See also Muskhelishvili [1932, 7], [1934, 3], [1954,26], § 32; Stevenson [1943, 2], [1945, ?]; Poritsky [1946, 3]; Sokolnikoff [1956, 22], Chap. 5; Solomon [1968, 22], Chap. 6, § 7. 2 Here y>' = dipjdz.
Sect. 48. Representation of elastic displacement fields. 165 Thus we conclude from (4) that the desired relation for ua holds. Further, by (a) of (1), Sn + iS12 = - t{q>A + *>>2)>2, (c) S22 — iS12=((pA + i(pf2)fl, and (b), (c) imply the desired results concerning Sa/5. Conversely, let y> and % be complex analytic functions on R, let ua and Sa/5 be defined by the relations in (7), and let <p be defined by (a) so that (b) holds. Then it is not difficult to verify that u satisfies the relation in (4), and that Sa/5 satisfies (c). Thus Sa/5 are the stresses associated with <p, and we conclude from the converse assertion in (4) that [ua, Sa/3] is an elastic state correspondign to /i and v. □ VIII. Exterior domains. 48. Representation of elastic displacement fields in a neighborhood of infinity. The conventional proofs of the fundamental theorems of elastostatics are confined in their validity to bounded domains. Of course, they can be trivially generalized to exterior domains provided one is willing to lay down sufficiently stringent restrictions on the behavior at infinity of the relevant fields, e.g., that the displacement be 0 (r'1) and the stress 0 (r~2) as r-±oo. However, such a priori assumptions are quite artificial: the rate at which these fields decay is an item of information that one would expect to infer from the solution, rather than a condition to be imposed on a solution in advance. In this section we shall establish representation theorems for elastostatic fields in the following neighborhood of infinity: ^(oo) = {x: r0< \x — 0| < oo}, where r0 > 0 is fixed. These representation theorems will be used in subsequent sections to infer the rate at which elastic states decay at infinity, and this, in turn, will be utilized to extend the fundamental theorems of elastostatics to exterior domains. We assume that the body B=Z(oo) is homogeneous and isotropic, and that the elasticity tensor is positive definite; thus the Lame moduli satisfy fi>0, 2(iJr'iX>0. (1) Representation theorem.1 Let u be an elastic displacement field on .S(oo) corresponding to zero body forces. Then u admits the representation oo oo u=2 0<*> + r«2 *w. (a) k=—oo k = — oo where </<*> and h^ are vector solid spherical harmonics of degree k, and Both of the series in (a), as well as the series resulting from any finite number of termwise differentiations, are uniformly convergent on every closed subregion ofZ(oo). Proof. First of all, it is not difficult to verify that the denominator in (b) cannot vanish, since the elasticity tensor is positive definite. 1 Kelvin [1863, 3]. See also Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11~\, Theorem 1.2. A generalization of this result to anisotropic bodies is given by Bezier [1967, 3].
166 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 48. In view of (42.2), u is biharmonic on Z(oo). Theorem (8.5) therefore assures the existence of an expansion of the form (a) which has the asserted convergence properties. This leaves only (b) to be confirmed. A simple computation shows that A {r* *W) = 4 (VhW) p + 6fc<*>, and thus the identity (p%(*>)p = ftft<*>, (c) which is valid for any vector solid harmonic hw, implies A(r2hW) = 2(2k + 3)hW. Hence Au = 2 2 (2* + 3)Aw. (d) A=— 00 Next, by hypothesis and by (42.2), divZlM=0, curl Au = Q; thus (d) implies 00 00 2 (2£ + 3)divfc<*>=0, 2 (2& + 3)curlfc<*>=0. (e) k=— 00 A=— 00 But divfc'*' is a solid harmonic of degree k — i. Hence the first of (e), by virtue of the uniqueness of the expansion in (8.5), implies divfc<*> = 0. (f) Similarly, curlfc(*> = 0, or equivalently, |7fcW = [|7fc(*)]r. (g) Consequently, (a), (c), (f), and (g) imply 00 Vdivu= 2 [Vdivgw+2(k + i)hm]. (h) k=—00 By hypothesis, /jtAu+(X + /j,)Fdivu=Q, (i) and substitution of (d) and (h) in (i) yields 00 2 {2[(A + l)(A + 3/«)+/«]^)+(A + ia)Fdiv9W} = 0, which implies the desired result (b). □ The next theorem gives a particular solution of the equations of elastostatics in a neighborhood of infinity. (2)1 Let b be a smooth vector field on -S(oo), and assume that div6=0, curl 6=0. 1 Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11], Theorem 4.3.
Sect. 49- Behavior of elastic states at infinity. 167 Then: (i) 6 admits the representation 00 6=2 &w, A=— 00 where the b(*' are divergence-free and curl-free vector solid spherical harmonics of degree k, and this infinite series, as well as the series resulting from any finite number of termwise differentiations, is uniformly convergent in every closed subregion of 2 (00); (ii) the same convergence properties apply to the series tt=-— y 1 b<*> 2^^ + 1)(/1 + 3^)+^ and the field u so defined is an elastic displacement field on ^(00) corresponding to the body force field b; (iii) for any integer n, b(x) = o(r") as r-±00, implies u(x) = 0(rn+1) as r-*-oo. Proof. By (8.6) b is harmonic. Thus (8.4) implies part (i) of this theorem. The uniform convergence of the series of (ii), and of the corresponding series resulting from successive differentiations, is apparent from the convergence properties of the series in (i). Thus u is of class C°° on -S(oo). That u satisfies the displacement equation of equilibrium may be verified by direct substitution. This establishes (ii). To justify (iii) we note from (i) and (8.4) that b(x) =o(rn) implies bm(x) =0 for k^n. Bearing in mind (ii) and appealing once more to (8.4), we see that (iii) holds true. □ 49. Behavior of elastic states at infinity. We now use the representation theorems developed in the preceding section to determine the behavior of elastic fields at infinity. We continue to assume that B =Z(oo) is homogeneous and isotropic and that the Lame moduli obey the inequalities fi>0, 2/i + }h>0. In addition, we assume that the body force field 6 is smooth on .2 (00), and that div 6 = 0, curlb=0. (1) Behavior of elastic states with vanishing displacements at infinity.1 Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state on £(00) corresponding to b, and assume that u(x)=o(\) t-> as r->oo. Then u{x)=0{r-i), S(x)=0(r-*), E (x) = 0 (r~2), b(x) = 0 (r~3) as r-^00. 1 Fichera [1950, 4]. See also Gurtin and Sternberg [1961,11], Theorem 5.1. Kupradze [1963,27,25], §111.3 established the estimate M=0(>-"1), but only with the additional assumption that dujdr = 0 (y-1). Note that if u = 0 (1), then div u and curl u are both 0(r~2), a conclusion which Duffin and Noll [1958, 8] reached by entirely different means.
168 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 49. Proof. By (42.2) u is biharmonic on £(00). If we apply (8.5) to u, we conclude that u=0(r'1). The remaining assertions then follow immediately from (iii) of (8.5) in conjunction with the strain-displacement relation, the stress- strain relation, and the equation of equilibrium. □ (2) Behavior of elastic states with vanishing stresses at infinity.1 Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state on 27 (00) corresponding to b, and assume that S(x) = o(i), b{x) = o{r-*) as r -^00. Then u(x)=w(x)+0(r~1), S(x) = 0(r-Z), E(x)=0(r-2), b(x)=0(r-3) as r->oo, where w is a rigid displacement field. Proof. In view of the assumed properties of 6, we infer from (48.2) the existence of a particular solution u of the displacement equation of equilibrium that is class C2 on I, (00) and satisfies u =0(r-1). Accordingly, by (1), the elastic state associated with u (i.e., generated by the strain-displacement and stress- strain relations) satisfies E=0(r'2) and S=0(r~2), while b must conform to b—0(r'3). We are thus able to exhibit a particular elastic state corresponding to 6 which possesses the requisite orders of magnitude at infinity. Therefore, since the fundamental system of field equations satisfied by elastic states is linear, it remains to be demonstrated that (2) is true when b = 0. Suppose now that 6=0. Then, by hypothesis and by (48.1), u admits the representation u = u-\-u, where 00 00 tt=I</<*>+>"2 2 Aw, k=— 00 k=~ 00 and where the solid harmonics g^k\ h^ obey (b) of (48.1) Next, define fields E and E through E = ${Vu+FuT), E = i(Vu+FuT), so that E = E + E. The two infinite series entering the second of (a) each represent a harmonic field on -S(oo). The second of (b) and part (iii) of (8.5) therefore imply £ = 0(7--1). B = 0(r"2), (d) while we conclude from the stress-strain relation that S = 0(r-*). Consequently, all we have left to show is that u is rigid; or equivalently that E = 0. (e) (b) \ (c) 1 Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11], Theorem 5.2.
Sect. SO. Extension of the basic theorems. 169 To this end we conclude from (b) in (48.1) that divfc<*> = 0, and hence reach, with the aid of (a) and (b) above, o oo oo trB=2divg'*»+2 2 P'*(*'. (f) where p(x) =x — Q. Next, since div</(*+2) is a solid harmonic of degree k + i, p • Fdivsr<*+2> = (k + l) divg<*+2>, (g) and since gm is a constant, VgW=0. (h) Thus if we eliminate fc'*' from (f), by recourse to (b) of (48.1), and use (g) and (h), we arrive at trE=y ?<2*-1>~_divoW (i) By hypothesis, /S =o(l); thus the stress-strain relation implies E = o(l), and we conclude from (c) and the second of (d) that E = o(\). (j) Thus if we apply (8.4) to the harmonic function tr E given by (i), bearing in mind that div </<*' is a solid harmonic of degree k — 1, we find that divg(*' = 0 for k>\, which, together with (b) of (48.1) and (h), yields fc<*> = 0 for k^ — 2. (k) Inserting (k) in the first of (a), and using (h) and the first of (b), we obtain E = zvgm. (1) Since Vg'*' is a solid harmonic of degree k — 1, we conclude from part (iii) of (8.4) that (1) is consistent with (j) only if (e) holds. □ 50. Extension of the basic theorems in elastostatics to exterior domains. We now use the results established in the last section to extend the basic theorems of elastostatics to exterior domains. Thus for this section we drop the requirement that B be bounded and assume instead that B is an exterior domain. We shall continue to assume that B is homogeneous and isotropic with Lame moduli fi and A. Let 6= [u, E, S] be an elastic state on B corresponding to the body force field 6, and suppose that the limits /= lim / sda, Q-+CO iSp m-- lim / pxsda e-*°o dSp
170 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 50. exist, where s=Sn, n is the outward unit normal to dXe, and Ee is the ball of radius q and center at 0. Then we call / and m the associated force and moment at infinity. Since S and b satisfy balance of forces and moments in every part of B, fsda-irJbdv = — f s da, SB B„ d£p f pxsda+ f pxbdv = — f pxsda, SB B„ d£p for sufficiently large q, where BQ = BnZe} Thus, letting g-^-oo, we see that / and m exist if and only if the integrals fbdv, fpxbdv B B exist, in which case /= — J sda— J b dv, 3B B m = — Jpxsda— f pxb dv. dB B (1) Extension of Betti's reciprocal theorem.2 Assume that the Lame moduli obey /i>0, 2/i + 3A>0. Let [u, E, S] and [u, E, S] be elastic states corresponding to the external force systems [b, s] and [b, s], respectively, with b and b divergence-free and curl-free and of class C2 on B. Further, assume that the associated forces f, f and the associated moments m, rh at infinity exist. Finally, assume that u(x) = w(x) + o(l), \ u(x) = w(x) + o(l), as r-^-oo, where w and w are the rigid displacements: w = uao + (oaoxp, w = u00 + co00xp. Then fs-uda+ f b-udv + f-u^ + m-cox dB B = J s-uda+ J b -udv + f-u^ -f-m • (ox = JS-Edv=JS-Edv. dB B B B Proof. Applying Betti's theorem (30.1) to the region BQ=BnZt, with q large enough so that dBCZe, we find that / s • uda-\- f b • udv~\- J s- uda SB B„ SS„ , . ~ ~ (a) = Js-uda + Jb-udv-{-Js-uda=JS-Edv = JS-Edv. SB B„ SXP B„ B„ Clearly, / s • u da = / s • (it — w) da + / s • wda (b) ssp ss„ ss„ 1 Note that 8Be = dB \jdSe for q sufficiently large, since B is an exterior domain. 2 This result for the case in which w —w = 0 is due to Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11], Theorem 6.1.
Sect. 50. Extension of the basic theorems. 171 and / s-wda= f s- (un + co^xp)da = uai • f sda + co^- f pxsda. (c) By hypothesis and by (49.1), u = w + 0(r'1), u = w + 0 (r"1), E = 0{r-*), S = 0(r~2), b = 0{r~s), (d) E = 0(r~2), S = 0(r~2), b = 0{r~3). Thus (b) and (c) imply fs-uda^f-u^+m-con (e) as g-s-oo. Similarly, / suda^fux+ma>x (f) as q-^-oo. The estimates (d) also imply that the volume integrals over Be in (a) are convergent as q-^-oo and tend to the corresponding integrals over B. Thus if we let g-^-oo in (a) and use (e) and (f), we arrive at the desired conclusion. □ As a direct corollary of this result we have the (2) Theorem of work and energy for exterior domains.1 Let [u, E, S], [b, s], f, m, as well as /j, and A obey the same hypotheses as in (1). Then f s-uda + f b-udv + /•tt00+m-oa) = 2UC{E}. dB B This relation differs from the corresponding result for finite regions by the addition of the term fu^ + m • co^, which represents the work done by the force and moment at infinity. (3) Uniqueness theorem for exterior domains.2 Assume that fi>0, 2j«+3A>0. Let 4 = [u, E, S] and ~i = [u, E, S] be elastic states corresponding to the same body force field and the same boundary data in the sense that u = u on Sfx, s = s on £f2. (a) Further, assume that either u(x) = u{x)-\-o{\) as r-^oo, (b) or both S(x)=S(x)+o(\) as r-^oo (c) and the corresponding traction fields are statically equivalent on dB, i.e. J sda = f sda, J pxsda— J pxsda. (d)3 dB dB 8B dB Then o and 1 are equal modulo a rigid displacement. 1 Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11], Theorem 6.2, for the case in which ic = 0. 2 Fichera [1950,4], Theorems II, V, and VI for case(b); Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 11] for case (c). See also Duffin and Noll [1958, 8] and Bezier [1967, 3]. Analogous uniqueness theorems for two-dimensional elastostatics are given by Tiffen [1952, 6] and Muskhelishvili [1954, 16], § 40. 3 Note that this condition is satisfied automatically when B is finite.
172 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 50. Proof. Let <j'= <j— 3. It suffices to prove that E' = 0. (e) Clearly, o' is an elastic state corresponding to zero body forces and vanishing boundary data. Assume (b) holds. Then u'{x) = o{\) as r-+oo, and (2) (with u'^ = to'^ = 0) yields W} = o, (f) which implies (e). Next assume (c) and (d) hold. Then S' (a5) = o(l) as r->oo, and we conclude from (49.2) that u' (x) — w (x) + 0 (r'1) as r->oo with w rigid. Further, by (d), /'=— fs'da = 0, m' = - fpxs'da = 0, dB dB and (2) again implies (f) and hence (e). □ It should be noted that (3) is valid only for unbounded regions with > finite boundaries. The uniqueness question associated with problems for general domains whose boundaries extend to infinity is yet to be disposed of satisfactorily.1 We emphasize that theorem (3), in contrast to (1) and (2), involves no > explicit restrictions concerning the body force field. If this field is integrable ' . over B, then (d) can be replaced by the requirement that the forces and moments at infinity coincide: f=_f, m = m. For the surface force problem, (d) may be omitted because it is implied by (a). On the other hand, if £^ is not empty, (d) is an independent hypothesis. This hypothesis, which requires the prescription of the resultant force and moment on dB (or equivalently, the force and moment at infinity), appears at first sight artificial, since the surface forces over at least a portion of the boundary are not known beforehand. One is therefore led to ask whether (d) is necessary for the truth of (3) when the regularity conditions are taken in the form (c). That this is indeed the case is clear from the next theorem. (4) Theorem (3) is false if either of the two hypotheses in (d) is omitted. Proof. For the purpose at hand, let B={a;:|a5-0|>1}, and assume that 8B =Sfx (6^ = 0) in (3)- It clearly suffices to exhibit two elastic states, both corresponding to zero body forces, both having strains not identically zero, both satisfying m=0 on dB, (a) S = o{\) as r->oo, (b) 1 For the special case of the displacement and surface force problems appropriate to the half-space, this question was settled by Turteltaub and Sternberg [1967, IS]. See also Knops [1965, IS].
Sect. 51- Basic singular solutions. 173 with one state obeying f sda = 0, (c) dB the other f pxsda=0. (d) dB To this end, let ^, =(=0 and to4= 0 be given vectors and consider the following two displacement fields :1 « (-) = ^ + V(^ ™*(~^) " » ^ ® Both of these displacement fields generate elastic states that correspond to zero body forces and obey (a), (b). Moreover, for (e): f= I sda = 24n/t--^- X+0, m= I pxsda = 0; dB dB while for (f): /=0, m = 87tfi(o. □ The leading two terms in (e) represent the displacement induced in the medium by a rigid translation A applied to the spherical boundary dB, the body being constrained against displacements at infinity; the last term in (e) corresponds to a rigid translation —A of the entire medium. On the other hand, the leading two terms in (f) represent the displacement generated by a rotation co of dB, while the last term corresponds to a rotation of the entire medium. IX. Basic singular solutions. Concentrated loads. Green's functions. 51. Basic singular solutions. In this section we study the basic singular solutions of elastostatics, assuming throughout that the body is homogeneous and isotropic, and that /* 4= 0, v 4= $» 1 • We begin with the Kelvin problem,2 which is concerned with a concentrated load applied at a point of a body occupying the entire space S. With a view toward giving a solution of this problem, we introduce the following notation. Throughout this section y is a fixed point of S, r = x — y is the position vector from y, and r= \r\. Further, we write 21, for the open ball Ev (y) with radius r\ centered at y. 1 Gurtin and Sternberg [1961,11] attribute these examples to R. T. Shield. 2 The solution to this problem was first given by Kelvin [1848, 3] (cf. Somigliana [1885, 4], Boussinesq [1885, !])• It was derived by Kelvin and Tait [1883, 1], §§ 730, 731 through a limit process that was made explicit by Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13] (cf. Love [1927, 3], § 130; Mindlin [1936, 1], [1953, 15]). The limit formulation presented here follows closely that adopted by Sternberg and Al-Khozai [1964, 20] and Turteltaub and Sternberg [1968, 14]. The solution for an anisotropic but homogeneous body was given by Fredholm [1900, 2]. A precise statement of Fredholm's result is contained in the work of SAenz [1953, 17]. See also Zeilon [1911, 1], Carrier [1944, 1], Lifshic and Rozencveig [1947, 4], Elliot [1948, 2], Synge [1957, 15], Kroner [1953, 14], Basheleishvili [1957, 1], Murtazaev [1962, 12], Bezier [1967, 3], Bross [1968, 1], Cakala, DomaiJski, and Milicer- Gruzewska [1968, 2].
174 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 51- By a sequence of body force fields tending to a concentrated load laty we mean a sequence {bm} of class C2 vector fields on $ with the following properties : (i) 6OT = 0on«f-i;i/OT; (ii) / bmdv-+l as m->oo; s (iii) the sequence |/|6m|<fw| is bounded. 8 (1) Limit definition of the solution to Kelvin's problem.1 Let {bm} be a sequence of body force fields tending to a concentrated load I at y. Then: (i) For each m there exists a unique elastic state 6m on $ that corresponds to the body force bm and has uniformly vanishing displacements at infinity. (ii) The sequence {6m} converges (uniformly on closed subsets ofS—{y}) to an elastic state 6y [I] onS' — {y}. (iii) The limit state 6y [I] is independent of the sequence {bm} tending to I and is generated by the displacement field uy[l] with values uw[l}{x) = -^- -^- + (3-4^)1 I, c= i6n/j,(l — v). We call 6y [I] the Kelvin state corresponding to a concentrated load I at y. Proof. Let um be defined by Um=Wm--^i_-}V{<PmJrr-Wm), \ where Then, by (6.5) and (44.1), um is an equilibrium displacement field corresponding to bm. Moreover, it is easy to verify that um(x) = o(i) as \x — 0|-*-oo, and, by the uniqueness theorem (50.3) for exterior domains, there is no other equihbrium displacement field corresponding to bm with this property. This establishes (i). Next, a simple calculation shows that the functions defined on ^-{«/} by <p(x) = 0, y>(x) = 1^3^-. (b) generate, in the sense of the Boussinesq-Papkovitch-Neuber solution (44.1), the displacement field uy[l] given in (iii). Thus to complete the proof we have only to show that given any closed region R in ^~{y}, 4m-+4y[l] uniformly on E; or equivalently, that q>m-*-<p and y>m-+ip uniformly on E, and that the first and second gradients of <pm and \pm tend to the corresponding gradients of cp and \p uniformly on R. Since the argument in each instance is strictly analogous, we shall merely prove that \pm-+\p. 1 Sternberg and Eubanks [1955.^3], Theorem 4.2. An analogous theorem for concentrated surface loads was given by Turteltaub and Sternberg [1968, lt\.
Sect. 51. Basic singular solutions. 175 Let R be a closed subset of S— {y}. Then there exists an m0 > 0 such that hence -£i/». n R = ! for xc-R and is finite. Thus F-01 :W„ (c) ^ = ^1^-5)= ^^ F~» i*-*r 3c-g|-|ac-y Kmn for ase.fi!, ^eZ1/m, and w>w0. Next, by (a) and (b), |lP«.(»)-1P(»)| = |« ""-Jflla'-fl I, $bmdv-l (d) izj* l/m 1 as —i/ consequently, (c) and (d) imply 1P»(*)-»(*)I ^- „—/|ft«.|<*" + «oH| $Kdv-l •^llm ^llm for a? 6 R and m>m0. This inequality, when combined with (ii) and (iii) in the definition of a sequence ot body force fields tending to a concentrated load, implies %pm-*%p uniformly on R. □ The need for condition (iii) in the definition of a sequence of body force fields tending to a concentrated load was established by Sternberg and Eubanks,1 who showed by means of a counterexample that conclusions (ii) and (iii) in (1) become invalid if this hypothesis is omitted. We will consistently write ^[l] = [uu[llEy[l},Sy[l]] for the Kelvin state corresponding to a concentrated load I at y. Clearly, the mapping l>-+ oy[l] is linear on V. In view of the stress-strain and strain-displacement relations, the stress field Sy[l] has the form Sw[t](») = ~%{}}!Ll£^r + (l-2v)[r® 1+ I®r- (r • I) 1]}. Let S* [I] be the unique tensor field with the property that Sw[v]l = S*[Z]Tv for every vector v, and let on 8B. We call Sy [I] the adjoint stress field and sy [I] the adjoint traction field corresponding to oy[l]. A simple calculation shows that w=-;p^; Note that Sy [I] is not symmetric. 1 [1955, 13], Theorem 4.3- + (1 — 2v) [I® r - r® I + (r ■ I) 1]|.
176 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 51. (2) Properties of the Kelvin state.1 The Kelvin state 6y [I] has the following properties: (i) 6y [l] is an elastic state on $— {y} corresponding to zero body forces. (ii) uy [I] (a?) = 0 (r'1) and Sy [I] (as) = 0 (r'2) as r->0 and also as r-+oo. (iii) For all r]>0, f sy[l]da = l, frxsy[l]da = 0, »■£„ as, where on 8ZV with n the inward unit normal. (iv) For every vector v, l ■ Uy[V] = V Uy[l] , l-Sy[V]=VS*[l], where sy [v] is the traction field on dB corresponding to <sy [v] and Sy [I] is the adjoint traction field on 8B corresponding to 4y[l]. Proof. Property (i) follows from (44.1) and the fact that the stress functions <p and \p defined in (b) of the proof of (1) are harmonic on ^-{y}. Properties (ii) and the first of (iv) are established by inspection of the fields uy[l] and Sy[l]. Property (iii) can be established by a direct computation based on the form of Sy[l]. An alternative proof proceeds as follows. Let {<jm} and {bm} be as in (1). Then balance of forces and moments imply that -/ smda+ f bmdv = 0, - f rxsmda + f rxbmdv = 0, where sm is the traction field on that side of dZn facing the point y. If we let m->oo in the above relations and use (ii) of (1) and properties (i)—(iii) of {bm}, we arrive at the desired relations in (iii). Finally, to establish the second of (iv) note that, by the symmetry of Sy[l] together with the definitions of Sy [I] and s^ [I], I ■ sy[v] = I • (Sy[v] n) = (Sy[v] I) - u = (^ [l^v) ■ n = v(S*[l]n)=vs*[l]. □ Sternberg and Eubanks 2 have shown that the formulation of Kelvin's problem in terms of (i), (iii), and the portion of (ii) concerning the limit as r-+oo, which appears in the literature,3 is incomplete in view of the existence of elastic states on d>—{y) that possess self-equilibrated singularities at t/.4 In contrast, properties (i), (ii), and the first of (iii) suffice to characterize the Kelvin state uniquely.5 1 Properties (i)-(iii), in the precise form stated here, are taken from Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13], Theorem 4.4. Assertion (iii) can be found in Love [1927, 3], § 131; Lur'e [1955, 10], §2.1. 2 [1955, 13]. 3 See, e.g., Timoshenko and Goodier [1951, 10], § 120. 4 E.g. the center of compression defined on p. 179. 5 As Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13] have remarked, Trefftz [1928, 3], § 32 and Butty [1946, 1], § 350 approached the Kelvin problem on the basis of properties (i), (ii), and the first of (iii) but made the erroneous assertion that (ii) is a consequence of the first of (iii). That this is not true is apparent from the state Oy [I] + a%y, where a is a scalar and "ty is the center of compression defined on p. 179. Indeed, this state obeys the first of (iii) without conforming to (ii).
Sect. 51- Basic singular solutions. Let uy[l] be defined on ^—{y} by 177 so that tf,m(»)=-^«.[«](»). tiy[l](x) = r®ei+ei®r- 3J±^pr _(3_4v)rji By (42.3), u%y\l\ is an elastic displacement field on $—{y}corresponding to null body forces. Let 3y [I] be the elastic state on &—{y} generated by uy[l]. We call <fy[l] the doublet state (corresponding to y, I and e^).1 Note that Thus, since it follows that «iffl (») = Jim \ {uy [I] (x) - uy [I] (x -he{)}. uy[l](x-a) = uy+a[l](x), "»M (») = Um |«» I * (») + «»+*«, or equivalently that (*)}. "»ffl=J™{«» I ~T~ f^y+hei I Thus w^[7] is the limit as A-*-0 of the sum of two displacement fields. These fields are associated with two Kelvin states: the first corresponds to a concentrated load -;- I applied at y; the second, corresponds to a concentrated load — v-l applied at yJrhei. The two load systems are shown in Fig. 13. The above relation also yields the important result y+he, Fig. 13- 1 These states were introduced by Love [1927, 3], § 132. See also Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13]. Haadbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 12
178 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 51- The next theorem is the analog of (2) for doublet states; its proof is strictly analogous and can safely be omitted. (3) Properties of the doublet states.1 The doublet state ~iy\l\ has the following properties: (i) ^ffl *s an Mastic s^e onS—{y} corresponding to zero body forces. (ii) Tiy[l] (x) =0(r'2) and Sy[l] (as) =0(r~s) «se->0 and also as r-+oo. (iii) For all rj>0, fsy[l]da=0, frxsy[l]da = — etxl, where on dZn with n the inward unit normal. (iv) For every vector v, l-Uy[v] =V-Uy[l\. (v) If 6y [I] is the Kelvin state corresponding to the concentrated load I at y, then i.e. ^~uy[l] = -uy[l], -°y-Sy[l] = -Sy[l]. Property (iii) could be anticipated intuitively because of the physical meaning attached to the doublet states (cf. Fig. 13). As is clear from (iii), the singularity of 3y [I] is statically equivalent to a couple or to null according as e^xZ^O or e,xJ = 0. In contrast to properties (i)—(iii) of (2), which characterize the Kelvin state uniquely, (i)-(iii) of (3), clearly, do not supply a unique characterization.2 Indeed, *y [' + a e«•] (no sum) has the same properties as Zy [I]. We call the unit Kelvin state corresponding to a unit load at y in the direction of e{. On the other hand, the unit doublet states at y are defined by By (3) the singularity of Z'J at y is statically equivalent to a couple or to null depending on whether »4=7 or t = /. We refer to 3JJ, t'4=/» as the unit doublet state with moment e,- X ej at y, and to dy (no sum) as the unit doublet state corresponding to a force doublet at y parallel to the xraxis. Clearly, 0y[l] = h0y> and the displacement fields belonging to 6y and 3y are given by <(*) = cV[^ + (3-4v)e,]( «£ (») = ^3 [in r + U ei ~ -^- -(3- 4v) r, et 1 Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13], Theorem 5.2. 2 Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13], p. 152.
Sect. 52. Concentrated loads. The reciprocal theorem. 179 The state S = ^4-3^4-333 °y °» ^ °y ^ °y is called the center of compression at y, while «w— 2eijk6y is the center of rotation at y parallel to the %^-axis.1 Using the formula for m^, it is a simple matter to verify that the displacement fields uy and uy associated with ly and 6y are given by 0 , . 2(i — 2v)r «»(«) = --—^3-- Moreover, it follows from (iii) of (3) that / syda = J rxsyda = 0, 327,, &i'„ /sl,<f« = 0, [ rxsyda = ei, where 0 o- ° • sy = Syn> Sy= Syn, and n is the inward unit normal to dZ^. 52. Concentrated loads. The reciprocal theorem. By a system, of concentrated loads we mean a vector-valued_ function 1! whose domain Dt is a finite set of (boundary or interior) points of B; the vector l(£,) is to be interpreted as a concen- trated load at £. If DtndB = 0, we say that the concentrated loads are internal. Finally, we write I— I (£) when D{ is a singleton {£}. Our next definition is motivated by (51.2) and the ensuing discussion. Let I be a system of concentrated loads. We say that <s = [u, E, S] is a singular elastic state corresponding to the external force system [6, s, I] if (i) 6 is a (regular) elastic state on B —Dt corresponding to the external force system [6, s]; (ii) for each ^Dt, u(x) =0(^1) and S(x) =0(r'2) as r = |a> —£|-*0; (iii) for each %£Dt, lim / Snda = l(Q, where Sfe{£,) = Bnd2e(£) and n is the inward unit normal to dZe(^). It follows from (51.2) that for £eS the Kelvin state corresponding to a concentrated load 1! at £ is a singular elastic state on B corresponding to I and to zero body forces. By (ii) and (iii) we have: (iv) for each £e Dt, lim /pxSfi<*«=($-0)xI(fl. 1 These solutions were first introduced by Dougali, [1898, 4]. Ci. Love [1927, 3], § 132; Lue'e [1955, 10], § 2.3; Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13]. 12*
180 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 52. Indeed, by (iii), / pxSnda-((-0)xl(Q = / (x-^)xS(x)n{x)daa. + o(l) as (?->0, and by (ii) the integral on the right tends to zero in this limit. The next theorem shows that for internal concentrated loads in a homogeneous and isotropic body, every singular elastic state admits a representation as a regular elastic state plus a sum of Kelvin states. (1) Decomposition theorem. Assume that the body is homogeneous and isotropic. Let I be a system of internal concentrated loads, and let 6 be a singular elastic state corresponding to I and to zero body forces. Then 6 admits the decomposition where <sR is a (regular) elastic state corresponding to vanishing body forces, and for each £€.D|, o$( = <>g[J(£)]) *s ^e Kelvin state corresponding to the concentrated load 1(0 at I Proof. For each t;£Dt let i(0=2,«)-{«}, with q sufficiently small that o for all $<zDg. Then, on 2'(£), u admits the representation1 OO CO u= 2 gf+r\ 2 hf, rt=\x-(\, (a) ft=— oo h=— oo where </j?> and h^ are vector solid spherical harmonics of degree k ({ being the origin of the spherical coordinate system) and Further, by (ii) in the definition of a singular elastic state,2 ^) = ^-2) = 0, kS. — 2, (c) and since g^\ k 2g0, is a homogeneous polynomial of degree k, (b) implies ^-2) = ^-1) = 0. (d) For each ge-Djlet us = g<fV + rlhl-V (e) on $—{£); then a simple computation using (b) shows that the state <jg corresponding to Ug (in the sense of the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations) is an elastic state on<^—{£} corresponding to 6=0. Thus if we let uR = u — 2 us (f) 1 It is clear that the representation theorem (48.1) remains valid when the deleted neigh- o borhood of infinity, 27(oo), is replaced by the deleted neighborhood of £, Z(%). 2 This follows from the analog of (8.5) for .£(£).
Sect. 52. Concentrated loads. The reciprocal theorem. 181 onB — Dlt then the associated state 6R is an elastic state on B—Dt also corresponding to 6=0. It follows from (a) and (c)-(e) that for each tieDt, 00 00 ^ = 2^+^2^-2^ fe) O on -£(ij); thus u£(x) can be continuously extended to a? = ij, and the resulting extension is C°° on Ze (ij). Therefore 6R so extended is an elastic state on B corresponding to zero body forces. To complete the proof, it clearly suffices to show that <jg is the Kelvin state corresponding to 1(1;). Since 9^^) = -, where the vector a is a constant, (b) and (e) yield us(x) = * + --.¾¾^ r\ Fdiv f "-). (h) By (f) and (g), u—u^is C°° on i?e(¢); thus the stress field Ss corresponding to u% satisfies (iii) in the definition of a singular elastic state: lim / Ssnda =I(fl. (i) An elementary computation based on (h) and (i) shows that (2A + S/t) ,,- hence we conclude from (h) and (51.1) that dg is the Kelvin state corresponding to £(¢) at {. □ (2) Balance of forces and moments for singular states. Let I be a system of concentrated loads, and let 6 be a singular elastic state corresponding to the external force system [6, s, l] with b continuous on B. Then J sda+fbdv + Z 1(0 = 0, dB B gei>| fpxsda+fpxbdv+ 2 (C-0)xI(0 = 0. dB B {£ Dj Here the surface integrals are to be interpreted as Cauchy principal values; i.e. J s da= lim / sda, dB e-*o *(«) * (¢) = 35-(5 £„.(£,), n=l {&,...,^} = An95, c = (a,--.,ew). Pra>/. Let Bl = Dlr\B, B(d,Q)=B-{) Zd($)-{) Zen(U, (a) gesj «=1 and choose d and q sufficiently small that the closed balls mentioned in (a) are mutually disj oint. (Note that &,..., ¢^ are all points of dB; while each £ e Bt is an interior point of 5.) Then 0 is a (regular) elastic state on 5 (5, q) ; hence / s<*«+ / 6<2i>=0. (b) 8B(<5, a) B(«,e)
182 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 52. Since 6 is continuous on B, f bdv^- f bdv as d-^0, <?->-0. (c) B{d, S) B Further, by (a), if d and q are sufficiently small, /=/+1/+2/. (d) BB{6,q) «"{«) n = l S^ejin) t&Bi^sit) where ^,(aj) = 5nai:,(aj). (e) Combining (b) and (d) and letting d->-0, g-»■(), we conclude, with the aid of (c) and (iii) in the definition of a singular elastic state, that f s da dB exists as a Cauchy principal value, and that the first relation in (2) holds. The second relation is derived in exactly the same manner using (iv) in place of (iii). □ We now give an extension of Betti's reciprocal theorem (30.1) which includes concentrated loads. This result, which is due to Turteltaub and Sternberg,1 will be extremely useful in establishing integral representation theorems for elastic states. (3) Reciprocal theorem for singular states. Assume that the elasticity field is symmetric and invertible. Let I and I be systems of concentrated loads with Dt and Df disjoint. Further, let [u, E, S] and [u, E, S] be singular elastic states corresponding to the external force systems [6 s, I] and [6, s, I], respectively, with b and b continuous on E. Then fs-uda+fb-udv+X «(£)' «(£) dB b ssdj; = fs-uda + fb-iidv+ £ *(£)'«(£) dB B J6Dj = fS-Edv = fS-Edv, B B where the surface integrals are to be interpreted as Cauchy principal values. Proof. Let Sf (x) =w (*) — w (£) (a) for each x e B and ££Dt. Then (iii) in the definition of a singular elastic state implies f s-uda= f S'5*da + l(£) -m(£) +o(1) as q->-0 (b) *ett) *e«) for every {eZ)|. Since 4 is an elastic state on E—Dl and 3 an elastic state on B—Df, and since Dlr\Dl =0, (a), (b), and (ii) in the definition of a singular state yield f s-uda^-l(£) •■&(!;), f s-uda^-0 (c) felt) *e(«) 1 [1968,14].
Sect. 52. Concentrated loads. The reciprocal theorem. 183 as p-^-0 for each ^eDt. Similarly, / s -uda->-i(^) 'W(§), f s-uda->-0 (d) as p-^-0 for each £eZ)j\ Now let {& W = (Z),uZ)r)na£, tf = (a.-..,ew), (e) «6Bjj n=l Then o and 3 are (regular) elastic states on B(8, q), and Betti's theorem (30.1) implies / s-W(f«+ / b-udv = f s-uda-\- f b-udv dB(d,Q) B(d,Q) 8B(6,Q) B(6,Q) = / S-Edv = f S-Edv. B(d,Q) B(S,Q) (i) (g) Further, by (e), if 8 and q axe sufficiently small, / = / + 2 ,,/ + 2 /. where we have used the notation given in (e) in the proof of (2). Since C is invertible on B, we conclude from (ii) that E is 0 (r~2) as the distance r from any of its singularities tends to zero. Thus, since DtnDi = 0, (ii) implies that S • E is also 0 (f~2) near its singularities. Clearly, the same property holds for S • E. Further, since 6 and 6 are continuous on B, b • it and 6 • u are 0 (r-1) near their singularities. Thus as 8 -*-0 and q -+0 all of the volume integrals in (f) tend to the corresponding integrals over B. Therefore, if we pass to this limit in (f) and use (g), (c), and (d), we arrive at the desired result. □ (4) Somigliana's theorem.1 Assume that the body is homogeneous and isotropic with Lame moduli that satisfy /^,^=0,2(4,-^^^4=0. Let [u, E, S] be a singular elastic state corresponding to the external force system [b, s, I]. Then2 «(!/) = / («, [«] - -¾ [«]) da + f uy [6] dv + 2 uy [I(fl] (£), dB B J6Dj or equivalently, «<(») = / «-s-s^,-w)rf«+JX-6^+ 2 «4(0-'(C). 0B B_ J6D{ 1 Somigliana [1885, 4], [1886, 4], [1889, <?J for a regular elastic state. See also Dougall [1898, 4]. The extension to singular states is due to Turteltaub and Sternberg [1968, 14], pp. 236-23 7. Somigliana's theorem was utilized to determine upper and lower bounds on elastic states by Diaz and Greenberg [1948, 1], Synge [1950, 12], Washizu [1953, 20] and Bramble and Payne [1961, 6]. Kanwal [1969, 4] used Somigliana's theorem to derive integral equations analogous to those used to study Stokes flow problems in hydrodynamics. See also Maiti and Makan [1971, 3]. 2 The properties of the Kelvin state in conjunction with this result furnish an alternative proof of the fact that u is of class C°° on B.
184 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 52. for yeB —Dt, where for any vector v,Uy[v] is the displacement field and s*[»] the adjoint traction field corresponding to the Kelvin state1 4y[t>], while uy and s'y are the displacement and traction fields for the unit Kelvin state2 oy. Proof. Let v be an arbitrary vector. Then the reciprocal theorem (3) applied to the states 6 = [w, E, S] and <,y [v] yields u{y) •»== / (s • u [v] — u ■ sy[v]) da + f b • Uy[v] dv + £ l($) ' "»[>](£)• BB B «£D| In view of (iv) of (51.2), this relation implies the first formula in (4). On the other hand, if we take v=et in the above relation, we are led to the second formula. □ As a corollary of Somigliana's theorem we have the (5) Integral identity for the displacement gradient.3 Assume that the hypotheses of (4) hold. Then for every yeB—Dt, uiJ(y) = -f(Uy<-s-sj>-u)da-fuyi-bdv-ZUyi(l;)-l(S), SB B «6Dj div u(y) = — / (Mj, • s — sy ■ u) da — J ky ■ b dv — £ %(£) • l(£), dB B i&Dt \[cwclu(y)]i= f (u„-s-Sy-u)da+fuy-bdv+Z «j,(£) • l($), SB B S6D{ where u*J and s^ are the displacement and traction fields for the unit doublet state* !$, uy and iy for the center of compression5 °6y, and 1¾ and sy for the center of rotation e 4y. Proof. If we differentiate the second relation in (4) with respect to yf, we arrive at7 u.J^^f^^-s-^Sy-^da + f^-Uy-bdv+Z^.K^-m- dB «60l In view of (v) of (51.3) and the definition of unit doublet states given on page 178, this relation implies the first formula in (5). The second and third formulae are immediate consequences of the first. □ It is a simple matter to extend the mean strain and volume change theorems (29.2) and (29.3) to include concentrated loads. In particular, the formula for the volume change in a homogeneous and isotropic body becomes dv(B) = -*Tffp-8da + fp-bdv+2l((-0)-Ht\, where k is the modulus of compression. 1 See p. 174. 2 Seep. 178. 3 The first identity is apparently due to Love [1927, <?], § 169- The formulae for the divergence and curl of u are due to Betti [1872, 1], §§ 8, 9. See also Dougall [1898, 4], Love [1927, 3], §§ 160, 162. 4 See p. 178. 5 See p. 179- 6 Seep. 179. 7 The differentiation under the integral sign is easily justified. Cf. the proof (Kellogg [1929, 1], p. 151) of the differentiability under the integral sign of Newtonian potentials of volume distributions.
Sect. 53. Integral representation of solutions to concentrated-load problems. 185 Suppose now that s=0 on dB, 6=0 on B, and that the system I consists of a pair of concentrated loads. If we let Dt = (¾, §2}> then it follows from balance of forces and moments (2) that *Ki) = -*(W = *e, and there results the following elegant formula for the volume change: Thus the volume change due to a pair of concentrated loads is independent of the shape or volume of B; it depends only upon the magnitude of the loads, their distance apart, and the modulus of compression of the material. 53. Integral representation of solutions to concentrated-load problems. In this section we will use the reciprocal theorem for singular states to establish an integral representation theorem for the mixed problem of elastostatics with concentrated loads included. Thus we assume given a symmetric and invertihle elasticity field C on B, surface displacements u on £fx, surface forces s on y2, a continuous body force field 6 on B, and a system of concentrated loads I. The generalized mixed problem is to find a singular elastic state [u, E, 8] that corresponds to the body force field 6 and to the system of concentrated loads I, and that satisfies the boundary conditions m = m on S^—Di, s = s on 6^ — Dg. We will call such a singular elastic state a solution of the generalised mixed problem. In order to introduce the notion of a Green's state we need the following (1) Lemma. Let f and m be given vectors. Then there exists a unique rigid displacement field w such that f wda=f, f pexwda = m, dB dB where c is the centroid of dB and pc(x) =x—c. We call w the rigid field on dB with force f and moment m. Proof. Suppose such a field w exists and let Since c is the centroid, and thus w = a-\-coxpc. (a) Jpcda = 0, (b) dB J w da=aa, (c) where a is the area of dB. Further, (a) and (b) also imply / pcxwda= f pcx((OXpc)da = I(o, (d) dB dB
186 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 53. where I is the centroidal inertia tensor: I=S[\Pc\^-Pc®Pc\da. (e) dB Since I is invertible, (c) and (d) imply that if such a rigid field w exists, it is unique and a— -, (o — I^vn. (f) Conversely, it is a simple matter to verify that w defined by (a) and (f) has all of the desired properties. □ Let ytB. We call 6y = [iiy, Ey, Sy] (i = \, 2, 3) Green's states at y for the mixed problem provided: (i) ~4y is a singular elastic state corresponding to vanishing body forces and to a concentrated load e4 at y; (ii) if £f\_ is not empty, then uy = 0 on ^, sy=0 on ^, where sy is the surface traction field of ~6y; (iii) if yx is empty, then stt = wy on dB, where wy is the rigid field with force — e, and moment — (t/ — c) xe,-. The above boundary condition insures that balance of forces and moments are satisfied when £fx is empty. Indeed, by (52.2) and (i), the Green's state ~<,y must satisfy fSyda+e — 0, SB f pcxs'yda+ (S-c)xe,. = 0; BB that ~4y is consistent with these results follows from (1) and (iii). For a homogeneous and isotropic body, the Green's states iy may be constructed as follows: where 6y is the unit Kelvin state corresponding to a concentrated load e^ at y, and 4y is a regular elastic state on B corresponding to zero body forces and chosen so that the boundary conditions (ii) and (iii) for Zy are satisfied. We say that an integrable vector field u on dB is normalised if fuda = 0, f pexuda = 0. dB BB Given a solution u of the traction problem (^ = 0), the field u-\-w with w rigid is also a solution. By (1) there exists a unique rigid w such that u-\-w is normalized. Thus we may always assume, without loss in generality, that solutions of the traction problem are normalized.
Sect. 53. Integral representation of solutions to concentrated-load problems. 187 (2) Integral representation theorem.1 Let [uy,Ey,Sy] (i = i,2, 3) be Green's states at y<cB for the mixed problem. Further, let [u, E, S] be a solution of the generalized mixed problem with u normalized if Sfx is empty. Then for y$Dt, Ui(y) = ~fsy-uda + fuy-Sda+fiiy-bdv + Zuy($)-l(?). Proof. Assume first that £fx is not empty. If we apply the reciprocal theorem (52.3) to the states <, and Zy and use (i) and (ii) in the definition of 4y together with the boundary conditions satisfied by <f, we find that / ~sy -uda+uM =fs-uyda+fb-uydv+Z '(«) •»%(«), which implies the above expression for u^y). If £^ is empty, we conclude from (iii) in the definition of Green's states that there exist vectors a=a*y and a = (oy such that sy = a-\- coxpc on dB. Thus, since u is normalized, f sy-uda = f (o+ coxpc) uda = a- f uda + at- f pcxuda = 0, dB dB dB dB and the reciprocal theorem again implies the desired result. □ (3) Symmetry of the Green's states. Let vOx and uy be displacement fields corresponding to Green's states atx,yeB (x4= y) for the mixed problem. Further, if £^ is empty, assume that w£, and uy are both normalized. Then ul(y)-ei = uy(x)-er Proof. We simply apply the integral representation theorem (2) to the state [u, E, S] =¾ and use properties (i)-(iii) of Green's states. □ In the presence of sufficient smoothness one can deduce an integral representation theorem for the displacement gradient (and hence also for the strain and stress fields) by differentiating the relations in (2) under the integral sign. An alternative approach is furnished by the (4) Representation theorem for the displacement gradient. Assume that B is homogeneous and isotropic. Choose y^B and let 1 A slightly different version of this theorem for the displacement and surface force problems without concentrated loads was given by Lauricella [1895, 1], who attributed the method to Volterra (cf. the earlier work of Somigliana discussed in footnote 1 on p. 183). A precise statement of the Lauricella-Volterra theorem is contained in the work of Sternberg and Eubanks [1955, 13]. In [1895, 1] and [1955, 13] the equilibration of the concentrated load ei at y in the Green's state 3* when 5^ is empty is effected through the introduction of a second internal singularity; the normalization of u is achieved by requiring the displacements and rotations to vanish at the location of this added singularity. The method used here to equilibrate the concentrated load and the normalization procedure for u is due to Bergman and Schiffer [1953, 3], pp. 223-224 (cf. Turteltaub and Sternberg [1968, 14]). For the surface force problem with concentrated loads this theorem is due to Turteltaub and Sternberg [1968, 14]. See also Dougall [1898, 4], [1904, 1], § 32; Lichtenstein [1924, 1]; Korn [1927, 2], § 14; Love [1927, 3], § 169; Trefftz [1928, 3], § 49; Arzhanyh [1950, 2], [1951, 2], [1953, 1], [1954, 2]; Radzhabov [1966, 20]; Idenbom and Orlov [1968, 9].
188 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 53. where: (i) H'j} are the unit doublet states1 at y; (ii) 4% are regular elastic states corresponding to zero body forces; (iii) if £fx is not empty, then ftj/=0 on yx, s*/ = 0 on ^, where iij/ is the displacement field and sj/ the traction field of <i%; (iv) if 6^ is empty, then sj/ = w# on dB, where w^ is a rigid field. Let [u, E, S] be a solution of the generalized mixed problem with u normalized if if^ is empty. Then for y$Dt, «< ,(y) = -I ~s$-uda + jui;-sda+fu% -bdv+% «#'(«)• I«). 5» A B «£Dj Proof. By (ii) and the reciprocal theorem (52.3), /■(8-^-^-«)rfa+/ft-^rf» + 2l(«)-i^(«) = 0. (a) dB B J6Dj Since ?J» = <$ — 3y, if we add (a) to the right-hand side of the first relation in (52.5), we find that »*./(«) = / (» • «»' - 3g ■«) rfa + / ft • *# ^ + 2 I(«) • uj/(£). (b) <JB B «£Dj It follows from (iii) that when £fx is not empty (b) reduces to the required expression for u{^(y). If if^ is empty, then an argument identical to that utilized in the proof of (2) can be used to verify that / s*/ -uda = 0; (c) dB and (b) and (c) yield the desired relation for u{j(y). □ The rigid field w*J of (iv) is not arbitrary. Indeed, in view of (i) and (ii), w?y" must obey balance of forces and moments on B—£e(y). If we apply these laws and then let q -+0, we conclude, with the aid of (51.3), that f sij da = 0, dB f rxs*? (f« = efxe-. dB Thus w*J must be the rigid field with force equal to zero and moment equal to et X e?-. The proof of the next theorem, which we omit, is completely analogous to the proof of (4) and is based on the relations for divw(t/) and curl w(t/) given in (52.5). (5) Representation theorem for the dilatation and rotation.* Assume that B is homogeneous and isotropic. Choose yeB and let ~ * ° ~* ** °i o„ = t„ — o„, "» = "» — "». 1 See p. 178. 2 Betti [1872, 1]. See also Love [1927, 3], §§ 161, 163.
Sect. 53. Integral representation of solutions to concentrated-load problems. 189 where: (i) ly is the center of compression at y and ly the center of rotation at y parallel to the Xf-axis;1 (ii) 6y and Oy are regular elastic states corresponding to zero body forces; (iii) if £f{ is not empty, then viy — Q on £fx, sw = 0 on £f2, wj, = 0 on yx, s*, = 0 on ^, where uy and Uy are the displacement fields and sy and sy the traction fields of 39 and 4y. (iv) if £fx is empty, then sy=0 on 8B, Sy = wy on 8B, where wy is a rigid field. Let [u, E, S] be a solution of the generalized mixed problem with u normalized if £^ is empty. Then for yiDt, divw(t/) = — f sy-uda-\- f uy-sda + fuy- bdv + 2 ««(£)" ^(£)> £ &% B J6Dj J [curl u (t/)] ,• = / sy • u da — J uy • s da — f uy • b dv — £ uy ($) • I ($). As before, the field wy of (iv) is not arbitrary; it follows from (i), (ii), and the relations on page 179 that Wy must be the rigid field with force equal to zero and moment equal to e,-. In view of the last theorem, div u and curl u can be computed, at least in principle, from the data. Further, since the displacement equation of equilibrium is equivalent to the relation2 u+ \ (l+ ^Jpdivw 0, the determination of w when div w is known is reduced to a problem in the theory of harmonic functions. Moreover, since the surface force field on dB can be written in the form3 s = 2ft +/unxcurlM+ A(divw)n, when div u and curl u have been found, the surface value of du/dn is known at points at which the surface force field is prescribed. This method of integration is due to Betti.4 Ericksen's theorem (33.1) extends, at once, to problems involving concentrated loads. (6) Assume that there exists a non-trivial solution of the generalized mixed problem with null data (u = 0, s = 0, 6=0,1=0). Then there exists a continuous body force field b on B of class C2 on B with the following property: the regular 1 See p. 179. 2 See p. 91. 3 See p. 93. 4 [1872, l). See also Love [1927, 3], § 159-
190 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 54. mixed problem corresponding to this body force and to null boundary data (it = 0, s = 0) has no solution. If ,5¾ is empty, b can be chosen so as to satisfy f bdv = f pxbdv = 0. B B In addition, there exists a system of concentrated loads I such that the generalized mixed problem corresponding to I, vanishing body forces, and null boundary data has no solution. If £fx is empty, I can be chosen so as to satisfy 2i«) = I«-o)xi«) = o. The proof of this theorem is based on the reciprocal theorem (52.3); it is strictly analogous to the proof of (33.1) and can safely be omitted. As an immediate corollary of (6) we have the following theorem, due to Turteltaub and Sternberg :1 If the regular mixed problem with null boundary data has a solution whenever the body force field is sufficiently smooth, then there is at most one solution to the generalized mixed problem. In the case of internal concentrated loads, a uniqueness theorem can be established that does not presuppose existence. (7) Uniqueness theorem for problems involving internal concentrated loads. Assume that the body is homogeneous and isotropic with positive definite elasticity tensor. Then any two solutions of the generalized mixed problem with internal concentrated loads are equal modulo a rigid displacement. Proof. Let 6 denote the difference between two solutions. Then, by the decomposition theorem (52.1), 6 is a regular elastic state corresponding to null data. Thus the uniqueness theorem (32.1) implies that <j = [w>, 0, 0] with w rigid. □ X. Saint-Venant's principle. 54. The v. Mises-Sternberg version of Saint-Venant's principle. Saint-Venant, in his great memoir2 on torsion and flexure, studied the deformation of a cylindrical body loaded by surface forces distributed over its plane ends. In order to justify ulHHg his results as an approximation in situations involving other end loadings, SAiNT-V^NAN[rjnad^a_conjecture.which may roughly be worded as follows: If two sets of loadings are statically equivalent at each end, then the difference in stress fields is negligible, except possibly near the ends; or equivalently, a system of loads having zero resultant force and moment at each end produces a stress field that is negligible away from the ends. This idea has since been elevated to the status of a general principle bearing the name of Saint-Venant. Its first ■A-^l-i general statement was given by Boussinesq :3 "An equilibrated system of external \'~°*""Vforces applied to an elastic body, all of the points of application lying within a ri'ic% given sphere, produces deformations of negligible magnitude at distances from rxa*0 the sphere which are sufficiently large compared to its radius." As was first pointed out by v. Mises,4 this formulation of Saint-Venant's principle, which has since become conventional, is in need of clarification, since 1 [1968, 14], Theorem 5.2. Actually, the Turteltaub-Sternberg theorem is slightly different from the one given above; the idea, however, is the same. 2 [1855,11 3 [1885, i], p. 298. "Des forces exterieures, qui se font equilibre sur un solide elastique et dont les points d'application se trouvent tous a 1'interieur d'une sphere donnee, ne produisent pas de deformations sensibles a des distances de cette sphere qui sont d'une certaine grandeur par rapport a son rayon." 4 [1945, 5].
Sect. 54. The v. Mises-Sternberg version of Saint-Venant's principle. 191 the system of external forces must necessarily be in equilibrium, at least when the body is finite. Further, as was noted by Sternberg,1 in the case of an un- bounded bodyjoaded on_a finite portion joFits^surfice, The stresses are arbitrarily i small at sufficiently large distances from the ioad region.2 I The first of these criticisms led v. Mises3 to suggest the following interpretation of the principle: "If the forces acting upon a body are restricted to several, small parts of the surface, each included in a sphere of radius q, then the ... stresses': produced in the interior of the body ... are smaller in order of magnitude when the forces for each single part are in equilibrium than when they are not." It is clear that this is the meaning intended by Boussinesq. Indeed, in order to justify the principle, Boussinesq examined the strains at an interior point of an elastic half-space subjected to normal concentrated loads upon its boundary. Assuming the points of application of the loads to lie within a sphere of radius q, he showed that the order of magnitude of the strains is q if the resultant force is zero, andj)2when jthejresultant moment also vanishes. Various arguments have since been given in support of the principle.* v. Mises utilized two examples involving tangential as well as normal surface loads to demonstrate that the above version of Saint-Venant's principle cannot be valid without qualification. The two examples chosen by v. Mises are the three-dimensional problem of the half-space and the plane problem of the circular disk, each under concentrated surface loads.5 Guided by these examples, v. Mises e conjectured a modified Saint-Venant principle-which he stated as follows: " (a) If a system of loads on an adequately supported body, all applied at surface points within a sphere of diameter q, have the vector sum zero, they produce in an inner point y of the body a strain or stress value s of the order of magnitude q. (b) If the loads, in addition to having vector sum zero,... form an equilibrium system within the sphere of diameter q, the s-value produced in the point y will, in general, still be of the order of magnitude q. (c) If the loads, in addition to being an equilibrium system, ... form a system in astatic equilibrium, then the s-value produced in y will be of the order of magnitude q2 or smaller. In particular, if loads applied to a small area are parallel to each other and not tangential to the surface and if they form an equilibrium system, they are also in astatic equilibrium and thus lead to an s of the order q2." The conjectures of v. Mises concerning concentrated surface loads were analyzed by Sternberg, whose results are also valid for continuously distributed surface loads. In. order to give a concise statement of Sternberg's theorem, we introduce the following definitions: We say that !FQ, 0 < q gj q0 , is a family of load regions on dB contracting to ztdBii:7 (i) &g = dB n S9 (0) for every q e (0, q0] ; 1 [1954, 20]. 2 Toupin [1965, 20] gives several counterexamples to the conventional statement of Saint-Venant's principle. 3 [1945, 5]. 4 Southwell [1923, 2], Supino [1931, 5], Goodier [1937, 1, 2], [1942, 2], Zanaboni [1937. 6, 7, 8], Locatelli [1940, 2], Dou [1966, 7]. 6 Erim [1948, 3] has applied v. Mises' analysis to the half-plane under concentrated loads. 6 [1945, 5]. 7 Cf. Sternberg and Al-Khozai [1964, 20], Def. 4.1.
192 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 54. (ii) there exists a class C2 mapping x: ^->#"ffo, where & is an open region in the plane containing the origin, such that ' 0¾ 8¾ !=0 Note that by (ii) the boundary of B possesses continuous curvatures near s; thus this portion of the boundary is required to exhibit a higher degree of smoothness than that automatically assured by the assumption that B be a regular region. For each &€{1, 2,..., K} let ^e(k), 0<q^q0, be a family of load regions on dB contracting to a point 2k£dB. We say that ie=\ue, Ee, Se], 0<q<q0, is a family of singular elastic states corresponding to loads on !FQ (k) if given any 06(0, Qo)-1 (iii) ae is a singular elastic_state corresponding to zero body forces, to surface tractions se, and to a system I of concentrated loads;" ' " ■ K (iv) the traction field s8 vanishes on dB — (J !F (k); A=l K (v) D^c^u^(*)j; (vi) \se{x)\ ^.M1 for every xedB and |fff(£)| f^M2 for every £€£)¾» where the constants M1 and M2 are independent of g; (vii) ue and Fm? admit the representations «»*. Ay) = /*,■*»'<*«+ z K (?) • fitf (?). for every «/€5, where for each y£B the functions uy and 1¾ are continuous on B-{y) and of class C2 on ^(fe) for £=1, 2,..., K. Since D;g is the set of jjoints at which Jhe concentrated loads of the system lQ are acting, (v)Ts"simply the requirement that there be no concentrated loads applied'outside of the K load regions ^e(k). In view of (iii), (v), and the integral representation theorem (53.2), the first representation formula in (vii) is simply the requirement that the Green's states for the surface force problem exist. For a homogeneous and isotropic body, it is clear from the discussion on page 186 that such Green's states will exist if the surface force problem for arbitrary (equilibrated) surface tractions has a solution with sufficiently smooth displacements. In view of the integral representation theorem (53.4), this also insures that the assertion in (vii) concerning VuQ hold. For convenience, we adopt the following notation: De(k)=DlQn3Pe(k), me(k)= f pxseda+ Z «-0)x^(«), Me(k)= f p®seda+ Z (¢-0)0^(0, 1 Cf. Sternberg and Al-Khozai [1964, 20], Dei. 4.2.
Sect. 54. The v. Mises-Sternberg version of Saint-Venant's principle. 193 so that fg (k) and me (k) denote the resultant force and resultant moment about the origin of the surface tractions and concentrated loads on ^e(k). We say that the force system is in equilibrium on jeacj^lgadregign^if for k = 1, 2,..., K and 0<q<q0. Further, using the terminology introduced in Sect. 18, we say that the force system is in astatic equilibrium on each load region if given any orthogonal tensor Q ^JQseda+ £ <H(£) = 0, JpxQseda+ £ («-0)xO^(0 = 0. Taking Q = \, we see that astatic equilibrium implies equilibrium. In addition, it follows from theorem (18.9) that the force system is in astatic equilibrium on each load region if and only if fe(k) = 0, Me(k) = 0, for k = 1, 2, ..., K and 0 < q < Q0. Finally, we say that the forsesare parallel and non-tangential, to. the boundary if there exist scalar functions <pe on dB ancfy>e on Die such that for each k, se(*) = %W «*. h(?) = fei^k for all a?&^,(&), %eDe(k), and #e(0, q0), where ak is a unit vector that is not tangent to 8B at zk. (1) Sternberg's theorem.1 Let zk, k = \, 2, ..., K, be K distinct regular points of dB, and for each k let ^e(k), 0<q^q0, be a family of load regions on 8B contracting to zk. Let oe = [ue, Eg, SJ, 0<q<q0, be a family of singular elastic states corresponding to loads on ^(k). Then given y&B: (a) ue(y)=0(es), Ee(y)=0(es), Se(y)=0(es) as q^O, where 6=0; (b) <5 = 1 if fe(k) = 0 for k = \,2,...,K and 0<q<q0\ (c) 6=2 if on each load region the force system is in equilibrium with forces that are parallel and non-tangential to the boundary; (d) 6=2 if the force system is in astatic equilibrium on each load region. Moreover, if the concentrated loads all vanish (i.e. lg = 0), which will be the case if 6e is regular for each q, then: (a') 6=2 (in general); (b') <5 = 3 if /e(&) = 0 for £=1,2,..., K and 0<q<q0; (c') <5=4 */ on each load region the force system is in equilibrium with forces that are parallel and non-tangential to the boundary; (d') <5=4 if the force system is in astatic equilibrium on each load region. Proof. Fix yeB. In view of the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations, it clearly suffices to establish the above order of magnitude estimates for uQ and VuQ. Let ue denote either uei(y) or ueit1-(y). Then by (vii) uQ admits the representation ue = fse-gda+ £ le(®-g($), (e) '[1954,20]. See also Schumann [1954, iS], Boley [1958,3], [1960,2], Sternberg [i960,12], Sternberg and Al-Khozai [1964,20], Keller [1965, 11]. The last author discusses the form which the principle might be expected to take in the case of thin bodies. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 13
194 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 54. where g denotes either uly or «**. Since the zk are all distinct, there exists a gj£(0, #0) such that the K sets ^e(k) are mutually disjoint for each #e(0, &). Thus, in view of (iv) and (v), «,= 2 »»(*). (f) where ».(*)= /vs<*« + 2^(0-0(0- We now fix the integer & and, for convenience, write v9 = v9(k), &e = &e(k), De = De(k), z = zk, so that v0= Jse-gda+ZW-9(^)- (s) &Q seoe Let x: SP^-tF^ be the function specified in (ii). It follows from the properties of x that there exists an open set 0 in 0 containing the origin, a number #2£(0, &), and a mapping a = (¾.¾) of #"?J onto ^8 such that a is the inverse of the restriction of x to ^. Further, it follows from the properties of x that a (a?) = 0(\x — z\) as x^-z. (h) Since the composite function gox (with values g(x(ot,))) is class C2 on ^, if we expand this function in a Taylor series in a about a = 0 and evaluate the result at a = a (x), we arrive at g(x)=a0 + a1^1(x) + a2a2(x) + c(x) (i) for a?e^"8j, where a0, (¾. and a2 are fixed vectors and, in view of (h), c is a class C2 function on J^ that satisfies c(x)=0(\x — z\2) as x^z. (j) By (h)-(j) and (vi), 2 f st-gda = a0- / s8 d« + £ Op • /a^s^a + O^4), &"q &q )3 = 1 ^) = a0-/s^« + 0(e»), (k) = 0(e*). 2 1,(0-9(0 = 00- 2 *ff(0 + 2<v 2 ^KHfO + ofe*). ?££<> $£De /9=1 $€D<, =«o- 2 w+o(q), a) = 0(1) as g->0. Conclusions (a) and (a') follow from (f), (g), (k)3, and (1)3. Further, it follows from the definition of fQ =fe(k) in conjunction with (f), (g), (k)2, and (1)2 that conclusions (b) and (b') are also valid. To establish the remaining results we first expand the function x in a Taylor series about a = 0: x(a,)=s + d1La.1 + d2a.2 + h(<x), (m) where MW (/3 = 1,2), (n) 9a« « = 0
Sect. 54. The v. Mises-Sternberg version of Saint-Venant's principle. 195 and h is a class C2 function on 3P that obeys h(x)=0(\x\2) as a^O. (o) Since p (x) — x — 0, we conclude from (m), (h), and (o) that 2 / p <g) se da = (g — 0) 0 f se da + £ dp ® / (¾ s8 d« + 0(#4), 2 «-0)(8H(«) = (*-0)(8i 2 ^fl + ZH® I «/>(?) *8($) + 0 (<?2). If we assume that the force system is in astatic equilibrium on each load region, then /e==0, Mj30, (q) and it follows from (p) and the definition of /e and MQ that /j=i (r) = o(g*) if i^o, where /^/o^a+Z^KHtt). (s) Each of the relations in (r) may be regarded as a system of inhomogeneous linear equations in the two unknowns fpe{@ = i, 2). It follows from (n) and the restrictions placed on x in (ii) that the coefficient matrix of this system has rank two. Hence (r) implies //,, = 0 (<?*). (t) = 0(e*) if ^o, and this result with (f), (g), (k)x, (1^, and (s) yields conclusions (d) and (d'). We have only to establish (c) and (c'). Thus suppose, in place of (q), that /,==0, me^0. (u) Clearly, (p) holds in the present circumstances with the operation " ® " replaced by "x". It follows from this relation in conjunction with (u) and (s) that (r) also holds with "®" replaced by "x". Thus if we assume that se(x) —<pe{x)a and le(§) =ye(£) a on ^=^(fe) and De=De(k), respectively, then £^xa{/^%rf«+2a^)%(£)} = 0(^), /8=1 l^e g€D, > = o(g*) if ¢,==0. This, in turn, implies that [(¾xd.) -a] { f^^da + £&,(?) fe(¢)} = 0(q*), = o(e«) if 1,==0. It follows from (n) and (ii) that d1x<f24=0. Therefore, since c^xefa is normal to 8B at g, the requirement that a not be tangent to 8B at g implies (e^ xd2) • a 4=0. Thus, in this instance, (v) implies (t), and, as before, we see that (c) and (c') are valid. □ On the basis of the traditional statement of Saint-Venant's principle discussed at the beginning of this section, one would expect a reduction from d — i 13*
196 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 55. to 8=2 in the order of magnitude estimates whenever the force system is in equilibrium on each load region, even when the surface tractions are not of the special form specified in (c), i.e. parallel and non-tangential to the boundary. That this is not the case is apparent from counterexamples of v. Mises.1 The precedin^^onchj^ian has a counterpart in the. .theQry_j5f_hasic_sJngular states discussed in Sect. 51. Thus consider the unit Kelvin state <>* and the unit doublet state P1, with 0 the point of application in both cases. Both of these states are regular on any infinite region S that does not contain 0. If the boundary of B is bounded, then /'=#0, m' = 0, /*'>'= 0, m*'>'4=0 (*'4=/), /*>' = 0, ml' = 0 (*==/), where /', m' and /,;, m*; denote the resultant force and moment aoout the origin of the surface forces on 8B corresponding to d' and ?*', respectively. Consider the rate of decay of the corresponding stress field at infinity. It,is clear from the results on p. 178 that Sf (x) = 0 (r-*), S* (a?) 4= 0 (r~3) S{> (x) = 0 (r -»), S* (x) 4= 0 (r "4) as r =\x — 0| ->oo, regardless of whether i =/ or i4=/- Consequently, whereas the stress field decays more rapidly when the resultant force on 8B vanishes than when this is not the case, the additional vanishing of the resultant moment does not produce a further reduction in the order of magnitude of the stresses as f->-00.2 55. Toupin's version of Saint-Venant's principle. Two alternative versions of Saint-Venant's principle were established by Toupin3 and K.NOWLES.4These authors considered the solution corresponding to a single system of surface loads, and both authors arrived at estimates for the strain energy U(l) of a portion of the body beyond a distance I from the load region.8 Knowles' result, which we will discuss in the next section, applies to the plane problem, while Toupin's result is for a semi-infinite cylinder loaded on its end face.6 * (1) Toupin's theorem.1 Let B be a homogeneous semi-infinite cylindrical body with end face Sf0, and assume that the elasticity tensor is symmetric and positive definite. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to zero body forces and to a surface force field s that satisfies: (i) s=0 on dB — ^0, (ii) / s da — fpxs da = 0, (iii) lim / u- Snda=0, 1 [1945. 5]. 2 The conclusions expressed in the last two paragraphs are due to Sternberg and Al-Khozai [1964,20], pp. 144-145- 3 [1965, 21]. 4 [1966, 12]. 5 The idea of estimating the energy U(l) of that portion of a circular cylinder a distance I from the loaded end appears in the work of Zanaboni [1937, 8]. 6 Knowles and Sternberg [1966, 13] have established a Saint-Venant principle for the torsion of solids of revolution. A result that is valid for more general regions was given by Melnik [1963, 19]. 7 [1965, 21]. See also Toupin [1965, 20].
Sect. 55. Toupin's version of Saint-Venant's principle. 197 where S^\ is the intersection with B of a plane perpendicular to the axis e of the cylinder and a distance I from 6^,. Let Oe^J,, let B, = {xeB: (x-0)-e>l}, and let U(l) denote the strain energy of Bt: %>c -r a * Then U(l) = ifE-C[E]dv. Bl 1 It U{l)£U(0)e J-W (l^t) for any t > 0, where the decay length y (t) is given by .»-0 PmW) Here /xM and fim are the maximum and minimum elastic moduli, while X (t) is the lowest (non-zero) characteristic value for the free vibrations of a disc with cross section £f0 and thickness t, a disc that is composed of the same material and that has its boundary traction-free.1 Then Fig, 14. Proof. Choose t, I > 0 and let B{l,t)=Bl-Bl+t. U{t) = \im\ JE-C[E]dv t^oo B(l,t) provided the limit exists. By (i) and the theorem of work and energy (28.3), Ju-Snda+ f u-Snda= f E- C[E]dv. r, srM B(i,t) Thus if we let t ->- 00 and use (iii) we conclude that U(l) exists and obeys the formula £/(/) = 1 fu-Snda. (a) Equating to zero the total force and moment on the portion B (0,1) of B between S"0 and S?i, we conclude, with the aid of (i) and (ii), that J Snda= fpx(Sn)da = 0. (b) 1 Thus we make the tacit assumption that the characteristic value problem stated in Sect. 76 has a solution, at least for the lowest non-zero characteristic value.
198 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 55. Let s' be the vector field on 8B (0,1) defined by s'=Sn on yu s'=0 on 35(0,1) -^,. Then (b) implies fs'da= Jpxs'da = 0, dB (o, /) en (o, /) and we conclude from Piola's theorem (18.3) with s = s' and 6 = 0 that f w • Snda = 0 / for every rigid displacement w. Therefore (a) yields t/(/) = £ fu-Snda (c) ^, provided u = u + w. (d) By (c) and the Schwarz inequality, U(t)^i]/fu*da f \Sn\2da. te) If we expand (a ]/#— ]/&)2, where a, b, and a are non-negative scalars with oc>0, we arrive at the geometric-arithmetic mean inequality ' — 2 Applying this inequality to (e) yields U{1) ^\U f\Sn\2da + ^ fu2da\. (f) Since \n\ =1 and C is symmetric, |Sn|2 ^ |S|2 = C[E] • C[E] = E ■ C2[E]. Let /<M and //,m denote the maximum and minimum elastic moduli for C; then by (24.6) ^m\E\^E-C[E]^^M\E\K Further, it follows from the definition of /iM and //,m that /x% and /i% are the maximum and minimum moduli for C2; thus ^lEl^E-C^^El2. The last three inequalities imply that \Sn\*^//M\E\*^ii*E-C[E], where ..* _ j"m . thus (/) implies C7(/) ^^ Lfi* fE-C[E]da + ~ fu2da\. . (g)
Sect. 55. Toupin's version of Saint-Venant's principle. 199 Next, choose t > 0 and let i+t 0(U)=J-/ U{X)dX. (h) If we integrate (g) between I and l-\-t, we arrive at tQ(l, t) g A W [ E • C [E] rfo + *- J W dv\ . (i) B (1,() B(l,t) ' Now let X{t) denote the lowest non-zero characteristic value corresponding to the free vibrations of the cylindrical disc B(l, t). Then1 / VvC[Vv]dv X(t)<z.B<hlL w — / K2 dv B(l,t) for every admissible displacement field v on B(l, t) that satisfies fvzdv^=0, fvdv— / pcxvdv = 0. B(l,t) B(l,t) B(l,t) By use of the same procedure as that used to prove (53.1), it is not difficult to show that the rigid^lisplacement w in (d) can be chosen so as to satisfy fwdv = — f udv, fpcxwdv = — f pcxudv, B(l,t) B (1,() B(l,t) B (1,() where c is the centroid of B(l, t) and pc(x) =x — c. By (d) when this is the case we have J udv— f pcxudv = 0; B (I, t) B (I, t) thus Ju'dv^-^y JE-C[E]dv, * (j) B (1,() B(l,t) and (i) and (j) yield m,t)^{ (-^y+ «,**) JE-C[E}dv. (k) B (I, t) If we differentiate (h) with respect to I, we arrive at --J!-=y ^+0-^01- _ w On the other hand, f E-C[E]dv = fE-C[E]dv- f E • C[E] dv = 2[U {1) -U{l + t)], (m) B(l,t) B, B,+, and (k)-(m) imply ~ ',; y (0-^- + ^.0^0, (n) where 1 See p. 264.
200 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 56. Clearly, y (t) is a minimum when a = • Henceforth we assume that a has this value, so that By(n) and thus ■«>=^S (t) &M Q ft, t) - W® Qft, f)£0 ft ^y or e vW . (o) Since C is positive definite, U(l) is a non-increasing function of I, and by (h) @ (M)is the mean value of C7(/) in the interval [I, l-\-t~\; therefore and (o) implies Setting ^ = 0 and l2 = l — t in (p), we obtain the desired energy estimate. □ In view of (24.6), if the material is homogeneous and isotropic with strictly' positive Lame moduli //, and X, then the characteristic decay length y (t) has the iorm n , . ?W_ VaTTAM • Toupin1 also derived an estimate for the magnitude of the strain tensor at interior points of the cylinder. A somewhat stronger estimate was established by Roseman 2 for an isotropic cylinder. Roseman proved that \S{x)\*^.K\U{l — a) - U(l + a)] for every a?e«$^, where if is a constant that depends on the Lame moduli and the cross-section, while a is a constant that depends only on the cross-section. When combined with Toupin's theorem, the above inequality yields pointwise exponential decay for the stress throughout the cylinder. 56. Knowles' version of Saint-Venant's principle. Knowles' version3 of Saint- Venant's principle is concerned with the plane problem of elastostatics for a simply-connected region loaded over a portion of its boundary curve. To state this result concisely we introduce the following notation. Let R be a simply-connected regular region in the xx, #2-plane, so that its boundary curve ^ is a piecewise smooth simple closed curve. As indicated in Fig. 15, ~~ 1 [1965, 21]. Toupin's estimate is based on (h) of Sect. 43, which is due to Diaz and Payne [1958, 6]. 2 [1966, 22]. The techniques used by Roseman are based on results of John [1963, 15], [1965, 10]. 3 [1966, 12].
Sect. 56. Knowles' version of Saint-Venant's principle. 201 Fig. 15. and we choose our coordinates so that the minimum value of x2 on "if0 is zero, ^^will represent that portion of the boundary curve along which surface tractions are applied. Let b = sup x2, « = sup %, Ri = {x€R: x1>l}, ^Ci = {x€R: x1 = l). We assume that for each le(0, a), the set ££l is the union of a finite number of line segments; we regard J2?( as parametrized by x2. Since R is simply-connected, (46.3) implies that the stress field Sa/8 corresponding to a plane elastic state is completely characterized by the field equations Knowles' theorem gives a decay estimate for the norm (a) (b) |S||;=1// ~SaPSaPda of such a stress field over Rt. (1) Knowles' theorem.1 Let Sa/8 (= S^) be smooth on E0 and of class C2 on R0. Suppose further that Sa/8 satisfies (a) on R0 and (c) Then for 0^/^ a where ||S||;^]/2JS||0<r>~, [1966, 12].
202 M. E. Guriin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 56. With a view toward proving this theorem, we first establish the following (2) Lemma.1 Let f be continuous on R0. Then - I fda = — I fdx2. dl Ri Si Proof. Consider the difference quotient F(l + d)-F(l) » J for the function F defined by F(l) = Jfda. If ^i is connected, this difference quotient can be written, for sufficiently small d, as an iterated integral, and the limit as <5->0 can be computed directly to prove (2). If =2^ is the union of disjoint line segments, the difference quotient is written as a sum of iterated integrals, and (2) again follows upon letting <5->-0. □ Proof of (1). By (47.1) there exists an Airy function cp for Sa/? on R0; thus 511 = 95,22' -^22 = ^,11- -^12 = -^,12. (d) AA<p = 0. (e) Since R0 is simply-connected, cp is single-valued; further, it follows from (d), (e), and our hypotheses on Sa/? that <p is analytic on R0 and of class C3 on ^0. Moreover, in view of (c), the relation <p(o) = m{o) in (47.2), (d) and (e) in the proof of (47.2), and the discussion given in the second paragraph following (47.1), we can assume, without loss in generality, that <P = <P,« = 0 on <g0. (f) Let W®=fSafiSal,da, (g) Ri so that ||S||,=]/F(/J. (h) Then (d) and (g) imply that W(l) = J <pial>(pal>da. (i) Ri In view of (e), we can write (i) in the form W{1) = / [95,195,11 — W.iii + 295,29^,12),1 Rt + (95,295,22- 95^,222- 295 95,112), i\ia> where /6(0, a). Thus (f) and Green's theorem yield the relation W(l) = - J (95,195,11 - 9595,111 + 295,2 95,12) d%s> and by (2) this relation, in turn, implies that W® = If I ^f'1 ^11 ~~ 95^.i" + 295,2 95,12) da. r\ 1 Knowles [1966, 12], Eq. (2.6).
Sect. 56. Knowles' version of Saint-Venant's principle. 203 Hence a fW(X) dX = - f {yA <ptll -<p<pini+2<P,2<P,i2) da> (J) since the integral on the right vanishes when I = a. Finally, since a f W(X) dX = - J (?>?! + <p% - <p <ptll)tl da, l Rt the integral over Rt in (j) can be transformed as follows by again applying Green's theorem and the boundary condition (f): fW{X)dX = f{<p\ + <p%- <p<pA1)dx2. (k) l S?i Next, by (i) and (2), dw(i) r ... —di~ = ~ \ <P,*P<P,*fidxi- (]) Thus given any scalar x, the formulae (k) and (1) imply the following identity: dW®+4x*fw(X)dX i J 0?n + 9^32+2^12- 4»2(9P?i + <f?t—<P<p,ii)] dx2. dl I (m) Letting F(l) = W(I) + 2xf W(X) dX, (n) i we can write (m) in the form -¾ + 2x F(l) = - f([Vt u + 2*V)2 js?« (°) after a rearrangement of terms in the integrand on the right side of (m). Our next objective is to determine a rx>sitive_yalue for x for which the right sjde_of JpJ is non-positive. To do so we make use of the following inequality. Hip is a smooth function on the closed interval [t0, /J, and if y>(t0) =^(4) =0, then A^wA^- (p)i where ip is the derivative of yi. This inequality reflects the fact that ^/½-¾)2 is the smallest characteristic value associated with the problem of minimizing ff2dt, 1 For a discussion of inequalities of this type, reference may be made to § 0.6 of Temple and Bickley [1956, 14]. A direct proof of (p) can be found in Hardy, Littlewood, and Polya [1959, 6].
204 M. E. Guriin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 56. with the minimum taken over all smooth functions f on [t0, /J that vanish at the end points and have *i fy>2di = i. h We require a slight generalization of (p). If, for fixed I€(0, a), f is a smooth function (of x2) on SPlt and if y> vanishes at the end points of each line segment that constitutes .=2^, then J f% d x 2 ^ |2- J y>2 d x2. (q) This inequality follows upon decomposing the integral on the left in (q) into a sum of integrals over the constituent line segments of 3?lt applying (p) to each of these, and observing that the length of each line segment is at most b. Fix /€(0, a). Since <ptl vanishes on ^0, it vanishes at the end points of the line segments that form J?;. Thus, because of the smoothness of <p, we may take f in (q) equal to <ptl with the result that J <PAi dx2 ^ p" J <P*idx2 we can write (o) in the f |2 + 2xF(l) ^- f [(-J- -4xj 9?! +tf,t-4x*cp%-4x*<p* v2 In view of this inequality, we can write (o) in the form dF(l) dl Alternatively, we can let f — <pt 2 in (q) with the result that / <pf22 dxz ^ ~ / <pfa dx2, set sei and this result when substituted into (r) yields dF(l) /"!/■>■** \ . /»* ~dl We now assume that dx2. (r) \f +2xF®?Z- f [(^-4^)^ + (½-4#)tf*-A*<fi dx2. (s) so that the coefficients of q?t and <p*2 in (s) are non-negative. Then we may take y> = cp in (q) and infer from (s) that 2$. + 2xF(l) £ - [(-J -4**) £ - 4*] J> dx2. The polynomial in x in the bracket has one positive zero, namely k where "-t> >-'(*-;-'?■ This value of x satisfies if). We now choose this value of x and conclude that F(l) satisfies the differential inequality ^ + 2xF(l)^0, 0<l<a. (u)
Sect. 56. Knowles' version of Saint-Venant's principle. 205 The inequality (u) implies that F{l)^F{0)e-*Kl, 0<l<a. Since x ^ 0, (i) and (n) imply that W{1) ^F{0) e~2*>, O^l^a. thus (v) (w) It remains to compute an upper bound for F(0). If we insert (n) into the left side of (v), we obtain an inequality which may be written in the form dl 1JW{X) dk < F(0)e -\xl Integrating both sides of this inequality from /=0 to 1= a, we find, with the aid of (n), that « r u $W{X) dX £ -¾ (1 - *-«"•) = ^ W(0) + 2xj W(X) dl (1— e-ixa) Therefore lxfw{X) dX: 1 — e-ixa 'X+e—*** W(0)£W{0), (X) and this result when inserted into (n) with 1=0 yields the inequality F{0)^2W{0). The inequalities (w) and (x) imply that W(l)^2W(0)e-2*1, O^l^a; in view of (i), this is the desired result. □ As was noted by Knowles,1 when R is a rectangular domain subject to self- equilibrated tractions along one edge, the optimum choice of the constant k in the estimate |S||^1/2|S||0, b s approximately 4.2.a Thus the universal constant k in (1) appears, in this particular case, to be conservative by a factor of approximately three. As is clear from the relation on page 152, the strain energy U{t) of Rt is given by U(l) = {JSapE^dv = V f[S«l>S°<l>-vSvv)dv- 1 [1966,12], p. 11. 2 See, e.g., Fadle [1940, 1], Horvay [1957, 9], and Babuska, Rektorys, and Vycichlo [1955, £]• The discussion by Babuska, Rektorys, and Vycichlo of the exponential decay of stresses in the rectangular case appears to be in error in that the roots of smallest modulus of the equation sin2 ^-z2 = o are underestimated by a factor of two (cf. Fadle [1940,1]).3 3 Knowles [1966, 12], p. 11, footnote 1.
206 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 56 a. If we assume that fi>0, 0< v < i, then the inequality (1 — 2 v) Sa/? Sap ;£ Sa/? Sap — v Syy 5g Sa/? Sa/? is easily derived using the same procedure as was used to establish (24.6). Thus -*■■;? \S\,£U(DZ-±\Sl. and the inequality in (1) can be written in the form M U{l)^-^U(0)e- b Knowles1 also proved that under the hypotheses of (1) the stresses satisfy the inequality where 6 is the distance from the point (%, x2) to the boundary of ^¾ and k is defined in (1). Note that this inequality is poor at points which are close to the boundary. "" ~~ 56 a. The Zanaboni-Robinson version of Saint-Venant's principle. (Added in proof.) This version of the principle is concerned with a one-parameter family Bv (0 < I < oo) of bodies (bounded regular regions) such that BTCB, (r<l) and B(r,l) = Bl-Br (r<l) has a regular interior. We assume given a continuous, symmetric, positive definite elasticity field C on " \FBl, ie [o, oo) a regular surface £f such that tf'CdBj (0<l<oo), and integrable surface tractions s on £f such that J sda = fpxs da=0. (1) Zanaboni-Robinson theorem? For each lC-[0, oo) let [ul,El,Sl] be an elastic state on Bt corresponding to the elasticity field C (restricted to BJ, to zero body forces, and to the following surface tractions: S;=s on £?, s,= 0 on dBt-y. Let U{T,I) = tfEfC[E,-\dv (t</). B(r,0 1 [1966, 12], Theorem 2. See also Roseman [1967, 12]. 2 The precise version stated here is due to Robinson [1966, 21], § 9.7; the underlying ideas, however, are contained in the work of Zanaboni [1937, 6, 7, 8]. See also Segenreich [1P7L £}• wn0 established interesting corollaries of this theorem.
Sect. 57. Some further results for homogeneous and isotropic bodies. 207 Then lim U(r, 1) = 0. r,l—*-oo r<l For the proof of this theorem we refer the reader to the book by Robinson.1 XI. Miscellaneous results. 57. Some further results for homogeneous and isotropic bodies. In this section we shall establish some results appropriate to homogeneous and isotropic bodies. Given a smooth vector field u on B and a closed regular surface if in B, we define the vector field * (u) on £f by2 * (u) = (X +2/j) (div u) n -\-/n (curl u) x n, where n is the unit outward normal to £f? The first theorem, which is due to Fosdick2, shows that the vector field t(u) when integrated over dB gives the actual load on the boundary. (1) Let £f be a closed regular surface in B. Further, let u be a smooth vector field on E, and let s be the corresponding surface traction field on if: s=fi(Vu-\- VuT) n + X(divu) n. Then f t(u)da= f sda. Proof. Since (curl m)xm = (Vu — VuT) n, it follows that s — t (u) = 2fi [VuT — (div u) 1] n, and thus that / sda— J t(u) da = 2/x f [VuT — (div u) 1] n da. Letting T denote the skew tensor field whose axial vector is u, we conclude from (15) of (4.1>that / s da— J t(u) da = — 2/j, / (curlT)Tnda, and the desired result follows from Stokes' theorem (6.2). □ Note that since dB is the union of closed surfaces £fx, ..., £fN, if u is constant on each £fn, then (1) implies f t(u)'uda = f s-uda; dB dB thus, in this instance, "the work done by t(u)" is equal to the work done by s. (2) Reciprocal theorem.* Let u and u be elastic displacement fields of class C2 on B corresponding to body force fields b and b, respectively. Then ft(u)-uda-\-fb-udv = ft(u),uda-\-fb-udv dB B dB B — I [(^ + 2/it) (divh) (divii) -\-/j,(cut\u) • (curlit)] dv. B 1 [1966, 211 §9-7. 2 Fosdick [1968, 5]. 3 Sometimes we will take SP=dB. It will be clear from the context when this is the case. 4 Weyl [1915, 3], p. 6; Fosdick [1968, 5],
208 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 57. Proof Let I(u, u) denote the last term in the above relation. It follows from the identity / (it X curl u) -nda= J (curl u) ■ (curl u) dv — / u • curl curl u dv dB B B in conjunction with the definition of t (u) that J t(u) •iida= J [(X-\-2/j,)(divu) ii • n + /j,(uxcurlu) -n] da dB dB = I(u,u) -f f [(X + 2fi) Vdivu — fi curl curl u] -udv. B But since u is an elastic displacement field, (A + 2/n) Pdiv u — fi curl curl u + b = 0.1 Therefore /£(tt) •#<£«+ / b • udv = I(u, ii), dB B and, since I(u, u) —I(u, u), the proof is complete. □ If we let u = u and b = b in (2j, we arrive at the following result, which is an analog of the theorem of work and energy (28.3). (3) Kelvin's theorem.2 Let u be an elastic displacement field of class C2 on B corresponding to the body force field b. Then f t(u) -uda-j- f b •udv = 2G{u}, dB B where G{u} = ^J [{X + 2[j) (divu)2+^|curl m|2] dv. B In view of the remark made following the proof of (1), when u is constant on each closed surface comprising dB, the left-hand sides of the relations in (3) and (28.3) coincide; therefore, in this instance, G{u} — U{E}. In particular, it follows that G{u} is equal to the strain energy when the displacement field vanishes on the boundary. Theorem (3) yields a much simpler proof3 for the uniqueness theorem (32.2) when B is homogeneous and isotropic. Indeed, if u = 0 on dB and b=0 on B, then Kelvin's theorem implies G{u} = 0. But if C or — C is strongly elliptic, we conclude from (25.1) that /j, (A + 2fj) > 0, and hence that divtt = 0, curltt = 0, which implies A u — 0. But if u is harmonic and vanishes on dB, then u must also vanish on B, and the proof is complete. Since B is homogeneous and isotropic, the functional 0 of the principle of minimum potential energy (34.2) has the form 0{u} = f [-£- IVu + VuT\2 + * (divtt)2 dv- fb-udv- fs-uda, B B & 1 This identity is derived on pp. 90-91. 2 Kelvin [1888, 4]. See also Weyl [1915, 3], p. 6. 3 This argument is due to Ericksen and Toupin [1956, 3]. See also Duffin and Noll [1958, S], Gurtin and Sternberg [i960, 7].
Sect. 57- Some further results for homogeneous andjsotropicjbodies. 209 as is clear from (24.5). If we confine our attention to the displacement problem, we can establish a minimum principle much simpler in nature than the principle of minimum potential energy. (4) Minimum principle for the displacement problem1. Consider the displacement problem for which 6^ — dB. Let s/ be the set of all kinematically admissible displacement fields, and let % be the functional on si defined by x{u}=G{u}— J b -udv B for every ues/. Then given u£s#, }{{u}^x{u} for all u€ s/if and only if u is a displacement field corresponding to a solution of the displacement problem. The proof of (4) follows at once from (34.2) by virtue of the following theorem, which establishes the connection between the functional 0 and x. (5)2 Suppose that the hypotheses of (4) hold. Let si be the set of all kinematically admissible displacement fields and let X{u}=x{u} — 0{u} for every ues/. Then A{tt}=A{tt'} for every u, u'£s/; i.e. A {it} is independent of u. Proof. Let uesf. Since \carl u\2 = Vu-(Vu-VuT), | Vu + VuT\ 2 = 2 Vu • (Vu + VuT), it follows that A {it} —fi J {(divtt)2 — Vu • VuT} dv =/n f div[tt(divu) — (Vu) u] dv. B B Thus X{u}=fi J tjda, tj = [u (div u) — (Vu)u]-n. dB We now complete the argument by showing that r\ depends solely on the boundary displacement it, which is common to all members of si'. Let the origin 0 of the cartesian frame be an arbitrary regular point of dB, and choose the frame so that the plane x3=0 coincides with the tangent plane of dB at 0, the pointing in the direction of the inner normal of dB at 0. For this choice of coordinates, 3«, , 3«, /3«, , 3«o\ , „ ,, ,=^+^_.._^__i_ + ._x) atO. (a) In a neighborhood of 0 the boundary dB admits the parametrization % = £i. *% = &%, *s =»*(©. 5=(¾.¾. (b) where ■Jjr(°)=° («=i-2). (c) Further, if we agree to write u(t-) =^(¾. |2< M£i> £2))» then, since uesf, u(x) — ii(£,) 1 Love [1906, 5], § 116. See also Gurtin and Sternberg [i960, 7], Theorem 2. 2 Gurtin and Sternberg [I960, 7], Theorem 3. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 14
210 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 58. in the neighborhood under consideration. Thus by (b)-(c) ■£-(0)=|j> (.=1.2). and we conclude from (a) that v=Ul^+U2.8^Ua^y + .dJL} at0. Therefore rj at 0 depends exclusively on the boundary data u. But the point 0 was an arbitrarily chosen regular point of dB. Thus A{u} depends solely on the boundary data u; hence A{u} — A{u'} for every u, u'es/. □ 58. Incompressible materials. An incompressible body is one for which only isochoric motions are possible, or equivalently only motions that satisfy divtt = 0. For a linearly elastic incompressible body the stress is specified by the strain tensor only up to an arbitrary pressure. Thus S+pl = C[E], where p = -±trS and C = Cx is a linear transformation from the space of traceless symmetric tensors into itself.1 The symmetry group ^x for the material at x is the set of all orthogonal tensors Q such that QC[E]Q*=C[QEQT] for every traceless symmetric tensor E. This definition is consistent, since tr (QEQT) = tr (QTQE) =trE = 0 when Q is orthogonal. If the material is isotropic, then (iii) of (22.1) is still valid; therefore C [E]=2ftE, and hence 8+^1 = 2^. Thus there is but one elastic constant for an isotropic and incompressible material— the shear modulus /j,. The fundamental field equations for the time-independent behavior of a linearly elastic incompressible body are therefore div tt=0, E = k{Vu + VuT), S+pi=C[E], p = -itr8, (a) divS + b=0. 1 We could also begin by assuming that S+p\ = C[Vu\; the steps leading to the reduction C [Vu] — C [JEJ would then be exactly the same those given in Sect. 20.
Sect. 58. Incompressible materials. 211 If we combine these relations, we are led to the displacement equation of equilibrium divC[Vu]-Vp+b=0, which for a homogeneous and isotropic body reduces to /j,Au-Vp+b=0. (b) Since u is divergence-free, Zl^>=divb; (c) hence in the absence of body forces the pressure p is harmonic. In view of (a)x and (3) of (4.1), we can also write (b) in the form ~ ficurl curlu-\-Vp — b = 0. On the other hand, if b = 0, then (b) and (c) imply that A curl it = 0, AAu = 0. Since tr E = 0, the compatibility equation (14.3) has the following form for an incompressible body: AE-VdivE-(VdivE)T = 0. If the body is homogeneous and isotropic, then the same procedure used on p. 92 to derive the stress equation of compatibility now yields AS-2VVp + 2Vb + {div b) 1 = 0, which in the absence of body forces has the simple form AS-2VVp=0. For an isotropic incompressible material the surface traction on the boundary dB takes the form s=Sn — —pn+fi(Vu-\-VuT) n. Using the steps given on p. 93, we can also write this relation as follows: s = —pn-\-2fi-g \-finxcuxlu. We define, for an incompressible elastic body, the notion of an elastic state in the same manner as before,1 except that the constitutive relation is replaced by (a)3 and the incompressibility condition (a)x is added. If this is done, the theorem of work and energy (28.3) remains valid for incompressible bodies, where, as before, U{E}=^fE-C[E]dv, B but now, of course, E is required to be traceless. The crucial step in proving this result is to note that if S and E obey (a)3, then S-E = -pl-E+E-C[E]=E-C[E], since 1 • E =tr E =0. Using a similar result, it is a simple matter to verify that Betti's reciprocal theorem (30.1) also remains valid. ^-95- 14*
212 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 59. If we define the mixed problem as before,1 then steps exactly the same as those used to establish (32.1) now yield the (1) Uniqueness theorem for an incompressible body. Assume that the body is incompressible and that the elasticity field C is positive definite. Let 6 = [u, E, S] and 3 = [u, E, S] be two solutions of the same mixed problem. Then 4 and 4 are equal modulo a rigid displacement and a uniform pressure, i.e. [u, E,S] = [u + w,E,S+pl], where w is a rigid displacement field and p is a scalar constant. Moreover, w = 0 if <fx + 0, while p=Oif ^+ 0. The principle of minimum potential energy (34.1) remains valid in the present circumstances provided we require that the kinematically admissible states satisfy div u = 0 and change the last few words to read: " only ifi — a modulo a rigid displacement and a uniform pressure." On the other hand, the principle of minimum complementary energy (34.3) remains valid if we replace &k{S} by Uk{S-\~P 1}, where p = — J tr S and K is the inverse of C, and if we change the last few words to read: "only ii S=S modulo a uniform pressure." E. Elastodynamics. I. The fundamental field equations. Elastic processes. Power and energy. Reciprocity. 59. The fundamental system of field equations. The fundamental system of field equations describing the motion of a linear elastic body consists of the strain-displacement relation E=j?(Vu + FuT), the stress-strain relation S = C[E], and the equation of motion2 div S-\-b—Qii. Here u, E, S, and 6 are the displacement, strain, stress, and body force fields defined on B x (0, /0)> where (0, /0) is a given interval of time, while C and q are the elasticity and density fields over B. Since C[E]—C[Vu], if the displacement field is sufficiently smooth, these equations combine to yield the displacement equation of motion: div C[Vu\ -\-b=Qti, which in components has the form (CijkiUkil)tj + bi=Qui. It is a simple matter to verify that, conversely, if u satisfies the displacement equation of motion, and if E and S are defined by the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations, then the equation of motion is satisfied. lp. 102. 2 Since the values of C^ [•] are assumed to be symmetric tensors, we need not add the requirement that S = ST.
Sect. 59- The fundamental system of field equations. 213 Assume for the moment that the body is homogeneous and isotropic. Then the procedure used to derive (a) on p. 90 now yields Navier's equation of motion1 [iAu-\-{X-\-[i) V6ivu-\-b =gu. (a) By (3) of (4.1), this equation may be written in the alternative form8 (A + 2[i) V div u —fi curl curl u + b = qii. If we assume that A + 2[i, [i, and q are positive, we can define constants q and *-f¥-- c«-l/f; <b> in terms of these constants the above equation becomes c\ Vdivu — c\ curl curl u-\ =u. (c) For convenience, we introduce the wave operators Qi and d2 defined by Uj=clAf-'f (cc = l,2). Then, since —e--_Cl-c2, Navier's equation (a) can be written in the form3 □2u+ (4-4) Vdiv u + -=0. (d) Assume now that b = 0. It is clear from (c) and (3) of (4.1) that4 curl u = 0 => Di u = 0, div w = 0=> 02^ = 0- For this reason, we call cx the irrotational velocity, c2 the isochoric velocity. Operating on Navier's equation, first with the divergence and then with the curl, we find that5 □1 divw = 0, (e) □ 2CUI"1M = 0- Thus the dilatation div u satisfies a wave equation with speed clt while the rotation J curl u satisfies a wave equation with speed c2. Clearly, 1 = ][J+2JL = 1/2<1-V> . 1 This relation was first derived by Navier [1823, 2], [1827, 2] in 1821. Navier's theory, which is based on a molecular model, is limited to situations for which fi = A. The general relation involving two elastic constants first appears in the work of Cauchy [1828, 1]; cf. Poisson [1829, 2], Lam£ and Clapeyron [1833, 1], Stokes [1845, 1], Lame [1852, 2], § 26. a Lame and Clapeyron [1833, 1], Lame [1852, 2], § 26. 3 Cauchy [1840, 1], p. 120. 4 The first of these results is due to Lame [1852, 2], § 61-62; the second to Cauchy [1840, 1], p. 137. 6 Cauchy [1828, 1], [1840,2], pp.120, 137- See also Lame and Clapeyron [1833,2], Stokes [1851, 1], Lame [1852, 2], § 27.
214 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 59. thus for most materials c1>c2, so that dilatational waves travel faster than rotational waves.1 In fact, cx=2c2 when v—^. Next, if we apply Qi to (a) (with 6=0) and use the first of (e), we arrive at HilpAu — Qii) = 0, or equivalently,2 DiD2m = 0. (f) Eq. (f) and the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations imply that Din2^=Din2s=o. Eqs. (e) are counterparts of the harmonicity of div u and curl u in the static theory; (f) is the counterpart of the biharmonicity of u. We now drop the assumption that B be homogeneous and isotropic. The quantity represents the total energy per unit volume. If C is symmetric, then the stress- strain and strain-displacement relations imply that e=S • Vu-{-qU-u. Thus, if we define q = — Su, we are led, with the aid of the equation of motion, to the following result: e-\-div q = b-u. (g) The quantity q is called the energy-flux vector, and (g) expresses a local form of balance of energy. Next, operating on the equation of motion with the symmetric gradient V and using the strain-displacement relation, we find that If we assume that C is invertible, so that E = K[S], where K is the compliance field, we arrive at the stress equation of motion3 If q is independent of x, this relation takes the form V{div S + b)=gK[S]. If, in addition, the material is isotropic, then the formula on page 78 giving E in terms of S yields K[S]=|[(l+y)S-y(trS)l], 1 In seismology waves traveling with speed or are called primary waves (P-waves), those with speed ca are called secondary waves (S-waves). a Cauchy [1840,1], p. 137- 3 Ignaczak [1963, 14] generalizing results of Valcovici [1951, 12] for a homogeneous, isotropic body and Iacovache [1950,6] for a homogeneous, isotropic, and incompressible body. See also Ignaczak [1959, 8], Teodorescu [1965, 19].
Sect. 60. Elastic processes. Power and energy. 215 where /5 is Young's modulus and v is Poisson's ratio; thus p(Vdiv S + Vb)=Q[(l+v)S-v(trS)l]. Given initial values u0 and v0 for u and u, the stress equation of motion implies the fundamental system in the following sense: let S satisfy this equation and the initial conditions S(-,0)=C[Vu0], S(.,0)=C[Vr0]; let E be defined by the inverted stress-strain relation; and let u be the unique solution of the equation of motion with the initial values u0 and v0. Then the strain-displacement relation holds, and hence [u, E, S] satisfies the fundamental system of equations. The fact that in elastodynamics the fundamental system of field equations is equivalent to a single equation for the stress tensor is most interesting, especially when compared to the equilibrium theory where (for a simply-connected body) the fundamental system is equivalent to a pair of equations: the stress equations of compatibility and equilibrium. 60. Elastic processes. Power and energy. By an admissible process we mean an ordered array p = [u, E, S] with the following properties: (i) u is an admissible motion ;x (ii) E is a continuous symmetric tensor field on B X [0, t0); (iii) S is a time-dependent admissible stress field.2 Clearly, the set of all admissible processes is a vector space provided we define addition and scalar multiplication in the natural manner; i.e. as we did for admissible states.3 We say that p = [u, E, S] is an elastic process (on B) corresponding to the body force 6 if p is an admissible process and E = ±(Vu + VuT), S = C[E], div S+b=Qii. As before, the surface force field s is then defined at every regular point of 95x[0,y by s(x, t) = S(x,t) n(x), and we call the pair [6, s] the external force system for p. If u(.,0)=u(-.0)=0 (I) on B, we can extend p smoothly to B X (— oo, t0) by defining w=0 and E = S=0 onBx(- oo,0). When (I) holds we call the resulting extended process p an elastic process with a quiescent past.* Further, to be consistent, we also extend the external force system by assuming that 6 and s vanish for negative time. 1 Cf. p. 43- a Cf. p. 49. 3 Cf. p. 95- 4 This terminology is due to Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16].
216 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 60. When we discuss the basic singular solutions of elastodynamics, we will be forced to deal with processes whose domain is of the form $$ X [0, oo), where £ is a point of $ and We say that p = [u, E, S] is an elastic process on $$ corresponding to 6 if u, E, S and b are functions on $% x [0, oo) and given any closed regular subregion PC^j, the restriction of p to P X [0, oo) is an elastic process on P corresponding to the restriction of 6 to Px [0, oo). When we omit mention of the domain of definition of an elastic process, it will always be understood to be Bx [0, t0). The following simple proposition will be extremely useful. (1) If [u, E, S] is an elastic process corresponding to the body force field b, then given any te(0,t0), [«(•,<), E {•,(), S(>,t)] is an elastic state corresponding to the body force b—qii. Given an elastic process, we call the function °tt on [0, t0) defined by the total energy. Here K is the kinetic energy: K — \ J qu2 dv, B U is the strain energy: U = Uc{E}=%fE-C[E]dv. B If C is symmetric, U = J / {E ■ C[E] +E • C[E]} dv = f E • C[E] dv = f S • E dv; B B B therefore the rate of change of total energy equals the rate of change of kinetic energy plus the stress power.1 This fact and the theorem of power expended (19.1) together yield the (2) Theorem of power and energy. Assume that C is symmetric. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic process corresponding to the external force system [6, s]. Then fs-uda-\-fb-udv =<%, BB B where % is the total energy. This theorem asserts that the rate at which work is done by the surface and body forces equals the rate of change of total energy. The following proposition, which is an immediate corollary of (2), will be useful in establishing uniqueness. (3) Assume that C is symmetric. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic process corresponding to the external force system [6, s], and suppose that 6 == 0 on B, s-u = 0 on 35. Then the total energy is constant, i.e. <&(t)=<&(0), 0^t<t0. 1 Cf. p. 65.
Sect. 60. Elastic processes. Power and energy. 217 Another interesting corollary of (2) may be deduced as follows. By (2) / / s-udadt + / / b-udvdt =<%{r) —%{0). 0 dB OB The left-hand side of this expression is the work done in the time interval [0, r]. If the initial state [«(•, 0), £(•, 0), S(-, 0)] is an unstrained state of rest, i.e. if £(.,0)=0, u(. ,0)=0, then #(0)=0. If, in addition, the elasticity tensor is positive semi-definite and the density positive, then #(r) Sg 0 and r r / / s-iida dt+ // b -iidvdt^O; 0 dB 0B in words, the work done starting from an unstrained rest state is always nonnegative.1 The next theorem, which is of interest in itself, forms the basis of a very strong uniqueness theorem for elastodynamics. For the purpose of this theorem we assume that the underlying time-interval [0, t0) is equal to [0, oo). (4) Brun's theorem.2 Assume that C is symmetric. Let [u, E, S] be an elastic process corresponding to the external force system [6, s], and suppose that u(. ,0)=0, £(.,0)=0. Let P(a, /5) = / s (x, a) • u(x, /5) dax + / 6 (x, a) • u(x, /5) dvx BB B for all a, /Se [0, oo). Then U(t) -K{t) =%f[P(t + X, t-X) -P(t-l t +X)] dX (0£t<oo), o where U is the strain energy and K the kinetic energy. Proof. By (18.2) with 6 replaced by 6(., a) —gii(•, a), s by s (•,<*), u by m(-,/S), andSby C[£(.,a)], P(a, ft = / {C[B(«)J • £(/9) +<>« (a) •«(/?)} iw, (a) where, for convenience, we have suppressed the argument x. Next, in view of the symmetry of C and the initial vanishing of the strain field, ff {C [E(t +X)]-E(t-X)-C [E{t - X)] -E(t+X)}dXdv B0 (b) = - ff -^- {C[E(t + X)]-E(t-X)}dXdv = 2U{t). B0 Similarly, // g{u(t+X) • ii(t-X) -ii(t-X) ■ ii(t + X)} dXdv = -2K(t), (c) B0 and (a), (b), and (c) imply the desired result. □ 1 Some related inequalities are given by Martin [1964, 14]. a Brun [1965, 4], Eq. (7b); [1969, 2].
218 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 61. 61. Graffi's reciprocal theorem. We shall assume throughout this section that the elasticity field is symmetric. Given an elastic process p = [w, E, S] corresponding to 6, we call the pair «„=«(•, 0), »„ = «(•, 0) the initial data for p and the function / defined by f(x, t)=i*b(x, t)+g(x) [«„(x) +tv0(x)} the associated pseudo body force field. Here, as before, i is the function on [0, t0) defined by i(t)=t. Betti's reciprocal theorem has the following important counterpart in elasto- dyn amies: (1) Graffi's reciprocal theorem.1 Let [u, E, S] and [u, E, S] be elastic processes corresponding to the external force systems [6, s] and [b, §]. Further, let [u0, v0] and [u0, v0] be the corresponding initial data, f and f the corresponding pseudo body force fields. Then i* f s*uda-\- f f*udv=i* f s*uda-\- ff*udv, (a) BB B BB B J S*Edv= J~S*Edv, (b) B B J s*iida-\- f b*udv-{- J q(u0- u-\-v0- u) dv BB B ^ B (C) = J s*uda-{- J b*udvJr f q(u0-u-\-v0-u) dv. »B B B Thus if both processes correspond to null initial data, then / s*uda-\- / b*iidv= J s*uda-\- / b*udv. (d) BB B BB B Proof. In view of the reciprocal theorem (19.5), it suffices to show that S*E=S*E. By definition, S*E(t) = J S(t-r)-E(r)dr, o where, for convenience, we have omitted the dependence of these functions on a?. Since C is symmetric, S(t-r)-E(r) =JB(t) ■ C[E(t-r)] =E{t — r) • C[E(r)] =E{t-r) • S(t). Thus S*E(t)=E*S(t)=S*E(t). n 1 The result (c) for homogeneous and isotropic bodies is due to Graffi [1939, 3], [1947, 2], [1954, 6], whose proof is based on Betti's theorem and systematic use of the Laplace transform. Later, Graffi [1963, 8] gave a direct proof utilizing the properties of the convolution. Hu [1958, 10] noticed that Graffi's results extend trivially to inhomogeneons and anisotropic bodies; however, Hu gave his results in the Laplace transform domain rather than the time domain. Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16], assuming homogeneity and isotropy, gave an extension of Graffi's theorem valid for infinite regions; their result was extended to homogeneous but anisotropic bodies by Wheeler [1970, 3]. Ainola [1966 2], showed that Graffi's theorem can be derived from a variational principle. Some interesting applications of Graffi's theorem are given by DiMaggio and Bleich [1959, 4] and Payton [1964, 16].
Sect. 62. The boundary-initial-value problem of elastodynamics. 219 Graffi1 also noticed that if both systems correspond to null external forces, then (c) implies J q(u0-u-\-v0-u) dv= f e(u0-ii-\~v0-u) dv; B B if, in addition, v0=v0 = 0, then / qu0-udv= f qu0- udv. B B This relation can be used to establish the orthogonality of the displacement fields corresponding to distinct modes of free vibration.2 For the remainder of this section let t0 = oo. We say that two external force systems [b, s] and [6, s] are synchronous if there exists a continuous scalar function g on [0, oo) such that b (x, t) = b0 (x) g(t), b (x, t) = b0 (x) g (t) for all (x, t)eBx [0, oo) and s (x, t) = s0 (x) g(t), s (x, t) = s0 (x) g (t) for all (x,t)edB x[0, oo). The next theorem shows that for synchronous external force systems a reciprocal theorem holds having the same form as Betti's theorem in elastostatics. (2) Reciprocal theorem for synchronous external force systems.3 Let [u, E, S] and [u, E, S] be elastic processes corresponding to null initial data and to synchronous external force systems [6, s] and [6, §]. Then fs-uda-\-fb-udv= fs-uda-\- / b-udv. dB B dB B Proof. By hypothesis and (d) of (1), g*<p=o, where <p = f s0-uda-j- f b0-u dv— fs0-uda—fb0-udv, dB B dB B and we conclude from (v) of (10.1) that either g = 0 or 95=0. If g = 0 the theorem holds trivially. Thus assume <p = 0. Then gcp=0, and the desired result follows. □ II. Boundary-initial-value problems. Uniqueness. 62. The boundary-initial-value problem of elastodynamics. Throughout the following three sections we assume given the following data: a time interval [0, t0), an elasticity field C on B, a density field q on B, body forces 6 on Bx(0, t0), initial displacements u0 on B, initial velocities v0 on B, surface displacements u on <$^x(0, /0), and surface tractions s on y2x(0, /0). Given the above data, the mixed problem of elastodynamics consists in finding an elastic process [u, E, S] that corresponds to 6 and satisfies the initial conditions u(-,0) =u0 and u(-, 0)=v0 on B, 1 [1947,2]- a Cf. {76. 3) 3 Graffi [1947, 2].
220 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 62. the displacement condition u=u on <S^X(0, /0), and the traction condition s=s on S^2X(0, t0). We call such an elastic process a solution of the mixed problem.1 As before, when 6^ — dB («$"2 = 0) we refer to the displacement problem, when </>% = dB (£fx =0) we refer to the traction problem. To avoid repeated hypotheses we assume once and for all that: (i) C and q are smooth on B; (ii) 6 is continuous on B x [0, /0); (iii) u0 and v0 are continuous on B; (iv) u is continuous on^X [0, t0); (v) s is continuous in time and piecewise regular on £^x[0, t0). The following proposition is an immediate consequence of the remarks made in Sect. 59; its proof is completely analogous to the proof of (31.1) and can safely be omitted. (1) Characterisation of the mixed problem in terms of displacements. Let u be an admissible motion. Then u corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem if and only if div C [Vu] -\-b = Qtt on B x (0, t0), u(',0)=u0 and u(-,0)=v0 on B, u=u on S^,X(0, t0), C[Vu]n = s on S?2 X (0, t0). Further, when the body is homogeneous and isotropic, the first and last of these conditions may be replaced by (iAu + (X+/i) Fdivw + b =qu on Bx(0,t0), (j,(Vu + VuT)n-\-k(divu)n=s on S^X(0,t0). For the remainder of this section we assume that Q>0. (2) Characterization of the traction problem in terms of stresses.2 Assume that: (a) C is invertible on B; (/9) q, u0, and v0 are of class C2 on B; (y) b is of class C2>° on Bx [0, t0); (3) S is a time-dependent admissible stress field3 of class C3>2 on Bx[0,(0) with S continuous on Bx[0, t0). 1 See footnote 2 on p. 102. 2 Ignaczak [1963, 14] for the case in which u0 = «0=0. 3 See p. 49.
Sect. 62. The boundary-initial-value problem of elastodynamics. 221 Then S corresponds to a solution of the traction problem if and only if pp!+6.)=K[S] on Bx(0,t0), S(-,0)=C[Vu0] and S{-,0)=C[Vv0] on B, s=s on dBx(0,t0). Proof. The necessity of the above relations follows from the discussion given at the end of Sect. 59. The sufficiency also follows from this discussion, but we will give the argument in detail. Let S satisfy the above system of equations. Then, since S is a time-dependent admissible stress field, (1) S and div S are continuous onffx [0, /0); and, by (i) and (a), (2) K= C'1 is continuous on E. We now define u and E through the relations tt=i.^S±/, e=K[S], (a) where / is the pseudo body force field f{x, t) = i*b (x, t) + g {x) [«0 (*) + tv0 (x)], (b) i(t) = t. It then follows that u, S, and b satisfy the equation of motion,1 and that u satisfies the initial conditions. Next, by (ii), (iii), (/9), (y), (d), (1), (2), (a), and (b), (3) u, u,.u, E, and E are continuous on ffx[0, t0), while u is of class C2 on Bx[0,t0); _^_ (4) E is of class C°-2 on B X [0, t0), V{u) and Vu are continuous on B x [0, t0), and V(u) = Vu. To complete the proof we have only to show that the strain-displacement relation holds (for then we could conclude from (3) and (4) that u is an admissible motion). It follows from (4), (a)2, the first relation in (2), and the equation of motion that ij= K [S] = V (-^-) = V(u) = toi. (c) On the other hand, since u satisfies the initial conditions, we conclude from (a)2 and the initial conditions satisfied by S that E(..0)=Fu(.,0), E(.,0) = Pu{;0); (d) thus, by (c) and (d), E = Vu. □ An interesting consequence of theorem (62.2) and the uniqueness theorem (63.1) is that a body force field with Vlplg) skew induces zero stresses in the body; i.e., if dB is traction-free, if uo=vo=0, and if F(6/g) is skew, then S=0 and u—i*b\Q is a rigid motion. The next two theorems give alternative characterizations of the mixed problem in which the initial conditions are incorporated into the field equations. These results will be extremely useful in the derivation of variational principles. 1 Cf. the proof of (19.2).
222 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 63. (3)1 Let p — [u, E, S] be an admissible process. Then p is a solution of the mixed problem if and only if E = Pu, S = C[E], i*div S+f = QU on Bx [0, t0), and u = u on ,5¾ X (0, t0), s=s on y2X(0, t0). Proof. This theorem is a direct consequence of (19.2). □ (4) Characterisation of the mixed problem in terms of stresses.2 A ssume that hypotheses (a.), (/3), and (y) of (2) hold. Let S be a time-dependent admissible stress field of class C3,° on Bx [0, tQ), and suppose that S is continuous on Ex [0, t0). Then S corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem if and only if P^J}^8+Lj=K[S] onBx[0,t0), i*divS=QU—f on <S^x(0,£0), s = s on y2X (0, t0). Proof. Clearly, (l) and (2) in the proof of (2) hold. Assume that $ satisfies the above relations. If we define u=i*tor8+f Es=K[8]> e then (3) of (2) also holds, and it is not difficult to verify that Vu=E and u = u on £fx x (0, t0). It therefore follows from (3) that p= [u, E, S] is a solution of the mixed problem. Conversely, if ft is a solution of the mixed problem, then we conclude, with the aid of (3), that the relations in (4) hold. □ 63. Uniqueness. In this section we discuss the uniqueness question appropriate to the fundamental initial-boundary-value problems discussed in the preceding section. We assume throughout that the density q is continuous on B. We will first establish the classical uniqueness theorem of Neumann. We will then give a more general theorem due to Brun ; we present Neumann's theorem separately because its hypotheses are sufficiently general to include most applications, and because its proof is quite simple. (1) Uniqueness theorem for the mixed problem.3 Suppose that the density field is strictly positive and the elasticity field symmetric and positive semi- definite. Then the mixed problem of elastodynamics has at most one solution. Proof. Let p = [u, E, S] be the difference between two solutions. Then p corresponds to vanishing body forces and satisfies w(.,0)=m(.,0)=0 on B, (a) m=0 on 5¾ x (0, t0), s=0 on 5¾ X (0, i!0). (b) By (a) E(., 0)=0, (c) 1 Gurtin [1964, 8], Theorem 3.2. 2 Gurtin [1964, 8], Theorem 3.4. 3 Neumann [1885, 3], § 61. An interesting generalization was given by Hill [1967, 9].
Sect. 64. Some further extensions of the fundamental lemma. 223 and (a) and (c) yield «(0)=0, (d) where $11 is the total energy.1 Moreover, in view of (60.3), (b) and (d) yield <%{t)=0, 0<t<t0. (e) By definition fy is the sum of the kinetic and strain energies, and by hypothesis both of these energies are positive; therefore they must both vanish. In particular, fQUzdv=0, (f) B and, since Q>0, u = 0 on B x (0, t0). This fact, when combined with the first of (a), yields u = 0 on B x (0, t0), and the proof is complete. □ Recently Brun has established the following major generalization of Neumann's theorem (1); it is important to note that no assumptions other than symmetry are placed on the elasticity field. We suppose for the purpose of this theorem that ;0=oo, so that the underlying time interval is [0, oo). (2) Extended uniqueness theorem.2 Suppose that the density field is strictly positive (or negative) and the elasticity field symmetric. Then the mixed problem of elastodynamics has at most one solution. Proof. As in the proof of (1), let p = [u, E, S] be the difference between two solutions. Then p corresponds to vanishing body forces and satisfies (a), (b), and (c) in the proof of (1). Thus we conclude from Bran's theorem (60.4) that U{t)-K{t)=0, 0^t«x>. (a) On the other hand, by (e) in the proof of (1), which also holds in the present circumstances, U(t)+K(t)=0, 0<t<oo. (b) Thus i£(£) = 0 and the last few steps in (1) yield the desired conclusion that u=o. a III. Variational principles. 64. Some further extensions of the fundamental lemma. We now establish, for functions of position and time, counterparts of the lemmas established in Sect. 35- With this in mind, we introduce the following definition. We say that a function / on Bx[0,t0) vanishesnear SfCdB if there exists a neighborhood N of £f such that / = 0 on (Nr« B)x[0, t0). 1 See p. 216. 2 Brun [1965, 4], [1969, 2]. This theorem was established independently by Knops and Payne [1968,11], using an entirely different method. For the displacement problem appropriate to a homogeneous and isotropic body, Gurtin and Sternberg [1961, 10] proved that uniqueness holds provided both wave speeds are positive; i.e. provided q is positive and the elasticity field strongly elliptic. This result was extended to anisotropic, but homogeneous, bodies by Gurtin andTouriN [1965, 9]. Hayes and Knops [1968, 7] showed, without assuming C symmetric, that uniqueness also holds when — C is strongly elliptic. Of course, the extended uniqueness theorem (2) includes as special cases Neumann's theorem and all of the above results except that of Hayes and Knops. See also Knops and Payne [1971, 2], § 8, for a thorough discussion of uniqueness in elastodynamics.
224 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 64. (1)1 Let W be a finite-dimensioned inner product space. Let w: Bx[0, Q->W be continuous and satisfy J w*v(x,t) dvx = 0 (0^t<t0) B for every class C°° function v. Bx[0, t0)->W that vanishes near 8B. Then w = 0 on B x [0, t0). Proof. Let /,, (t) denote the open interval (t— h, r+h), and for /a(t)C (0, t0) let Wh (t) be the set of all C°° scalar functions y on [0, t0) with the properties: (a) ^>0 on Ik{x), (b) y=0 on [0,t0)-Ih(r). It is clear from the discussion at the beginning of Sect. 7 that Wh (t) is not empty. Let ej, e2,..., e„ be an orthonormal basis in W, and let » w= 2 wiei- »■=1 As in the proof of the fundamental lemma (7.1), we assume that for some (x0, t)gBx(0, t0) and some integer k, wk{x0, t)>0. Then there exists an h>0 such that £h(x0)cB, Ih(r)C(0, t0), and wk>0 on £k(x0) xlk(r). Let v(x,s)=<p(x)f(s) ek, where2 <pe 0h(x0),ye Wh(t — x), and t£ (r+h, t0). Then v is of class C°° on B x [0,t0), vanishes near 8B, and J w*v(x, t) dvx= J J w(x, t — s) -v(x, s) ds dvx B BO t = /J'zMaM—s) <p(x)yi{s) ds dvx B 0 t-r+h = / / wk(x, t— s) cp{x)ip{s)dsdvx>0, M*>) t—t-h which is a contradiction. Thus w=Q on Bx\0,t0). □ The proofs of the next three lemmas can safely be omitted; they are completely analogous, respectively, to the proofs of (35.1), (35.2), and (35.3) and utilize the procedure given in the proof of (1). (2)3 Let Wbe a finite-dimensional inner product space. Let w. y% x [0, t0) -*-W be piecewise regular and continuous in time, and assume that Jw*v(x, t) dax=0 (0^t<t0) for every class C°° function v: Bx[0, t0) -*-W that vanishes near 3\. Then w = 0 on ^x[0, t0). 1 Gurtin [1964, 8], Lemma 2.1. 2 <X>h (a;0) is defined in Sect. 7. 3 Gurtin [1964, 8], Lemma 2.2.
Sect. 65. Variational principles. 225 (3)1 Let ubea vector field on £^ x [0, t0) that is piecewise regular and continuous in time, and suppose that J (Sn) *u(x, t) dVn = 0 (0 ^t<t0) for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on Ex[0, t0) which vanishes near y2. Then « = 0 on ^x[0, t0). (4)2 Let ubea vector field on y2 x [0, t0) that is piecewise regular and continuous in time, and suppose that /w*divS(ac, t) dvx = 0 (0^t<t0) for every class C°° symmetric tensor field S on Bx [0, t0). Then M = 0 on £?2x[0,t0). 65. Variational principles. In this section we will establish several variational principles for elastodynamics. In addition to hypotheses (i)-(v)3 of Sect. 62 we assume throughout that the elasticity field C is symmetric. We begin by giving Kirchhoff's generalization of Hamilton's principle in particle mechanics. By a kinematically admissible process we mean an admissible process that satisfies the strain-displacement relation, the stress-strain relation, and the displacement boundary condition. (1) Ha-milton-Kirchhoff principle.4 Let «s/ denote the set of all kinematically admissible processes p= [u, E, S] that have ii and E continuous on B X [0, t0] and tt(-,0) = a, u(>,t0) = p on B, where a and fi are prescribed vector fields. Let •?]{•} be the functional on s# defined by rj{p}= f°U{E} dt- JJ (i Qitf+b • u) dv dt- f Js-udadt 0 0B 0 SP, for every p= [u, E, S] e«s/. Then dr]{p} = 0 at p£j/ if and only if p satisfies the equation of motion and the traction boundary condition. Proof. Let pes/, and let p= [u, E, S] be an admissible process with the following property: p+Apes/ for every scalar A. (a) 1 Gurtin [1964,5], Lemma 2.3. In 1965 HlavaCek (private communication) pointed out that the proof given by Gurtin [1964, 8] is incorrect and furnished a valid proof. 2 Gurtin [1964, 8], Lemma 2.4. 3 For the validity of (1) we need the stronger assumption that (ii), (iv), and (v) hold with the interval [0, t0) replaced by [0, t0]. 4 Kirchhoff [1852, 2], [1859, 2], [1876, 2], § 11. See also Love [1927, 3], § 115; Loca- telli [1945, 3, 4]; Washizu [1957, 18]; Kneshke and Rudiger [1962,10]; Chen [1964, 6]; Yu [1964,23]; Ben-Amoz [1966,2]; Karnopp [1966,20], [1968,20]; Komkov [1966,25]; Tonti [1966, 26]. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 15
226 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 65. Clearly, (a) holds if and only if p satisfies the strain-displacement relation, the stress-strain relation, the boundary condition m=0 on S^x[OJ0], (b) and the end conditions u(-,0) = u(-,t0) = 0 on B. (c) Next, to to (d) = I j (S • E—qu- u—b ■ u) dv dt— I s -udadt, OB o s?t where we have used the symmetry of C and the stress-strain relation. By (c) '° . • ^° .. ~ J qu ■ u dt= — J qu. • u dt, (e) o o and (d), (e), the fact that E and u satisfy the strain-displacement relation, (18.1), and (b) imply to (- t0 d^rj{p}= — J J (divS + 6 — qu) ■ udv+ f J (s — s) ■ udadt. (f) OB o yt Clearly, 8r}{ft}=0ii divS+b = Qii on Bx[0,t0), s = s on S?2x[0,t0). (g) On the other hand, if (f) vanishes for every p consistent with (a), then (f) vanishes for every admissible motion u consistent with (b) and (c), and obvious extensions of (7.1) and (35.1) yield (g). □ The Hamilton-Kirchhoff principle is concerned with the variation of a functional over a set of processes that assume a given displacement distribution at an initial as well as at a later time. This type of principle clearly does not characterize the initial-value problem of elastodynamics, since it fails to take into account the initial velocity distribution and presupposes the knowledge of the displacements at a later time—an item of information not available in advance. We now give several variational principles which do, in fact, characterize this initial-value problem. We assume for the remainder of this section that the density q is strictly positive. Note that, in view of assumptions (i)-(iii) of Sect. 62, the pseudo body force field f(x, t) =i*b(x, t) +q{x) [u0(x) +tv0(x)], i(t) =t is continuous on B X [0, t0). We begin with a variational principle in which the admissible processes are not required to meet any of the field equations, initial conditions, or boundary conditions; this principle is a counterpart of the Hu-Washizu principle (38.1) in elastostatics. (2)1 Let j/ denote the set of all admissible processes, and for each td\0, t0) define the functional /1,(-} on $0 by At{p} = f {^i*E*C[E] +%QU*u — i*S*E — [i*divS+f]*u} (x, t) dv^ B + f {i*s*u}(x, t) dax-\- J fi*(s — s)*u\ da^ &x sr, 1 Gurtin [1964, 8], Theorem 4.1.
Sect. 65. Variational principles. 227 for every p = [u, E, S] e $¢- Then 6A,{fi} = 0 (0^t<t0) at an admissible process p if and only if p is a solution of the mixed problem. Proof. Let p = [u, E, S] and p = [u, E, S] be admissible processes. Then p + Xp is an admissible process for every scalar X. Since C is symmetric, E(t - t) • C [E{x)} = C [E(t - t)] • E{x), and thus E*C[E]=C[E]*E=E*C[E]. (a) Let Ut{E} = J / i*E*C[E] (x, t) dvx. B Then (a) imphes Ut{E + XE}=Ut{E}+X2 Uf{E} +X f i*E*C[E] (x, t) dvx. (b) B Thus, since d~At{p}= ddX At{p+Xp}\n, it follows that d~PAt{p} = f {i#(C[E] —S)*E—i*S*E — (i*div S+f — Q u)*u — i*u*div S}(x, t) dvx B + J {i*s*u}(x, t) dax-\- J i*{s*u-\-(s— s)*u}(x, t) dax. If we apply (19.3) to S and u, we find that i* Ju*div S dv =i* J s*uda—i* J S*Vu dv; b m b thus d~pAt{p} = / ** (C[E] - S)*E(x, t) dvx b — J (i*div S+f — qu)*u(x, t) dvx B + Ji*{Vu-E)*S{x, t) dvx (c) B + /i*(u — u)*s(x, t) dax + f i*(s — s)*u(x,t) dax (0^t<t0). If p is a solution of the mixed problem, then we conclude from (c) and (62.3) that d~At{p}=0 (0^t<t0) for every pts/ (d) which implies dAt{p}=0 (0^t<t0). (e) To prove the converse assertion assume that (e) and hence (d) holds. If we choose p = [u, 0, 0] and let u vanish near 8B, then it follows from (c) and (d) that / (i*div S+f — qu)*u(x, t) dvx=0 (0^t<t0). B 15*
228 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 65- Since this relation must hold for every m of class C00 on Ex[0, t0) that vanishes near dB, we conclude from (64.1) that i*div S+f = gu. Next, by choosing jtistfvn. the forms [0, E, 0] and [0, 0, S], where E and S vanish near dB, we conclude from (c), (d), and (64.1) with HP equal to the set of all symmetric tensors that i*(C[E]—S)=0, i*(Pu—E)=0. Thus, by (iv) of (10.1) with <p=i, ft satisfies the stress-strain and displacement- strain relations. In view of (62.3), to complete the proof we have only to show that p satisfies the boundary conditions. By (c), (d), (iv) of (10.1), and the results established thus far, /(« — «)* (Sn) (x, t) dax + f (s — s) * u (x, t) dax = 0 (0 ^ t < t0) for every pzstf. Therefore, if we take pzstf equal to [«, 0, 0] and [0, 0, S] and appeal to (64.2) and (64.3), we conclude that p satisfies the boundary conditions. □ Our next theorem is an analog of the Hellinger-Prange-Reissner principle (38.2). (3)1 Assume that the elasticity field is invertible. Let s# denote the set of all admissible processes that satisfy the strain-displacement relation, and for each te(0, t0) define the functional ©<{"} on ^ by 0({p}= J {%i*S*K[S] —%QU*u — i*S*E+f*u} (x, t) dvx B + / {i*s*(u —u)} (x, t) dax-\- f {i*s*«*} (x, t) dax for every p = [u, E, S] e j</. Then d@({p}=0 (0^t<t0) at pzstfif and only if p is a solution of the mixed problem. Proof. Let p and p be admissible processes, and suppose that p-\-hp£s& for every scalar X, or equivalently, that p,p£s#. In view of the symmetry of C, K is symmetric. Thus if we proceed as in the proof of (2), we conclude, with the aid of (19.3), that2 d~6t{p) = / i*(K[S] -E) *S(x, t) dvx B + / (i*div S +/ — qu) *u(x, t) dvx B (a) + / i* (u — m) *s (x, t) dax + / i*(s — s)*u{x, t) dax (0^t<t0). If p is a solution of the mixed problem, then (a), because of (62.3), yields det{fi}=o (o^t<t0). (b) On the other hand, (a), (b), (64.1), (64.2), (64.3), (iv) of (10.1), and (62.3) imply that p is a solution of the mixed problem. □ 1 Gurtin [1964, 8], Theorem 4.2. 2 Cf. the proof of (38£).
Sect. 65. Variational principles 229 If p = [tt, E, S] is a kinematically admissible process, then, by virtue of (19.3), At{p} defined in (2) reduces to <&({p}, where &t{p}=? f {i*S*E + gu*u — 2f*u} (x, t) dvx — f {i*s*u} (x, t) da^. b sr, Thus we are led to the following: (4) Analog of the principle of minimum potential energy.1 For each te[0, t0) let 0t{'} be the functioned defined on the set stf of all kinematically admissible processes by the above relation. Then at pes/ if and only if pis a solution of the mixed problem. Proof. Let p = [«, E, S] be an admissible process, and suppose that p + lpest for every scalar A. (a) Condition (a) is equivalent to the requirement that p satisfy the strain-displacement relation, the stress-strain relation, and the boundary condition m = 0 on £fxx\0,t0). (b) Next, since the restriction of At{-} of (2) to (the present) s4 is equal to $«{•}, we conclude from (c) in the proof of (2) and the properties of p and p that h &t{p} = — I (*'*div S +/—qu) * u{x, t) dvx B - (c) + fi*(s— s)*u(x, t) da^. {0^t<t0) for every admissible motion it that satisfies (b). If p is a solution of the mixed problem, then, by virtue of (62.3), 50,{p)==O (0^t<t0). Conversely, if the variation of 0( vanishes at p for all t, then it follows from (c), (64.1), and (64.2) that p is a solution of the mixed problem. □ It is a simple matter to prove counterparts of theorems (34.2) and (57.4) characterizing the displacement field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem.2 Rather than do this we shall establish a variational principle which involves only the stress field and which has no counterpart in elastostatics. In addition to the assumptions made previously, we now assume that:3 (A) C is invertible onB; q, Uq, and v0 are of class C2 onB; 6 is of class C2'0 on Bx[o,g. (5) First variational principle for the stress field4. Let s£ denote the set of all time-dependent admissible stress fields of class C3' 0onBx(0, t0) with S continuous on Ex [0, rf0). For each te [0, t0) let ./]{•} be the functional on sf defined by rt{S}=%J {i'*div S*div S +S*K[S] -2S* Vf'} (x, t) dvx + / {(/'—"**) *s} ix> 0 ^am + I {*'*(s —s)*div S} (x, f) dax, where ^1 *"• Q Q 1 Gurtin [1964, «], Theorem 4.3. 2 Cf. Gurtin [1964, «], § 5- 3 These assumptions are slightly more stringent than necessary. 4 Gurtin [1964, S], Theorem 6.1.
230 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 66. c5/]{S}=0 (0<t<t0) at Sestf if and only if S corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem. Proof. Let Sc-s/, so that S + X Stsf for every scalar X. Then, since K is symmetric, the divergence theorem and the properties of the convolution yield, after some work, ds rt{S} = -/ {V(i'*div S +/') -K[S]}*S{x, t) dvx B + / (»'*div S — u-\-f')*s{x, t) dax (a) + f i'*(s — s)*divS(ac, t) dax (0^t<t0) for every Sesf. If S corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem, then (62.4) implies that drt{S}=0 (0^t<t0). (b) On the other hand, (a), (b), the symmetry of S, (64.1), (64.3), (64.4), (iv) of (10.1), and (62.4) imply that S corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem. □ Let <s/ be as defined in (5). By a dynamically admissible stress field we mean a tensor field Sestf that satisfies the traction boundary condition. For such a stress field, -T({S}, defined in (5), reduces to Qt{S}=% J {i'*div S*div S+S*K[S]-2S*Pf'} (x, t) dvx B + / {(/' — «) *s} ft, t) dax- Thus we are led to the following theorem, the proof of which is strictly analogous to that given for (5). (6) Second variational principle for the stress field.J For each te [0, t0) let Q,{'} be defined on the set of dynamically admissible stress fields by the above relation. Then 6Qt{S}=0 (0<t<t0) at a dynamically admissible stress field S if and only if S corresponds to a solution of the mixed problem. If we apply (19.3) to the term involving S * Vf', we can rewrite the expression for Qt{S} m the form Q({S} = J / {*''*div S*div S +S*K[S] +2 div S*f'} (x, t) dvx — / {u*s} (x, t) dax — / {f'*s} (x, t) dax. 9*\ '^2 Of course, the last term may be omitted without destroying the validity of (6), since it is the same for every dynamically admissible S. 66. Minimum principles. For the variational principles established in the preceding section the relevant functionals were stationary, but not necessarily a minimum, at a solution. On the other hand, the principles of minimum potential 1 Gurtin [1964, 8], Theorem 6.2.
Sect. 66. Minimum principles. 231 energy and minimum complementary energy are true minimum principles. This difference is nontrivial; indeed, the lower bound on the energy provided by a minimum principle is useful in establishing the convergence of numerical solutions. In this section we establish minimum principles for the Laplace transforms of the functionals associated with the variational principles (65.4) and (65.6). We let t0 =oo, so that the underlying time interval is [0, oo). In addition to hypotheses (i)-(v) of Sect. 62 we now assume that: (vi) C is symmetric and positive definite; (vii) q>0; (viii) 6, u, and s possess Laplace transforms. Let s£h denote the set of all kinematically admissible processes ft = [u, E, S] such that1 ft and Vft possess Laplace transforms. Then for p&rfL the function t^0t{ft} of (65.4) has a Laplace transform _ °° <P„{*} = / «-" <P,{*} «tt (r?0^r?<oo) 0 for some rj0^0. In fact, since the Laplace transform of i(t) = t is \\rf, it follows from (vii) of (10.1) and the transformed stress-strain relation S = C[E] that *,{*} = y uc{E(;n)) + J{{ q(*) «(*.nY-/>. v) • «(*.v)}dv* 1 r- - V — ^ J s{x,r))-u(x rj) dax (»?0^r?<oo). It is interesting to note the similarity between &v{'} and the functional ¢{-} of the principle of minimum potential energy (34.1). This similarity is emphasized by the (1) Theorem of minimum transformed energy.2 Assume that the elasticity field is positive semi-definite. Let fa<zJ#L be a solution of the mixed, problem. Then for each pd^L there exists an tjq^O such that 0n{ft}^0n{ft} (r?0^r?<oo). Proof. Since ft, fi£<stfL, there exists an rfoJgO such that the Laplace transforms of ft, p, Vp, Vft, and 6 exist on B X [%, oo). Let ft'= p-ft. (a) Then ft' is an admissible process, ft' and Vp' possess Laplace transforms, and E'^{Vu' + Vu'T), (b) S'=C[E], (c) m' = 0 on ,9[. (d) Moreover S = C[E], since p£s/L; thus (28.1) and (a) imply UC{E} - UC{E} = UC{E'} +jS-E'dv. (e) B 1 Here Vp = [Ft*, VE, VS]. 2 Benthien and Gurtin [1970, 1].
232 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 67. Similarly, / QtPdv— / QvPdv= / Qu'*dv-\-2 f QU-u'dv. (f) B B B B If we apply (18.1) to S and «', we conclude, with the aid of (b) and (d), that fS-E'dv=fs-u'da-fu'-divSdv. (g) B S% B Further, since p€s#L is a solution of the mixed problem, if we take the Laplace transform of the third and fifth relations in (62.3), we find that ijf div S(*. V) + /(*. V) = Q (*)«(*' f) (h) for every (ae, ^)6JBx[?;0, oo) and s = s on ^gX[%,<»). (i) By (L) and (e)-(i), 0„(p) - <?,(p) = jFUc{E'(.,r,)} + \ [q(x) u'(x, V)*dvm (% 5gV < oo); B this implies the desired result, since C is positive semi-definite and q positive. □ Note that, since q > 0, we can strengthen the inequality in (1) as follows: $n{p) < $r,{p} whenever «(•,??)#=«(•,??). We now assume that (A) on p. 229 holds, and, in addition, that Vb possesses a Laplace transform. Let &L denote the set of all dynamically admissible stress fields S such that S and VS possess Laplace transforms. Then for Se@L the function tt-*Qt{S} of (65.6) has a Laplace transform £1^{S}(r)0<^r)<oo) for some %>0. In fact, _ /• r rjj„ 5/™ „\t2 _ _ dv„ _ I 2omr)" B B and we are led to the (2) Minimum principle for the stress field. Let Se3iL be the stress field corresponding to a solution of the mixed problem. Then for each S£@L there exists an rjo^O such that The proof of this theorem is strictly analogous to that of (1) and can safely be omitted. IV. Homogeneous and isotropic bodies. 67. Complete solutions of the field equations. In this section we study certain general solutions of the displacement equation of motion1 c\ Fdiv u — c\ curl curl u-\— = ii, xtt. p. 213.
Sect. 67. Complete solutions of the field equations. 233 assuming throughout that c|>c|>0 and that bjg admits the Helmholtz decomposition1 — = — Vx— curly, divy = 0, with x and y of class CM on B X (0, t0). A solution u of class Cz on B X (0, t0) will be referred to as an elastic motion corresponding to 6. (1) Green-Lame~ solution.2 Let u — Vq> + curl \p, (LJ severe 99 «m<2 y> are class C3 /ieWs on Bx (0, <0) ^«< satisfy3 Di <?> = :*, n2v=y- (L2) TTtm it is an elastic motion corresponding to b. Proof. By (L,) c? Pdiv m — c| curl curl u — ii-\ e = V{c\A <p—'(p — x} + curl{— c\ curl curl \p — y> — y}. In view of (1) and (3) of (4.1), curl curl curl ip = — curl A y>, and the desired result follows from (L2). □ (2) Completeness of the Green-Lame~ solution.* Let u be an elastic motion of class_C3 corresponding to b, and assume that u(>, r) and u[', r) are continuous on B at some time t€(0, t0). Then there exist class Cz fields <p and ip on Bx(0,t0) that satisfy (1^), (L2). Moreover, divip = 0. 1 As is clear from the proof of (6.7), such an expansion is ensured if b/g is continuous on B x (0, t0) and of class C2.° on B x (0, *0). 2 Lame [1852, 2], p. 149. The two-dimensional version was obtained earlier by Green [1839,11- The solution u = V(p, Di <p = x appears in the work of Poisson [1829, 2], p. 404. Related solutions are given by Bondarenko [i960, 4}, Kilchevskii and Levchuk [1967, Iff], Chadwick and Trowbridge [1967, 5] show that u = V<f — curl curl (p ip) — curl (pa>) Di<p=o, n2v=o. n2«=o, defines an elastic motion corresponding to b = 0. Further, they prove that this solution is complete for regions bounded by concentric spheres. 8 The wave operators Da are defined on p. 213- 4 Clebsch [1863,2] was the first to assert that the Green-Lam6 solution is complete. Clebsch also gave a proof which Sternberg [I960, 13] showed is open to serious objection. (Actually, Clebsch's proof is valid when the boundary of the region consists of a single closed surface.) Another inconclusive proof was given by Kelvin [1904, 5] in 1884. The first general completeness proof was furnished by Somigliana [1892, 7]. Completeness proofs were also supplied byTEDONE [1897, 1~\, Duhem [1898, 5], and Sternberg and Gurtin [1962, IS]. An explicit version of Duhem's proof was given by Sternberg [i960, 13]. The work of Somigliana, Tedone, and Duhem appears to be little known; in fact, Sneddon and Berry [1958, 18], p. 109 state that the Green-Lame solution is incomplete if the region occupied by the medium has a boundary. Further, as Sternberg [i960, 13] has remarked, the completeness proof given by Pearson [1959, H] is open to objections.
234 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 67. Proof. * If we integrate the equation of motion twice, we arrive at u(t) = m(t) + m(t) (t - t) + V // [cfdiv tt(A) - k(A)] rfArfs TT (a) + curl // [- c| curl m (A) - y (A)] rfA rfs, T T where, for convenience, we have omitted all mention of the variable x. If we apply the Helmholtz resolution (6.7) to u(r) and u(t), we find that u (t) + u (t) (* — t) = Fa (*) + curl /? (*), (b) where a and /J are class C2 fields that satisfy a = 0, /j = 0, div/J=0. (c) Thus if we define functions <p and yj on £ x (0, £0) by <p(t) = oL(t) + //[cf divw(A) -«(A)]rfAis, (d) T T v (*) = 0 (<) - // [4 curlw (A) + y (A)] df A rfs, (e) T T then m= F95 + curly, (f) and, since div y =0, (c), (d), and (e) imply divip = 0. (g) Moreover, by (c), (d), and (e), <p = cfdivw — %, ip= — c|curlM — y, (h) and (f), (g), and (1)-(3) of (4.1) yield divu=A<p, curltt=— Atp. (i) Finally, (h) and (i) imply the desired result (L2). □ It follows from (d), (e), and (i) that <p and tp are sufficiently smooth that D2curl ip=curl D2V> and (2) has the following corollary: (3) Poisson's decomposition theorem.2 Let u satisfy the hypotheses of (2) with body force field 6 = 0. Then u admits the decomposition where u^ and u% are class C2 fields on Bx (0, t0) that satisfy □iMi = 0, curltt^O, □ 2^2 = 0, div «2=0. 1 Somigliana [-1892, 7]. See also Bishop [-1953, 4]. 2 Poisson [1829, 3]. Although Poisson's results are based on a molecular model which yields jx = X, his proof in no way depends on this constraint.
Sect. 67- Complete solutions of the field equations. 235 (4) Cauchy-Kovalevshi-Somigliana solution.1 Let *=nig + ($-($rtivg, (Sx) where g is a class C4 vector field on Bx (0, t0) that satisfies n*ulg = -h-. (S2) Then u is an elastic motion corresponding to b. Proof. By (¾ n2M + (ci-c|)FdivM = D2 Di 9 + (4 - cf) D2 Fdivg + (cf - ${{^ Fdiv g + (c| - cj) /I Pdiv g}. In view of (S2) and the identity D,/-Di/=(ci-c!)/l/, the right-hand side of the above relation reduces to — bjq; thus we conclude from (d) on p. 213 that u is an elastic motion corresponding to 6. □ If g is independent of time, then (SO, (S2) reduce to u = clAg + (cl-cl) Vdivg, which is, to within a multiplicative constant, the Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution (44.3). If in the time-dependent Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution we define2 V=Diff, 95 = 2c!divg— pxp, then (S^, (S2) reduce to M = V+ ~JyV{<p+ p-xp), \2tV = — —, ni9> = -p-DiV, ■»ci e which may be regarded as a dynamic generalization of the Boussinesq-Papko- vitch-Neuber solution (44.1). Since the potentials <p and \p obey a coupled differential equation, this solution is of no practical interest in elastodynamics.3 We now establish the completeness of the Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution. For convenience, we shall assume that the body forces are zero. (5) Completeness of the Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution.* Let u be a class C6 elastic motion corresponding to zero body forces, and suppose that u(•, t) and u{-, t) are continuous on B at some t€ (0, t0). Then there exists a classC* vector field g on Bx(0, t0) such that (S^, (S2) hold. 1 Cauchy [1840, 1], pp. 208-209; Kovalevsky [1885, 2], p. 269; Somigliana [1892, 7]. This solution was arrived at independently by Iacovache [1949, 4]; it was extended to include body forces by Sternberg and Eubanks [1957, 14\ See also Bondarenko [1957, 2], Predeleanu [1958, 13], Teodorescu [I960, 14]. 2 Sternberg and Eubanks [1957, 14]. Cf. the remarks on p. 142. 3 Sternberg [i960, 13]. 4 Somigliana [1892, 7]. This theorem was arrived at independently by Sternberg and Eubanks [1957, 14] using an entirely different method of proof and without assuming that b =0. A third completeness proof is contained in the work of Sternberg and Gurtin [1962, 13].
236 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 67. Proof. By hypothesis and (2), cfFdivw — el curl curl it =u, (a) w= V<p-\-c\xrly>, (b) Di9» = 0, Di!V = 0- (c) Further, it follows from the proof of (2) that q> and \p are of class C5. Substituting (b) into (a), u = c\A curl yj — Fdiv (4 curl ip — cf Vq>), (d) where we have used the fact that div curl = 0. By (c) c\A curl \p — curl ip = c\A curl \p — Di curl v, and thus cjM curl y = -j-^-j Di curl v • (e) cl—c2 Eqs. (d), (e), and the first of (c) imply that u = "2 *—» di(ci curl V — ci V<P) — Fdiv(c|curl vp— c\ Fq>), c1 — c2 and thus u{t) =v{x) +v(r)(t-r) + DiMO ~ (Ci-CD Fdiv*(0, where T T *>=«+ „2—72" [cl curl v- ci v<p\ ■ cl c2 In the above equations we have omitted all mention of the variable x. Next, since the Boussinesq-Somigliana-Galerkin solution (44.3) is complete, we can expand v(r) — v(-, r) and v(r) = «(•, t) as follows v(t) = clAg-L + (4 - c\) FdivfiT!, v (t) = c\A g2 + (4 — c\) Fdiv g2, where gx and g2 are of class C4 on B. Thus if we define g(x, t)=h(x, t)+g1(x) + {t — x) g2(x), then g is of class C4, M = Di3 + (cl-c2)Fdivsr, and (SJ holds. Finally, (Sj) and (a) imply (S2). Q In attempting to judge the comparative merits of the Cauchy-Kovalevski- Somigliana solution (SJ, (S2) and the Green-Lame solution (1^), (L2), the following considerations would appear to be pertinent.1 The former remains complete in the equilibrium case if the generating potential g [x, t) is taken to be a function of position alone. In contrast, the Green-Lame solution has no equilibrium counterpart in the foregoing sense. This circumstance reflects the relative economy of the Green-Lam^ solution, which is simpler in structure than the available complete solutions to the equations of equilibrium. Further, (SJ contains space 1 These observations are due to Sternberg [I960, 13].
Sect. 67- Complete solutions of the field equations. 237 derivatives of g up to the second order while only first-order derivatives of q> and y> are seen to enter (L2). Finally, (1^), (L2) are conveniently transformed into general orthogonal curvilinear coordinates, whereas (S^, (S2) give rise to exceedingly cumbersome forms when referred to curvilinear coordinates, with the exception of cyhndrical coordinates. For all of these reasons, the Green-Lame solution deserves preference over the Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution in applications. In the absence of body forces the Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana stress function satisfies the repeated wave equation □2DiSr = 0. The next result yields an important decomposition for solutions of this equation. (6) Boggio's theorem.1 Let g be a vector field of class C4 on Ex (0, t0), and suppose that □2DiSr = 0. Then 9 = 9i + 92, where gt and </2 are class C2 fields on Bx (0, t0) that satisfy Di»i = 0, n2»2 = o. Proof.2 It suffices to establish the existence of a classC2 field ^onfix(0, t0) with the following properties: □ iSTi = 0, n2(sr-»i)=0. (a) Indeed, once such a g1 has been found, we simply define 92 = 9-9i Since Ua9i=clAg1-g1 (<x = l,2), it follows that if [Jj g1 = 0, then c2 — c2 □2»i= V*' Thus (a) is satisfied if □i3i = 0, »!=/, (b) where /=-^-erD.»- Notice that/is of class C2 on Ex (0, t0) and obeys □i/=0. (c) Thus to complete the proof it suffices to exhibit a field gt satisfying (b), subject to (c). Let t€ (0, t0) and consider the function g1 defined by g-i.{x,t) = ///(*, X)dXds-\-h{ac) +tq(ac) 1 Boggio [1903, 1]. This theorem was established independently by Sternberg and Eubanks [1957, 14]. 2 Sternberg and Eubanks [1957, 1£\-
238 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 67. for (x, t)eBx (0, t0), where h and q are as of yet unspecified. Then g1 meets the second of (b). We now show that h and q can be chosen such that Q1g1=0. Clearly, □iffi(a>, t) = // 4Af(x, X) dlds -f{x, t) + c\Ah(x)+tc\Aq{x), X X and by (c) clAf=f. Thus Di9i(x,t) = -/(a?, t) +T/(a?,T) -</(», t) +4Ah(x) +tc\Aq{x). Since/is of class C2onSx(0, t0), /(•, t) and f(',r) are of class C1 on B; hence, in view of (6.5), there exist functions h and q of class C2 on B such that cf A h (x) =/(sb, t) — t/'(as, t) , c?Jqf(£c) =/(», t), which yields nx £^=0. D An interesting relation between the Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution and the Green-Lame solution was established by Sternberg.1 Assume that the body forces vanish. Let g be the stress function in (Sj), (S2). Then by (S2) and Boggio's theorem, there exist functions g1 and </2 sucn that 0=01 + 02, (a) □i0i = O, D2»2 = 0. (b) By the second of (b), Di92:=(4-cl)Ag2; (c) thus, using (a) and (b), we can write (SJ as u = (4-4)[Ag2-V&iv(gi + g2)], (d) and, since curl curl g2 = V div g2 — A g2, (d) can be written in the form u = (4 — cf) [Fdiv g1 + curl curl g2]. If we define functions <p and \p by 99 = (c| - c2) div g1, xp = {c\- cf) curl g2, (e) then (e) takes the form u= V(p + cm\y), divip = 0, (f) while (b) yields □i9> = 0, D2V = 0. (g) Eqs. (f) and (g) are identical to (L,) and (L2). Thus we have Sternberg's result: The Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution reduces to the Green-Lame solution provided the field g is subjected to the transformation (a), (b), and (e). In view of the completeness of the Cauchy-Kovalevski-Somigliana solution, this reduction theorem furnishes an alternative proof of the completeness of the Green-Lame solution. 1 [1960, 13].
Sect. 68. Basic singular solutions. 239 68. Basic singular solutions. In this section we will discuss the basic singular solutions of elastodynamics, assuming throughout that the body is homogeneous and isotropic with cx > 0, c2 > 0. Throughout this section y is a fixed point of i, r=x—y, r = \r\, and Sn = %n (y) is the open ball with center at y and radius r\. Recall1 that =Sf is the set of all smooth vector functions on (—oo, oo) that vanish on (—oo, 0). For each le^Clet uy{l} be the vector field on (<? — {y})x (— oo, oo) defined by 1/¾ Uy{l\ (X,t)= -— " 3r®r ^Jxi(t-Xr)dX 1/¾ Further, let E,{i) and £>,{&} be defined through the strain-displacement and stress-strain relations, so that S„{I}(».0 = ^>-[(r7i)-*®- -(»"/,) l-r®/,-/,®r where with /X{1) (a?, 0 = -64 f XI {t-Xr) dX + i2 \l(t-r/cj --*-l{t -r/cj 1/¾ 1/¾ /,{1} (as, Q=-64 [ M{t-Xr)dX+2l(t-rfa)+(i -4-J) I(*-r/e,) 1/¾ 1/¾ /,{1} (a?, t) = -6c\jXl{t-Xr) dX+Wt-rlca)-?g Ip-r/c,) 1/¾ + -"-^-r/Cl). We write ^{1} = [«,(!}, E,(I},S,(I}] and call #,{1} the Stokes process2 corresponding to a concentrated load I at y. Clearly, the mapping Ii->^V(I} is linear on „SP. 1 See p. 26. 2 This solution is due to Stokes [1851, 1]. It was deduced by Love [1904, 3], [1927, 3], § 212 through a limit process based on a sequence of time-dependent body force fields that approaches a concentrated load (cf. (51.1)). The form of Stokes' solution presented here is taken from Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16]. A generalization of Stokes' solution, valid for inhomogeneous media, is contained in the work of Mikhlin [1947, 5]. See also Babich [1961, 1], Gutzwiller [1962, 8], Murtazaev [1962, 12], Nowak [1969, 5].
240 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 68. (1) Let la&and define S*{1} on {&—{y}) X(—oo, oo) by SJW (x, t) = -4 ~ \^\:^-r®U-h®r-(r-f3) l], where f{ =/,-{!} (*, <) is defined above. Then S„{k}*l=S*{l}T*k. Proof. It follows from the definition of f{ and (10.2) that hence ft{l}* k = l*ft{k}. Thus, in view of the definition of Sy{k), 4nr* S„{k}*l = (r •£{&}) • (r • I) -~ -(r -/2{fe}) *l -(/,{*}•!) r-(r • I)*/3{fc} -®-) • (A{*}# I)]r-(l#/i{*}) *--(/3{fc}**) r-(/,{fc}# I)r r-f r) • (*#*{!})]»•-(/.«# *) *--(fe*/aW)»— (fe#/3«) r = 47rr3S*{t}r*fe. D Let on 8Bx( — oo, oo), where S*{Z} is the tensor field defined in (1). We call s*{l} the adjoint traction field on SB corresponding to j&tf{l}. (2) Properties of the Stokes process.1 Let leJ£. Then the Stokes process fiu{l} has the following properties: (i) If I is of class C2, then fiy{l} is an elastic process on <0—{y} with a quiescent past, and #y{l} corresponds to zero body forces. (ii) uy{l} (x, •) =0(r~x) and Sy{l} (x, •) =0(r~2) as r->0 and also as r-+oo, uniformly on every interval of the form (— oo, t]. (iii) lim / sy{l}da=l, lim / rxsu{l}da=0, where on 327,, x(— oo, oo) with n the inward unit normal. Moreover, the above limits are attained uniformly on every interval of the form (— oo, /]. (iv) For every &€-§?, l*uy{k} = k*uy{l}, l*sy{k} = k*s^{l}, where sy{k} is the traction field on 8B corresponding to Py{k}, and s* {1} is the adjoint traction field on 8B corresponding to py{l}. Proof. Parts (i) and (ii) follow from the assumed properties of I and the formulae for uy{l} and Sy{l}. 1 This theorem, with the exception of the second of (iv), is due to Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16]. See also Love [1927, S], who asserts (iii).
Sect. 68. Basic singular solutions. 241 Consider now part (iii). A simple computation based on the formula for Sy{l} leads to the result J sy{l} (x, r) da3S= j I(t — ^/¾) + 21(t — ^/c2) ssn + -V.-i(T-tilca + l?-i{T-rilcJ which implies the first of (iii), since I€.§?. The second of (iii) is an immediate consequence of the order of magnitude estimate for SU{1} in (ii). The first of property (iv) is easily established with the aid of (10.2). To prove the second, note that by (1) l*su{k} = l*(Sy{k} n) =(Sy{k}*l) n = {Sy{l}T*k)-n = k*{Sy{l}n)=k*sy{l}. □ Let Ie^? be of class C2, and let uy{l} be defined on (^ — {y}) X(— oo, oo) by Uy{l}(X, t)=-*x-Uy{l}(X,t). Then r 1/¾ *r{0(*. 0 = -4^- 3(i^r--^l-e,®r-r®e<) fxi{t-kr)dX + (6':^_r.l_e.(g)r-r®e<)(^-l(<-r/Cl)-jrl(<-r/C2)) + >(*(<-^2) + f i(*-r/c,)) c2 c2 We write £{*} = ^(9.^(0.^(0]. where -Ej,{0 and Sj,{t} are defined through the strain-displacement and stress- strain relations, and call py{l} the doublet process (corresponding to y, I, and et). (3) Properties of the doublet processes.1 Let lz££ be of class C2. Then the doublet process ply{l} has the following properties: (i) If I is of class C3, then fiy{l} is an elastic process on $' — {y} with a quiescent past, and Py{l} corresponds to zero body forces. (ii) Tiy{l} (x, •) =0(r~2) and Sy{l} (x, • ) =0(r'3) as r->0 and also as r-+oo, uniformly on every interval of the form (— 00, f\. (iii) Urn / ~sL{l}da=Q, lim / rx.sy{l}da = — etxl, where s<{l} = S»{I}n on dSv with n the inward unit normal. (iv) If keJi? is of class C2, then k*uy{l} = l*Uy{k}. 1 Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 26], Theorem 3.2. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 16
242 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect/69. (v) If py{l} is the Stokes process corresponding to the concentrated load I at y, then J-Py{l} = -py{l}. 69. Love's integral identity. In this section we will establish Love's theorem; this theorem is a direct analog of Somigliana's theorem (52.4) in elastostatics. We continue to assume that B is homogeneous and isotropic with c1 > 0, c2 > 0. (1) Lemma.1 Let p = [u, E, S] be an elastic process with a quiescent past, and let py{l} = [uy{I}, Ey{l}, Sy{l}] be the Stokes process corresponding to a concentrated load leJ? at y&B. Then lim / s*uy{l}da=0, n-*> 82:„ (y) where lim / u*sy{l}da=l*u(y, • ), s=Sn, sy{l}=Sy{l}n on d£v(y) x(—oo, oo) with n the inward unit normal. Proof. Since both states have quiescent pasts, the above relations hold trivially on (— oo, 0]. Thus hold t>0 fixed for the remainder of the argument. Let /8 be such that £p{y)CB, choose r\6(0,/8]. and write 2rl=2tj(y). Further, let v(x, r) =u{x, r) —u(y, r) for (x, r)eBx [0, oo). Then t \I(rj)—l*u(y,t)\^ J f sy{l} (x,t — r)-v(x,r) drdaa as. o + fu(y,t- f sy{l} (x,r) daa, — l{x) dx (a) (b) where I[rj) = J u*sy{l}(x, t) dax. dZ„ The second term in the right-hand member of (b) tends to zero with r\, since the limit may be taken under the time-integral2 and because of (iii) in (68.2). Consequently, \I(rj)—l*u(y,t)\^4nrj2tMs(rj)Mi(rj)+o(i) as »y->0, (c) where M3(rj) =sup{\v(x, t)| : (x, r)e8i7,X[0, t]}, M^r,) =sup {\sy{l} (x, t)| : (x, T)e027„x [0, (]}, for rj£(0,/8]. From (a) and the continuity of u on Ex[0, oo) follows Af8(77)=0(1) as 77->0. On the other hand, (ii) of (68.2) yields Mi{v)=0(v~2) as i?->0. The inequality (c), when combined with the above estimates, implies the second result in (1). A strictly analogous argument yields the first result in (1). □ 1 Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, Iff], Lemma 3.1. 2 See Mikusinski [1959, 10], p. 143-
Sect. 70. The acoustic tensor. 243 (2) Love's integral identity.1 Let p = [u, E, S] be an elastic process on B corresponding to the external force system \b, s], let p have a quiescent past, and suppose that s(x, -)ejSf for every xedB, and that b(x, >)6JS?'for every xeB. Then U(H>')= I luy{s} — «»{«}] da+ J uy{b} dv dB B for yeB, where, for any leJ?, uy{l} is the displacement field and s£{l} the adjoint traction field corresponding to the Stokes process Py{l}. Proof.2 By hypothesis, u is an admissible motion and u(.,O)=u(.,O)=0 (a) on B. Thus u(x, •)€ J? for every xeB. Therefore, since s(x, ')e3? for every xedB, the above expression holds trivially on (— oo, 0]. We now establish its validity on (0, oo). Choose a>0 with 2a(y)CB, and set B,=B-r,(») (b) for rj€ (0, a]. Let le 3? be of class C2. By (a) and (i) of (68.2), p and py{l) both correspond to null initial data, while py{l} corresponds to vanishing body forces. Thus we are entitled to apply (d) of Graffi's reciprocal theorem (61.1) to p and Py{l} on Bv with the result that f s*uy{l}da-{- f b*uy{l} dv= f sy{l}*u da (c) 8B„ B„ 8B„ on (0, oo). If we let r\ ->0 in (c) and use (b) and (1), we arrive at the result / s*uy{l} da-\- J b*uy{l} dv= f sy{l}*uda-{-l*u(y, •). (d) dB B dB By (iv) of (68.2) and the properties of the convolution (10.1), (d) can be written in the form f / iuy{s}~ sy{u}] da-{- f uy{b} dv —u{y, -)1 * I = 0 (e) IdB B J on [0, oo). Since Ze jSf is an arbitrary class C2 function, (e) and (v) of (10.1) yield the desired result. □ V. Wave propagation. 70. The acoustic tensor. As we will see in the next few sections, the notion of an acoustic tensor is central to the study of wave propagation. In this section we define this tensor and establish some of its properties. Fix xeB and let C = Cx be the elasticity tensor and q — q (x) > 0 the density at x. Let m be a unit vector. Since C is a linear transformation, q'1 C [a (g) m] m 1 Love [1904, 3]. A similar result was deduced previously by Volterra [1894, 4], but Volterra's result is confined to two-dimensional elastostatics. See also Somigliana [1906, 6], De Hoop [1958, 4], Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16]. None of the above authors utilizes the adjoint traction field, which considerably simplifies Love's identity. Related integral identities are contained in the work of Arzhanyh [1950, 2], [1951, 2, 3, 4], [1954, 1, 2], [1955, 2, 3], Knopoff [1956, 6], Doyle [1966, 8]. A similar integral identity for the stress field, involving linear combinations of doublet processes, was established by Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16], Theorem 3.4. 2 The proof we give here is due to Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16], pp. 71, 72. Love [1904, 3] based his proof on Betti's reciprocal theorem (30.1), treating the inertia term as a body force. 16*
244 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 70. is a linear, vector-valued function of the vector a and hence is represented by the operation of a tensor A(m) acting on a: A (m) a = q _1 C [a ® m] m for every vector a. We call A(m) the acoustic tensor for the direction m. In components Aik(m)=Q-lCiiklmiml. (1) Properties of the acoustic tensor. (i) A(m) is symmetric for every m if and only if C is symmetric. (ii) A(m) is positive definite for every m if and only if C is strongly elliptic. (iii) A(m) is positive definite for every m whenever C is positive definite. (iv) Given any Q in the symmetry group ^,, QA(m)QT =A(Qm) for every m. Proof. Let C=g_1C. Clearly, b-A(m) a = b- C[a®m] m = (b®m) • C[a®m]. (a) Properties (i) and (ii) are direct consequences of (a) and (ii) of (20.1). Further, since C positive definite implies C strongly elliptic, (ii) implies (iii). Finally, since (Qa)®(Qm)=Q(a®m)QT, it follows from (f) on p. 7\ that QTA(Qm) Qa = QTC[Qfi®Qrn\ Qm = QTC[Q(a®m) QT] Qm = £\a®m~\ m=A(m) a, which implies (iv). □ / (2) Properties of the ajcoustic tensor when the material is isotropic.1 Assume that the material at £ is isotropic with Lame moduli /u and X. Then A(mj) =c\ m®m + cl(l— m®m), where cx and c2 are the wave speeds: Further, c\ and c\ are the principal values of A(m); the line spanned by m is the characteristic space for c\, the plane perpendicular to m the characteristic space for c\. Proof. By (i) of (20.1) and (22.2), C[a®m] =C[sym a®rri] =fi(a®m+m®a) -f-A(a-m) 1; thus C[a®m] m=fia-\-(X+fi) (a-m) m = [fjL \ + {X+p) m®m] a ~[f*(l— m®m) + (A + 2fi) m®m] a, which yields the above formula for A(m). The remainder of the proof follows from the spectral theorem (3.2) . □ 1 The form 6f the acoustic tensor for various anisotropic materials was given by Sakadi [1941,2] and Fedorov [1965,5], §19. Fbdorov [1963,5] has established a method of computing the isotropic acoustic tensor that is closest (in a precise sense) to a given anisotropic acoustic tensor.
Sect. 71. Progressive waves. 245 When we wish to make explicit the dependence of the acoustic tensor A(m) on xzB, we write A(x, m), i.e. A(x,m) a = g'1 (x) Cx[a®m\m. In the following proposition the region B is completely arbitrary. (3) Let C and q'1 be bounded on B with C symmetric and strongly elliptic. For each xeB and unit vector m, let A (x, m) be the largest characteristic value of the acoustic tensor A(x, m). Then the number %>0 defined by c\[ =sup {A(x, m): xeB, \m\ = 1} is finite, and \G-Cx[G]\^eW<?M\G\* for every xeE whenever G is of the form G=a®v. We call cM the maximum speed of propagation corresponding to C and q. Proof. By hypothesis and (i) and (ii) of (1), A(x, m) is always symmetric and positive definite. Thus A (a?, m) >0 and v-A(x, m) »5gA(as, m)|»|2 (a) for every vector v. Thus if the supremuni of A (x, m) is finite, cM will be well defined. Let e(x, m) with \e(x, m)\ = 1 be a characteristic vector corresponding to A (a?, m). Then A (x, m)—e (x, m) • A(x, m) e (x, m), (b) and since v-A(x, m) v=q~1(x) (v®m) ■ Cx[v®m] ^e-i(x)\Cx\ ^011^=^(05) |<y|e|« (C) for every vector v, (b) implies that A (a?, m) ^-1(32)10,1. (d) Since q'1 and C are bounded on B, e_1|C| is bounded, and therefore cM is finite. The final inequality in (3) follows from (a), (c), and the definition of cM. □ -^- 71. Progressive waves. In this section we study plane progressive wave solutionsx to the displacement equation of motion. These simple solutions are important in that they yield valuable information concerning the propagation characteristics of elastic materials. We assume that the body is homogeneous and the density strictly positive. By a progressive wave we mean a function u on $ x (— oo, oo) of the form u(x, t) =aq>(p-m — ct), (a)2 where: (i) (p is a real-valued function of class C2 on (—oo, oo) with (ii) a and m are unit vectors called, respectively, the direction of motion and the direction of propagation; 1 For studies of steady waves, of which plane progressive waves are a special case, see SAenz [1953, 11] and Stroh [1962, 14]. 2 Recall that p (x) = x — 0.
246 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 71. (iii) c is a scalar called the velocity of propagation. We say that the wave is longitudinal if a and m are linearly dependent; transverse if a and m are perpendicular; elastic if u satisfies the displacement equation of motion AivC[Vu]=QU (b) on (?x(— oo, oo). Thus an elastic progressive wave is an elastic motion of the form (a) that corresponds to zero body forces. Let a denote any given constant, and let nt denote the plane defined by nt={x: (a? —0) -m— ct=a}. Then at any given time t the displacement field u is constant on nt. This plane is perpendicular to m and, as a function of t, is moving with velocity c in the direction m. For this reason u is sometimes referred to as a plane progressive wave. By (a) Vu = q>' a®m, (c) where as 's=p-m-ct r v ' as2 \s=p-m-ct Thus divu = <p' am, curl u = q>' m xa, and, since cp' ^0 (because <p" ^0), it follows that a progressive wave is: longitudinal <=> curl w = 0, transverse <=> div u = 0. By(c) C[Fw] =9>'C[a(g)»i], and, as C is independent of x, div C[Vu] =(p"C[a®m] m=Q<p"A(m)a, (d) where A(m) is the acoustic tensor discussed in the previous section: A(m) a = Q~1C[a®m] m. Next, Qti = Qc!i<p" a, (e) and (d) and (e) yield the (1) Propagation condition for progressive waves.1 A necessary and sufficient condition that the progressive wave u defined in (a) be elastic is that the Fresnel-Hadamard propagation condition A(m) a=c2a hold. 1 According to Truesdell and Toupin [1960, 17], § 300, the ideas behind this theorem can be traced back to the work of Fresnel. See also Cauchy [1840, 1], pp. 42-50; Green [1841, iy, Musgrave [1954, 15]; Miller and Musgrave [1956, 8]; Synge [1956, 13], [1957, lay, Farnell [1961, 7]; Musgrave [1961, 15].
Sect. 71. Progressive wave. 247 Thus for a progressive wave to propagate in a direction m its amplitude must be a principal vector of the acoustic tensor A(m) and the square of the velocity of propagation must be the associated characteristic value. If the elasticity tensor C is symmetric, then, by (i) of (70.1), A(m) is symmetric, and hence has at least three orthogonal principal directions 0^,02,0^ and three associated principal values c\, c\, c\ for every m. Further, if C is strongly elliptic, then A(m) will be positive definite and %, c2, and c3 will be real. Thus, if C is symmetric and strongly elliptic, there exist, for every direction m, three orthogonal directions of motion and three associated velocities of propagation clt c2, c3 for progressive waves. Theorem (1), when combined with (70.2), implies the (2) Propagation condition for isotropic bodies.1 For an isotropic material the progressive wave u defined in (a) will be elastic if and only if either (i) c2 = c\ = — — and the wave is longitudinal; or (ii) c2=c%=fiJQ and the wave is transverse. Thus for an isotropic material there are but two types of progressive waves: longitudinal and transverse. One can ask whether or not longitudinal and/or transverse waves exist for anisotropic materials. This question is answered by the (3) Fedorov-Stippes theorem.2 There exist longitudinal and transverse elastic progressive waves provided the elasticity tensor is symmetric and strongly elliptic. Proof. By (1) there exists a longitudinal progressive wave in the direction m provided A(m)m = km (a) for some scalar A>0. Since C is strongly elliptic, A(m) is positive definite; thus, given any m, m- A(m)m>0, A(m)m^0. (b) Consider the function I defined on the surface of the unit sphere by ,. . A{m) m , . I m) = -. .—'. -r . (c) v ' \A(m) m\ v ' i By the first of (b), I is continuous, maps the surface of the unit sphere into itself, \ \ and maps no point into its antipode. By a fixed point theorem,3 any such map I has a fixed point. Thus there exists a unit vector m^ such that l{m1) =m1, or equivalently, by (c), A(m1)m1 = A»w1, k = \A{m^m1\. Thus there exists a longitudinal progressive wave in the direction m^. By the spectral theorem (3.2), there exist unit vectors ma and m3 such that m^, m2, ms are orthonormal and m2 and m3 are principal directions for A{m^. Since A(m^ 1 Cauchy [1840, 1], pp. 137-142. See also Lam£ [1852, 2], § 59; Weyrauch [1884, 2], §§ 98-99; Butty [1946, 1], §§ 60-62; Pailloux [1956, 9], p. 35- 2 This theorem was arrived at independently by Fedorov [1964, 7] and Stif-pes [1965, 18]. See also Truesdell [1966, 27], [1968, 13] and Fedorov [1965, S], § 18. Kolodner [1966, 14] has extended the Fedorov-Stippes theorem by showing that there exist three distinct directions along which longitudinal waves propagate. Sadaki [1941, 2] has calculated the actual directions along which longitudinal and transverse waves propagate for various crystal classes. See alsoBRUGGER [1965, 3]. Waterman [1959, 18] has established results for waves that are nearly longitudinal or nearly transverse. 3 See, e.g., Bourgin [1963, 2], Theorem 8.7 on p. 132.
248 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 72. is positive definite, the corresponding characteristic values c\ and c\ are positive and hence are the squares of positive numbers. Thus there exist progressive waves in the direction m^ whose directions of motion are equal to m2 and m^. But m2 and wig are orthogonal to m^. Thus these progressive waves are transverse. □ (4)1 Assume that the elasticity tensor is symmetric and strongly elliptic. Ldje be an axis^oj_ syjfjmetiyJPLAlMAterial.2 Then there exist longitudinal and transverse elastic progressive waves whose direction of propagation is e. Proof. Clearly, we have only to show that e is a characteristic vector for A(e). Since e is an axis of symmetry, Qe=e (a) for some ^=(= 1 in the symmetry group. Thus, by (iv) of (70.1), QA(e)=A(e)Q, and we conclude from the commutation theorem (3.3) that Q leaves invariant each characteristic space of A(e). By (a) Q must be a proper rotation about e through an angle •&. If ■& 4= n, then the only spaces left invariant by Q are the one-dimensional space 91 spanned by e, the plane perpendicular to 91, and the entire space "V. If # = n, then Q leaves invariant, in addition, each one-dimensional space spanned by a vector perpendicular to e. In either event, it is clear that at least one characteristic space of A(e) must contain e. □ It follows from the above proof that if #4=¾ elastic transverse waves can propagate in the direction of e with any amplitude perpendicular to e, and all' of these waves propagate with the same velocity. 72. Propagating surfaces. Surfaces of discontinuity. In this section we define the notion of a propagating singular surface. Roughly speaking, this is a surface, moving with time, across which some kinematic quantity suffers a jump discontinuity. Recall that (fW =gx(-00,00), y<4> =y x (-00, 00). By a smoothly propagating surface we mean a smooth_tln"ee-dimensional manifold "W in Sw with the following property: given any (x, f)£iT, there exists a normal" (ft, a^gY^4' to W at (x, t) with ft 4=0, « + 0. This assumption implies the existence of a four-vector field m = (m, — c) on iT that is normal to "W and has |m|=1, 00. We call m the direction of propagation and c the speed of propagation. For the remainder of this section let #"be a smoothly propagating surface in Bx(0,t0). Since iT is a smooth manifold, and since c is strictly positive, W has the following property: given any point (x0, t^zW there exists a neighborhood £ of x0, a neighborhood T of l0, and a smooth scalar field y> on Z such that t=ip{x) for all (x,t)€Nr^W, N=ZxT. 1 Fedorov [1965, 5], pp. 92-94. 2 See p. 73.
Sect. 72. Propagating surfaces. Surfaces of discontinuity. 249 In terms of y>: m(X, t) = -r~ ,T, clX, t) = 7^-r-rr- V ' |Fy(a:)| I Py (*") I for all (x,t)€N<^ir. For t fixed, is the smooth surface in B occupied by if at time t;1 it is not difficult to show that the vector m (x, t) is normal to £ft at x. Let r={y(t):ttT} be a smooth curve on W of the form y(t) = (y(t), t). We say that J" is a ray if y{>) is a solution of the differential equation2 Thus i/ (•) is the path traversed by a particle on if whose trajectory at any time t is perpendicular to Sft and whose speed is c. Assume, without loss in generality, that the ray F passes through the neighborhood N in which the manifold if is described by y>. Let a denote arc length along J": t <r= f\y(r)\dr. o Since \y\ never vanishes, a is an invertible function of t; we write t for the inverse function, i.e. t^t{a), and we define y{a)=y{t{a)), c(o)^c(y(o)J(a)), Vela) = |7a,c (x,w(x))\ =17(777^1-) m(a)=m(y(a),'t(a)). = m(<r) = C» VV{y(a)), (^.^=1^(^(a))|«, Since da it follows that Thus we are led to the following differential equation for the ray: c* \daj\da ) c2 c da2 It follows from this equation that if the velocity c is constant on if, then every ray is a straight line. """ ~ Let7 be a function on Bx (0, t0). We call if a singular surface of order zero with respect to / if / is continuous on B x (0, t0) —if and / suffers a jump disccaitinuity-^cross^. The jump in / across if is then the function [/] on if 1 In the literature it is customary to define a smoothly propagating surface to be a (smooth) one-parameter family SPt, 0<t<tB, of smooth surfaces S?t in B. In this instance •)T = {(aB, t):x£Srt, o<t<t„}. 2 Since y • m = (cm, 1) • (m, — c) = 0, this definition is consistent in the sense that the tangent to P is also tangent to if.
250 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 72. defined by1 [f] (x, t) = Hm {/(x,t+h)-f(x,t-h)}. Thus the jump in / is the difference between the values of / just behind and immediately in front of the wave. Since / is continuous on each side of if, we can evaluate [/] by taking limits along the normal m: W(§) = lim{/(§-Am)-/(§+Am)} h-±0+ iox\={x,t)elf. Let n S2 1 be a fixed integer. We call if a singular surface of order n with respect to / if:2 (i) / is class C"-1 on B x (0, t0) and class Cn on Bx (0, t0)-if; (ii) the derivatives of / of order n suffer jump discontinuities across if. The next theorem shows that for a singular surface of order 1, the jumps in the space and time derivatives of the associated function are related. ^.(1) Maxwell's compatibility theorem.3 Let cp be a scalar field, v a vector field, and T a tensor field on Bx(0, t0), and suppose that if is a singular surface of order \ with respect to cp, v, and T. Then c[Vcp\ = — [y]m, (1) c[Vv] = — [v]®m, (2) c[divv]= — [v]m, (3) c [curl v] = [v] x m, (4) c[divT] = -[T]m. (5) Proof. Choose a point \^if and a (non-zero) four-vector a such that a -m(£)=0. Since if has dimension 3, a is tangent to if at \. Further, since if is smooth, there exists a smooth curve Q = {z (a): 0¾ ^ a ^ a2} on if through 2; whose tangent at 2; is a; i.e. for some 0,,6(0¾. <x2) *(oo)=?. *'K)=°> (a) where , dz da For ^¢^ and any function f on Bx(0, t0), let /t(?) = lim/(?-Aiii). ft—M)+ /,(0 = Iim/(?+*«•), so that _ W(S) =/i(S)-/,(?). (b) 1 This notation was introduced by Christoffel [1877, 1], § 6. 2 The notion of a singular surface of order n |ao is due to Duhem [1900, 1] and Hada- mard [1901, 5], § 1, [1903, 3], § 75- See also Truesdell and Toupin [196O, 17], § 187. 3 Maxwell [1873, 1], § 78, [1881, 1], § 78a. Cf. also Weingarten [1901, 7], Hadamard [1903, 3], § 73, Truesdell and Toupin [i960, 17], § 175, Hill [1961, 14].
Sect. 72. Propagating surfaces. Surfaces of discontinuity. 251 Then, by the smoothness properties of <p, -/.- 9¾(*(«)) = -£ l™ 9» (z(«) -*•») = 11^1^(=0-^) = lim ^(4) ?>(z(a) -Am) • *'(«) • Thus (a) implies1 *->o+ da. <Pl (* («)) !«=«„ = « • (P<4> <P)l (5) • (C) A similar result holds also for cp^; if we subtract this result from (c) and use (b), we arrive at the relation -/.-[?>] (*(«))!«-«.=«• Ww¥\ (5)- (d) On the other hand, since cp is continuous across #7 hence (d) implies for every J-e^and every o tangent to if at $•. Thus [F^gp] (?) must be parallel to m(g): Wm<p] (9 = A(9 m(§); (e) equivalently, [[79?]= Am, [95] = —Ac, which implies (1). If we apply (1) to the scalar field v • a, where a is an arbitrarily chosen vector, we find that c [V (v ■ a)] = — [v ■ a] m. Thus c[VvT] a = —(m® [»]) a, which yields (2). If we take the trace of (2), we arrive at (3); if we take the skew part, we arrive at (4). Finally, (5) follows from (3) with v =TTa, where a is an arbitrary vector. □ We now sketch an alternative proof of the relation (1) in (1). By a four- dimensional counterpart of Stokes' theorem, / skw {([7(4)cp) ®ri}da = Q for every closed T^-regular2 hypersurface £f in Bx(0,t0). The same argument used to derive (c) in the proof of (73.1) here yields skw {[[7(4) cp] ® m} = 0. Operating with this equation on m, we are led to the relation (e) in the proof of (1). The next theorem shows that for a vector field v with a discontinuity of order 1, the jumgs^in Vv and v are completely determined by the jumps in the divergence and curl of_».__ 1 Hadamard [1903, 3], § 72. Cf. Lichtenstein [1929, 2], Chap. 1, § 9, and Truesdell and Toupin [i960, 17], § 174. 2 This term is defined on p. 252.
252 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 72. (2) Weingarten's theorem.1 Let ~W be a singular surface of order 1 with respect to a vector field v on By.(0, t0), and let a = [v\. Then a-m = o<=> [div»] =0, (1) axm = 0<=> [curl»] =0, (2) a = — cm [div v] + cm x [curl v]. (3) Proof. The results (l) and (2) follow from (3) and (4) of (1). To establish (3) we note that the identity a = (a • m) m + (a<S>m) m — (m(g)a) m in conjunction with (2) and (3) of (1) imply a = —c[diw] m — c[Vv] m-\-c[VvT\ m. This relation yields (3), since [Vv — VvT] m = [curl v] xm. □ We will occasionally deal with integrals of the form f Mn da, where ,^ is a closed hypersurface with outward unit normal field n. If ~W is a singular surface of order zero with respect to M, then M will suffer a jump discontinuity across £fr\HT. To insure that the above integral exists and that the value of M in the integrand at a point of discontinuity equals its limit from the region interior to Zf, we give the following definitions. Let ^bea closed regular hypersurface in J3x(0, t0), i.e. ,^ is the boundary of a regular region D#> in B x (0, t0). A point £e £f is #"-regular if either %$ir or "%<L-W and there exists an open ball Tin S(4) with center at £ such that {Wr^Z) C Sf (see Fig. 16). We say that ,^ is if '-regular if the set of points of £f that are not "^"-regular has zero area measure. x Fig. 16. %x and %% are l^-regular; i-3 is not nF-regular. 1 [1901, 7]. Cf. also Truesdell and Toupin [1960,17], § 175.
Sect. 73. Shock waves. Acceleration waves. Mild discontinuities. 253 \ I Let iTbe a singular surface of order zero with respect to a four-tensor field M on B x (0, *0). Then the limit M(S = MmM(?) exists for every regular "%^Sf. Further, the integral J Mn da ST exists whenever if is a closed 1^-regular hypersurface in B x (0, t0). When such is the case we define r / Mnda= J Mn da. 73. Shock waves. Acceleration waves. Mild discontinuities. Throughout this section -W is a smoothly propagating surface in B x (0, t0) with direction of propagation m and speed of propagation c. Further, we assume that the elasticity field C and the density field q are continuous on J5, that q is strictly positive, and that the fo>^ /orce /»rirf vanishes. Let «J2:1 be a fixed integer. By a wave of order n we mean an ordered array [u, S] with properties (i)—(iii) below. (i) u is a vector field and S a symmetric tensor field on B X (0, t0). (ii) ~W is a singular surface of order n with respect to u and order « — 1 with respect to S. (iii) u and S satisfy balance of linear momentum in the following form: given any closed ^-regular hypersurface £f in J5x (0, t0), f Mn da=0, where M is the stress^momentum field1 corresponding.t.QjSJ and u. Requirement (iii) is motivated by (19.6). For n S: 2, (iii) may be replaced by the assumption that divS = e« on J5x(0, t0)— iT. (a) For n = \ the discussion given at the end of the last section insures the existence of the integral in (iii); in addition, the value of M in the integrand is equal to its limit from the region interior to £f. When n—\, (iii) implies (a), but the converse is not true. However, in this instance (iii) is equivalent to the following requirement: (iii') for every one-parameter family Pt (^ < t < ts) of parts of B, j (Sn) (x, t) dax = -~ J (qu) (x, t) dvx BP, Pt whenever the integral on the left and the derivative on the right exist. Here the stress Son 8Pt is to be interpreted as its limit from the interior of Pt. Given a wave of order n, we call r(»). a = [u] 1 See p. 67.
254 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 73- the amplitude, and we assume, for convenience, that a never vanishes. A wave of"order"'{' is""sometimes referred to as a stress wave or shock wave; a wave of order 2 is often called an acceleration waveTYof a'sEocK wave the amplitude equals the jump in the velocity, while for an acceleration wave a is equal to the jump in the acceleration. We call a wave longitudinal or transverse according as a and m are parallel or perpendicular r For "a.wave"of order n, iT is a singular surface of order 1 with respect to u ; thus Weingarten's theorem (72.2) implies that a is completely determined by the jumps in the divergence and curl of u s : a = — cm [div u ] + cm x [curl u ]. In addition, we conclude from (72.2) that the wave is: (k-1) longitudinals [curl u ]=0, ,.. (»-i), transverse <=> [div tt]=0. For a wave of order n the time-derivative of S of order w — 1 is allowed to jump across the wave. The next result gives a relation between this jump and the amplitude a. (1) Balance of momentum at the wave.1 For a wave of order n Sg 1, (»-D [ S ] m= —Qca. Proof. Let n = 1. Let £ be an open ball in B x (0, t0) with center on iT. For £ sufficiently small, ~W divides £ into two regular regions £+ and £' with "^-regular boundaries. Let £' be that portion of £ into which m points (see Fig. 17). Fig. 17. 1 Although we have assumed that the body force field b = 0, the above result remains valid if we assume instead that b is of class Cn—1 on B X (0, t0). For a shock wave (n = 1) the relation in (2) has a long history. Hydrodynamical special cases for situations in which S= —pi were obtained by Stokes [1848, 2], Eq. (3), Riemann [i860, 1], § 5, Rankine [1870,2], §§3-5, Christoffel [1877, 1], §1, Hugoniot [1887, i], §140, and Jouguet [1901, 6]; for general S but linearized acceleration, by Christoffel [1877, 2], § 4; for finite elastic deformation by Zemplen [1905, 3], p. 448, [1905, 4], § 3, whose derivation is based on Hamilton's principle. The general result (for n — 1) is due to Kotchine [1926, 2], Eq. (18). Cf. also Truesdell and Toupin [1960, 17], § 205, Jeffrey [1964, 11].
Sect. 73. Shock waves. Acceleration waves. Mild discontinuities. 255 By (iii) ^ J Mnda= J Mnda = f Mnda—Q, as 82+ 82- where M is the stress momentum field; thus fMnda-\- f Mnda— f Mnda=0. (a) 82+ 82- 8i' The boundary of £ can be decomposed into a portion contained in d£* and a portion contained in d£~; the remainder of d£+ and the remainder of d£~ are equal, as sets, to £r\W; as surfaces,/Jfowever, they have opposite orientation. Thus (a) reduces to / {lim M(5+) m(g) - lim M(%~) m©} da% = 0, (b) Xr\nr K+-*% \~~-+% where £* is a point of £*. In deriving (b) we have used the fact that the value of M in the integral over d£* is equal to its limit from the interior of £*. Since (b) must hold for every sufficiently small open ball £ with center on ~W, it follows that [M]m=0, (c) or equivalently, using the definitions of M and m,1 [S] m = —Qc[u\ = —qca, which is the desired relation for n = 1.2 Consider now a wave of order n2g2. Choose (cc, <) in Bx(0, /0) —#". Then there exists an open ball £ in B centered at x and an open time interval TC (to>h) containing £ such that #^ (27 xT) =0. Thus S is a time-dependent admissible stress field and u is an admissible motion on £xT; (iii) and (19.6) therefore imply divS=@fi on £xT. Since (x, t) in B x (0, i!0) — "#^ was arbitrarily chosen, the above relation holds on B x (0, t0) — W. If we differentiate n — 2 times with respect to i! and take the jump in the resulting equation, we arrive at («-a> («) [div S ]=Q[u]=ga. (d) (»-2) Clearly, ~W is a singular surface of order 1 with respect to S ; thus (5) of (72.1) yields (»-2) (»-l) c[div S ] = -[ S ]m. (e) Eqs. (d) and (e) imply the desired result for n S2 2. □ We say that a wave [«, S] of order n 2g 1 is elastic if S=C|Vu]. We now show that for an elastic wave of any order traveling in the direction m^ the square of the speed.must.be a characteristic.„v.alue of the acoustic, tensor A(ni)j..and the amplitude must lie in the corresponding characteristic space. 1 See pp. 67, 248. 2 The proof up to this point is due to Keller [1964, 12],
256 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 73. (2) Propagation theorem for waves of order n.1 Elastic waves of all orders n ^ 1 obey the Fresnel-Hadamard propagation condition A{m) a = c2a. Proof. Let [u, S] be an elastic wave of order n ;> 1. Since if is a singular surface of order 1 with respect to v = u , we can apply (2) of (72.1) with the result: (B_1) (M) c[V u ] = — [m]®»h = — a®m. (a) Next, (a) and the stress-strain relation imply C["s ]=C[c[|7<"tt1,]]=-C[o®m], (b) and since A(m) a = g-1C[a(g)m] m, (b) and (1) imply the desired result. □ More pedantically, the Fresnel-Hadamard condition reads A(x, m) a (x, t) = c2 (x, t) a (x, t) for every (x, t)^W. Combining (2) and (70.2), we arrive at the (3) Propagation theorem for isotropic bodies.2 If the body is isotropic then a wave of order » 2:1 is either longitudinal, in which case rl — A— 2t* + * c -c1—e-, or transverse, in which case Comparing (2) and (3) to (71.1) and (71.2), we see that the laws of propagation,,,, of waves of discontinuity are the same as those of progressive waves; thus the discussion following (71.1) and (71.2) also holds in_the present circumstances. | In particular, we note flialir^is^ymmetric" aii'ar'strongry~elliptic, there existTTor I every direction m, three associated velocities of propagation for singular surf aces. Note that the maximum speed of propagation cM defined in (70.3) is the supremum over all possible velocities of propagation of elastic waves of any order. For a homogeneous and isotropic body the velocity of propagation c is identically constant. Therefore (3) and the remark made on p. 249 yield the following result. 1 This theorem is essentially due to Christoffel [1877. 2], who gave a proof for n = \. Hadamard [1903, 3], §§ 260, 267-268, extended Christoffel's result to acceleration waves (n = 2). That the Fresnel-Hadamard condition should hold for all n is clear from the results of Ericksen[1953, Iff], §6, and Truesdeix[i 961,22], §3, in finite elasticity theory (cf. Trues- dell and Noll [1965, 22], § 72). See also Hugoniot [1886, 2]; Duhem [1904, 2], Part 4, Chap. 1, §5; Love [1927,3], §206-209; Finzi [1942, 1]; Pastori [1949, 7]; Petrashen [1958,12]; Buchwald [1959.-7]; Truesdell andToupin [1960,17], § 301; Nariboli [1966,18]. 2 Hugoniot [1886, 2]. Elastic waves of order zero (for which if is a singular surface of order zero with respect to the displacement field) in an isotropic but inhomogeneous body are discussed by Gvozdev [1959, 5] using the theory of weak solutions. Gvozdev shows that such waves travel with a velocity equal to cx or c2. Other studies concerned with wave propagation in isotropic elastic media are: Levin and Rytov [1956, 7], Thomas [1957, 17], Babich and Alekseev [1958, 1], Skuridin and Gvozdev [1958, 16], Karal and Keller [1959,9]. Skuridin [1959, 14].
Sect. 74. Domain of influence. Uniqueness for infinite regions. 25 7 (4) Suppose that the body is homogeneous and isotropic. Then, for a wave^ of any order nj=l,_thejJ?yj aZ? ^&!£!}£.M.?l$s- 74. Domain of influence. Uniqueness for infinite regions. In this section we allow B to be a bounded or unbounded regular region. We assume that C is positive definite and symmetric, that q is strictly positive, and that C and q'1 are continuous and bounded on B. It then follows that the maximum speed of propagation cM defined in (70.3) is finite. Given an elastic process [u, E, S] and a given time te(0, t0), let Dt denote the set of all xeB such that: (i) if xeB, then u(x, 0)=(=0 or u(x, 0)4=0 or b(x, t)=(=0 for some t€ [0, t]; (ii) if xedB, then s (x, t) • ii (x, t) =)= 0 for some re [0, t]. Here [6, s] is the external force system associated with the process. Roughly speaking, D( is the support of the initial and boundary data. Consider next the set Dt of all points of B that can be reached by signals propagating from Dt with speeds equal to or less than the maximum speed of propagation cM: Dt={x^B:Dtr,Smt(x)^9). We call Dt the domain of influence1 of the data at time t. The next theorem, which is the main result of this section, shows that on [o, t] the data has no effect on points outside of Dt. (1) Domain of influence theorem.2 Let [u, E, S] be an elastic process, and let Df be the domain of influence of its data at time t. Then M=0, E=S=0 on (B— Dt)x[0, t]. The proof of this theorem is based on the following lemma. In the statement and proof of this lemma e (x, G) is the strain energy density at x corresponding to the (not necessarily symmetric) tensor G: s{x,G)=\G-Cx[G}. (a) (2) Wheeler-Sternberg lemma? Let [u, E, S] be an elastic state corresponding to the external force system [6, s]. Further, letx:B-> [0, t0) be a continuous 1 Since Dt is based on the maximum speed of propagation, it is, actually, an upper bound on the domain of influence. Cf. Duff [1960, 5]. 2 This is a miuor modification of a theorem due to Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, Iff], Lemma 2.2 and Wheeler [1970, 3], Theorem 1. These authors assume vanishing initial data and do not utilize the notion of a domain of influence. The general idea is due to Zaremba [1915, i], who established an analogous result for the wave equation. Zaremba's scheme was rediscovered independently by Rubinowicz [1920, 2] and Friedrichs and Lewy [1928, 1]. See also Courant and Hilbert [1962, 5], pp. 659-661, Bers, John, and Schechter [1964, 3], Duff [1960, 5]. 3 Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, Iff], Lemma 2.1 for homogeneous and isotropic media; Wheeler [1970, 3], Lemma 1, for anisotropic but homogeneous media. Both of the above results assume vanishing initial data. Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 17
B — e 258 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 74. and piecewise smooth field on B with {xeB: r(x) >0} finite. Then t(sb) T(ac) / I s(x, t) • u{x, t) dt da + \ \ b(x,f) -u(x, t) dt dv 8B 0 BO f {-%- [m2(*.t(*)) -w2(»,0)] -e{x,6[x)) +e(x, Vu(x,r(x)) + G(x)) (b) (a>, Vu{x, 0))\dv where G{x)=ii(x, x{x)) <g> Vr(x). (c) Proof of (2). For any function / on J3x[0, t0), let fT be the function on E defined by Mx)=f(x,T(x)). (d) Further, let r(aO fe=Sti, «(«) = / k(x,t)dt. (e) o Then » is continuous on 5 and piecewise smooth on B, and we conclude, with the aid of the equation of motion, that t(sb) div»(*)=fcT(*)-|7T(*)+ f\s- Vu + -e2-(u-u)—b-u (x,t)dt. (f) 0 Since k=S-Vu, (f) takes the form div v (x) = kz (x) ■ Vr (x) + e (x, Vur (x))—e (x, Vu (x, 0)) t(sb) + e^- [uz(x) - wa(#, 0)] - f 6 •«*(«, *) rf*. 0 A simple calculation using the symmetry of C yields kz(x) ■ Vr(x) = Vr(x) ■ (Sz(x) uz(x)) = Sz(x) -G(x)=G(x) ■ Cx[Vur(x)] = s(x, Vuz(x)+G(x))-e(x, Vuz(x))—e(x, G(x)); thus div t> (a?) =-^ «?(*)-u*(x, 0) -e(a>, G(*))+c(a!, |7Mr(a;)+G(cc)) T[X) (g) -£ (¾. Ftt(a!, 0))-/6 •!*(*, <) <^. Each of the terms on the right hand side of (g) is a piecewise continuous function of x on B. Moreover, it is clear from (e) and the assumed properties of r that v has bounded support. Thus div v is integrable on B, and the divergence theorem together with (g) and the second of (e) imply (b). □ Proof of (1). Let (*, A) e (B - Dt) x (0, t) be fixed, let Q = B^£XeM(z), (h)
Sect. 74. Domain of influence. Uniqueness faMjnfinite regions. vjjnfinit 259 Fig. 18. and let r: B -> [0, t) be defined by , > (A 1- \x—z\, xeQ, t(*)={ cm ' '' lo, »(f.Q. (i) Then t is continuous and piecewise smooth on B, and Vr has a weak point discontinuity at x = z and a jump discontinuity across Br\dQ. Moreover, IIZrHA- on£, (i) |7t = 0 on £-£. Since A < t, we conclude from (h) and the definition of the domain of influence Dt that hence By (i) and (k), b=0 on Qx[0,t], s-ti=0 on (Qr\dB)x[0,f], u(-, 0) =m(., 0) =0 on Q. (k) (1) r(x) (m) // b(x,rj) •u(x,if) drj dv=0, b o r(a>) // s(£c,^) •«(», ?;) dtjda=0. dB 0 Next, (i), (j), and (c) imply u(x, r(x)) — u(x, 0), Fm(cc, t(cc)) = Vu(x, 0), C(cc)=0, #¢£. (n) By (a), (n), and (1), e(x, G{x))=0, XQ.Q, it2 (x, t (x)) — m2 (as, 0) = e [x, Vu(x, t(*)) + G(x)) — e (ae, Vu(x, 0)) = (°) u2(x, r(x)), xcQ, 0, cc$.Q, e [x, Vu (x, x {x)) + G(x)), xeQ, 0, x$Q. 17*
260 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 74. Clearly, t satisfies the hypotheses of the Wheeler-Sternberg lemma (2). Therefore we may conclude from (b), (m), and (o) that f M&Hjiifa r(x)) -e(x, G(x)) +e(x, Vu{x, r(x))+G(x)) dv=0. (p) a Since \G{x)\2 = \Vr{x)\2u2(x, r{x)) for xe(B— {«}), it follows from (a), (j) and the inequality in (70.3) that e{x,G(x))^-e-{*±u*{x,T(x)); thus ^ it* (x, r (as)) - £ (x, G(x)) S: 0 (q) for xe(B — {«}). Since C is positive definite, the function e is non-negative, and (q) implies that the integrand in (p) is non-negative on Q — {«}. Thus, since this integrand is also continuous on Q — {«}, we conclude from (p) that it must vanish on this set. This fact, in conjunction with (q), implies e (x, Vu(x, x (*)) + G{x)) = o, xe (Q — {s}). Thus, since C is positive definite, (a) yields E(x,r(x))+symG(x)=0, xe(Q-{s}). (r) By (i) In view of (i) and the continuity of E and u, E(x,r(x))->E(s,X), u(x, t(x))->u(s, X) as x-^-z. (t) If we let x—z-\-5e, where e is a fixed unit vector, and take the limit in (r) as <5-»-0, we conclude, with the aid of (c), (s), and (t), that E(z, A) + — sym {u(*. A) <g>e} = 0. (u) CM Since (u) must hold for every unit vector e, (u) must hold with e replaced by — e; thus E(», A)=0. As (s, A) was arbitrarily chosen in (B—D() x(0, £), and since E is continuous, £==0 on (E-Dt)x[0,f]. (v) By the definition of D(, 6=0 on (5— D()x[0, (], tt(.,0)=ti(',O)=0 on 5— Dt; (w) (v) and the first of (w) together with the stress-strain relation and the equation of motion imply S = 0, « = 0 on (B—D,)x[0,f]. (x) The second of (x) and (w) yield m = 0 on (B-Dt)x[0,t), and the proof is complete. □
Sect. 75- Basic equations. 261 We now use the domain of influence theorem to establish a uniqueness theorem for elastodynamks thaHs valid for infinite domains. In "comparing: this theorem to theUniqueness theorems of Neumann (63.1) and Brun (63.2) it must be remembered that among the assumptions made at the beginning of this section are the assumptions that Cbe_gositiye. definite and symmetricand .that q be strictly positive. (3) Uniqueness theorem.1 Under the assumptions made at the beginning of this section the mixed problem of elastodynamics has at most one solution. Proof. Let p = [u, E, S] be the difference between two solutions. Then p corresponds to vanishing body forces and satisfies tt(-,O)=M(-,0)=0 on B, s-m=0 on Bx(O,t0). Choose t arbitrarily in (0, t0). Clearly, Dt is empty, and thus the domain of influence Dt of the data at time t is empty. Therefore we conclude from (1) that p vanishes on J5x [0, t\. Since t was arbitrarily chosen, the proof is complete. □ 1 Itj^iould^be noted that Wheeler and Sternberg's uniqueness theorem (3) I is valid for exterior domains and also for regions..whose.boundaries extend to iriflnityT An elastodyhamic uniqueness theorem valid for infinite regions may aTtefnatively be based on the classical energy identity following Neumann's procedure (63.1), provided one introduces suitable restrictions on the orders of magnitude of the velocity and stress fields at infinity. The advantage of (3) is that it does nqt.i.nxQlv£.~sucli. artificial a priori assumptions. The analogous uniqueness issue in elastostatics, where the equations are elliptic rather than hyperbolic, is considerably more involved. For exterior domains elastostatic uniqueness, theorems that avoid extraneous order prescriptions at infinity are given in Sect. 50. VI. The free vibration problem. 75. Basic equations. The free vibration problem2 is concerned with an elastic body undergoing motions of the form u(x, t)—u (x) sin (<ot+y), E(x, t) =E(x) sin (cot +y), (a) S (x, t)=S (x) sin (cot+y), where a> is the frequency of vibration and y is the phase. If we assume null body forces, then these fields will satisfy the fundamental field equations of elastodynamics if and only if the amplitudes u(x), E(x), and S(x) obey the relations E = $(Vu + VuT), S=C[E], divS+e<u2w=0. Since C[E]=C[Vu], 1 Wheeler and Sternberg [1968, 16] for the case in which B is homogeneous and isotropic; Wheeler [197O, 3] for the case in which B is homogeneous, but anisotropic. 2 The vibration problem for infinite domains is treated in detail by Kupradze [1963, 17, 18].
262 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 76. the above relations yield the following equation for the displacement amplitude: divC[Vu]+Q(oiu=0, (b) which, for a homogeneous and isotropic body, takes the form /j,A u + {X+[j) Vdivu->rQco2u — 0. Also, a simple calculation, similar to that used to deduce (e) of Sect. 59, yields the relations c\ A divw+ft)2divw = 0, c\ A curl u +co2 curl u = 0, where c^ and c2 are the irrotational and isochoric velocities. Of course, these formulae could also have been derived by substituting the relation for u (x, t) in (a) into (e) on p. 213. Returning to the general inhomogeneous and anisotropic body, we see that the procedure given on p. 214. here yields the following relation for the stress amplitude: p(^_)+ft,aK[S]=0, where K = C_1 is the compliance tensor. 76. Characteristic solutions. Minimum principles. We assume that the elasticity field has the following properties: (i) C is smooth on B; (ii) C is positive definite and symmetric. Let 3i = the set of all admissible displacement fields,1 and let £? be the operator on 3i defined by SCu=divC[Vu]. For convenience, we introduce the following notation: <m, v} = f u-v dv, B |u|=V<u,u>, <u,v}c= f Vu- C[Vv] dv. B Note that, by (ii) of (20.1), (u,v}c = fVu-C[Vv]dv. B The free vibration problem consists in finding combinations of the frequency to and amplitude u that are possible when a portion £^ of the boundary is clamped and the remainder ^ is free. This should motivate the following definition: By a characteristic solution (for the free vibration problem) we mean an ordered pair [A, u] such that A is a scalar, we^, and .S?w+Aw = 0, ||w|| = l, w = 0 on Selt s=0 on ^2; 1 See p. 59.
Sect. 76. Characteristic solutions. Minimum principles. 263 here s is the traction field corresponding to u, i.e. s = C[Vu] n on dB. We call A a characteristic value, u an associated characteristic displacement. Given A, the corresponding frequency of vibration is given by » = ]/}: as we will soon see, A is always non-negative. Finally, we say that the entire boundary is clamped if Sfx = 8B (5"2 = 0), /ree if ,¾ = 8B (5^=0). fl_) Lemma. Assume that: (i) we^ re»i% Jzfw continuous on B; (ii) « is continuous on B and piecewise smooth on B, while Vv is piecewise continuous on B. Then <i?M, «> = — <m, w>c + / s • v da, dB where s is the traction field corresponding to u. Proof. Let S=C[Fu], so that s=Sn on dB. Then / (Jzfw) -vdv=J (div S) • w rf v = / s-v da— f S- Vv dv B B dB B = / s • v da — (u, v}c- □ (2) Properties of characteristic values.1 Let [A, u] 6e a characteristic solution. Then A = <M,M>c, so that A^O. Jm /ad, A = 0 if and only if u is rigid. Moreover, a characteristic solution [A, u] mtt A=0 exists only if the entire boundary is free, in which case every rigid displacement u with |tt|=l is a characteristic vector corresponding to A=0. Proof. Since [A, u] is a characteristic solution, J5?w + Aw = 0, H| = l, (a) and s-u=0 on dB, (b) where s is the corresponding traction field. By (a) <JSPu, m> = —A<m, m> = —A; therefore we conclude from (b) and (1) that A = <M, M>c. Moreover, since C is positive definite, <«, m>c = 0, 1 Clebsch [1862, T\, § 20, generalizing a result of Poisson [1829, 2] for the vibrations of an elastic sphere. See also Ibbetson [1887, 2], § 256, CesA.ro [1894, 1], p. 58. Azhmudinov and Mamatordiev [1967, 1] show that when the boundary is clamped A is given by a certain integral over dB.
264 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 76. with equality holding if and only if the associated strain field vanishes, that is, if and only if u is rigid. Further, since u vanishes on 6^, a rigid u is possible only if «9^=0. (Since 6^ is a regular surface, if non-empty it must contain at least three non-collinear points.) On the other hand, if £fx — 0, it is a simple matter to verify that [0, tt] is a characteristic solution whenever u is rigid and |tt| = 1. □ (3) Orthogonality of characteristic displacements.1 Let [A, u] and [A, u] be characteristic solutions with A 4= A. Then <u, w> = <M, m>c = <J£u, u> = 0. Proof. By hypothesis J5?w-|-Aw = 0( (a) JSfu + iu = 0, (b) s -14=8-^=0 on 3B, (c) where s and s are the traction fields of u and u. By (a) and (b) <.£?«,«> +A<w, m> = 0, (d) <j2?w, m> + A<w, w>=0. On the other hand, (c), (1), and the symmetry of C imply that <jg?H, M> = - <M, M>c = - <U, M>c = <.£?W, M>. (e) By (d) and (e) (A — l)<u, u)—0; hence <u, ii>=0 if A 4= A. The remaining results follow from (d) and (e). □ Theorem (3) asserts that characteristic displacements corresponding to distinct characteristic values are orthogonal. This is not necessarily true if the characteristic values are equal. Indeed, if u^ ,1½,..., u„ are characteristic displacements corresponding to the same characteristic value A, then it is a simple matter to verify that any field u with flw J = 1 lying in the span of {%, u2,..., un} is also a characteristic displacement corresponding to A. Henceforth c€ denotes the set of all vector fields v with the following properties^ ""'" (i) v is continuous on B and piecewise smooth on B; (ii) Vv is piecewise continuous on B; (iii) H = l; (iv) v==0 on £^. (4) Minimum principle for the lowest characteristic value.2 Let Uj^e^r,^" and assume that (1¾. Wj>c5S <w, v}c for every veJf. Define A1 = <w1,e«1>c. Then [^, wj is a characteristic solution, and ^ is the lowest characteristic value. 1 See footnote \ on p. 263. See also Poisson [1826, T\. 2 PoincarS [1890, 2], p. 211, [1892, 6], p. 103- See also Tedone [1907, 2], § l5d; Cou- rant [1920, iy, Courant and Hilbert [1953, 8], p. 339; Hu [1958,11].
Sect. 76. Characteristic solutions. Minimum principles. 265 Proof. Let oc4=±l be an arbitrary real number and choose vejf. Then 1¾ + xv 14=0, and ||wi + at>| v 1 ' belongs to Jf; thus, by hypothesis, 1«! +at> ^ = <«!, M!>C ^ <M>, W>C = TuTXXiT» <"l +aW- "l +*®>C and hence If we expand both bilinear forms and use the relations ||t71| = [1^^11 =1 and \ = <Mj, Mi>c» we arrive at 2a[A1<M1, v} — <«!, v}c] +a2[^ — <v, v}c] ^0. Since this inequality must hold for every a 4= ± 1> we must have A^m^i?) —<«!,w>c=0. (a) As 17 = 0 on S?x, (1) implies that <«i» «>c = — <-^«i» »> + / si" ® <*«. where sx is the traction field corresponding to 1¾. In view of the last two relations, / (if Mj + h Uj) ■ v d v — / sx ■ v d a = 0 for <?wry continuous and piecewise smooth vector field v with v = 0 on Sfx and |i?|| = l. Since this expression is linear in v, we can drop the requirement that H| = l. Therefore it follows from (7.1) and (35.1) that J?!*! + Ax 1¾ = 0 on B, S! = 0 on ^2. Thus, since u^X, [^, 1¾] is a characteristic solution. If [A, u] is another characteristic solution, then (2) implies that A = <W, W>c. Thus we conclude from our present hypotheses that and hence ^ is the lowest characteristic value. □ Theorem (4) asserts that the minimum (if it exists) of the functional <». «>c (a) under the supplementary condition \\v\\ = \ (b) is the lowest characteristic value. We now show that the determination of the M-th characteristic value can be reduced to the variational problem of finding a minimum of the functional (a) under the supplementary condition (b) and the constraint <i7,w,>=0, 7 = 1,2,...,» —1,
266 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 76. where %, w2,..., un_1 are the characteristic vectors for the first n — \ characteristic values. Let 1¾, w2, ...,un be piecewise continuous vector fields on B. Then we write for the set of all piecewise continuous vector fields v on B such that <v, w,>=0, 7 = 1,2,..., ». f5_) Minimum principle.1 Let u^, u2,... belong to 2<-^$C, and let *&• <&■ .^=,^^(11^1¾. ■.., M,-i}X, 7^2. Assume that, for each »- S: 1, MreJ^ a«rf <uf, ur}c 5i <w, » >c /or eaery w G Jfr. Define A, by A, = <w,,w,>c. Then each [A,, ur] is a characteristic solution and O^A^A^ ••• . Proof. By (4), W, u{\ is a characteristic solution. We now proceed by induction. Thus we assume that «3:2 and that [A,, u,] is a characteristic solution for 1^7^» —1. Since M„e^, <mb,m,>=0, 1 = 1,2,...,» — 1. (a) On the other hand, our induction hypothesis and (1) imply that 0 = A,-<w„, u,-> = - <w„, .§?u,-> = <w„,w,->c— / s{-unda, t ==1, 2,..., m-1. But m„=0 on ,¾ and 8^ = 0 on «5^; therefore <«»»«i>c = 0, t = l,2,...,» —1. (b) Now choose veJfn and let t» = ii , ir («„ + aw), where a=t=±l- Then weJf„, and steps directly analogous to those used to establish (a) in the proof of (4) now lead to the result that A„<w*,«>-<w„,«>c = 0 (c) for every veJJT„. Let vcJf be arbitrarily chosen. If v lies in the span of 1¾. w2, ..., uh_1, then (a) and (b) imply that *„<«». »>-<H„ «>c=0. (d) Assume that » does not lie in the span of u^u^,..., un_x. Then there exist scalars /3, ^, t2, ..., tn_1 such that ^=/3^+¾^) (e) 1 See footnote 2 on p. 264.
Sect. 76. Characteristic solutions. Minimum principles. 267 belongs to $Tn. Indeed, let and (since »4= — 2 ^»u») choose (} such that ||w| = l. By (c) and (e), _ _ n-l *„<«». «>-<«„> »>c+ 2 k[K<un, «<> -<m„, u,>c] =0. (f) t = l Thus we conclude from (a) and (b) that (d) remains valid in the present circumstances. Hence (d) holds for every v€Jf, and, as in the proof of (4), this implies that [A„, un] is a characteristic solution. □ We now show that the minimum principle (5) characterizes all of the solutions of the free vibration problem provided A^oo.1 (6) Completeness of the minimum principle. Let \, A2,... and 1¾, w2,... obey the hypotheses of the minimum principle (5) and assume, in addition, that A„->- 00 as n -> 00. Let [A, u] be a characteristic solution. Then X—X, for some integer r, and if Ar-i < Af = A,+1 = ■ • • = A,+M < A,+M+1, then u is contained in the span of ur, ur.n,..., ur+n. In particular, if n =0 so that Ar is distinct, then u=:t»r Proof. Assume that A is not equal to any of the A,'s. By (4), X>XX. Thus, since Xn->00, there exists anm^2 such that Xm_x<X<Xm. (a) Since [A,, wf] is a characteristic value for every r, we conclude from (3) that _!*€{«!, 1¾. ..., MOT_1}-L. Thus, as the hypotheses of (S) hold, <Wm,W»,>C^<W.W>C. or equivalently, by (2), which contradicts (a). Thus X=Xr for some r. Assume now that Af_1<Ar=Af+1= ••• =Af+M<Af+M+1, and let W = {ur,ur+1,...,ur+n}. Since A #= A?- for / < r, it follows from (3) that «€{1^,1*2, ...,1^)-1-. (b) We decompose u as follows: M=M0 + M±, (c) where w0 belongs to the span of °ll and u±e^L. Indeed, we simply take ;'=r To complete the proof it suffices to show that wx=0. If w0=0, then u=uL, and it follows from (b) and the fact that u^e'Bf-i- that ue^.tta, ...,uf+B}-L. (d) 1 See (78.1).
268 M.E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 77. Thus, as before, K+n+l s£/> and we have a contradiction. Thus M0=j=0. Assume now that wx=|=0 and let - _ w„ - _ «1 "•-KT U±-Ju±\- Since u0 is a linear combination of characteristic displacements corresponding to the same characteristic value A, [A, u0] is a characteristic solution; this fact and (c) imply that [A, HjJ is also a characteristic solution. Thus, by (3), u^ is orthogonal to every u.<f<Bf, and hence (d) holds with u replaced by uL. Thus we are again led to a contradiction; consequently 1*1=0. □ 77. The minimax principle and its consequences. We now establish an alternative characterization of the free vibration problem. We continue to assume that C is symmetric, positive definite, and smooth on B. For convenience, we introduce the following notation: W = the set of all piecewise continuous vector fields on B, 5r=fX#"x-"Xf" (»times). Recall that JT is the set of all vector fields on B with properties (i)-(iv) listed on p. 264. (1) Minimax principle.1 Let [A,,w,] satisfy the hypotheses of (76.5) for 1 ^ r 5g n +1. Define <p on Wn by <p{w1,w2, ...,wn)=mi{(v,v}c: v^.Jf^{w1,wi,.... wn}±}. Then ^»+i = ?>K.M2. ---,^) =sup{(p(wltw2,..., wn): {wltw2, ....w^aW"). Proof. By hypothesis, A„+1 = 9?(M1,M2, ..., Uj= <MM+i, M„+i>c- (a) Thus it suffices to prove that A„+1^ cp (wltw2,...,wn) for every (w1,tot, ....wJeiT". (b) To accomplish this we will show that for every (u>1> w2,.... w„)eWnthere exists a ve.yT^{w1, w2,.... ic,,}-1 such that <w,w>c^*»+i; (c) for then (b) would follow from the inequality q>(uj1,wt, ...,w„)^,<y,v}c^An+1. Choose (w1,w2,..., wn)eW". Let n+l w=2«<«f. (d) where the oc/s are as yet undetermined. Clearly, vejf^{w1, w2,.... w^L if »+1 2«? = 1 (e) 1 Courant [1920, i]. See also Courant and Hilbert [1953, 5], p. 406.
Sect. 77. The minimax principle and its consequences. 269 and n+1 2 *,■<«,-. «v>=o (7=1,2,...,»). (f) t=l The system (f) consists of n equations in # + 1 unknowns and can always be solved for 0¾.¾. ...,ocM+1. Moreover, since the system is homogeneous, the requirement (e) can also be met. We have only to show that the function v so defined satisfies (c). Since1 <ui,ujyc = Xjdij (no sum) i, / = 1, 2, ..., » + 1, (d) implies <».»>e="2«?^- (g) t=l Further, (e) and the fact that Af^^,+1, i^n + \ imply "ZX ^ ^Vi. (h) t = l and (g), (h) yield the desired inequality (c). □ Let Ai, A2,... and 1¾. w2,... obey the hypotheses of the minimum principle (76.5). We call the ordered array {K> K> ■••} the spectrum corresponding to C, B, S^, and £f2, and we say that u^, u2, ... is an associated system of normal modes. By (76.6), (78.1), and Footnote 2 on p. 270, the spectrum contains every characteristic value, and hence it is independent of the choice of i^, w2,... (as long as this choice is consistent with (76.5)). We now consider a second body B composed of an elastic material with elasticity field C. We will discuss the vibration problem for such a body taking as boundary conditions w = 0 on £fx and s=0 on ^2, where ,¾ and ^2 are complementary subsets of 8B. In particular, we compare the spectrum corresponding to this problem with the spectrum for the problem discussed previously (assuming, of course that both spectrums exist). We assume that C is positive definite, symmetric, and smooth on B. We write if E-CX[E]^E-CX[E] for every symmetric tensor E and every xeBr\B. (2) Comparison theorem.2 Let {A^ A2, ...} be the spectrum corresponding to C,B,Sfx, and S^', {A^ A2,...}, the spectrum corresponding to C,B,§\, and i^. Assume that either 1 This follows from (d) and (e) in the proof of (16.3) and the fact that <«,-, ufy = «5,?- (i, 7 = 1, 2, ..., n+ 1). 2 Cf. Courant and Hilbert [1953, 5], pp. 407-412.
270 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 78. (i) B = B, §{<iSfx, C^C, or (ii) the entire boundary of B is clamped, and BCB, C^C. Then K^K. 7 = 1,2,... Proof. Let X be as before, and let X be the corresponding set for B and 6^. Assume that (i) holds. Then, since B = B and .¾ C .¾ > &<£. (a) Further, since C^C, <v, w>c^<w,w>c- (b) Let n ^ 1 be a fixed integer, let <p be as defined in (1), and let <p be defined on •3T»by £>(*»!, t»2,..., u>„) =inf {<v, w>g: ve^'^{w1, w2,..., w„}^-}. Then by (a) and (b) £=>. and we conclude from the minimax principle (1) that The proof under hypothesis (ii) is strictly analogous. □ 78. Completeness of the characteristic solutions. In this section we show that the characteristic values A„ become infinite as »^- oo. This implies, in particular, that each characteristic value has only a finite multiplicity. More important, however, is that the unboundedness of the characteristic values yields the completeness of the characteristic displacement fields. Thus we assume that the spectrum {Aj, A2,...} exists; in addition, we suppose that C is positive definite, symmetric, and smooth on B. (1) Infinite growth of the characteristic values.1 Assume that B is properly regular and that ^4=0-2 Then the spectrum {^, A2,...} has the following property: lim Xn — oo. n~>oo Proof. Assume that there exists a real number M such that K?iM (a) for all n. Then by (76.2) <un,u„yc^M, where u^, w2,... is an associated system of normal modes. Thus, since <«„. «„>c = 2 U{E„}, 1 Weyl [1915, 3~\. See also Courant and Hilbert [1953,8], p. 412 and Fichera [1971, 1], Theorem 6.V. 2 Note that we do not include the important case in which the entire boundary is free. That the theorem also holds in that instance is clear from the work of Weyl [1915, 3] and Fichera [1971, 1], Theorem 6.V. In fact, Weyl [1915, 3] proves that (for a homogeneous and isotropic body) X„ goes to infinity as «*. Fichera (private communication, 1971) has remarked that Weyl's result is easily extended to include inhomogeneous and anisotropic bodies (with symmetric and positive definite C).
Sect. 78. Completeness of the characteristic solutions. 271 where En is the strain field corresponding to un, we conclude from Korn's inequality (13.9) that there exists a constant K such that f\Vun\*dv£K B for all n. Consequently, since Kia = 1. (b) we conclude from Rellich's lemma (7.2) that there exists a subsequence {u„t} such that lim |m„,—M„t|=0. (c) ;, A~>oo But in view of the method of construction of 1¾. u2, ... in (76.5), <«»/. «»t>=0, »,-#»*. (d) By (b) and (d), 11««*-««* II2=\\un,f+K*|2=2, which contradicts (c). Thus there cannot exist a number M that satisfies (a); hence A„-> oo as m-> oo. [J The next theorem shows that every vector field / with property (A) below admits an expansion in terms of normal modes. (A) / is continuous on B, piecewise smooth on B, and vanishes on yx; while F/ is piecewise continuous on B. (2) Completeness of the normal modes.1 Let u^.u^,... be a system of normal modes corresponding to the spectrum {A1( A2,...}, and assume that lim A» = oo. Let f satisfy property (A). Then lim 1/- £ cMwM| = 0, JV-^-oo M=i wfere iAe cM are 2Ae Fourier coefficients cn = </,«„> • Moreover, the cn satisfy the completeness relation Proof. Let with Then, since it follows that AT 9n=1— 2c»m». (a) n=l C„ = </-"»> • <"»,.«»> =^m». (b) SM2 = |/II2-ZC»- (c) 1 Cf. Courant and Hilbert [1953, 8], p- 424.
272 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. Sect. 78. Thus the series 2 c\ converges and satisfies Bessel's inequality «=i By (a) and (c), to complete the proof it suffices to prove that \\gN |->o as N->oo. (e) Suppose that for some M,\\gM\\=0. Then (c) would imply that cM+n = 0, n = \, 2,.... and hence that ||srM+n||=°. n = i,2 Thus, in this instance, (e) holds trivially. Assume now that ||sTiv[| never vanishes and let 9n By (a), (b), and (f), ^ = Sl' N^'2>- (f) <Srjv-M«>=0, « = 1,2, ..., AT, (g) and we conclude from the properties of un and / that 9n£^n+i> (n) where $TN+l is defined in (76.5). Hence —. — 1 %n+i ^S (9n> 9n}c — T^jf (9n> 9n}c, or equivalent] y, \\9n la < <gw. 9n}c Since ^jvii-*"00 as N->oo, to complete the proof it suffices to show that (9n> 9n}c remains bounded in this limit. It follows from (76.1), the fact that [Xn, un] is a characteristic solution, (g), and (h) that <Srjv.M»>c=0, « = 1,2,..., N. Thus, since <un. um}c = K <5«„ (no sum), we conclude from (a) that N N <f,f>C = <9N+ Z C»Un.9N+ Z C„M„>C »=1 »=1 N = <9n>9n>c+ Z h%- »=1 Consequently, as An 5:0, <9N,9N>C^<f,f>C; hence (,gN, gN}c remains bounded as N->oo. □ Under reasonable assumptions on B and on S^lt the set of vector fields with property (A) is dense (with respect to the norm | • |) in the space of continuous functions on B. Thus, under such assumptions, (2) will hold for functions/ that are continuous on B.
References. 273 References. (Italic numbers in parentheses following the reference indicate the sections where the work is mentioned.) 1780 1. Euler, L.: Determinate onerum, quae columnae gestare valent. Acta Acad. Sci. Petrop. 2 (1778), 121-145- To be reprinted in L. Euleri Opera Omnia (2) 17. (22) 1822 1. Fourier, J.: Theorie Analytique de la Chaleur. Paris: Didot = CEuvres 1. (15) 1823 1. Cauchy, A.-L.: Recherches sur l'equilibre et le mouvement interieur des corps solides ou fluides, elastiques ou non elastiques. Bull. Soc. Philomath. 9-13 = CEuvres (2) 2, 300-304. (15, 22) 2. Navier, C.-L.-M.-H.: Sur les lois de l'equilibre et du mouvement des corps solides elastiques (1821). Bull. Soc. Philomath. I77-I8I. (Abstract of [1827, 2].) (22, 27, 59) 1826 1. Poisson, S.-D.: Notes sur les racines des equations transcendantes. Bull. Soc. Philomath. 145-H8. (76) 1827 1. Cauchy, A.-L.: De la pression ou tension dans un corps solide (1822). Ex. de Math. 2, 42-56 = CEuvres (2) 7, 60-78. (15) 2. Navier, C.-L.-M.-H.: Memoire sur les lois de l'equilibre et du mouvement des corps solides elastiques (1821). Mem. Acad. Sci. Inst. France (2) 7, 375-393- (22, 27, 59) 1828 1. Cauchy, A.-L.: Sur les equations qui expriment les conditions d'equilibre ou les lois du mouvement interieur d'un corps solide, elastique ou non elastique (1822). Ex. de Math. 3, 160-187 = CEuvres (2) 8, 195-226. (22, 27, 59) 1829 1. Cauchy, A.-L.: Sur l'equilibre et le mouvement interieur des corps considered comme des masses continues. Ex. de Math. 4, 293-319 = CEuvres (2) 9, 343-369. (20, 22) 2. Poisson, S.-D.: Memoire sur l'equilibre et le mouvement des corps elastiques (1828). Mem. Acad. Sci. Inst. France (2) 8, 357-570. (15, 22, 27, 59, 67, 76) 3. —• Addition au memoire sur l'equilibre et le mouvement des corps elastiques. Mem. Acad. Sci. Inst. France. (2) 8, 623-627. (67) 1830 1. Cauchy, A.-L.: Sur les diverses methodes a I'aide desquelles on peut etablir les equations qui representent les lois d'equilibre, ou le mouvement interieur des corps solides ou fluides. Bull. Sci. Math. Soc. Prop. Conn. 13, 169-176. (22) 1831 1. Poisson, S.-D.: Memoire sur les equations generates de l'equilibre et du mouvement des "corps solides elastiques et des fluides (1829). J. Ecole Polytech. 13, cahier 20, 1-174. (20, 22) 1833 1. Lame, G., and E. Clapeyron: Memoire sur l'equilibre des corps solides homogenes. Mem. Divers Savants Acad. Sci. Paris (1828) (2) 4, 465-562. (27, 59) 2. Piola, G.: La meccanica dei corpi naturalmente estesi trattata col calcolo delle variazioni. Opusc. Mat. Fis. di Diversi Autori. Milano: Giusti 1, 201-236. (18) 1839 1. Green, G.: On the laws of reflection and refraction of light at the common surface of two non-crystallized media (1837). Trans. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 7 (1838-1842), 1-24 = Papers, 245-269- (24, 34, 67) 1840 1. Cauchy, A. L.: Exercises d'Analyse et de Physique Mathematique 1. Paris: Bachelier =CEuvres (2) 12 (59, 67, 71) 1841 1- Green, G.: On the propagation of light in crystallized media (1839). Trans. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 7 (1838-1842), 121-140 = Papers 293-311- (24, 71) 2. — Supplement to a memoir on the reflexion and refraction of light. Trans. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 7, (1838-1842), 113-120= Papers 283-290. 1845 1. Stokes, G. G.: On the theories of the internal friction of fluids in motion, and of the equilibrium and motion of elastic solids. Trans. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 8 (1844— 1849), 287-319 = Papers 1, 75-129- (22, 27, 59) 1848 1. Piola, G.: Intorno alle equazioni fondamentali del movimento di corpi qualsivo- gliono, considerati secondo la naturale loro forma e costituzione (1845). Mem. Mat. Fis. Soc. Ital. Modena 24\ 1-186. (18) 2. Stokes, G. G.: On a difficulty in the theory of sound. Phil. Mag. 23, 349-356. A drastically condensed version, with an added note, appears in Papers 2, 51-55. (73) 3. Thomson, W. (Lord Kelvin) : On the equations of equilibrium of an elastic solid. Cambr. Dubl. Math. J. 3, 87-89. (51) 1849 1. Haughton, S.: On the equilibrium and motion of solid and fluid bodies (1846). Trans. Roy. Irish Acad. 21, 151-198. (34) 1850 1. Kirchhoff, G.: Uber das Gleichgewicht und die Bewegung einer elastischen Scheibe. J. Reine Angew. Math. 40, 51-88= Ges. Abh. 237-279. (34) 1851 1. Stokes, G. G.: On the dynamical theory of diffraction (1849). Trans. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 9, 1-62= Papers 2, 243-328. (59, 68) Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 18
274 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 2. — On the effect of the internal friction of fluids on the motion of pendulums (1850). Trans. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 92, 8-106 = Papers 3, 1-141. (19) 1852 1. Kirchhoff, G.: Uber die Gleichungen des Gleichgewichts eines elastischen Korpers bei nicht unendlich kleinen Verschiebungen seiner Theile. Sitzgsber. Akad. Wiss. Wien 9, 762-773. (Not reprinted in Ges. Abh.) (65) 2. Lame, G.: Lecons sur la Theorie Mathematique de l'Elasticite. Paris: Bachelier. Also 2nd ed., Paris 1866. (22, 27, 28, 44, 59, 67, 71) 1855 1. St. Venant, A.-J.-C. B., de: Memoire sur la torsion des prismes ... (1853). Mem. Divers Savants Acad. Sci. Paris 14, 233-560. {54) 1859 1- Kirchhoff, G.: Uber das Gleichgewicht und die Bewegung eines unendlich dilnnen elastischen Stabes. J. Reine Angew. Math. 56, 285-313 = Ges. Abh., 285-316. {13, 14, 32, 65) 1860 1. Riemann,B.: Uber die Fortpflanzung ebener Luf twellen von endlicher Schwingungs- weite. Gott. Abh., Math. CI. 8 (1858-1859), 43-65 = Werke, 145-164. (73) 1862 1. Clebsch, A.: Theorie der Elasticitat fester Korper. Leipzig: Teubner. There is an expanded version in French by B. De Saint Venant and A. Flamant, Paris 1883. {32, 47, 76) 1863 1. Airy, G. B.: On the strains in the interior of beams. Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc. Lond. 153, 49-80. Abstract in Rep. Brit. Assn. 1862, 82-86 (1863). {17, 47) 2. Clebsch, A.: Uber die Reflexion an einer Kugelflache. J. Reine Angew. Math. 61, 195-262. {67) 3. Thomson, W. (Lord Kelvin) : Dynamical problems regarding elastic spheroidal shells and spheroids of incompressible liquid. Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc. Lond. 153, 583-616= Papers 3, 351-394. (34, 48) 1864 1. St. Venant, A.-J.-C. B. de: Etablissement elementaire des formules et equations generates de la theorie de 1'dlasticite des corps solides. Appendix in: Resume des Lecons donnees a l'Ecole des Ponts et Chaussees sur 1'Application de la Mecanique, premiere partie, premiere section, De la Resistance des Corps Solides, par C.-L.- M.-H. Navier, 3rd ed. Paris. {14) 1865 1. Cotterill, J. H.: Further application of the principle of least action. Phil. Mag. (4), 29, 430-436. (18, 34, 36) 1866 1. Verdet, E.: Introduction, CEuvres de Fresnel 1, IX-XCIX. (22) 1868 1. Fresnel, A.: Second supplement au memoire sur la double refraction (1822). CEuvres 2, 369-442. (15) 2. Maxwell, J. C.: On reciprocal diagrams in space, and their relation to Airy's function of stress. Proc. Lond. Math. Soc. (1) 2 (1865-1969), 58-60 = Papers 2, 102-104. (17) 1870 1. Maxwell, J. C.: On reciprocal figures, frames, and diagrams of forces. Trans. Roy. Soc. Edinburgh 26 (I869-I872), 1-40 = Papers 2, 161-207. (17, 46, 47) 2. Rankine, W. J. M.: On the thermodynamic theory of waves of finite longitudinal disturbance. Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc. Lond. 160, 277-288 = Papers, 530-543. (73) 1871 1. Boussinesq, J.: Etude nouvelle sur 1'equUibre et le mouvement des corps solides elastiques dont certaines dimensions sont tres petites par rapport a d'autres. Premier Memoire. J. Math. Pures Appl. (2) 16, 125-240. (14) 1872 1. Betti, E.: Teoria dell'Elasticita. Nuovo Cim. (2) 7-8, 5-21, 69-97, 158-180; 9, 34-43; 10 (1873), 58-84 = Opere 2, 291-390. (27, 29, 30, 44, 52, 53) 1873 1. Maxwell, J.C.: A Treatise on Electricity and Magnetism. 2 vols. Oxford. Cf. [1881, 1]. (72) 1874 1. Betti, E.: Sopra l'equazioni di equilibrio dei corpi solidi elastici. Ann. Mat. (2) 6, 101-111 = Opere 2, 379-390. (30) 2. Umov, N.: Ableitung der Bewegungsgleichungen der Energie in continuirlichen Korpern. Z. Math. Phys. 19, 418-431. (19) 1876 1. Kirchhoff, G.: Vorlesungen uber mathematische Physik: Mechanik. Leipzig. 2nd ed., 1877; 3rd ed., 1883. (14, 26, 32, 65) 1877 1. Christoffel, E. B.: Untersuchungen ilber die mit dem Fortbestehen linearer partieller Differentialgleichungen vertraglichen Unstetigkeiten. Ann. Mat. (2) 8, 81-113 = Abh. 2, 51-80. (72, 73) 2. — Uber die Fortpflanzung von StoBen durch elastische feste Korper. Ann. Mat. (2) 8, 193-244 = Abh. 1, 81-126. (73) 1878 1. Boussinesq, J.: Equilibre d'elasticitd d'un solide isotrope sans pesanteur, support- tant differents poids. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 86, 1260-1263. (44) 1881 1. Maxwell, J. C: 2nd ed. of [1873, 1~\. (72)
References. 275 1882 1. Voigt, W.: Allgemeine Formeln fiir die Bestimmung der Elasticitatsconstanten von Krystallen durch die Beobachtung der Biegung und Drillung von Prismen. Ann. Phys. (2) 16, 273-321, 398-416. (26, 47) 1883 1. Thomson, W. (Lord Kelvin), and P. G. Tait: Treatise on Natural Philosophy, Part 2. Cambridge. (44, 51) 1884 1- Minnigerode, B.: Untersuchungen iiber die Symmetrieverhaltnisse und die Elasticitat der Krystalle. Nach Konigl. Ges. Wiss. Gottingen, 195-226, 374-384, 488-492. (26) 2. Weyrauch, J. J.: Theorie elastischer Korper. Leipzig: Teubner. (71) 1885 1. Boussinesq, J.: Application des potentiels a l'etude de l'equilibre et des mouve- ments des solides elastiques. Paris: Gauthier-Villars. (44, SI, 54) 2. Kovalevski, S.: Uber die Brechung des Lichtes in cristallinischen Mitteln. Acta Math. 6, 249-304. (87) 3. Neumann, F.: Vorlesungen iiber die Theorie der Elastizitat. Leipzig: Teubner. (26, 63) 4. Somigliana, C.: Sopra 1'equilibrio di un corpo elastico isotropo. Nuovo Cimento (3) 17, 140-148, 272-276; 18, 161-166. (51, 52) 1886 1. Beltrami, E.: Sull'interpretazione meccanica delle formole di Maxwell. Mem. Accad. Sci. Bologna (4) 7, l-38 = Opere 4, 190-223- (14) 2. Hugoniot, H.: Sur un theoreme general relatif a la propagation du mouvement. C.R. Acad. Sci. Paris 102, 858-860. (73) 3. Ibbetson, W. J.: On the Airy-Maxwell solution of the equations of equilibrium of an isotropic elastic solid, under conservative forces. Proc. Lond. Math. Soc. 17, 296-309- (47) 4. Somigliana, C.: Sopra 1'equilibrio di un corpo elastico isotropo. Nuovo Cimento (3) 19, 84-90, 278-282; 20, 181-185. (52) 1887 1. Hugoniot, H.: Memoire sur la propagation du mouvement dans les corps et specialement dans les gaz parfaits. J. Ecole Polytech. 57, 3-97; 58, 1-125 (1889). The date of the memoir is 26 October 1885. (73) 2. Ibbetson, W. J.: An Elementary Treatise on the Mathematical Theory of Perfectly Elastic Solids with a Short Account of Viscous Fluids. London: MacMillan. (47, 76) 3. Voigt, W.: Theoretische Studien uber die Elasticitatsverhaltnisse der Krystalle. Abh. Ges. Wiss. Gottingen 34, 100 pp. (26) 1888 1. Boussinesq, J.: Equilibre d'elasticite d'un solide sans pesanteur, homogene et isotrope, dont les parties profondes sont maintenues fixes, pendant que sa surface eprouve des pressions ou des deplacements connus, s'annulant hors d'une region restreinte oil Us sont arbitrates. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 106, 1043-1048. (44) 2. — Equilibre d'elasticite d'un solide sans pesanteur, homogene et isotrope, dont les parties profondes sont maintenues fixes, pendant que sa surface eprouve des pressions ou des deplacements connus, s'annulant hors d'une region restreinte ou ils sont arbitraires - cas ou les donees sont mixtes, c'est-a-dire relatives en partie aux pressions et en partie aux deplacements. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 106, IH9-II23. (44) 3. Levy, M.: Sur une propriety generate des corps solides elastiques. C. R. Acad. Sci. Paris 107, 414-416. (30) 4. Thomson, W. (Lord Kelvin) : On the reflection and refraction of light. Phil. Mag. (5) 26, 414-425. Reprinted in part as Sections 107-111 of Baltimore Lectures on Molecular Dynamics and the Wave Theory of Light. London: Clay and Sons 1904. (32, 57) 1889 1. Beltrami, E.: Sur la theorie de la deformation infiniment petite d'un milieu. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 108, 502-504 = Opere 4, 344-347- (14) 2. Padova, E.: Sulle deformazioni infinitesimi. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (4) 52, 174-178. (14) 3. Somigliana, C: Sulle equazioni della elasticita. Ann. Mat. (2) [17, 37-64. (27, 44, 52) 1890 7. Donati, L.: Illustrazione al teorema del Menabrea. Mem. Accad. Sci. Bologna (4) 10, 267-274. (18, 34, 36) 2. Poincare, H.: Sur les equations aux derivees partielles de la physique mathe- matique. Am. J. Math. 12, 211-294. (76) 3. Fontaneau, M. E.: Sur l'equilibre d'dlasticite d'une enveloppe spherique. Nouv. Ann. de Math. (3) 9, 455^171. (44) 1891 1. Schoenfliess, A.: Kristallsysteme und Kristallstruktur. Leipzig. (21) 1892 1. Beltrami, E.: Osservazioni sulla nota precedente. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) llf 141-142 = Opere 4, 510-512. (17, 27) 2. Chree, C.: Changes in the dimensions of elastic solids due to given systems of forces. Cambridge Phil. Soc. Trans. 15, 313-337- (IS, 29) 18*
M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 3. Fontaneau, M. E.: Sur la deformation des corps isotropes en equilibre d'elasticite\ Assoc. Fran. Avan. Sci., C.R. 21st Sess. (2), 190-207- (44) 4. Morera, G.: Soluzione generale delle equazioni indefinite dell'equilibrio di un corpo continuo. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) llf 137-141. (17) 5. Morera, G.: Appendice alia Nota: Sulla soluzione piu generale delle equazioni indefinite dell'equilibrio di un corpo continuo. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) lj, 233-234. (17) 6. Poincare, H.: Lecons sur la theorie de 1'elasticite. Paris. (76) 7. Somigliana, C.: Sulle espressioni anahtiche generali dei movimenti oscillatori. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) l1, 111-119- {67) 1894 1. CesAro, E.: Introduzione alia teoria matematica della elasticita. Torino: Fratelli, Bocca. (76) 2. Donati, L.: Ulteriori osservazioni intorno al teorema del Menabrea. Mem. Accad. Sci. Bologna (5) 4, 449-474. (18, 27, 34, 36) 3. Somigliana, C.: Sopra gli integrali delle equazioni della isotropia elastica. Nuovo Cimento (3) 36, 28-39- {44) 4. Volterra, V.: Sur les vibrations des corps elastiques isotropes. Acta Math. 18, 161-232. (69) 1895 1- Lauricella, G.: Equilibrio dei corpi elastici isotropi. Ann. Scuola Norm. Pisa 7, 1-120. {53) 1896 1. Cosserat, E., et F.: Sur la theorie de 1'elasticite. Ann. Fac. Sci. Toulouse 10, 1-116. {14) 1897 1. Tedone, O.: Sulle vibrazioni dei corpi solidi, omogenei ed isotropi. Mem. Accad. Sci. Torino (2) 47, 181-258. {67) 1898 1. Cosserat, E., et F.: Sur la deformation infiniment petite d'une ellipso'ide elastique. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 127, 315-318. {32) 2. — Sur les equations de la theorie de l'elasticitd. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 126, IO89- 1091. (32) 3. — Sur les fonctions potentielles de la theorie de 1'elasticite. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 126, 1129-1132. (32) 4. Dougall, J.: A general method of solving the equations of elasticity. Edinburgh Math. Soc. Proc. 16, 82-98. (51, 52, 53) 5. Duhem, P.: Sur l'integrale des equations des petits mouvements d'un solide iso- trope. Mem. Soc. Sci. Bordeaux (5) 3, 317-329- (67) 6. Goursat, E.: Sur l'equation AAu = 0. Bull. Soc. Math. France 26, 236-237. (47) 7. Levy, M.: Sur la legitimitd de la regie dite du trapeze dans l'dtude de la resistance des barrages en maconnerie. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 126, 1235. (46, 47) 1899 1. Poincare, H.: Theorie du potentiel Newtonien. Paris: Gauthier-Villars. (8) 1900 1. Duhem, P.: Sur le theoreme d'Hugoniot et quelques thebremes analogues. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 131, 1171-1173. (72) 2. Fredholm, I.: Sur les equations de l'dquilibre d'un corps solide elastique. Acta Math. 23, 1-42. (51) 3. Michell, J.H.: On the direct determination of stress in an elastic solid, with applications to the theory of plates. Proc. Lond. Math. Soc. 31 (1899), 100-124. (27, 45, 46, 47) 4. — The uniform torsion and flexure of incomplete tores, with application to helical springs. Proc. Lond. Math. Soc. 31, 130-146. (44) 5. Voigt, W.: Elementare Mechanik. Leipzig: Veit. (44) 6. — L'Elasticitd des Cristaux. Rapports Congres Int. Phys. 1. Paris: Gauthier-Villars, 277-347. (26) 1901 1. Abraham, M.: Geometrische Grundbegriffe. In: Vol. 43 of the Encyklopadie der Mathematischen Wissenschaften, edited by F. Klein and C. Muller. Leipzig: Teubner. (14) 2. Cosserat, E., et F.: Sur la deformation infiniment petite d'un corps elastique soumis a des forces donnees. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 133, 271-273, 400. (32) 3. — Sur la deformation infiniment petite d'un ellipsoide elastique soumis a des efforts donnes sur la frontiere. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 133, 361-364. (32) 4. — Sur la deformation infiniment petite d'une enveloppe spherique elastique. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 133, 326-329. (32) 5. Hadamard, J.: Sur la propagation des ondes. Bull. Soc. Math. France 29, 50-60. (72) 6. Jouguet, E.: Sur la propagation des discontinuity's dans les fluides. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 132, 673-676. (73) 7. Weingarten, G.: Sulle superficie di discontinuity nella teoria della elasticita dei corpi solidi. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) 101, 57-60. (14, 72)
References. 277 1903 1- Boggio, T.: Sull'integrazione di alcune equazioni lineari alle derivate parziali. Ann. Mat. (3) 8, 181-231. (67) 2. Filon, L. N. G.: On an approximative solution for the bending of a beam of rectangular cross-section under any system of load, with special reference to points of concentrated or discontinuous loading. Phil. Trans. Roy Soc. Lond., Ser. A 201, 63-155. (45, 47) 3. Hadamard, J.: Lecons sur la Propagation des Ondes et les liquations de l'Hydro- dynamique. Paris: Hermann. (34, 72, 73) 4. Tedone, O.: Saggio di una teoria generate delle equazioni dell'equilibrio elastico per un corpo isotropo. Ann. Mat. (3) 8, 129-180. (27) 1904 1. Dougall, J.: The equilibrium of an isotropic elastic plate. Trans. Roy. Soc. Edinburgh 41, 129-228. (53) 2. Duhem, P.: Recherches sur I'elasticite. Ann. Ecole Norm. (3) 21, 99-139, 375-414; 22 (1905), 143-217; 23 (1906), 169-223 = repr. separ., Paris 1906. (73) 3. Love, A. E. H.: The propagation of wave-motion in an isotropic elastic solid medium. Proc. Lond. Math. Soc. (2) 1, 291-344. (68, 69) 4. Tedone, O.: Saggio di una teoria generale delle equazioni dell'equilibrio elastico per un corpo isotropo. Ann. Mat. (3) 10, 13-64. (27, 44) 5. Thomson, W. (Lord Kelvin) : Baltimore Lectures on Molecular Dynamics and the Wave Theory of Light. London: Clay and Sons. (67) 1905 1. Klein, F., and K.Wieghardt: Uber Spannungsflachen und reziproke Diagramme, mit besonderer Berilcksichtigung der Maxwellschen Arbeiten. Arch. Math. Phys. (3) 8, 1-10, 95-119- (17) 2. Timpe, A.: Probleme der Spannungsverteilung in ebenen Systemen einfach gelost mit Hilfe der Airyschen Funktion. Dissertation. Gottingen. (14) 3. Zemplen, G.: Kriterien fur die physikalische Bedeutung der unstetigen Losungen der hydrodynamischen Bewegungsgleichungen. Math. Ann. 61, 437-449. (73) 4. — Besondere Ausfilhrungen uber unstetige Bewegungen in Fliissigkeiten. In: Vol. 44 of the Encyklopadie der Mathematischen Wissenschaften, edited by F. Klein and C. Muller. Leipzig: Teubner. (73) 1906 1. Born, M.: Untersuchungen liber die Stabilitat der elastischen Linie in Ebene und Raum unter verschiedenen Grenzbedingungen. Dissertation. Gottingen. (38) 2. CesAro, E.: Sulle formole del Volterra, fondamentali nella teoria delle distorsioni elastiche. Rend. Napoli (3 a) 12, 311-321. (14) 3. Fredholm, I.: Solution d'un probleme fondamental de la theorie de I'elasticite. Ark. Mat. Astr. Fys. 2, 1-8. (32) 4. Korn, A.: Die Eigenschwingungen eines elastischen Korpers mit ruhender Ober- flache. Akad. Wiss., Miinchen, Math. phys. Kl. Sitz. 36, 351-402. (13) 5. Love, A. E. H.: A Treatise on the Mathematical Theory of Elasticity, 2nd ed. Cambridge. (17, 34, 57) 6. Somigliana, C.: Sopra alcune formole fondamentali della dinamica dei mezzi isotropi. Atti Accad. Sci. Torino 41, 869-885, 1070-1090. (69) 1907 1. Boggio T.: Nuova risoluzione di un problema fondamentale della teoria dell' elasticity. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. 16, 248-255. (32) 2. Tedone, O.: Allgemeine Theoreme der mathematischen Elastizitatslehre (Integra- tionstheorie). In Vol. 4 of the Encyklopadie der Mathematischen Wissenschaften, edited by F. Klein and C. Muller. Leipzig: Teubner. (76) 3. —, and A. Timpe: Spezielle Ausfuhrungen zur Statik elastischer K6rper. In Vol. 4 of the Encyklopadie der Mathematischen Wissenschaften, edited by F. Klein and C. Muller. Leipzig: Teubner. (44) 4. Volterra, V.: Sur l'equilibre des corps elastiques multiplement connexes. Ann. Ecole Norm. (3) 24, 401-517- (14) 1908 1. Korn, A.: Solution generate du probleme d'equilibre dans la theorie de I'elasticite, dans le cas ou les efforts sont donnes a la surface. Ann. Fac. Sci. Toulouse (2) 10, 165-269- (IS) 2. Ritz, W.: tlber eine neue Methode zur LSsung gewisser Variationsprobleme der mathematischen Physik. J. Reine Angew. Math. 135, 1-61 =CEuvres 192-264. (39) 3. Routh, E. T.: A Treatise on Analytical Statics, 2nd ed. Cambridge. (18) 1909 1- Mises, R. v.: Theorie der Wasserrader. Z. Math. Phys. 57, 1-120. (19) 2. Kolosov, G. V.: On an application of complex function theory to a plane problem in the mathematical theory of elasticity (in Russian). Dissertation at Dorpat (Yuriev) University. (47) 3. Korn, A.: Uber einige Ungleichungen, welche in der Theorie der elastischen und elektrischen Schwingungen eine Rolle spielen. Akad. Umiejet. Krakow Bulletin Int. 705-724. (13)
M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 1910 1. Voigt, W.: Lehrbuch der Kristallphysik. Leipzig: Teubner. (21,26) 1911 1. Zeilon, N.: Das Fundamentalintegral der allgemeinen partiellen linearen Diffe- rentialgleichung mit konstanten Koeffizienten. Ark. Mat. Ast. Fys. 6, 38, 1-32. (51) 1912 1. Colonnetti, G.: L'equilibrio elastico dal punto di vista energetico. Mem. Accad. Sci. Torino (2) 62, 479-495- (34) 2. Gwyther, R. F.: The formal specification of the elements of stress in cartesian, and in cylindrical and spherical polar coordinates. Mem. Manchester Lit. Phil. Soc. 56, No. 10 (13 PP-). (17) 1913 1. Gwyther, R. F.: The specification of the elements of stress. Part II. A simplification of the specification given in Part I. Mem. Manchester Lit. Phil. Soc. 57, No. 5 (4 pp.) (17) 1914 1. Hellinger, E.: Die allgemeinen Ansatze der Mechanik der Kontinua. In: Vol. 44 of the Encyklopadie der Mathematischen Wissenschaften, edited by F. Klein and C. Muller. Leipzig: Teubner. (38) 2. Kolosov, G. V.: Uber einige Eigenschaften des ebenen Problems der Elastizitats- theorie. Z. Math. Phys. 62, 383-409- (47) 1915 1. Domke, O.: Uber Variationsprinzipien in der Elastizitatslehre nebst Anwendungen auf die technische Statik. Z. Math. Phys. 63, 174-192. (34, 36) 2. Korn, A.: Uber die beiden bisher zur Losung der ersten Randwertaufgabe der Elastizitatstheorie eingeschlagenen Wege. Annaes. Acad. Poly. Porto 10, 129-156- (44) 3. Weyl, H.: Das asymptotische Verteilungsgesetz der Eigenschwingungen eines be- liebig gestalteten elastischen Korpers. Rend. Circ. Mat. Palermo 39, 1-50. (57, 78) 4. Zaremba, S.: Sopra un teorema d'unicita relativo alia equazione delle onde sferiche. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) 24, 904-908. (74) 1916 1. Prange, G.: Die Variations- und Minimalprinzipe der Statik der Baukonstruk- tionen. Habilitationsschrift. Tech. Univ. Hannover. (34, 38) 1919 1. Muskhelishvili, N. I.: Sur l'integration de liquation biharmonique. Izv. Akad. Nauk SSSR. 663-686. (47) 2. Serini, R.: Deformazioni simmetriche dei corpi elastici. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (5) 28, 343-347- (44) 1920 1. Courant, R.: Uber die Eigenwerte bei den Differentialgleichungen der mathematischen Physik. Math. Z. 7, 1-57- (76, 77) 2. Rubinowicz, A.: Herstellung von Losungen gemischter Randwertprobleme bei hyperbolischen Differentialgleichungen zweiter Ordnung durch Zusammenstucke- lung aus Losungen einfacher gemischter Randwertaufgaben. Mon. Math. Phys. 30, 65-79- (74) 1923 1. Burgatti, P.: Sopra una soluzione molto generale dell'equazioni dell'equilibrio elastico. Atti Accad. Bologna Rend. (2) 27, 66-73- (44) 2. Southwell, R.: On Castigliano's theorem of least work and the principle of Saint- Venant. Phil. Mag. (6) 45, 193-212. (54) 1924 1. Lichtenstein, L.: Uber die erste Randwertaufgabe der Elastizitatstheorie. Math. Z. 20, 21-28. (27, 53) 2. Timpe, A.: Achsensymmetrische Deformation von Umdrehungskorpern. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 4, 361-376. (44) 1925 1. Weber, C.: Achsensymmetrische Deformation von Umdrehungskorpern. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 5, 477-468. (44) 1926 1. Burgatti, P.: Sopra due utili forme dell'integrale generale dell'equazione per l'equilibrio dei solidi elastici isotropi. Mem. Accad. Sci. Bologna (8) 3, 63-67- (44) 2. Kotchine, N. E.: Sur la theorie des ondes de choc dans un fluide. Rend. Circ. Mat. Palermo 50, 305-344. (73) 1927 1. Auerbach, F.: Elastizitat der Kristalle. Handbuch der Physikalischen und Techni- schen Mechanik 3, 239-282. Leipzig: Barth. (26) 2. Korn, A.: Allgemeine Theorie der Elastizitat. Handbuch der Physikalischen und Technischen Mechanik 3, I-47. Leipzig: Barth. (27, 53) 3. Love, A. E. H.: A Treatise on the Mathematical Theory of Elasticity, 4th ed. Cambridge. (18, 26, 27, 29, 44, 45, 47, 51, 52, 53, 54, 65, 68, 73) 1928 1. Friedrichs, K. O., and H. Lewy: Uber die Eindeutigkeit und das Abhangigkeits- gebiet der Losungen beim Anfangswertproblem linearer hyperbolischer Differentialgleichungen. Math. Ann. 98, 192-204. (74) 2. Geckeler, J. W.: Elastizitatstheorie anisotroper Korper (Kristallelastizitat). In: Volume VI of the Handbuch der Physik, edited by R- Grammel. Berlin: Springer. (26) 3. Trefftz, E.: Mathematische Elastizitatstheorie. In: Volume VI of the Handbuch der Physik, edited by R. Grammel. Berlin: Springer. (34, 44, 47, 51, 53)
References. 279 4. — Konvergenz und Fehlerschatzung beim Ritzschen Verfahren. Math. Ann. 100, 503-521. (37) 1929 1. Kellogg, O. D.: Foundations of Potential Theory. Berlin: Springer. (5, 6, 8, 52) 2. Lichtenstein, L.: Grundlagen der Hydromechanik. Berlin: Springer. (6, 72) 1930 1. Filon, L. N. G.: On the relation between corresponding problems in plane stress and in generalized plane stress. Q. J. Appl. Math. 1, 289-299. (45) 2. Galerkin, B.: On an investigation of stresses and deformations in elastic isotropic solids [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR, 353-358. (44) 3. — Contribution a la solution generate du probleme de la theorie de l'elasticitddans le cas de trois dimensions. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 190, 1047-1048. (44) 4. Rellich, F.: Ein Satz ilber mittlere Konvergenz. Nachr. Ges. Wissen. Gottingen. Math.-Phys. Kl., 30-35. (7) 1931 1. Burgatti, P.: Teoria Matematica della Elasticity. Bologna: Zanichelli. (30) 2. Coker, E. G., and L. N. G. Filon: A Treatise on Photoelasticity. Cambridge. (45) 3. Galerkin, B.: On the general solution of a problem in the theory of elasticity in three dimensions by means of stress and displacement functions [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR, 281-286. (44) 4. Hobson, E. W.: The Theory of Spherical and Ellipsoidal Harmonies. Cambridge. (8) 5. Supino, G.: Sopra alcune limitazioni per la sollecitazione elastica e sopra la dimo- strazione del principio del De Saint Venant. Ann. Mat. (4) 9, 91-119. (54) 1932 1. Muskhelishvili, N. I.: Recherches sur les problemes aux limites relatifs al'dquation biharmonique et aux e'quations de l'elasticite a deux dimensions. Math. Ann. 107, 282-312. (47) 2. Papkovitch, P. F.: Expressions generates des composantes des tensions, ne ren- fermant comme fonctions arbitrates que des fonctions harmoniques. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 195, 754-756. (44) 3. — Solution generate des equations differentielles fondamentales d'dlasticite, exprimee par trois fonctions harmoniques. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 195, 513-515- (44) 4. — The representation of the general integral of the fundamental equations of the theory of elasticity in terms of harmonic functions [in Russian]. Izv. Akad. Nauk SSSR, Fiz.-Mat. Ser. 10, 1425-1435. (44) 5. Signorini, A.: Sollecitazioni iperastatiche. Rend. 1st. Lombardo (2) 65, 1-7. (18) 1933 1. Marguerre, K.: Ebenes und achsensymmetrisches Problem der Elastizitats- theorie. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 13, 437-438. (44) 2. Muskhelishvili, N. I.: Recherches sur les problemes aux limites relatifs a l'equa- tion biharmonique et aux equations de l'elasticite' a deux dimensions. Math. Ann. 107, 282-312. (32) 3. Phillips, H. B.: Vector Analysis. New York: Wiley. (6) 4. Signorini, A.: Sopra alcune questioni di statica dei sistemi continui. Ann. Scuola Norm. Pisa (2) 2, 231-257. (18) 1934 1. Biezeno, C.: Uber die Marguerresche Spannungsfunktion. Ing.-Arch. 5, 120-124. (44) 2. Finzi, B.: Integrazione delle equazioni indefinite della meccanica dei sistemi continui. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (6) 19, 578-584, 620-623. (17) 3. Muskhelishvili, N. I.: A new general method of solution of the fundamental boundary problems of the plane theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 3, 7-9- (47) 4. Neuber, H.: Ein neuer Ansatz zur Losung raumlicher Probleme der Elastizitats- theorie. Der Hohlkegel unter Einzellast als Beispiel. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 14, 203-212. (44) 5. Phillips, H. B.: Stress functions. J. Math. Phys. 13, 421-425. (47) 6. Sobrero, L.: Nuovo metodo per lo studio dei problemi di elasticity con applicazione al problema della piastra forata. Ric. Ingegneria 2, 255-264. (44) 1935 1- Grodski, G. D.: The integration of the general equations of equilibrium of an isotropic elastic body by means of the Newtonian potential and harmonic functions [in Russian]. Izv. Akad. Nauk SSSR Otdel Mat. 4, 587-6H. (44) 2. Kolosov, G. V.: An Application of the Complex Variable in the Theory of Elasticity [in Russian]. Moscow-Leningrad: Gostehizdat. (47) 3. Marguerre, K.: Ebenes und achsensymmetrisches Problem der Elastizitats- theorie. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 13, 437-438. (44) 4. Neuber, H.: Der raumliche Spannungszustand in Umdrehungskerben. Ing. Arch. 6, 133-156. (44) 5. Nielsen, T.: Elementare Mechanik. Berlin: Springer. (13) 6. Sobolev, S. L.: General theory of the diffraction of waves on Riemann surfaces. Trudy Mat. Inst. Steklov 9, 39-105- (42)
M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 7. Sobrero, L.: Del significato meccanico della funzione di Airy. Ric. Ingegneria 3, 77-80 = Atti. Accad. Lincei Rend. (6) 21, 264-269. (17) 8. ■— Delle funzioni analoghe al potentiale intervenienti nella fisica-matematica. Atti. Accad. Lincei. Rend. (6) 21, 448-454. (44, 47) 9. Westergaard, H.: General solution of the problem of elastostatics of an w-dimen- sional homogeneous isotropic solid in an M-dimensional space. Bull. Amer. Math. Soc. 41, 695-699- (44) 1936 1. Mindlin, R. D.: Force at a point in the interior of a semi-infinite solid. Phys. 7, 195-202. (51) 2. Mindlin R.: Note on the Galerkin and Papkovitch stress functions. Bull. Amer. Math. Soc. 42, 373-376. (44) 3. Nicolesco, M.: Les fonctions polyharmoniques. Actualit^s Sci. Ind. No. 331. (8) 4. Picone, M.: Nuovi indirizzi di ricerca nella teoria e nel calcolo delle soluzioni di talune equazioni lineari alle derivate parziali della Fisica Matematica. Ann. Scuola Norm. Pisa (2) 5, 213-288 (8) 5. Southwell, R. V.: Castigliano's principle of minimum strain energy. Proc. Rov. Soc. Lond. (A) 154, 4-21. (18, 36) 6. Zanaboni, O.: II problema della funzione delle tensioni in un sistema spaziale isotropo. Bull. Un. Mat. Ital. 15, 71-76. (44) 1937 1. Goodier, J. N.: A general proof of Saint-Venant's principle. Phil. Mag. (7) 23, 607-609. (54) 2. — Supplementary note on "A general proof of Saint-Venant's principle". Phil. Mag. (7) 24, 325. (54) 3. Neuber, H.: Kerbspannungslehre. Berlin: Springer. (44) 4. Odqvist, F.: Equations de compatibilite pour un systeme de coordonnees triples orthogonaux quelconques. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 205, 202-204. (14) 5. Papkovitch, P. F.: Survey of some general solutions of the fundamental differential equations of equilibrium of an isotropic elastic body [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 1, H7-I32. (44) 6. Zanaboni, O.: Dimostrazione generate del principio del De Saint-Venant. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. 25, 117-121. (54, 56a) 7. — Valutazione dell'errore massimo cui da luogo l'applicazione del principio del Saint-Venant. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. 25, 595-601. (54, 56a) 8. — Sull'approssimazione dovuta al principio del De Saint-Venant nei solidi pris- matici isotropi. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. 26, 340-345. (54, 55, 56a) 1938 1. Blinchikov, T. N.: The differential equations of equilibrium of the theory of elasticity in curvilinear coordinate systems [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 2, 407-413. (14) 2. Sherman, D. J.: On the distribution of eigenvalues of integral equations in the plane theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Trudy Seismol. Inst. Akad. Nauk SSSR, No. 82. (32) 3. Slobodyansky, M.: Expression of the solution of the diferential equations of elasticity by means of one, two, and three functions and proof of the generality of these solutions [in Russian]. Uch. Zap. Mosk. Gos. Univ. 24, 191-202. (44) 4. — Stress functions for spatial problems in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Uch. Zap. Mosk. Gos. Univ. 24, 181-190. (44) 5. Southwell, R. V.: Castigliano's principle of minimum strain-energy, and the conditions of compatibility for strain. Stephen Timoshenko 60th Aniv. Vol. New York: MacMillan. (18, 36) 1939 1. Burgers, J. M.: Some considerations on the fields of stress connected with dislocations in a regular crystal lattice. Proc. Koninkl. Ned. Akad. Wetenschap. 42, 293-325, 378-399- (14) 2. Friedrichs, K. O.: On differential operators in Hilbert spaces. Am. J. Math. 61, 523-544. (42) 3. Graffi, D.: Sui teoremi di reciprocity nei fenomeni dipendenti dal tempo. Ann. Mat. (4) 18, 173-200. (61) 4. Papkovitch, P. F.: Theory of Elasticity [in Russian]. Moscow. (44) 1940 1. Fadle, J.: Die Selbstspannungs-Eigenwertfunktionen der quadratischen Scheibe. Ing. Arch. 11, 125-149- (56) 2. Locatelli, P.: Estensione del principio di St. Venant a corpi non perfettamente elastici. Atti Accad. Sci. Torino 75, 502-510. (54) 3. — Sul principio di Menabrea. Boll. Un. Nat. Ital. (2) 2, 342-347- (18, 36) 4. —■ Sulla congruenza delle deformazioni. Rend. 1st. Lombardo 73=(3) 4 (1939- 1940), 457-464. (18, 36)
References. 281 1941 1. Platrier, C.: Sur l'integration des equations indefinies de l'equilibre elastique. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 212, 749-751. (44) 2. Sakadi, Z.: Elastic waves in crystals. Proc. Phys. Math. Soc. Japan (3) 23, 539-547. (70, 71) 1942 1. Finzi, B.: Propagazione ondosa nei continui anisotropi. Rend. 1st. Lombardo, 75=(3) 6 (1941/42) 630-640. (73) 2. Goodier, J. N.: An extension of Saint-Venant's principle, with applications. J. Appl. Phys. 13, 167-171. (54) 1943 1. Frank, P., and R. v. Mises: Die Differential- und Integralgleichungen der Mechanik und Physik, Vol. 1. New York: Rosenberg. (8) 2. Stevenson, A. C.: Some boundary problems of two-dimensional elasticity. Phil. Mag. (7) 34, 766-793. (47) 3. Udeschini, P.: Sull'energia di deformazione. Rend. 1st. Lombardo 76= (3) 7, 25- 34. (24) 1944 1. Carrier, G. F.: The thermal stress and body-force problems of the infinite ortho- tropic solid. Q. Appl. Math. 2, 31-36. (51) 2. Friedrichs, K. O.: The identity of weak and strong extensions of differential operators. Trans. Am. Math. Soc. 55, 132-151. (42) 3. Vlasov, V. Z.: Equations of compatibility of deformation in curvilinear co-ordinates [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 8, 301-306. (14) 1945 1- Fox, L., and R. V. Southwell: Relaxation methods applied to engineering problems. VII A. Biharmonic analysis as applied to the flexure and extension of flat elastic plates. Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc. Lond. Ser. A 239, 419-460. (47) 2. Kuzmin, R. O.: On Maxwell's and Morera's formulae in the theory of elasticity. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 49, 326-328. (17) 3. Locatelli, P.: Nuove espressioni variazionali nella dinamica elastica. Rend. 1st. Lombardo 78= (3) 9, 247-257- (65) 4. — SulTinterpretazione di principi variazionali dinamica nella statica elastica. Rend. 1st. Lombardo 78 = (3) 9, 301-306. (65) 5. Mises, R. v.: On Saint-Venant's principle. Bull. Amer. Math. Soc. 51, 555-562. (54) 6. Rayleigh, J. W. S.: The Theory of Sound, Vol. 1. New York: Dover. (39) 7. Stevenson, A. C.: Complex potentials in two-dimensional elasticity. Proc. Roy. Soc. Lond. (A) 184, 129-179. 218-229- (47) 1946 1. Butty, E.: Tratado de elasticidad teorico-technica. Buenos Aires: Centro Estudian- tes de Ingenieria. (51, 71) 2. Hearmon, R. F. S.: The elastic constants of anisotropic materials. Rev. Mod. Phys. 18, 409-440. (26) 3. Poritsky, H.: Application of analytic functions to two-dimensional biharmonic analysis. Trans. Am. Math. Soc. 59, 248-279- (47) 4. Prager, W.: On plane elastic strain in doubly-connected domains. Q. Appl. Math. 3, 377-380. (47) 1947 1. Friedrichs, K. 0.: On the boundary-value problems of the theory of elasticity and Korn's inequality. Ann. Math. 48, 441-471. (13, 42) 2. Graffi, D.: Sul teorema di reciprocity nella dinamica dei corpi elastici. Mem. Accad. Sci. Bologna 18, 103-109- (19, 61) 3. Gutm an, C. G.: General solution of a problem in the theory of elasticity in generalized cylindrical coordinates [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 58, 993-996. (44) 4. Lifshic, I. M., and L. N. Rozencveig: On the construction of the Green's tensor for the fundamental equations of the theory of elasticity in the case of an unrestricted anisotropic elastic medium [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk SSSR. Zhurnal Eksper. Teoret. Fiz. 17, 783-791. (51) 5. Mikhlin, S. G.: Fundamental solutions of the dynamic equations of the theory of elasticity for inhomogeneous media [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 11, 423-432. Y («*> /^ 6. Prager, W., and J. L. Synge: Approximations in elasticity based on the concept of function space. Q. Appl. Math. 5, 241-269. (34) 7. Shapiro, G.: Les fonctions des tensions dans un systeme arbitraire de coordonnees curvilignes. Dokl. Acad. Sci. URSS 55, 693-695. (44) 8. Ter-Mkrtychan, L. N.: On general solutions of the problems of the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Trudy Leningr. Politekhn. Akad. in-ta, No. 4. (44) 9. Van Hove, L.: Sur l'extension de la condition de Legendre du calcul des variations aux integrates multiples a plusieurs fonctions inconnues. Proc. Koninkl. Ned. Akad. Wetenschap. 50, 18-23- (32) 1948 1. Diaz, J. B., and H. J. Greenberg: Upper and lower bounds for the solution of the first boundary value problem of elasticity. Q. Appl. Math. 6, 326-331. (52)
282 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 2. Elliot, H. A.: Three-dimensional stress distributions in hexagonal aeolotropic crystals. Proc. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 44, 522-533- (51) 3. Erim, K.: Sur le principe de Saint-Venant. Proc. Seventh Int. Cong. Appl. Mech. London. (54) 4. Flint, E. E.: A Practical Handbook on Geometrical Crystallography [in Russian]. Moscow: Gosgeolizdat. (21) 5. Moriguti, S.: On Castigliano's theorem in three-dimensional elastostatics [in Japanese]. J. Soc. Appl. Mech. Japan 1, 175-180. (18) 6. Timpe, A.: Torsionsfreie achsensymmetrische Deformation von Umdrehungs- korpern und ihre Inversion. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 28, 161-166. (44) 7. Weber, C.: Spannungsfunktionen des dreidimensionalen Kontinuums. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 28, 193-197- (17) 1949 1- Finzi, B., andM. Pastori : Calcolo Tensoriale e Applicazioni. Bologna: Zanichelli. (17) 2. Freiberger, W.: On the solution of the equilibrium equations of elasticity in general curvilinear coordinates. Australian J. Sci. A 2, 483-492. (44) 3. — The uniform torsion of an incomplete tore. Australian J. Sci. A 2, 354-375- (44) 4. Iacovache, M.: O extindere a metodei lui Galerkin pentru sistemul ecua^iilor elasticitatii. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 1, 593-596. (44, 67) 5. Krutkov, Y. A.: Tensor Stress Functions and General Solutions in the Static Theory of Elasticity [in Russian]. Moscow: Akademkniga. (17, 44) 6. Moisil, G.: Asupra formulelor lui Galerkin in teoria elasticitatii. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 1, 587-592. (44) 7. Pastori, M.: Propagazione ondosa nei continui anisotropi e corrispondenti direzioni principali. Nuovo Cimento (9) 6, 187-193. (73) 8. Peretti, G.: Significato del tensore arbitrario che interviene nell'integrale generale delle equazioni della statica dei continui. Atti Sem. Mat. Fis. Univ. Modena 3, 77-82. (17) 1950 1. Aquaro, G.: Un teorema di media per le equazioni dell'elasticita. Riv. Mat. Univ. Parma 1, 419-424. (43) 2. Arzhanyh, I. S.: On the theory of integration of the dynamical equations of an isotropic elastic body [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR (N.S.) 73, 41-44. (53, 69) 3. Blokh, V.: Stress functions in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 14, 415-422. (17, 44) 4. Fichera, G.: Sull'esistenza e sul calcolo delle soluzioni dei problemi al contorno, relativi all'equilibrio di un corpo elastico. Ann. Scuola Norm. Pisa (3) 4, 35-99- (49, 50) 5. Fridman, M. M.: The mathematical theory of elasticity of anisotropic media [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 14, 321-340. (45) 6. Iacovache, M.: Asupra relatiilor dintre tensiuni intr'un corp elastic in miscare. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 2, 699-705- (59) 7. Ionescu-Cazimir, V.: Asupra ecuatiilor echilibrului termoelastic. I. Analogul vectorului lui Galerkin. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 2, 589-595- (44) 8. Moisil, G.: Asupra unui vector analog vectorului lui Galerkin pentru echilibrul corpurilor elastice cu isotropie transversa. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 2, 207-210 (44) 9. Morinaga, K., and T. N6no: On stress-functions in general coordinates. J. sci. Hiroshima Univ. Ser. A 14, 181-194. (17) 10. Reissner, E.: On a variational theorem in elasticity. J. Math. Phys. 29, 90-95- (38) 11. Sobolev, S. L.: Some Applications of Functional Analysis in Mathematical Physics [in Russian]. Leningrad: University Press. (I have seen this work only in the English translation by F. E. Browder, Providence: Am. Math. Soc. 1963.) (42) 12. Synge, J. L.: Upper and lower bounds for solutions of problems in elasticity. Proc. Roy. Irish Acad. Sect. A S3, 41-64. (43, 52) 13. Timpe, A.: Spannungsfunktionen filr die von Kugel- und Kegelflachen begrenzten Korper- und Kuppelprobleme. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 30, 50-61. (44) 1951 1. Albrecht, F.: L'equilibre elastique des cristaux du systeme cubique. Com. Acad. R. P. Romane 1, 403-408. (27) 2. Arzhanyh, I. S.: The integral equations of the dynamics of an elastic body [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR (N.S.) 76, 501-503- (53, 69) 3. — Integral equations for the representation of the vector of translation, spatial dilatation, and rotation of an elastic body [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 15, 387— 391- (69) 4. — The fundamental integral equations of the dynamics of an elastic body [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR (N.S.) 81, 513-516. (69)
References. 283 5. Eidus, D. M.: On the mixed problem of the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR. 76, 181-184. (13) 6. Fichera, G.: l)ber eine Moglichkeit zur Kontrolle der physikalischen Widerspruchs- freiheit der Gleichungen der mathematischen Elastizitatstheorie. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 31, 268-270. (31) 7. Filonenko-Borodich, M. M.: The problem of the equilibrium of an elastic parallelepiped subject to assigned loads on its boundaries [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 15, 137-148. (17) 8. — Two problems on the equilibrium of an elastic parallelepiped [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 15, 563-574. (17) 9. Sternberg, E., R. A. Eubanks and M. A. Sadowski: On the stress function approaches of Boussinesq and Timpe to the axisymmetric problem of elasticity theory. J. Appl. Phys. 22, 1121-1124. (44) 10. Timoshenko, S., and J.N. Goodier: Theory of Elasticity, 2nd ed. New York: McGraw Hill. (51) 11. Timpe, A.: Spannungsfunktionen achsensymmetrischer Deformationen in Zylinder- koordinaten. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 31, 220-224. (44) 12. Valcovici, V.: Sur les relations entre les tensions. Com. Acad. R. P. Romane 1, 337-339- (59) 1952 1. Cooperman, P.: An extension of the method of Trefftz for finding local bounds on the solutions of boundary-value problems, and on their derivatives. Q. Appl. Math. 10, 359-373. (37) 2. Mikhlin, S. G.: The Problem of the Minimum of a Quadratic Functional [in Russian]. Moscow. (I have seen this work only in the English translation by A. Fein- stein, San Francisco: Holden Day 1965.) (13, 43) 3. Moisil, A.: Les relations entre les tensions pour les corps elastiques a. isotropic transverse. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 3, 473-480. (27) 4. Sbrana, F.: Una propriety caratteristica delle equazioni dell'elasticity. Atti Accad. Ligure Sci. Lett. 9, 84-88. (43) 5. Sneddon, I. N.: The stress produced by a pulse of pressure moving along the surface of a semi-infinite solid. Rend. Circ. Mat. Palermo (2) 1, 57-62. (47) 6. Tiffen, R.: Uniqueness theorems of two-dimensional elasticity theory. Q. J. Mech. Appl. Math. 5, 237-252. (50) 7. Westergaard, H.: Theory of Elasticity and Plasticity. Cambridge. (44) 1953 1- Arzhanyh, I. S.: Construction of the integral equations of statics in the theory of elasticity by means of Green's functions [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR. Trudy Inst. Mat. Meh. 10, 5-25. (53) 2. — Stress tensor functions for the dynamics of an elastic body [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR., No. 7, 3-4. (17) 3. Bergman, S., and M. Schiffer: Kernel functions and elliptic differential equations in mathematical physics. New York: Academic. (53) 4. Bishop, R. E. D.: On dynamical problems of plane stress and plane strain. Q. J. Mech. Appl. Math. 6, 250-254. (67) 5. Bland, D. R.: Mean displacements on the boundary of an elastic solid. Q. J. Mech. Appl. Math. 6, 379-384. (29) 6. Brdicka, M.: The equations of compatibility and stress functions in tensor form [in Russian]. Czech. J. Phys. 3, 36-52. (44) 7. Churikov, F.: On a form of the general solution of the equilibrium equations for the displacements in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 17, 751-754. (44) 8. Courant, R., and D. Hilbert: Methods of Mathematical Physics, Vol. 1. New York: Interscience. (39, 76, 77, 78) 9. Dzhanelidze, G. I.: The general solution of the equations of the theory of elasticity in arbitrary linear coordinates [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 88, 423-425. (44) 10. Ericksen, J. L.: On the propagation of waves in isotropic incompressible perfectly elastic materials. J. Rational Mech. Anal. 2, 329-337. Reprinted in Problems of Non-linear Elasticity. Intl. Sci. Rev. Ser. New York: Gordon and Breach 1965. (73) 11. Fichera, G.: Condizioni perch6 sia compatibile il problema principale della statica elastica. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (8) 14, 397-400. (31) 12. Foppl, L.: Ein Mittelwertsatz der ebenen Elastizitatstheorie. Sitzber. Math.-Naturw. Kl. Bayer Akad. Wiss. MUnchen 1952, 21 5-217. (43) 13. Hu, H.: On the three-dimensional problems of the theory of elasticity of a transversely isotropic body. Sci. Sinica (Peking) 2, 145-151. (44) 14. Kroner, E.: Das Fundamentalintegral der anisotropen elastischen Differential- gleichungen. Z. Physik 136, 402-410. (51)
284 M. K. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 15. Mindlin, R. D.: Force at a point in the interior of a semi-infinite solid. Proc. First Midwestern Conf. Solid Mech. (51) 16. Misicu, M.: Echilibrul mediilor continue cu deformari mari. Stud. Cercet. Mec. Metal. 4, 31-53- (32) 17. SAenz, A. W.: Uniformly moving dislocations in anisotropic media. J. Rational Mech. Anal. 2, 83-98. (51, 71) 18. Schaefer, H.: Die Spannungsfunktionen des dreidimensionalen Kontinuums und des elastischen Korpers. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 33, 356—362 (17, 18, 44). 19. Trenin, S.: On the solutions of the equilibrium equations of an axisymmetrical problem in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Vestn. Mosk. Univ. Ser. Fiz., Mat. 8, 7-13- (44) 20. Washizu, K.: Bounds for solutions of boundary-value problems in elasticity. J. Math. Phys. 32, 117-128. (52) 1954 1. Arzhanyh, I. S.: Dynamical potentials of the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR. Trudy Inst. Mat. Meh. 13, 3-17- (69) 2. — Integral Equations of Basic Problems in the Theory of Vector Fields and in Elasticity [in Russian]. Tashkent: Izdat. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR. (53, 69) 3. Brdicka, M.: Covariant form of the general solution of the Galerkin equations of elastic equilibrium [in Russian]. Czech. J. Phys. 4, 246. (44) 4. Browder, F. E.: Strongly elliptic systems of differential equations. Contrib. Th. Partial Diff. Eqns. Annals, of Math. Studies No. 33, 15-51- (32) 5. Eubanks, R., and E. Sternberg: On the axisymmetric problem of elasticity theory for a medium with transverse isotropy. J. Rational Mech. Anal. 3, 89-101. (44) 6. Graffi, D.: Uber den Reziprozitatssatz in der Dynamik der elastischen Korper. Ing. Arch. 22, 45-46. (19, 61) 7. Gunther, W.: Spannungsfunktionen und Vertraglichkeitsbedingungen der Kon- tinuumsmechanik. Abhandl. Braunschweig. Wiss. Ges. 6, 207-219. (17) 8. Hu, H.: On the general theory of elasticity for a spherically isotropic medium. Sci. Sinica (Peking) 3, 247-260. (44) 9. Ionescu, D.: Asupra vectorului lui Galerkin In teoria elasticitatii si in hidrodinamica fluidelor viscoase. Bui. St. Acad. R. P. Romane 6, 555-571 (44)' 10. Klyushnikov, V. D.: Derivation of the Beltrami-Michell equations from a variational principle [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 18, 250-252. (18) 11. Kroner, E.: Die Spannungsfunktionen der dreidimensionalen isotropen Elastizi- tatstheorie. Z. Physik 139, 175-188. Correction, Z. Phys. 143, 175 (1955). [17, 44) 12. Langhaar, H., and M. Stippes: Three-dimensional stress functions. J. Franklin Inst. 258, 371-382. (17) 13. Ling, C. B., and K. L. Yang: On symmetric strains in solids of revolution in curvilinear coordinates. Ann. Acad. Sinica Taipei 1, 507-516. (44) 14. Morrey, C. B., Jr. : Second order elliptic systems of differential equations. Contrib. Th. Partial Diff. Eqns. Annals of Math. Studies No. 33, 101-159- (32) 15. Musgrave, M. J. P.: On the propagation of elastic waves in aeolotropic media. Proc. Roy. Soc. Lond., Ser. (A) 226, 339-366. (71) 16. Muskhelishvili, N. I.: Some Basic Problems of the Mathematical Theory of Elasticity [in Russian], 4th Ed. Moscow. (I have seen this work only in the English translation by J. R. M. Radok, Groningen: Noordhoff 1963) (47, 50). 17. Ornstein, W.: Stress functions of Maxwell and Morera. Q. Appl. Math. 12, 198-201. (17) 18. Schumann, W.: Sur differentes formes du principe de B. de Saint-Venant. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 238, 988-990. (54) 19. Slobodyansky, M. G.: The general form of solutions of the equations of elasticity for simply connected and multiply connected domains expressed by harmonic functions [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 18, 55-74. (44) 20. Sternberg, E.: On Saint-Venant's principle. Q. Appl. Math. 11, 393-402. (54) 1955 1- Aymerich, G.: Una propriety deU'energia elastica. Boll. Un. Mat. Ital. (3) 10, 332-336. (34) 2. Arzhanyh, I. S.: Regular integral equations of the dynamics of an elastic body [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR. Trudy Inst. Mat. Meh. 15, 79-85- (69) 3. — Retarded potentials of tbe dynamics of an elastic body [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR. Trudy Inst. Mat. Meh. 16, 5-22. (69) 4. BabuSka, I., K. Rektorys, and F. Vycichlo: Mathematical Theory of Elasticity for the Plane Problem [in Czechoslovakian]. Prague. (I have seen this work only in the German translation by W. Heinrich, Berlin: Akademie 1960.) (56) 5. Hu, H.: On some variational principles in the theory of elasticity and the theory of plasticity. Sci. Sinica (Peking) 4, 33-54. (38)
References. 285 6. Kaczkowski, Z.: The conjugate directions in an anisotropic body [in Polish]. Arch. Mech. Stos. 7, 52-86. (31) 7. Kroner, E.: Die Spannungsfunktioncn der dreidimensionalen anisotropen Elasti- zitatstheorie. Z. Physik 141, 386-398. (17) 8. — Die inneren Spannungen und der Inkompatibilitatstcnsor in der Elastizitats- thcorie. Z. Angew. Phys. 7, 249-257- (17) 9. Lodge, A. S.: The transformation to isotropic form of the equilibrium equations for a class of anisotropic elastic solids. Q. J. Mech. Appl. Math. 8, 211-225. (31) 10. Lur'e, A. I.: Three-dimensional problems in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Moscow: Gostckhizdat. (I have seen this work only in the English translation by D. B. McVean, New York: Interscience 1964.) (17, 44, 51) 11. Marguerre, K.: Ansatze zur Losung der Grundgleichungen der Elastizitatstheorie. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 35, 241-263. (17, 44) 12. Schaefer, H.: Die Spannungsfunktion einer Dyname. Abhandl. Braunschweig. Wiss. Ges. 7, 107-112. (17) 13. Sternberg, E., and R. A. Eubanks: On the concept of concentrated loads and an extension of the uniqueness theorem in the linear theory of elasticity. J. Rational Mech. Anal. 4, 135-168. (28, 51, 53) 14. Washizu, K.: On the variational principles of elasticity and plasticity. Rept. 25-18, Cont. Nsori-07833 Massachusetts Institute of Technology, March. (38) 1956 1. Dorn, W. S., and A. Schild: A converse to the virtual work theorem for deformablc solids. Q. Appl. Math. 14, 209-213. (17, 36) 2. Duffin, R. J.: Analytic continuation in elasticity. J. Rational Mech. Anal. 5, 939-950. (42, 44) 3. Ericksen, J. L., and R. A. Toupin: Implications of Hadamard's condition for elastic stability with respect to uniqueness theorems. Canad. J. Math. 8, 432-436. Reprinted in Foundations of Elasticity Theory. Intl. Sci. Rev. Ser. New York: Gordon and Breach 1965- (32, 57) 4. Eubanks, R. A., and E. Sternberg: On the completeness of the Boussinesq- Papkovitch stress functions. J. Rational Mech. Anal. 5, 735-746. (44) 5. Finzi, L.: Legame fra equilibrio e congruenza e suo significato fisico. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (8) 20, 205-211. (47) 6. Knopoff, L.: Diffraction of elastic waves. J. Acoust. Soc. Amer. 28, 217-229. (69) 7. Levin, M. L., and S. M. Rytov: Transition to geometrical approximations in elasticity theory [in Russian], Soviet Phys. Acoust. 2, 179-184. (73) 8. Miller, G. F., and M. J. P. Musgrave: On the propagation of elastic waves in aeolotropic media. III. Media of cubic symmetry. Proc. Roy. Soc. Lond. (A) 236, 352-383. (71) 9. Pailloux, M. H.: Elasticite. Mem. Sci. Math. Acad. Sci. Paris 132. (71) 10. Radok, J. R. M.: On the solutions of problems of dynamic plane elasticity. Q. Appl. Math. 14, 289-298. (47) 11. Schaefer, H.: Die drei Spannungsfunktioncn des zweidimensionalen ebenen Kontinuums. Osterreich. Ing. Arch. 10, 267-277. (47) 12. Sokolnikoff, I. S.: Mathematical Theory of Elasticity. 2nd Ed. New York: McGraw-Hill. (14, 27, 36, 37, 44, 47) 13. Synge, J. L.: Flux of energy for elastic waves in anisotropic media. Proc. Roy. Irish Acad., Sect. A 58, 13-21. (71) 14. Temple, G., and W. G. Bickley: Rayleigh's principle and its applications to engineering. New York: Dover. (56) 1957 1. Basheleishvili, M. O.: On fundamental solutions of the differential equations of an anisotropic elastic body [in Russian]. Soobsc. Akad. Nauk Gruzin. SSR. 19, No. 4, 393-400. (51) 2. Bondarenko, B. A.: On a class of solutions of dynamical equations in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR. Trudy Inst. Mat. Meh. 21, 41-49- (67) 3. Brdicka, M.: On the general form of the Beltrami equation and Papkovitch's solution of the axially symmetric problem of the classical theory of elasticity. Czech. J. Phys. 7, 262-274. (17, 44) 4. Courant, R.: Differential and Integral Calculus, Vol. 2. New York: Interscience. (6) 5. Ericksen, J. L.: On the Dirichlet problem for linear differential equations. Proc. Amer. Math. Soc. 8, 521-522. (32) 6. Filonenko-Borodich, M. M.: On the problem of Lamd for the parallelepiped in the general case of surface loads [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 21, 550-559- (1?) 7. Garabaldi, A. C.: Su una propriety di media caratteristica per l'equazione dell'elastostatica. Rend. Sem. Mat. Univ. Padova 27, 306-318. (43)
286 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 8. Hill, R.: On uniqueness and stability in the theory of finite elastic strain. J. Mech. Phys. Solids 5, 229-241. (32, 34) 9. Horvay, G.: Saint-Vcnant's principle: a biharmonic eigenvalue problem. J. Appl. Mech. 24, 381-386. (56) ,ViO. Mikhlin, S. G.: Variational Methods in Mathematical Physics [in Russian]. Moscow. (I have seen this work only in the English translation by T. Boddington, New York: Pergamon 1964.) (34, 37, 39). 11. Noll, W.: Verschiebungsfunktionen fur elastische Schwingungsprobleme. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 37, 81-87- (44) 12. Solomon, L.: Displacement potentials for the equations of elastostatics [in Roumanian]. Buletinul Stiintific Ac. R.P.R., 9, 415-431. (44) 13. Solyanik-Krassa, K. V.: Stress functions of an axisymmetric problem in the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 21, 285-286. (44) 14. Sternberg, E„ and R. A. Eubanks: On stress functions for elastokinetics and the integrations of the repeated wave equation. Q. Appl. Math. 15, 149-153. (67) y IS. Synge, J.L.: The Hypercircle in Mathematical Physics; a Method for the Approximate Solution of Boundary-Value Problems. Cambridge. (34, 51) 16. — Elastic waves in anisotropic media. J. Math. Phys. 35, 323-334. (71) 17. Thomas, T. Y.: The decay of waves in elastic solids. J. Math. Mech. 6, 759-768. (73) 18. Washizu, K.: On the variational principles applied to dynamic problems of elastic bodies. ASRL TR 25-23- Massachusetts Institute of Technology. (65) 1958 1. Babich, V. M., and A. S. Alekseev: A ray method of computing wave front intensities [in Russian], Izv. Akad. Nauk SSSR, Ser. Geofiz. 17-31. (73) 2. Blokh, V. I.: On the representation of the general solution of the basic equations of the static theory of elasticity for an isotropic body with the aid of harmonic functions [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 22, 473-479. (44) 3. Boley, B.: Some observations on Saint-Venant's principle. Proc. Third U.S. National Congress Appl. Mech. 259-264. (54) 4. De Hoop, A. T.: Representation theorems for the displacement in an elastic solid and their application to elastodynamic diffraction theory. Doctoral Dissertation, Technische Hogeschool, Delft. (69) 5. Dekv, V. M.: The solution of the spatial problem in the theory of elasticity [in Ukrainian]. Dopovidi Acad. Nauk Ukr. RSR 29-32. (44) 6. Diaz, J. B., and L. E. Payne: Mean value theorems in the theory of elasticity. Proc. Third U. S. Natl. Congress Appl. Mech. 293-303- (8, 43, 55) 7. On a mean value theorem and its converse for the displacements in the theory of elasticity. Port. Mat. 17, 123-126. (43) 8. Duffin, R. J., and W. Noll: On exterior boundary value problems in elasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 2, 191-196. (32, 49, 50, 57) 9. Halmos, P.: Finite-Dimensional Vector Spaces. New York: Van Nostrand. (3, 23) 10. Hu, H.: On reciprocal theorems in the dynamics of elastic bodies and some applications. Sci. Sinica (Peking) 7, 137-150. (61) 11. — On two variational principles about the natural frequencies of elastic bodies. Sci. Sinica (Peking) 7, 293-312. (76) 12. Petrashen, G. I.: The investigations of the propagation of elastic waves [in Russian]. Vestn. Leningrad Univ. 13, No. 22, 119-136. (73) 13. Predeleanu, M.: Uber die Verschiebungsfunktionen fur das achsensymmetrische Problem der Elastodynamik. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 38, 402-405- (67) 14. Reissner, E.: On variational principles in elasticity. Proc. Symp. Appl. Math. Vol. 8, Calculus of Variations and its Applications. New York: McGraw Hill. (38) 15. Skuridin, G. A., and A. A. Gvozdev: Boundary conditions for the jumps of discontinuous solutions of the dynamical equations of the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Izv. Akad. Nauk SSSR. Ser. Geofiz. 145-156. (73) y?6. Smith, G. F., and R. S. Rivlin: The strain-energy function for anisotropic elastic materials. Trans. Amer. Math. Soc. 88, 175-193. (21, 26) 17. Sneddon, I. N.: Note on a paper by J. R. M. Radok. Q. Appl. Math. 16, 197- (47) 18. — and D. S. Berry: The classical theory of elasticity. Handbuch der Physik 6. Berlin-Gottingen-Heidelberg: Springer. (67) 19. Teodorescu, P. P.: A plane problem of the theory of elasticity with arbitrary body forces [in Russian]. Rev. Mec. Appl. 3, 101-108. (47) 20. Washizu, K.: A note on the conditions of compatibility. J. Math. Phys. 36, 306-312. (18) 1959 1. Buchwald, V. T.: Elastic waves in anisotropic media. Proc. Roy. Soc. Lond. (A) 253, 563-580. (73)
References. 287 2. Dana, J. S.: Dana's manual of mineralogy 17th cd., revised by C. S. Hurlbut, Jr. New York: John Wiley. (21) 3. Deev, V. M.: On the form of the general solution of the three-dimensional problem of the theory of elasticity expressed with the aid of harmonic functions [in Russian]. Prikl. Math. Meh. 23, 1132-1133; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 23, 1619-1622. (44) 4. DiMaggio, F. L., and H. H. Bleich: An application of a dynamic reciprocal theorem. J. Appl. Mech. 26, 678-679- (61) 5. Gvozdev, A. A.: On the conditions at elastic wave fronts propagating in a non- homogeneous medium [in Russian]. Prikl. Math. Meh. 23, 395-397; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 23, 556-561. (73) 6. Hardy, G. H., J. E. Littlewood, and G. Polya: Inequalities. Cambridge. (56) 7. Hijab, W. A.: Application of Papkovitch functions to three-dimensional problems of elasticity. Proc. Math. Phys. Soc. U.A.R. No. 23, 99-115. (44) 8. Ignaczak, J.: Direct determination of stresses from the stress equations of motion in elasticity. Arch. Mech. Stos. 11, 671-678. (59) 9. Karal, F. C, and J. B. Keller: Elastic wave propagation in homogeneous and inhomogeneous media. J. Acoust. Soc. Am. 31, 694-705- (73) 10. Mikusinski, J.: Operational Calculus. New York: Pergamon. (10, 69) 11. Pearson, C. E.: Theoretical Elasticity. Cambridge: Harvard University Press. (67) 12. Schaefer, H.: Die Spannungsfunktionen des dreidimensionalen Kontinuums; statische Deutung und Randwerte. Ing. Arch. 28, 291-306. (17) 13. Signorini, A.: Questioni di elasticity non linearizzata e semilinearizzata. Rend. Mat. e Appl. 18, 95-139- (31) 14. Skuridin, G. A.: Duhamel's principle and asymptotic solutions of dynamical equations in the theory of elasticity. II [in Russian], lzv. Akad. Nauk SSSR. Ser. Geofiz. 337-343. (73) 15. Slobodyansky, M. G.: On the general and complete form of solutions of the equations of elasticity [in Russian]. Prikl. Math. Meh. 23, 468-482; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 23, 666-685. (44) 16. Truesdell, C.: Invariant and complete stress functions for general continua. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 3, 1-29. (17, 44) 17. — The rational mechanics of materials-past, present, future. Applied Mech. Rev. 12," 75-80. Corrected reprint, Applied Mechanics Surveys. Washington: Spartan Books. 1965. (22) 18. Waterman, P. C.: Orientation dependence of elastic waves in single crystals. Phys. Rev. (2) 113, 1240-1253. (71) 1960 1. Bernstein, B., and R. Toupin: Korn inequalities for the sphere and for the circle. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 6, 51-64. (13) 2. Boley, B. A.: On a dynamical Saint-Venant principle. J. Appl. Mech. 27, 74-78. (54) (54) 3. — and J. H. Weiner: Theory of Thermal Stresses. New York: Wiley. (14) 4. Bondarenko, B. A.: Gradient and curl solutions of the dynamical equations of elasticity theory [in Russian]. Issled. Mat. Analizu Mehanike Uzbek. Izdat. Akad. Nauk Uzbek. SSR., Tashkent, 17-29. (67) 5. Duff, G. F. D.: The Cauchy problem for elastic waves in an anisotropic medium. Trans. Roy. Soc. Lond. (A) 252, 249-273- (74) 6. Ericksen, J. L.: Tensor fields. Appendix to [1960, 17]. (27) 7. Gurtin, M. E., and E. Sternberg: On the first boundary-value problem of linear elastostatics. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 3, 177-187. (32, 34, 57) 8. Indenbom, V. L.: Reciprocity theorems and influence functions for the dislocation density tensor and the deformation incompatibility tensor [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 128, 906-909; translated as Soviet Phys. Doklady 4, 1125-1128. (30) 9. Rieder, G.: Topologische Fragen in der Theorie der Spannungsfunktionen. Ab- handl. Braunschweig. Wiss. Ges. 7, 4-65- (17) 10. Rudiger, D.: Eine Verallgemeinerung des I'rinzips vom Minimum der potentiellen Energie elastischer Korper. Ing. Arch. 27, 421-428. (38, 41) 11. Sirotin, Y. I.: Group tensor spaces [in Russian]. Kristallografiya 5, 171-179; translated as Soviet Phys.-Cryst. 5, 157-165. (26) 12. Sternberg, E.: On some recent developments in the linear theory of elasticity. In Structural Mechanics. New York: Pergamon Press. (17, 54) 13. — On the integration of the equations of motion in the classical theory of elasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 6, 34-50. (67)
288 M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 14. Teodorescu, P.P.: Sur une representation par potentiels dans le probleme tri- dimensionnel de l'elastodynamique. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 250, 1792-1794. (67) 15. Truesdell, C.: A program toward rediscovering the rational mechanics of the age of reason. Arch. Hist. Exact Sc. 1, 3-36. Corrected reprint in Essays in the History of Mechanics. Berlin-Heidelberg-New York: Springer-Verlag 1968. (22) 16. — The Rational Mechanics of Flexible or Elastic Bodies, 1638-1788. L. Euleri Opera Omnia (2) II2. Zurich: Fussli. (22) 17. — and R. Toupin: The classical field theories. In Vol. 31 of the Handbuch der Physik, edited by S. Flugge. Berlin-Gottingen-Heidelberg: Springer-Verlag. (12, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 71, 72, 73) 1961 1. Babich, V. M.: Fundamental solutions of the dynamical equations of elasticity for nonhomogeneous media [in Russian]. Prikl. Mat. Meh. 25, 38-45; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 25, 49-60. (68) 2. Blokh, V. I.: Stress functions and displacement functions [in Russian]. Dopovidi Akad. Nauk. Ukr. RSR 455-458. (17, 44) 3. Bramble, J. H., and L. E. Payne: An analogue of the spherical harmonics for the equation of elasticity. J. Math. Phys. 15, 163-171- (32) 4. A new decomposition formula in the theory of elasticity. J. Res. Nat. Bur. Std. 65 B, 151-156. (44) 5. On some new continuation formulas and uniqueness theorems in the theory of elasticity. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 3, 1-17. (40) 6.- A priori bounds in the first boundary-value problem in elasticity. J. Res. Nat. Bur. Std. 65 B, 269-276. (52) 7. Farnell, G. W.: Elastic waves in trigonal crystals. Can. J. Phys. 39, 65-80. (71) 8. Fichera, G.: II teorema del massimo modulo per l'equazione dell'elastostatica. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 7, 373-387- (42) 9. Goldberg, R. R.: Fourier Transforms. Cambridge. (32) 10. Gurtin, M. E., and E. Sternberg : A note on uniqueness in classical elastodynamics. Q. Appl. Math. 19, 169-171. (63) 11. Theorems in linear elastostatics for exterior domains. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 8, 99-119- (*, 34, 48, 49, 50) 12. Hill, R.: Bifurcation and uniqueness in non-linear mechanics of continua. Problems Contin. Mech. (Muskhelisvili Anniv. Vol.), 155-164. Phila.: Soc. Indust. Appl. Math. (32) 13. — Uniqueness in general boundary-value problems for elastic or inelastic solids. J. Mech. Phys. Solids 9, 114-130. (32) 14. — Discontinuity relations in mechanics of solids. Progress in Solid Mechanics. Vol. II, 245-276. Amsterdam: North-Holland. (72) 15. Musgrave, M. J. P.: Elastic waves in anisotropic media. Progress in Solid Mechanics. Vol. II, 61-85. (71) 16. Naghdi, P.M., and C. S.Hsu: On a representation of displacements in linear elasticity in terms of three stress functions. J. Math. Mech. 10, 233-245. (44) 17. Payne, L. E., and H. F. Weinberger: On Korn's inequality. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 8, 89-98. (13) 18. Reissner, E.: On some variational theorems in elasticity. Problems of Continuum Mechanics (Muskhelishvili Anniversary Volume), 370-381. Phila.: Soc. Indust. Appl. Math. (38) 19. Rudiger, D.: Ein neues Variationsprinzip in der Elastizitatstheorie. Ing. Arch. 30, 220-224. (38) 20. Solomon, L.: On the degree of arbitrariness in the determination of the functions of Papkovitch [in Roumanian]. Comun. Acad. RPR., 11, 1039-1045- (44) 21. Sveklo, V. A.: On the solution of dynamic problems in the plane theory of elasticity for anisotropic media [in Russian], Prikl. Mat. Meh. 25, 885-896; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 25, 1324-1339- (47) 22. Truesdell, C.: General and exact theory of waves in finite elastic strain. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 8, 263-296. Reprinted in Problems of Non-linear Elasticity. Intl. Sci. Rev. Ser. New York: Gordon and Breach 1965 and also in Wave Propagation in Dissipative Materials. Berlin-Heidelberg-New York: Springer 1965. (73) 1962 1. Alexandrov, A. Y., and I. I. Solovev: One form of solution of three-dimensional axisymmetric problems of elasticity theory by means of functions of a complex variable and the solution of these problems for the sphere [in Russian], Prikl. Mat. Mech. 26, 138-145; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 26, 188-198. (44) 2. Blokh, V. I.: On some consequences of two variational principles in the mechanics of solid deformable bodies. Akad. Nauk. Ukr. RSR Prikl. Meh. 8, 56-62. (18)
References. 289 3. Bramble, J. H., and L. E. Payne: On the uniqueness problem in the second boundary-value problem in elasticity. Proc. Fourth U.S. National Congress Appl. Mech. 1, 469-473- (32) 4. Some uniqueness theorems in the theory of elasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 9, 319-328. (32) 5. Courant, R.: Partial Differential Equations. Vol. 2 of Methods of Mathematical Physics by R. Courant and D. Hilbert. New York: Interscience. (6, 74) 6. Gobert, J.: Une inegalite' fondamentale de la theorie de l'elasticite. Bull. Soc. Roy Sci. Liege 31, 182-191. (13) 7. Gurtin, M.: On Helmholtz's theorem and the completeness of the Papkovitch- Neuber stress functions for infinite domains. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 9, 225-233. (44) 8. Gutzwiller, M. C.: Note on Green's function in anisotropic elasticity. Q. Appl. Math. 20, 249-256. (68) 9. Hashin, Z., and S. Shtrikman: On some variational principles in anisotropic and nonhomogeneous elasticity. J. Mech. Phys. Solids 10, 335-352. (34) 10. Kneshke, A., u. D. Rudiger: Eine Erweiterung des Hamiltonschen Prinzips zur Integration mechanischer Anfangs-Randwertaufgaben. Ing. Arch. 31, 101-112. (65) 11. Minagawa, S.: Riemannian three-dimensional stress-function space. RAAG Mem. 3, 69-81. (17) 12. Murtazaev, D.: Fundamental solutions of systems of equations in elasticity theory [in Russian]. Izv. Vyss. UCebn. Zaved. Matematika No. 1 (26) 109-117. (51, 68) 13. Sternberg, E., and M. Gurtin: On the completeness of certain stress functions in the linear theory of elasticity. Proc. Fourth U. S. Nat. Cong. Appl. Mech. 793-797. (44, 67) 14. Stroh, A. N.: Steady state problems in anisotropic elasticity. J. Math. Phys. 41, 77-103. (71) 15. Strubecker, K.: Airysche Spannungsfunktion und isotrope Differentialgeometrie. Math. Z. 78, 189-198. (47) 1963 1. Adler, G.: Maggiorazione delle tensiom in un corpo elastico mediante gli sposta- menti superficiali. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (8) 34, 369-371. (42) 2. Bourgin, D. G.: Modern Algebraic Topology. New York: Macmillan. (71) 3. Diaz, J. B., and L. E. Payne: New mean value theorems in the linear theory of elasticity. Contrib. Diff. Eqts. 1, 29-38. (43) X 4. Ericksen, J. L.: Non-existence theorems in linear elasticity theory. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 14, 180-183. (33) 5. Fedorov, F. I.: The theory of elastic waves in crystals. Comparison with isotropic medium [in Russian]. Kristallografiya 8, 213-220; translated as Soviet Phys.-Cryst. 8, 159-163. (70) 6. Fichera, G.: Problemi elastostatici con vincoli unilaterali: II problema di Signorini con ambigue condizioni al contorno. Atti Accad. Naz. Lincei Mem. (8) 7, 91-140. English translation in: Estratto dai Seminari dell'Istituto Nazionale di Alta Matematica 1962-1963. Rome: Edizioni Cremonese 1964. (31) X 7. Gazis, D. C, I. Tadjbakhsh, and R. A. Toupin: The elasticity tensor of a given symmetry nearest to an anisotropic elastic tensor. Acta Cryst. 16, 917-922. (22) 8. Graffi, D.: Sui teoremi di reciprocity nei fenomeni non stazionari. Atti Accad. Sci. Bologna (11) 10, 33-40. (19, 61) 9. Gurtin, M. E.: A generalization of the Beltrami stress functions in continuum mechanics. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 13, 321-329. (17) 10. — A note on the principle of minimum potential energy for linear anisotropic elastic solids. Q. Appl. Math. 20, 379-382. (32, 34) 11. — Variational principles in the linear theory of viscoelasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 13, 179-191- (36) 12. Hayes, M.: Wave propagation and uniqueness in prestressed elastic solids. Proc. Roy. Soc. Lond. (A) 274, 500-506. (32) 13. Hill, R.: New derivations of some elastic extremum principles. Progress in Applied Mechanics, the Prager Anniversary Volume. New York: Macmillan. 99-106. (34) 14. Ignaczak, J.: A completeness problem for the stress equation of motion in the linear theory of elasticity. Arch. Mech. Stosow. 15, 225-234. (59, 62) 15. John, F.: Estimates for the error in the equations of nonlinear plate theory. New York University, Courant Institute of Math. Sc. Rept. IMM-NYU 308. (55) 16. Kawatate, K.: A note on the stress function. Rep. Res. Inst. Appl. Mech. Kyushi Univ. 11, 21-27. (17) Handbuch der Physik, Bd. VI a/2. 19
M. E. Gurtin: The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 17. Kupradze, V. D.: Potential Methods in the Theory of Elasticity [in Russian]. Moscow. (I have seen this work only in the English translation by H. Gutfreund, Jerusalem: Monson 1965.) (27, 30, 45, 49, 75). 18. — Dynamical problems in elasticity. Vol. Ill of Progress in Solid Mechanics. New York: Wiley. (27, 30, 45, 49, 75) 19. Melnik, S. I.: Estimates for the St. Venant principle [in Russian]. Perm. Gos. Univ. Ucen. Zap. Mat. 103, 178-180. (55) 20. Mills, N.: Uniqueness in classical linear isotropic elasticity theory. M. Sci. Thesis, University of Newcastle upon Tyne. (32) 21. Pastori, M.: Equilibrio e congruenza nei sistemi continui. Aspetto formale e geometrico. Aspetto energetico ed estensioni. Confer. Sem. Mat. Univ. Bari, 95-96. (17) 22. Tang, L.-M., and H.-C. Sun: Three-dimensional elasticity problems solved by complex variable method. Sci. Sinica (Peking) 12, 1627-1649- (44) 23. Teodorescu, P. P.: Sur l'utilisation des potentiels reels dans le probleme plan de la theorie de l'elasticite. Bull. Math. Soc. Sci. Math. Phys. R.P. Romaine (N.S.) 7(55), 77-111. (47) 24. Truesdell, C.: The meaning of Betti's reciprocal theorem. J. Res. Nat. Bur. Std. B 67, 85-86. (30) 25. Volkov, S. D., and M. L. Komissarova: Certain representations of the general solutions of the boundary-value problems of elasticity theory [in Russian]. In2h. Zh. 3, 86-92. (44) 1. Adler, G.: Majoration des tensions dans un corps elastique a I'aide des deplace- ments superficiels. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 16, 345-372. (42) 2. Aleksandrov, A. Y., and I. I. Solovev: On a generalization of a method of solution of axially symmetric problems in the theory of elasticity by means of analytic functions to spatial problems without axial symmetry [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk SSSR 154, 294-297; translated as Soviet Phys. Dokl. 9, 99-102. (44) 3. Bers, L., F. John, and M. Schechter: Partial Differential Equations. New York: Interscience. (74) 4. Bramble, J. H., and L. E. Payne: Some mean value theorems in elastostatics. SI AM J. 12, 105-114. (43) 5. Coleman, B. D., and W. Noll: Material symmetry and thermostatic inequalities in finite elastic deformations. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 15, 87-111. (21) 6. Chen, Y.: Remarks on variational principles in elastodynamics. J. Franklin Inst. 278, 1-7. (65) 7. Fedorov, F. I.: On the theory of waves in crystals, [in Russian]. Mosk. Univ. Vestn. Fiz. Ast. (3) 6, 36-40. (71) 8. Gurtin, M. E.: Variational principles in linear elastodynamics. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 16, 34-50. (19, 62, 64, 65) 9. Herrmann, L. R.: Stress functions for the asymmetric, orthotropic elasticity equations. AIAA J. 2, 1822-1824. (44) 10. Ionov, V. N., and G. A. VvodenskiI: On the possible forms of the general solution of the equilibrium equations in curvilinear coordinates [in Russian]. Izv. Vyss. Ucebn. Zaved. Mat. (43) 6, 59-66. (17) 11. Jeffrey, A.: A note on the derivation of the discontinuity conditions across contact discontinuities, shocks, and phase fronts. Z. Angew. Math. Phys. 15, 68—71. (73) 12. Keller, H. B.: Propagation of stress discontinuities in inhomogeneous elastic media. SIAM Rev. 6, 356-382. (73) 13. Knops, R.: Uniqueness for the whole space in classical elasticity. J. Lond. Math. Soc. 39, 708-712. (32) 14. Martin, J.: A displacement bound technique for elastic continua subjected to a certain class of dynamic loading. J. Mech. Phys Solids 12, 165-175. (60) 15. N6no, T.: Sur les champs de tensions. J. Sci. Hiroshima Univ. Ser. A-I. 28, 209-221. (17) 16. Payton, R. G.: An application of the dynamic Betti-Rayleigh reciprocal theorem to moving point loads in elastic media. Q. Appl. Math. 21, 299-313. (61) 17. Rieder, G.: Die Berechnung des Spannungsfeldes von Einzelkraften mit Hilfe raumlicher Spannungsfunktionen und ihre Anwendung zur quellenmaGigen Dar- stellung der Verschiebung bei Eigenspannungszustanden. Osterr. Ing. Arch. 18, 173-201. (17) 18. — Die Randbedingungen fur den Spannungsfunktionentensor an ebenen und ge- krUmmten belasteten Oberflachen. Osterr. Ing. Arch. 18, 208-243. (17) 19. — Uber eine Spezialisierung des Schaeferschen Spannungsfunktionenansatzes in der raumlichen Elastizitatstheorie. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 44, 329-330. (17)
References. 291 20. Sternberg, E., and S. Al-Khozai: On Green's functions and Saint Venant's principle in the linear theory of viscoelasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 15, 112-146. (51, 54) 21. Stickforth, J.: Zur Anwendung des Castiglianoschen Prinzips und der Beltrami- schen Spannungsfunktionen bei mehrfach zusammenhangenden elastischen K6r- pern unter Beriicksichtigung von Eigenspannungen. Tech. Mitt. Krupp Forsch.-Ber. 22, 83-92. (18) 22. Teodorescu, P. P.: A hundred years of research on the plane problem of the theory of elasticity [in Romanian]. Stud. Cere. Mat. 15, 355-367. (45) 23. Yu, Y.-Y.: Generalized Hamilton's principle and variational equation of motion in nonlinear elasticity theory, with application to plate theory. J. Acoust. Soc. Am. 36, 111-120. (65) 24. Zorski, H.: On the equations describing small deformations superposed on finite deformations. Proc. Intl. Sympos. Second-order Effects, Haifa 1962, 109-128. (32) 1965 1. Alexsandrov, I. Y.: Solution of axisymmetric and other three-dimensional problems in the theory of elasticity by means of analytical functions. Appl. Theory of Functions in Continuum Mechanics (Proc. Int. Sympos. Tbilisi. 1963) Vol. I, 97-118. Moscow: Izdat. Nauka. (44) 2. Bramble, J. H., and L. E. Payne: Some converses of mean value theorems in the theory of elasticity. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 10, 553-567. (43) 3. Brugger, K.: Pure modes for elastic waves in crystals. J. Appl. Phys. 36, 759-768. (71) 4. Brun, L.: Sur l'unicite en thermoelasticite' dynamique et diverses expressions analogues a la formule de Clapeyron. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris 261, 2584-2587. (60, 63) 5. Fedorov, F. I.: Theory of Elastic Waves in Crystals [in Russian]. Moscow: Nauka Press (I have seen this work only in the English translation by J. E. S. Bradley, New York: Plenum 1968.) (70, 71) 6. De Veubeke, B. F.: Displacement and equilibrium models in the finite element method. Stress Analysis. New York: Wiley. (38) Ys7. Ericksen, J. L.: Nonexistence theorems in linearized elastostatics. J. Diff. Eqts. 1, 446-451- (S3) 8. Friedrichs, K. O., and H. B. Keller: A finite difference scheme for generalized Neumann problems. Numerical Solution of Partial Differential Equations. New York: Academic. (39) 9. Gurtin, M. E., and R. A. Toupin: A uniqueness theorem for the displacement boundary-value problem of linear elastodynamics. Q. Appl. Math. 23, 79-81. (63) 10. John, F.: Estimates for the derivatives of the stresses in a thin shell and interior shell equations. Comm. Pure Appl. Math. 18, 235-267. (55) 11. Keller, H. B.: Saint-Venant's procedure and Saint Venant's principle. Q. Appl. Math. 22, 293-304. (54) 12. Knops, R. J.: Uniqueness of axisymmetric elastostatic problems for finite regions. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 18, 107-116. (32) 13. — Uniqueness of the displacement boundary-value problem for the classical elastic half-space. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 20, 373-377. (32, 50) 14. Minagawa, S.: On Riemannian and non-Riemannian stress function spaces with reference to two-dimensional stress functions. Reports of the Research Institute for Strength and Fracture of Materials. Tohuku Univ. 1, 15-31. (17) 15. Muskhelishvili, N. 1.: Applications of the theory of functions of a complex variable to the theory of elasticity. Appl. Theory of Functions in Continuum Mechanics (Proc. Int. Sympos. Tbilisi, 1963) Vol. I, 32-55 (Russian); 56-75 (English) Moscow: Izdat Nauka. (45) 16. Reissner, E.: A note on variational principles in elasticity. Int. J. Solids Structures 1, 93-95. (38) 17. Stickforth, J.: On the derivation of the conditions of compatibility from Casti- gliano's principle by means of three-dimensional stress functions. J. Math. Phys. 44, 214-226. (18) 18. Stippes, M.: Steady state waves in anisotropic media. Ann. Meeting Soc. Eng. Sci., Nov., 1965 (unpublished). (71) 19. Teodorescu, P. P.: Uber das dreidimensionale Problem der Elastokinetik. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 45, 513-523. (59) 20. Toupin, R. A.: Saint-Venant and a matter of principle. Trans. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 28, 221-232. (54, 55) 21. — Saint-Venant's principle. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 18, 83-96. (24, 55) 22. Truesdell, C, and W. Noll: The non-linear field theories of mechanics. In Vol. 33 of the Handbuch der Physik, edited by S. Flugge. Berlin-Heidelberg- New York: Springer Verlag. (12, 16, 19, 20, 21, 23, 73) 19*
292 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of^Elasticity. 1966 1. Ainola, L. I.: A reciprocal theorem for dynamic problems of the theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Prikl. Math. Meh. 31, 176-177; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 31, 190-192. (61) 2. Ben-Amoz, M.: Variational principles in anisotropic and non-homogeneous elasto- kinetics. Q. Appl. Math. 24, 82-86. (65) 3. Beran, M., and J. Molyneux: Use of classical variational principles to determine bounds for the effective bulk modulus in heterogeneous media. Q. Appl. Math. 24, 107-118. (34) 4. Bernikov, H. B.: Generalization of the Boussinesq-Galerkin solution to anisotropic bodies [in Russian]. Dokl. Akad. Nauk. Tadzh. SSR 9, No. 6, 3-6. (44) 5. Burckhardt, J. J.: Die Bewegungsgruppen der Kristallographie. Basel und Stuttgart: Birkhauser Verlag. (21) 6. Carlson, D.: Completeness of the Beltrami stress functions in continuum mechanics. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 15, 311-315- (17) 7. Dou, A.: Upper estimate of the potential elastic energy of a cylinder. Comm. Pure Appl. Math. 19, 83-93- (54) 8. Doyle, J. M.: Integration of the Laplace transformed equations of classical elasto- kinetics. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 13, 118-131. (69) 9. Hayes, M.: On the displacement boundary-value problem in linear elastostatics. Q. J. Mech. Appl. Math. 19, 151-155- (32) 10. Karnopp, B. H.: Complementary variational principles in linear elastodynamics. Tensor (N.S.) 17, 300-307- (65) 11. Key, S.: A convergence investigation of the direct stiffness method. Ph. D. Thesis. Dept. Aero. Eng. University of Washington. (39) 12. Knowles, J. K.: On Saint Venant's principle in the two-dimensional linear theory of elasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 21, 1-22. (55, 56) 13. — and E. Sternberg: On Saint Venant's principle and the torsion of solids of revolution. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 22, 100-120. (55) 14. Kolodner, I.: Existence of longitudinal waves in anisotropic media. J. Acoust. Soc. Am. 40, 730-731. (71) 15. Komkov, V.: Application of Rail's theorem to classical elastodynamics. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 14, 511-521. (65) 16. Mikhlin, S. G.: On Cosserat functions. Problems in Mathematical Analysis. Vol. 1. Boundary Value Problems and Integral Equations [in Russian]. Leningrad University Press. (I have seen this work only in the English translation. New York: Consultant's Bureau 1968, 55-64.) (32) 17. Muskhelishvili: Some Basic Problems of the Mathematical Theory of Elasticity [in Russian] 5th Ed. Moscow. (I have not seen this work.) (45) 18. Nariboli, G. A.: Wave propagation in anisotropic elasticity. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 16, 108-122. (73) 19. Oravas, G., and L. McLean: Historical developments of energetical principles in elastomechanics. Appl. Mech. Rev. 19, 647-656, 919-933- (34, 38) 20. Radzhabov, R. R.: The construction of the Green's tensor for the first boundary- value problem of the theory of elasticity [in Russian], Voprosy Kibernet. Vychisl. Mat. Vyp. 6, 96-111. (53) 21. Robinson, A.: Non-Standard Analysis. Amsterdam: North-Holland. (56a) 22. Roseman, J. J.: A pointwise estimate for the stress in a cylinder and its application to Saint-Venant's principle. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 21, 23-48. (55) 23. Shield, R. T., and C. A. Anderson: Some least work principles for elastic bodies. Z. Angew. Math. Phys. 17, 663-676. (30) 24. Sternberg, E., and J. K. Knowles: Minimum energy characterizations of Saint Venant's solution to the relaxed Saint-Venant problem. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 21, 89-107. (40, 41) 25. Stippes, M.: On stress functions in classical elasticity. Q. Appl. Math. 24, H9-125. (17, 44) 26. Tonti, E.: Condizioni iniziali nei principi variazionali. Rend. 1st. Lombardo (A) 100, 982-988. (65) 27. Truesdell, C.: Existence of longitudinal waves. J. Acoust. Soc. Am. 40, 729-730. (71) 28. — The Elements of Continuum Mechanics. Berlin-Heidelberg-New York: Springer. (27) 1967 1. Azhymudinov, T., and G. Mamaturdiev: Representation of eigenvalues of the first boundary-value problem of elasticity theory by means of a contour-integral. Izv. Akad. Nauk UzSSR Ser. Fiz.-Mat. Nauk 11, No. 3, 3-9. (76)
References. 293 2. Beatty, M. F.: A reciprocal theorem in the linearized theory of couple-stresses. ActaMech. 3, 154-166. (30) 3. Bezier, P.: Sur quelques proprietes des solutions de problemes de l'elastostatique line"aire. C. R. Acad. Sci., Paris (A) 265, 365-367. (48, 50, 51) 4. Carlson, D.: A note on the Beltrami stress functions. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 47, 206-207- (17) 5. Chad wick, P., and E. A. Trowbridge: Elastic wave fields generated by scalar wave functions. Proc. Cambridge Phil. Soc. 63, 1177-1187. (67) 6. Hlavacek, I.: Derivation of non-classical variational principles in the theory of elasticity. Apl. Mat. 12, 15-29. (38) 7. ■— Variational principles in the linear theory of elasticity for general boundary conditions. Apl. Mat. 12, 425-448. (38, 41) 8. Hashin, Z.: Variational principles of elasticity in terms of the polarization tensor. Int. J. Eng. Sci. 5, 213-223. (34) 9. Hill, R.: Eigenmodal deformations in elastic/plastic continua. J. Mech. Phys. Solids 15, 371-386. (63) 10. Kilchevskii, M. O., and O. F. Levchuk: One of the forms of the general solution of the elastodynamic equations [in Ukrainian]. Dopovidi Akad. Nauk. Ukr. RSR (A) 801-804. (67) 11. Prager, W.: Variational principles of linear elastostatics for discontinuous displacements, strains and stresses. Recent Progress in Applied Mechanics. The Folke Odqvist Volume. New York: Wiley. 463-474. (38, 41) 12. Roseman, J. J.: The principle of Saint Venant in linear and non-linear plane elasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 26, 142-162. (56) 13. Schuler, K. W., and R. L. Fosdick: Generalized Beltrami stress functions. Dept. Mech. Rept, Illinois Inst. Tech. (17, 47) 14. Stippes, M.: A note on stress functions. Int. J. Solids Structures 3, 705-711- (17, 44) 15. Tong, P., and T. H. H. Pian: The convergence of finite element method in solving linear elastic problems. Int. J. Solids Structures 3, 865-879. (39) 16. Tonti, E.: Principii variazionali nell'elastostatica. Atti Accad. Lincei Rend. (8) 42, 390-394. (18, 38) 17. — Variational principles in elastostatics. Meccanica 2, 201-208. (18, 38) / 18. Turteltaub, M. J., and E. Sternberg: Elastostatic uniqueness in the half- space. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 24, 233-242. (50) 19. Zienkiewicz, O. C, and Y. K. Cheung: The Finite Element Method in Structural and Continuum Mechanics. New York: McGraw-Hill. (39) 1968 1. Bross, H.: Das Fundamentalintegral der Elastizitatstheorie far kubische Medien. Z. Angew. Math. Phys. 19, 434-446. (51) 2. Cakala, S., Z. Domanski, and H. Milicer-Gruzewska: Construction of the fundamental solution of the system of equations of the static theory of elasticity and the solution of the first boundary-value problem for a half space [in Polish]. Zeszyty Nauk. Politech. Warszaw. Mat. No. 14, 151-164. (51) 3. Dafermos, C. M.: Some remarks on Korn's inequality. Z. Angew. Math. Phys. 19, 913-920. (13) 4. Edelstein, W. S., and R. L. Fosdick: A note on non-uniqueness in linear elasticity theory. Z. Angew. Math. Phys. 19, 906-912. (32) 5. Fosdick, R. L.: On the displacement boundary-value problem of static linear elasticity theory. Z. Angew. Math. Phys. 19, 219-233- (57) 6. Gurtin, M. E., V. J. Mizel, and W. O. Williams: A note on Cauchy's stress theorem. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 22, 398-401. (15) 7. Hayes, M., and R. J. Knops: On the displacement boundary-value problem of linear elastodynamics. Q. Appl. Math. 26, 291-293. (63) 8. Horak, V.: Inverse Variationsprinzipien der Mechanik fester Korper. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 48, 143-146. (38) 9. Indenbom, V. L., and S. S. Orlov: Construction of Green's function in terms of Green's function of lower dimensions [in Russian]. Prikl. Math. Meh. 32, 414-420; translated as J. Appl. Math. Mech. 414-420. (53) 10. Karnopp, B. H.: Reissner's variational principle and elastodynamics. Acta Mech. 6, 158-164. (65) 11. Knops, R. J., and L.E.Payne: Uniqueness in classical elastodynamics. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 27, 349-355- (63) 12. Solomon, L.: Elasticity Line"aire. Paris: Masson. (27, 38, 44, 47) 13. Truesdell, C.: Comment on longitudinal waves. J. Acoust. Soc. Am. 43, 170. (71)
294 M. E. Gurtin : The Linear Theory of Elasticity. 14. Turteltaub, M. J., and E. Sternberg: On concentrated loads and Green's functions in elastostatics. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 29, 193-240. (51, 52, 53) 15. Washizu, K.: Variational methods in elasticity and plasticity. New York: Perga- mon. (38) 16. Wheeler, L. T., and E. Sternberg : Some theorems in classical elastodynamics. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 31, 51-90. (60, 61, 68, 69, 74) 1969 1. Berg, C. A.: The physical meaning of astatic equilibrium in Saint Venant's principle for linear elasticity. J. Appl. Mech. 36, 392-396. (18, 29) 2. Brun, L.: Methodes energe'tiques dans les systemes eVolutifs line'aires. J. Mecanique 8, 125-191- (60, 63) 3. de La Penha, G., and S. B. Childs: A note on Love's stress function. ATAA J. 7, 540. (44) 4. Kanwal, R. P.: Integral equations formulation of classical elasticity. Q. Appl. Math. 27, 57-65. (52) 5. Nowak, M.: Equations of motion of an elastic free-free body. Bull. Acad. Polon. Sci., Ser. Sci. Tech. 17, 31-36. (68) 6. Rubenfeld, L. A., and J. B. Keller: Bounds on elastic moduli of composite media. SI AM J. Appl. Math. 17, 495-510. (34) 7. Schultz, M. H.: Error bounds on the Rayleigh-Ritz-Galerkin method. J. Math. Anal. Appl. 27, 524-533. (39) 8. Stippes, M.: Completeness of the Papkovitch potentials. Q. Appl. Math. 26, 477- 483. (44) 9. Youngdahl, C. K.: On the completeness of a set of stress functions appropriate to the solution of elasticity problems in general cylindrical coordinates. Int. J. Eng. Sci. 7, 61-79- (44) 1970 1. Benthien, G., and M. E. Gurtin: A principle of minimum transformed energy in elastodynamics. J. Appl. Mech. 31, 1147-1149- (66) 2. HlavACek, I., and J. NeCas: On inequalities of Korn's type. I. Boundary-value problems for elliptic systems of partial differential equations. II. Applications to linear elasticity. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 36, 305-334. (28) 3. Wheeler, L. T.: Some results in the linear dynamical theory of anisotropic elastic solids. Q. Appl. Math. 28, 91-101. (61, 74) 4. Zienkiewicz, O. C.: The finite element method; from intuition to generality. Appl. Mech. Rev. 23, 249-256. (39) 1971 1. Fichera, G.: Existence theorems in elasticity. Below in Volume VIa/2 of the Hand - buch derPhysik, edited by C. Truesdell. Berlin-Heidelberg-New York: Springer. (5, 7, 13, 31, 33, 36, 78) 2. Knops, R. J., and L. E. Payne: Uniqueness theorems in linear elasticity. In: Springer Tracts in Natural Philosophy (ed. B. D. Coleman), Vol. 19. Berlin-Heidelberg- New York: Springer. (32, 40, 63) 3. Maiti, M., and G. R. Makan: On an integral equation approach to displacement problems of classical elasticity. Q. Appl. Math. To appear. (52) 4. Segenreich, S. A.: On the strain energy distribution in self equilibrated cylinders. 5. Thesis. COPPE, Federal Univ. Rio de Janeiro. Addendum. The following additional papers would have been referred to, had I seen them in time. 1956 Teleman, S.: The method of orthogonal projection in the theory of elasticity. Rev. Math. Pures Appl. 1, 49-66. 1957 Roseau, M.: Sur un theoreme d'unicit(5 applicable a certains problemes de diffraction d'ondes elastiques. C.R. Acad. Sci., Paris 245, 1780-1782. 1959 Campanato, S.: Sui problemi al contorno per sistemi de equazioni differenziali lineari del tipo dell'elasticita. Ann. Scuola Norm. Pisa (3) 13, 223-258, 275-302. 1961 Baikuziev, K.: Some methods of solving the Cauchy problem of the mathematical theory of elasticity [in Russian]. Izv. Akad. Nauk USSR Ser. Fiz.-Mat. 3-12. 1962 Gegelia, T. G.: Some fundamental boundary-value problems in elasticity theory in space [in Russian]. Akad. Nauk Gruzin. SSSR Trudy Tbiliss. Mat. Inst. Razmadze 28, 53-72. Kupradze, V. D.: Singular integral equations and boundary-value problems of elasticity theory [in Russian]. Tbiliss. Gos. Univ. Trudy Ser. Meh.-Mat. Nauk. 84, 63-75- Rieder, G.: Iterationsverfahren und Operatorgleichungen in der Elastizitatstheorie. Abhandl. Braunschweig. Wiss. Ges. 14, 109-343-
References. 295 1963 Deev, V. M.: Representation of the general solution of a three-dimensional problem of elasticity theory by particular solutions of Lame's equations [in Ukrainian]. Dopovidi Akad. Nauk. Ukr. RSR 1464-1467. Volkov, S. D., and M. L. Komissarova : Certain representations of the general solutions of the boundary-value problems of elasticity theory [in Russian]. Inzh. Zh. 3, 86-92. 1964 Kurlandzki, J.: Mathematical formulation of a certain method for solving boundary problems of mechanics. Proc. Vibration Problems 5, 117-124- 1965 Niemeyer, H.: Uber die elastischen Eigenschwingungen endlicher Korper. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 19, 24-61. 1966 Barr, A. D. S.: An extension of the Uu-Washizu variational principle in linear elasticity for dynamic problems. J. Appl. Mech. 88, 465. Mikhlin, S. G.: Numerical Realization of Variational Methods [in Russian]. Moscow. (I have not seen this work.) 1967 Colautti, M. P.: Sui problemi variazionali di un corpo elastico incompressibile. Mem. Accad. Lincei (8) 8, 291-343- Lai, P. T.: Potentiels elastiques: Tenseurs de Green et de Neumann. J. Me'can. 6, 211-242. 1968 Cakala, S., Z. Domanski, and H. Milicer-Gruzewska: Construction of the fundamental solution of the system of equations of the static theory of elasticity and the solution of the first boundary value problem for a half space [in Polish]. Zeszyty Nauk. Politech. Warszaw. Mat. No. 14, 151-164. Knops, R. J., and L. E. Payne: Stability in linear elasticity. Int. J. Solids Structures 4, 1233-1242. Lai, P. T.: Elastic potentials and Green's tensor. Parti. Memorial de rArtillerie Francaise 42, 23-96. 1970 Bufler, H.: Erweiterung des Prinzips der virtuellen Verschiebungen und des Prinzips der virtuellen Krafte. Z. Angew. Math. Mech. 50, 104-108. 1971 HlavAcek, I.: On Reissner's variational theorem for boundary values in linear elasticity. Apl. Mat. 16, 109-124. Horgan, CO., and J. K. Knowles: Eigenvalue problems associated with Korn's inequalities. Arch. Rational Mech. Anal. 40, 384-402. Maisonneuve, O.: Sur le principe de Saint-Venant. These, University de Poitiers. 1972 Duvaut, G., and J. L. Lions: Sur les Inequations en Me'canique et en Physique. Paris: Dunod.